]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - etc/NEWS
Mark locate-file as documented.
[gnu-emacs] / etc / NEWS
1 GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2003-05-21
2 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 See the end for copying conditions.
5
6 Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org.
7 For older news, see the file ONEWS
8 You can narrow news to the specific version by calling
9 `view-emacs-news' with a prefix argument or by typing C-u C-h C-n.
10
11 Temporary note:
12 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated.
13 --- means no change in the manuals is called for.
14 When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or ---
15 so we will look at it and add it to the manual.
16
17 \f
18 * Installation Changes in Emacs 22.1
19
20 ---
21 ** Emacs now supports new configure options `--program-prefix',
22 `--program-suffix' and `--program-transform-name' that affect the names of
23 installed programs.
24
25 ---
26 ** Emacs can now be built without sound support.
27
28 ---
29 ** You can build Emacs with Gtk+ widgets by specifying `--with-x-toolkit=gtk'
30 when you run configure. This requires Gtk+ 2.0 or newer. This port
31 provides a way to display multilingual text in menus (with some caveats).
32
33 ---
34 ** The `emacsserver' program has been removed, replaced with Lisp code.
35
36 ---
37 ** By default, Emacs now uses a setgid helper program to update game
38 scores. The directory ${localstatedir}/games/emacs is the normal
39 place for game scores to be stored. You can control this with the
40 configure option `--with-game-dir'. The specific user that Emacs uses
41 to own the game scores is controlled by `--with-game-user'. If access
42 to a game user is not available, then scores will be stored separately
43 in each user's home directory.
44
45 ---
46 ** Leim is now part of the Emacs distribution.
47 You no longer need to download a separate tarball in order to build
48 Emacs with Leim.
49
50 +++
51 ** The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual is now part of the distribution.
52
53 The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual in Info format is built as part of the
54 Emacs build procedure and installed together with the Emacs User
55 Manual. A menu item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy
56 accessible (Help->More Manuals->Emacs Lisp Reference).
57
58 ---
59 ** The Introduction to Programming in Emacs Lisp manual is now part of
60 the distribution.
61
62 This manual is now part of the standard distribution and is installed,
63 together with the Emacs User Manual, into the Info directory. A menu
64 item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy accessible
65 (Help->More Manuals->Introduction to Emacs Lisp).
66
67 ---
68 ** New translations of the Emacs Tutorial are available in the
69 following languages: Brasilian Portuguese, Bulgarian, Chinese (both
70 with simplified and traditional characters), French, and Italian.
71 Type `C-u C-h t' to choose one of them in case your language setup
72 doesn't automatically select the right one.
73
74 ---
75 ** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available.
76
77 ---
78 ** Emacs now includes support for loading image libraries on demand.
79 (Currently this feature is only used on MS Windows.) You can configure
80 the supported image types and their associated dynamic libraries by
81 setting the variable `image-library-alist'.
82
83 ---
84 ** Support for Cygwin was added.
85
86 ---
87 ** Support for FreeBSD/Alpha has been added.
88
89 ---
90 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on S390 machines was added.
91
92 ---
93 ** Support for MacOS X was added.
94 See the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
95
96 ---
97 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on X86-64 machines was added.
98
99 ---
100 ** Mac OS 9 port now uses the Carbon API by default. You can also
101 create non-Carbon build by specifying `NonCarbon' as a target. See
102 the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
103
104 ---
105 ** Building with -DENABLE_CHECKING does not automatically build with union
106 types any more. Add -DUSE_LISP_UNION_TYPE if you want union types.
107
108 ---
109 ** When pure storage overflows while dumping, Emacs now prints how
110 much pure storage it will approximately need.
111 \f
112 * Startup Changes in Emacs 22.1
113
114 ** New command line option -Q or --quick.
115 This is like using -q --no-site-file, but in addition it also disables
116 the fancy startup screen.
117
118 +++
119 ** New command line option -D or --basic-display.
120 Disables the menu-bar, the tool-bar, the scroll-bars, tool tips, and
121 the blinking cursor.
122
123 +++
124 ** New command line option -nbc or --no-blinking-cursor disables
125 the blinking cursor on graphical terminals.
126
127 +++
128 ** The option --script FILE runs Emacs in batch mode and loads FILE.
129 It is useful for writing Emacs Lisp shell script files, because they
130 can start with this line:
131
132 #!/usr/bin/emacs --script
133
134 +++
135 ** The option --directory DIR now modifies `load-path' immediately.
136 Directories are added to the front of `load-path' in the order they
137 appear on the command line. For example, with this command line:
138
139 emacs -batch -L .. -L /tmp --eval "(require 'foo)"
140
141 Emacs looks for library `foo' in the parent directory, then in /tmp, then
142 in the other directories in `load-path'. (-L is short for --directory.)
143
144 +++
145 ** The command line option --no-windows has been changed to
146 --no-window-system. The old one still works, but is deprecated.
147
148 +++
149 ** The -f option, used from the command line to call a function,
150 now reads arguments for the function interactively if it is
151 an interactively callable function.
152
153 +++
154 ** When you specify a frame size with --geometry, the size applies to
155 all frames you create. A position specified with --geometry only
156 affects the initial frame.
157
158 +++
159 ** Emacs can now be invoked in full-screen mode on a windowed display.
160 When Emacs is invoked on a window system, the new command-line options
161 `--fullwidth', `--fullheight', and `--fullscreen' produce a frame
162 whose width, height, or both width and height take up the entire
163 screen size. (For now, this does not work with some window managers.)
164
165 +++
166 ** Emacs now displays a splash screen by default even if command-line
167 arguments were given. The new command-line option --no-splash
168 disables the splash screen; see also the variable
169 `inhibit-startup-message' (which is also aliased as
170 `inhibit-splash-screen').
171
172 +++
173 ** New user option `inhibit-startup-buffer-menu'.
174 When loading many files, for instance with `emacs *', Emacs normally
175 displays a buffer menu. This option turns the buffer menu off.
176
177 +++
178 ** Init file changes
179 You can now put the init files .emacs and .emacs_SHELL under
180 ~/.emacs.d or directly under ~. Emacs will find them in either place.
181
182 +++
183 ** Emacs now reads the standard abbrevs file ~/.abbrev_defs
184 automatically at startup, if it exists. When Emacs offers to save
185 modified buffers, it saves the abbrevs too if they have changed. It
186 can do this either silently or asking for confirmation first,
187 according to the value of `save-abbrevs'.
188 \f
189 * Incompatible Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
190
191 +++
192 ** M-g is now a prefix key.
193 M-g g and M-g M-g run goto-line.
194 M-g n and M-g M-n run next-error (like C-x `).
195 M-g p and M-g M-p run previous-error.
196
197 +++
198 ** C-u M-g M-g switches to the most recent previous buffer,
199 and goes to the specified line in that buffer.
200
201 When goto-line starts to execute, if there's a number in the buffer at
202 point then it acts as the default argument for the minibuffer.
203
204 +++
205 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
206 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
207 the operating system or your X server.
208
209 +++
210 ** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
211
212 +++
213 ** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
214 (beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs discards it and warns
215 you about it.
216
217 +++
218 ** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
219 in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
220
221 +++
222 ** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
223 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
224 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
225
226 +++
227 ** The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
228 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
229
230 +++
231 ** In incremental search, C-w is changed. M-%, C-M-w and C-M-y are special.
232
233 See below under "incremental search changes".
234
235 ---
236 ** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
237
238 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
239 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
240 directory with Dired.
241
242 +++
243 ** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
244 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
245 it remains unchanged.
246
247 +++
248 ** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
249 M-o M-o requests refontification.
250
251 +++
252 ** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
253
254 See below for more details.
255
256 +++
257 ** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
258 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
259 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
260 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
261 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
262 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
263 \f
264 * Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
265
266 +++
267 ** The max size of buffers and integers has been doubled.
268 On 32bit machines, it is now 256M (i.e. 268435455).
269
270 +++
271 ** M-g is now a prefix key.
272 M-g g and M-g M-g run goto-line.
273 M-g n and M-g M-n run next-error (like C-x `).
274 M-g p and M-g M-p run previous-error.
275
276 +++
277 ** C-u M-g M-g switches to the most recent previous buffer,
278 and goes to the specified line in that buffer.
279
280 When goto-line starts to execute, if there's a number in the buffer at
281 point then it acts as the default argument for the minibuffer.
282
283 +++
284 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
285 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
286 the operating system or your X server.
287
288 +++
289 ** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
290
291 +++
292 ** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
293 (beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs discards it and warns
294 you about it.
295
296 +++
297 ** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
298 in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
299
300 +++
301 ** You can now switch buffers in a cyclic order with C-x C-left and
302 (prev-buffer) and C-x C-right (next-buffer). C-x left and C-x right
303 can be used as well.
304
305 +++
306 ** `undo-only' does an undo which does not redo any previous undo.
307
308 +++
309 ** M-SPC (just-one-space) when given a numeric argument N
310 converts whitespace around point to N spaces.
311
312 ---
313 ** New commands to operate on pairs of open and close characters:
314 `insert-pair', `delete-pair', `raise-sexp'.
315
316 ---
317 ** New command `kill-whole-line' kills an entire line at once.
318 By default, it is bound to C-S-<backspace>.
319
320 +++
321 ** Yanking text now discards certain text properties that can
322 be inconvenient when you did not expect them. The variable
323 `yank-excluded-properties' specifies which ones. Insertion
324 of register contents and rectangles also discards these properties.
325
326 +++
327 ** The default values of paragraph-start and indent-line-function have
328 been changed to reflect those used in Text mode rather than those used
329 in Indented-Text mode.
330
331 +++
332 ** M-x setenv now expands environment variable references.
333
334 Substrings of the form `$foo' and `${foo}' in the specified new value
335 now refer to the value of environment variable foo. To include a `$'
336 in the value, use `$$'.
337
338 +++
339 ** `special-display-buffer-names' and `special-display-regexps' now
340 understand two new boolean pseudo-frame-parameters `same-frame' and
341 `same-window'.
342
343 +++
344 ** The default for the paper size (variable ps-paper-type) is taken
345 from the locale.
346
347 ** Mark command changes:
348
349 +++
350 *** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
351 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
352 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
353
354 +++
355 *** Marking commands extend the region when invoked multiple times.
356
357 If you type C-M-SPC (mark-sexp), M-@ (mark-word), M-h
358 (mark-paragraph), or C-M-h (mark-defun) repeatedly, the marked region
359 extends each time, so you can mark the next two sexps with M-C-SPC
360 M-C-SPC, for example. This feature also works for
361 mark-end-of-sentence, if you bind that to a key. It also extends the
362 region when the mark is active in Transient Mark mode, regardless of
363 the last command. To start a new region with one of marking commands
364 in Transient Mark mode, you can deactivate the active region with C-g,
365 or set the new mark with C-SPC.
366
367 +++
368 *** M-h (mark-paragraph) now accepts a prefix arg.
369
370 With positive arg, M-h marks the current and the following paragraphs;
371 if the arg is negative, it marks the current and the preceding
372 paragraphs.
373
374 +++
375 *** Some commands do something special in Transient Mark mode when the
376 mark is active--for instance, they limit their operation to the
377 region. Even if you don't normally use Transient Mark mode, you might
378 want to get this behavior from a particular command. There are two
379 ways you can enable Transient Mark mode and activate the mark, for one
380 command only.
381
382 One method is to type C-SPC C-SPC; this enables Transient Mark mode
383 and sets the mark at point. The other method is to type C-u C-x C-x.
384 This enables Transient Mark mode temporarily but does not alter the
385 mark or the region.
386
387 After these commands, Transient Mark mode remains enabled until you
388 deactivate the mark. That typically happens when you type a command
389 that alters the buffer, but you can also deactivate the mark by typing
390 C-g.
391
392 +++
393 *** Movement commands `beginning-of-buffer', `end-of-buffer',
394 `beginning-of-defun', `end-of-defun' do not set the mark if the mark
395 is already active in Transient Mark mode.
396
397 ** Help command changes:
398
399 +++
400 *** Changes in C-h bindings:
401
402 C-h e displays the *Messages* buffer.
403
404 C-h followed by a control character is used for displaying files
405 that do not change:
406
407 C-h C-f displays the FAQ.
408 C-h C-e displays the PROBLEMS file.
409
410 The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
411 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
412
413 C-h c, C-h k, C-h w, and C-h f now handle remapped interactive commands.
414
415 - C-h c and C-h k report the actual command (after possible remapping)
416 run by the key sequence.
417
418 - C-h w and C-h f on a command which has been remapped now report the
419 command it is remapped to, and the keys which can be used to run
420 that command.
421
422 For example, if C-k is bound to kill-line, and kill-line is remapped
423 to new-kill-line, these commands now report:
424
425 - C-h c and C-h k C-k reports:
426 C-k runs the command new-kill-line
427
428 - C-h w and C-h f kill-line reports:
429 kill-line is remapped to new-kill-line which is on C-k, <deleteline>
430
431 - C-h w and C-h f new-kill-line reports:
432 new-kill-line is on C-k
433
434 ---
435 *** Help commands `describe-function' and `describe-key' now show function
436 arguments in lowercase italics on displays that support it. To change the
437 default, customize face `help-argument-name' or redefine the function
438 `help-default-arg-highlight'.
439
440 +++
441 *** C-h v and C-h f commands now include a hyperlink to the C source for
442 variables and functions defined in C (if the C source is available).
443
444 +++
445 *** Help mode now only makes hyperlinks for faces when the face name is
446 preceded or followed by the word `face'. It no longer makes
447 hyperlinks for variables without variable documentation, unless
448 preceded by one of the words `variable' or `option'. It now makes
449 hyperlinks to Info anchors (or nodes) if the anchor (or node) name is
450 enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `info anchor' or `Info
451 anchor' (in addition to earlier `info node' and `Info node').
452
453 +++
454 *** The new command `describe-char' (C-u C-x =) pops up a buffer with
455 description various information about a character, including its
456 encodings and syntax, its text properties, how to input, overlays, and
457 widgets at point. You can get more information about some of them, by
458 clicking on mouse-sensitive areas or moving there and pressing RET.
459
460 +++
461 *** The command `list-text-properties-at' has been deleted because
462 C-u C-x = gives the same information and more.
463
464 +++
465 *** New command `display-local-help' displays any local help at point
466 in the echo area. It is bound to `C-h .'. It normally displays the
467 same string that would be displayed on mouse-over using the
468 `help-echo' property, but, in certain cases, it can display a more
469 keyboard oriented alternative.
470
471 +++
472 *** New user option `help-at-pt-display-when-idle' allows to
473 automatically show the help provided by `display-local-help' on
474 point-over, after suitable idle time. The amount of idle time is
475 determined by the user option `help-at-pt-timer-delay' and defaults
476 to one second. This feature is turned off by default.
477
478 +++
479 *** The apropos commands now accept a list of words to match.
480 When more than one word is specified, at least two of those words must
481 be present for an item to match. Regular expression matching is still
482 available.
483
484 +++
485 *** The new option `apropos-sort-by-scores' causes the matching items
486 to be sorted according to their score. The score for an item is a
487 number calculated to indicate how well the item matches the words or
488 regular expression that you entered to the apropos command. The best
489 match is listed first, and the calculated score is shown for each
490 matching item.
491
492 ** Incremental Search changes:
493
494 +++
495 *** Vertical scrolling is now possible within incremental search.
496 To enable this feature, customize the new user option
497 `isearch-allow-scroll'. User written commands which satisfy stringent
498 constraints can be marked as "scrolling commands". See the Emacs manual
499 for details.
500
501 +++
502 *** C-w in incremental search now grabs either a character or a word,
503 making the decision in a heuristic way. This new job is done by the
504 command `isearch-yank-word-or-char'. To restore the old behavior,
505 bind C-w to `isearch-yank-word' in `isearch-mode-map'.
506
507 +++
508 *** C-y in incremental search now grabs the next line if point is already
509 at the end of a line.
510
511 +++
512 *** C-M-w deletes and C-M-y grabs a character in isearch mode.
513 Another method to grab a character is to enter the minibuffer by `M-e'
514 and to type `C-f' at the end of the search string in the minibuffer.
515
516 +++
517 *** M-% typed in isearch mode invokes `query-replace' or
518 `query-replace-regexp' (depending on search mode) with the current
519 search string used as the string to replace.
520
521 +++
522 *** Isearch no longer adds `isearch-resume' commands to the command
523 history by default. To enable this feature, customize the new
524 user option `isearch-resume-in-command-history'.
525
526 ** Replace command changes:
527
528 ---
529 *** New user option `query-replace-skip-read-only': when non-nil,
530 `query-replace' and related functions simply ignore
531 a match if part of it has a read-only property.
532
533 +++
534 *** When used interactively, the commands `query-replace-regexp' and
535 `replace-regexp' allow \,expr to be used in a replacement string,
536 where expr is an arbitrary Lisp expression evaluated at replacement
537 time. In many cases, this will be more convenient than using
538 `query-replace-regexp-eval'. `\#' in a replacement string now refers
539 to the count of replacements already made by the replacement command.
540 All regular expression replacement commands now allow `\?' in the
541 replacement string to specify a position where the replacement string
542 can be edited for each replacement.
543
544 +++
545 *** query-replace uses isearch lazy highlighting when the new user option
546 `query-replace-lazy-highlight' is non-nil.
547
548 ---
549 *** The current match in query-replace is highlighted in new face
550 `query-replace' which by default inherits from isearch face.
551
552 ** File operation changes:
553
554 +++
555 *** Unquoted `$' in file names do not signal an error any more when
556 the corresponding environment variable does not exist.
557 Instead, the `$ENVVAR' text is left as is, so that `$$' quoting
558 is only rarely needed.
559
560 +++
561 *** In processing a local variables list, Emacs strips the prefix and
562 suffix are from every line before processing all the lines.
563
564 +++
565 *** find-file-read-only visits multiple files in read-only mode,
566 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
567
568 +++
569 *** find-alternate-file replaces the current file with multiple files,
570 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
571
572 +++
573 *** Auto Compression mode is now enabled by default.
574
575 ---
576 *** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
577
578 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
579 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
580 directory with Dired.
581
582 +++
583 *** When you are root, and you visit a file whose modes specify
584 read-only, the Emacs buffer is now read-only too. Type C-x C-q if you
585 want to make the buffer writable. (As root, you can in fact alter the
586 file.)
587
588 +++
589 *** C-x s (save-some-buffers) now offers an option `d' to diff a buffer
590 against its file, so you can see what changes you would be saving.
591
592 +++
593 *** The commands copy-file, rename-file, make-symbolic-link and
594 add-name-to-file, when given a directory as the "new name" argument,
595 convert it to a file name by merging in the within-directory part of
596 the existing file's name. (This is the same convention that shell
597 commands cp, mv, and ln follow.) Thus, M-x copy-file RET ~/foo RET
598 /tmp RET copies ~/foo to /tmp/foo.
599
600 ---
601 *** When used interactively, `format-write-file' now asks for confirmation
602 before overwriting an existing file, unless a prefix argument is
603 supplied. This behavior is analogous to `write-file'.
604
605 ---
606 *** The variable `auto-save-file-name-transforms' now has a third element that
607 controls whether or not the function `make-auto-save-file-name' will
608 attempt to construct a unique auto-save name (e.g. for remote files).
609
610 +++
611 *** If the user visits a file larger than `large-file-warning-threshold',
612 Emacs asks for confirmation.
613
614 +++
615 *** require-final-newline now has two new possible values:
616
617 `visit' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's needed
618 when visiting the file.
619
620 `visit-save' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's
621 needed when visiting the file, and also add a newline if it's needed
622 when saving the file.
623
624 +++
625 *** The new option mode-require-final-newline controls how certain
626 major modes enable require-final-newline. Any major mode that's
627 designed for a kind of file that should normally end in a newline
628 sets require-final-newline based on mode-require-final-newline.
629 So you can customize mode-require-final-newline to control what these
630 modes do.
631
632 ** Minibuffer changes:
633
634 +++
635 *** There's a new face `minibuffer-prompt'.
636 Emacs adds this face to the list of text properties stored in the
637 variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', which is used to display the
638 prompt string.
639
640 ---
641 *** Enhanced visual feedback in `*Completions*' buffer.
642
643 Completions lists use faces to highlight what all completions
644 have in common and where they begin to differ.
645
646 The common prefix shared by all possible completions uses the face
647 `completions-common-part', while the first character that isn't the
648 same uses the face `completions-first-difference'. By default,
649 `completions-common-part' inherits from `default', and
650 `completions-first-difference' inherits from `bold'. The idea of
651 `completions-common-part' is that you can use it to make the common
652 parts less visible than normal, so that the rest of the differing
653 parts is, by contrast, slightly highlighted.
654
655 +++
656 *** File-name completion can now ignore specified directories.
657 If an element of the list in `completion-ignored-extensions' ends in a
658 slash `/', it indicates a subdirectory that should be ignored when
659 completing file names. Elements of `completion-ignored-extensions'
660 which do not end in a slash are never considered when a completion
661 candidate is a directory.
662
663 +++
664 *** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
665 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
666 it remains unchanged.
667
668 +++
669 *** New user option `history-delete-duplicates'.
670 If set to t when adding a new history element, all previous identical
671 elements are deleted.
672
673 ** Redisplay changes:
674
675 +++
676 *** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode.
677 When the file is maintained under version control, that information
678 appears between the position information and the major mode.
679
680 +++
681 *** New face `escape-glyph' highlights control characters and escape glyphs.
682
683 +++
684 *** Non-breaking space and hyphens are now prefixed with an escape
685 character, unless the new user variable `show-nonbreak-escape' is set
686 to nil.
687
688 +++
689 *** The parameters of automatic hscrolling can now be customized.
690 The variable `hscroll-margin' determines how many columns away from
691 the window edge point is allowed to get before automatic hscrolling
692 will horizontally scroll the window. The default value is 5.
693
694 The variable `hscroll-step' determines how many columns automatic
695 hscrolling scrolls the window when point gets too close to the
696 window edge. If its value is zero, the default, Emacs scrolls the
697 window so as to center point. If its value is an integer, it says how
698 many columns to scroll. If the value is a floating-point number, it
699 gives the fraction of the window's width to scroll the window.
700
701 The variable `automatic-hscrolling' was renamed to
702 `auto-hscroll-mode'. The old name is still available as an alias.
703
704 *** Moving or scrolling through images (and other lines) taller that
705 the window now works sensibly, by automatically adjusting the window's
706 vscroll property.
707
708 +++
709 *** The new face `mode-line-inactive' is used to display the mode line
710 of non-selected windows. The `mode-line' face is now used to display
711 the mode line of the currently selected window.
712
713 The new variable `mode-line-in-non-selected-windows' controls whether
714 the `mode-line-inactive' face is used.
715
716 +++
717 *** You can now customize the use of window fringes. To control this
718 for all frames, use M-x fringe-mode or the Show/Hide submenu of the
719 top-level Options menu, or customize the `fringe-mode' variable. To
720 control this for a specific frame, use the command M-x
721 set-fringe-style.
722
723 +++
724 *** Angle icons in the fringes can indicate the buffer boundaries. In
725 addition, up and down arrow bitmaps in the fringe indicate which ways
726 the window can be scrolled.
727
728 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
729 `indicate-buffer-boundaries' to a non-nil value. The default value of
730 this variable is found in `default-indicate-buffer-boundaries'.
731
732 If value is `left' or `right', both angle and arrow bitmaps are
733 displayed in the left or right fringe, resp.
734
735 The value can also be an alist which specifies the presense and
736 position of each bitmap individually.
737
738 For example, ((top . left) (t . right)) places the top angle bitmap
739 in left fringe, the bottom angle bitmap in right fringe, and both
740 arrow bitmaps in right fringe. To show just the angle bitmaps in the
741 left fringe, but no arrow bitmaps, use ((top . left) (bottom . left)).
742
743 +++
744 *** On window systems, lines which are exactly as wide as the window
745 (not counting the final newline character) are no longer broken into
746 two lines on the display (with just the newline on the second line).
747 Instead, the newline now "overflows" into the right fringe, and the
748 cursor will be displayed in the fringe when positioned on that newline.
749
750 The new user option 'overflow-newline-into-fringe' can be set to nil to
751 revert to the old behavior of continuing such lines.
752
753 +++
754 *** When a window has display margin areas, the fringes are now
755 displayed between the margins and the buffer's text area, rather than
756 outside those margins.
757
758 +++
759 *** A window can now have individual fringe and scroll-bar settings,
760 in addition to the individual display margin settings.
761
762 Such individual settings are now preserved when windows are split
763 horizontally or vertically, a saved window configuration is restored,
764 or when the frame is resized.
765
766 ** Cursor display changes:
767
768 +++
769 *** On X, MS Windows, and Mac OS, the blinking cursor's "off" state is
770 now controlled by the variable `blink-cursor-alist'.
771
772 +++
773 *** The X resource cursorBlink can be used to turn off cursor blinking.
774
775 +++
776 *** Emacs can produce an underscore-like (horizontal bar) cursor.
777 The underscore cursor is set by putting `(cursor-type . hbar)' in
778 default-frame-alist. It supports variable heights, like the `bar'
779 cursor does.
780
781 +++
782 *** Display of hollow cursors now obeys the buffer-local value (if any)
783 of `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' in the buffer that the cursor
784 appears in.
785
786 +++
787 *** The variable `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' can now be set to any
788 of the recognized cursor types.
789
790 ** Font-Lock changes:
791
792 +++
793 *** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
794 M-o M-o requests refontification.
795
796 +++
797 *** All modes now support using M-x font-lock-mode to toggle
798 fontification, even those such as Occur, Info, and comint-derived
799 modes that do their own fontification in a special way.
800
801 The variable `Info-fontify' is no longer applicable; to disable
802 fontification in Info, remove `turn-on-font-lock' from
803 `Info-mode-hook'.
804
805 +++
806 *** font-lock-lines-before specifies a number of lines before the
807 current line that should be refontified when you change the buffer.
808 The default value is 1.
809
810 +++
811 *** font-lock: in modes like C and Lisp where the fontification assumes that
812 an open-paren in column 0 is always outside of any string or comment,
813 font-lock now highlights any such open-paren-in-column-zero in bold-red
814 if it is inside a string or a comment, to indicate that it can cause
815 trouble with fontification and/or indentation.
816
817 +++
818 *** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-preprocessor-face'.
819
820 *** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-comment-delimiter-face'.
821
822 *** Easy to overlook single character negation can now be font-locked.
823 You can use the new variable `font-lock-negation-char-face' and the face of
824 the same name to customize this. Currently the cc-modes, sh-script-mode,
825 cperl-mode and make-mode support this.
826
827 ---
828 *** The default settings for JIT stealth lock parameters are changed.
829 The default value for the user option jit-lock-stealth-time is now 16
830 instead of 3, and the default value of jit-lock-stealth-nice is now
831 0.5 instead of 0.125. The new defaults should lower the CPU usage
832 when Emacs is fontifying in the background.
833
834 ---
835 *** jit-lock can now be delayed with `jit-lock-defer-time'.
836
837 If this variable is non-nil, its value should be the amount of Emacs
838 idle time in seconds to wait before starting fontification. For
839 example, if you set `jit-lock-defer-time' to 0.25, fontification will
840 only happen after 0.25s of idle time.
841
842 ---
843 *** contextual refontification is now separate from stealth fontification.
844
845 jit-lock-defer-contextually is renamed jit-lock-contextually and
846 jit-lock-context-time determines the delay after which contextual
847 refontification takes place.
848
849 ** Menu support:
850
851 ---
852 *** A menu item "Show/Hide" was added to the top-level menu "Options".
853 This menu allows you to turn various display features on and off (such
854 as the fringes, the tool bar, the speedbar, and the menu bar itself).
855 You can also move the vertical scroll bar to either side here or turn
856 it off completely. There is also a menu-item to toggle displaying of
857 current date and time, current line and column number in the
858 mode-line.
859
860 ---
861 *** Speedbar has moved from the "Tools" top level menu to "Show/Hide".
862
863 ---
864 *** You can exit dialog windows and menus by typing C-g.
865
866 ---
867 *** The menu item "Open File..." has been split into two items, "New File..."
868 and "Open File...". "Open File..." now opens only existing files. This is
869 to support existing GUI file selection dialogs better.
870
871 +++
872 *** The file selection dialog for Gtk+, Mac, W32 and Motif/Lesstif can be
873 disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'.
874
875 ---
876 *** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can
877 be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+, Mac and W32).
878
879 +++
880 *** The Lucid menus can display multilingual text in your locale. You have
881 to explicitly specify a fontSet resource for this to work, for example
882 `-xrm "Emacs*fontSet: -*-helvetica-medium-r-*--*-120-*-*-*-*-*-*,*"'.
883
884 ---
885 *** Dialogs for Lucid/Athena and Lesstif/Motif now pops down when pressing
886 ESC, like they do for Gtk+, Mac and W32.
887
888 +++
889 *** For Gtk+ version 2.4, you can make Emacs use the old file dialog
890 by setting the variable `x-use-old-gtk-file-dialog' to t. Default is to use
891 the new dialog.
892
893 ** Mouse changes:
894
895 +++
896 *** New display feature: focus follows the mouse from one Emacs window
897 to another, even within a frame. If you set the variable
898 mouse-autoselect-window to non-nil value, moving the mouse to a
899 different Emacs window will select that window (minibuffer window can
900 be selected only when it is active). The default is nil, so that this
901 feature is not enabled.
902
903 +++
904 *** On X, when the window manager requires that you click on a frame to
905 select it (give it focus), the selected window and cursor position
906 normally changes according to the mouse click position. If you set
907 the variable x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position to t, the selected
908 window and cursor position do not change when you click on a frame
909 to give it focus.
910
911 +++
912 *** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
913
914 Traditionally, Emacs uses a Mouse-1 click to set point and a Mouse-2
915 click to follow a link, whereas most other applications use a Mouse-1
916 click for both purposes, depending on whether you click outside or
917 inside a link. Now the behavior of a Mouse-1 click has been changed
918 to match this context-sentitive dual behavior. (If you prefer the old
919 behavior, set the user option `mouse-1-click-follows-link' to nil.)
920
921 Depending on the current mode, a Mouse-2 click in Emacs can do much
922 more than just follow a link, so the new Mouse-1 behavior is only
923 activated for modes which explicitly mark a clickable text as a "link"
924 (see the new function `mouse-on-link-p' for details). The Lisp
925 packages that are included in release 22.1 have been adapted to do
926 this, but external packages may not yet support this. However, there
927 is no risk in using such packages, as the worst thing that could
928 happen is that you get the original Mouse-1 behavior when you click
929 on a link, which typically means that you set point where you click.
930
931 If you want to get the original Mouse-1 action also inside a link, you
932 just need to press the Mouse-1 button a little longer than a normal
933 click (i.e. press and hold the Mouse-1 button for half a second before
934 you release it).
935
936 Dragging the Mouse-1 inside a link still performs the original
937 drag-mouse-1 action, typically copy the text.
938
939 You can customize the new Mouse-1 behavior via the new user options
940 `mouse-1-click-follows-link' and `mouse-1-click-in-non-selected-windows'.
941
942 +++
943 *** Emacs normally highlights mouse sensitive text whenever the mouse
944 is over the text. By setting the new variable `mouse-highlight', you
945 can optionally enable mouse highlighting only after you move the
946 mouse, so that highlighting disappears when you press a key. You can
947 also disable mouse highlighting.
948
949 +++
950 *** You can now customize if selecting a region by dragging the mouse
951 shall not copy the selected text to the kill-ring by setting the new
952 variable mouse-drag-copy-region to nil.
953
954 ---
955 *** mouse-wheels can now scroll a specific fraction of the window
956 (rather than a fixed number of lines) and the scrolling is `progressive'.
957
958 ---
959 *** Emacs ignores mouse-2 clicks while the mouse wheel is being moved.
960
961 People tend to push the mouse wheel (which counts as a mouse-2 click)
962 unintentionally while turning the wheel, so these clicks are now
963 ignored. You can customize this with the mouse-wheel-click-event and
964 mouse-wheel-inhibit-click-time variables.
965
966 +++
967 *** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default.
968
969 ** Mule changes:
970
971 ---
972 *** Language environment and various default coding systems are setup
973 more correctly according to the current locale name. If the locale
974 name doesn't specify a charset, the default is what glibc defines.
975 This change can result in using the different coding systems as
976 default in some locale (e.g. vi_VN).
977
978 +++
979 *** The keyboard-coding-system is now automatically set based on your
980 current locale settings if you are not using a window system. This
981 can mean that the META key doesn't work but generates non-ASCII
982 characters instead, depending on how the terminal (or terminal
983 emulator) works. Use `set-keyboard-coding-system' (or customize
984 keyboard-coding-system) if you prefer META to work (the old default)
985 or if the locale doesn't describe the character set actually generated
986 by the keyboard. See Info node `Single-Byte Character Support'.
987
988 +++
989 *** The new command `revert-buffer-with-coding-system' (C-x RET r)
990 revisits the current file using a coding system that you specify.
991
992 +++
993 *** New command `recode-region' decodes the region again by a specified
994 coding system.
995
996 +++
997 *** The new command `recode-file-name' changes the encoding of the name
998 of a file.
999
1000 ---
1001 *** New command `ucs-insert' inserts a character specified by its
1002 unicode.
1003
1004 +++
1005 *** The new command `set-file-name-coding-system' (C-x RET F) sets
1006 coding system for encoding and decoding file names. A new menu item
1007 (Options->Mule->Set Coding Systems->For File Name) invokes this
1008 command.
1009
1010 +++
1011 *** New command quail-show-key shows what key (or key sequence) to type
1012 in the current input method to input a character at point.
1013
1014 +++
1015 *** Limited support for character `unification' has been added.
1016 Emacs now knows how to translate between different representations of
1017 the same characters in various Emacs charsets according to standard
1018 Unicode mappings. This applies mainly to characters in the ISO 8859
1019 sets plus some other 8-bit sets, but can be extended. For instance,
1020 translation works amongst the Emacs ...-iso8859-... charsets and the
1021 mule-unicode-... ones.
1022
1023 By default this translation happens automatically on encoding.
1024 Self-inserting characters are translated to make the input conformant
1025 with the encoding of the buffer in which it's being used, where
1026 possible.
1027
1028 You can force a more complete unification with the user option
1029 unify-8859-on-decoding-mode. That maps all the Latin-N character sets
1030 into Unicode characters (from the latin-iso8859-1 and
1031 mule-unicode-0100-24ff charsets) on decoding. Note that this mode
1032 will often effectively clobber data with an iso-2022 encoding.
1033
1034 ---
1035 *** There is support for decoding Greek and Cyrillic characters into
1036 either Unicode (the mule-unicode charsets) or the iso-8859 charsets,
1037 when possible. The latter are more space-efficient. This is
1038 controlled by user option utf-fragment-on-decoding.
1039
1040 ---
1041 *** New language environments: French, Ukrainian, Tajik,
1042 Bulgarian, Belarusian, Ukrainian, UTF-8, Windows-1255, Welsh, Latin-6,
1043 Latin-7, Lithuanian, Latvian, Swedish, Slovenian, Croatian, Georgian,
1044 Italian, Russian, Malayalam, Tamil, Russian, Chinese-EUC-TW. (Set up
1045 automatically according to the locale.)
1046
1047 ---
1048 *** New input methods: latin-alt-postfix, latin-postfix, latin-prefix,
1049 ukrainian-computer, belarusian, bulgarian-bds, russian-computer,
1050 vietnamese-telex, lithuanian-numeric, lithuanian-keyboard,
1051 latvian-keyboard, welsh, georgian, rfc1345, ucs, sgml,
1052 bulgarian-phonetic, dutch, slovenian, croatian, malayalam-inscript,
1053 tamil-inscript.
1054
1055 ---
1056 *** New input method chinese-sisheng for inputting Chinese Pinyin
1057 characters.
1058
1059 ---
1060 *** Improved Thai support. A new minor mode `thai-word-mode' (which is
1061 automatically activated if you select Thai as a language
1062 environment) changes key bindings of most word-oriented commands to
1063 versions which recognize Thai words. Affected commands are
1064 M-f (forward-word)
1065 M-b (backward-word)
1066 M-d (kill-word)
1067 M-DEL (backward-kill-word)
1068 M-t (transpose-words)
1069 M-q (fill-paragraph)
1070
1071 ---
1072 *** Indian support has been updated.
1073 The in-is13194 coding system is now Unicode-based. CDAC fonts are
1074 assumed. There is a framework for supporting various
1075 Indian scripts, but currently only Devanagari, Malayalam and Tamil are
1076 supported.
1077
1078 ---
1079 *** A UTF-7 coding system is available in the library `utf-7'.
1080
1081 ---
1082 *** The utf-8/16 coding systems have been enhanced.
1083 By default, untranslatable utf-8 sequences are simply composed into
1084 single quasi-characters. User option `utf-translate-cjk-mode' (it is
1085 turned on by default) arranges to translate many utf-8 CJK character
1086 sequences into real Emacs characters in a similar way to the Mule-UCS
1087 system. As this loads a fairly big data on demand, people who are not
1088 interested in CJK characters may want to customize it to nil.
1089 You can augment/amend the CJK translation via hash tables
1090 `ucs-mule-cjk-to-unicode' and `ucs-unicode-to-mule-cjk'. The utf-8
1091 coding system now also encodes characters from most of Emacs's
1092 one-dimensional internal charsets, specifically the ISO-8859 ones.
1093 The utf-16 coding system is affected similarly.
1094
1095 ---
1096 *** A new coding system `euc-tw' has been added for traditional Chinese
1097 in CNS encoding; it accepts both Big 5 and CNS as input; on saving,
1098 Big 5 is then converted to CNS.
1099
1100 ---
1101 *** Many new coding systems are available by loading the `code-pages'
1102 library. These include complete versions of most of those in
1103 codepage.el, based on Unicode mappings. `codepage-setup' is now
1104 obsolete and is used only in the MS-DOS port of Emacs. windows-1252
1105 and windows-1251 are preloaded since the former is so common and the
1106 latter is used by GNU locales.
1107
1108 ---
1109 *** New variable `utf-translate-cjk-unicode-range' controls which
1110 Unicode characters to translate in `utf-translate-cjk-mode'.
1111
1112 ---
1113 *** iso-10646-1 (`Unicode') fonts can be used to display any range of
1114 characters encodable by the utf-8 coding system. Just specify the
1115 fontset appropriately.
1116
1117 ** Customize changes:
1118
1119 +++
1120 *** The commands M-x customize-face and M-x customize-face-other-window
1121 now look at the character after point. If a face or faces are
1122 specified for that character, the commands by default customize those
1123 faces.
1124
1125 ---
1126 *** The face-customization widget has been reworked to be less confusing.
1127 In particular, when you enable a face attribute using the corresponding
1128 check-box, there's no longer a redundant `*' option in value selection
1129 for that attribute; the values you can choose are only those which make
1130 sense for the attribute. When an attribute is de-selected by unchecking
1131 its check-box, then the (now ignored, but still present temporarily in
1132 case you re-select the attribute) value is hidden.
1133
1134 +++
1135 *** When you set or reset a variable's value in a Customize buffer,
1136 the previous value becomes the "backup value" of the variable.
1137 You can go back to that backup value by selecting "Use Backup Value"
1138 under the "[State]" button.
1139
1140 ** Buffer Menu changes:
1141
1142 +++
1143 *** New command `Buffer-menu-toggle-files-only' toggles display of file
1144 buffers only in the Buffer Menu. It is bound to `T' in Buffer Menu
1145 mode.
1146
1147 +++
1148 *** `buffer-menu' and `list-buffers' now list buffers whose names begin
1149 with a space, when those buffers are visiting files. Normally buffers
1150 whose names begin with space are omitted.
1151
1152 ---
1153 *** The new options `buffers-menu-show-directories' and
1154 `buffers-menu-show-status' let you control how buffers are displayed
1155 in the menu dropped down when you click "Buffers" from the menu bar.
1156
1157 `buffers-menu-show-directories' controls whether the menu displays
1158 leading directories as part of the file name visited by the buffer.
1159 If its value is `unless-uniquify', the default, directories are
1160 shown unless uniquify-buffer-name-style' is non-nil. The value of nil
1161 and t turn the display of directories off and on, respectively.
1162
1163 `buffers-menu-show-status' controls whether the Buffers menu includes
1164 the modified and read-only status of the buffers. By default it is
1165 t, and the status is shown.
1166
1167 Setting these variables directly does not take effect until next time
1168 the Buffers menu is regenerated.
1169
1170 ** Dired mode:
1171
1172 ---
1173 *** New faces dired-header, dired-mark, dired-marked, dired-flagged,
1174 dired-ignored, dired-directory, dired-symlink, dired-warning
1175 introduced for Dired mode instead of font-lock faces.
1176
1177 +++
1178 *** New Dired command `dired-compare-directories' marks files
1179 with different file attributes in two dired buffers.
1180
1181 +++
1182 *** New Dired command `dired-do-touch' (bound to T) changes timestamps
1183 of marked files with the value entered in the minibuffer.
1184
1185 +++
1186 *** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
1187 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
1188 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
1189 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
1190 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
1191 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
1192
1193 +++
1194 *** In Dired, the w command now copies the current line's file name
1195 into the kill ring. With a zero prefix arg, copies absolute file names.
1196
1197 +++
1198 *** In Dired-x, Omitting files is now a minor mode, dired-omit-mode.
1199
1200 The mode toggling command is bound to M-o. A new command
1201 dired-mark-omitted, bound to * O, marks omitted files. The variable
1202 dired-omit-files-p is obsoleted, use the mode toggling function
1203 instead.
1204
1205 +++
1206 *** The variables dired-free-space-program and dired-free-space-args
1207 have been renamed to directory-free-space-program and
1208 directory-free-space-args, and they now apply whenever Emacs puts a
1209 directory listing into a buffer.
1210
1211 ** Comint changes:
1212
1213 ---
1214 *** The comint prompt can now be made read-only, using the new user
1215 option `comint-prompt-read-only'. This is not enabled by default,
1216 except in IELM buffers. The read-only status of IELM prompts can be
1217 controlled with the new user option `ielm-prompt-read-only', which
1218 overrides `comint-prompt-read-only'.
1219
1220 The new commands `comint-kill-whole-line' and `comint-kill-region'
1221 support editing comint buffers with read-only prompts.
1222
1223 `comint-kill-whole-line' is like `kill-whole-line', but ignores both
1224 read-only and field properties. Hence, it always kill entire
1225 lines, including any prompts.
1226
1227 `comint-kill-region' is like `kill-region', except that it ignores
1228 read-only properties, if it is safe to do so. This means that if any
1229 part of a prompt is deleted, then the entire prompt must be deleted
1230 and that all prompts must stay at the beginning of a line. If this is
1231 not the case, then `comint-kill-region' behaves just like
1232 `kill-region' if read-only are involved: it copies the text to the
1233 kill-ring, but does not delete it.
1234
1235 +++
1236 *** The new command `comint-insert-previous-argument' in comint-derived
1237 modes (shell-mode etc) inserts arguments from previous command lines,
1238 like bash's `ESC .' binding. It is bound by default to `C-c .', but
1239 otherwise behaves quite similarly to the bash version.
1240
1241 *** `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields' has been renamed
1242 `comint-use-prompt-regexp'. The old name has been kept as an alias,
1243 but declared obsolete.
1244
1245 ** M-x Compile changes:
1246
1247 ---
1248 *** M-x compile has become more robust and reliable
1249
1250 Quite a few more kinds of messages are recognized. Messages that are
1251 recognized as warnings or informational come in orange or green, instead of
1252 red. Informational messages are by default skipped with `next-error'
1253 (controlled by `compilation-skip-threshold').
1254
1255 Location data is collected on the fly as the *compilation* buffer changes.
1256 This means you could modify messages to make them point to different files.
1257 This also means you can not go to locations of messages you may have deleted.
1258
1259 The variable `compilation-error-regexp-alist' has now become customizable. If
1260 you had added your own regexps to this, you'll probably need to include a
1261 leading `^', otherwise they'll match anywhere on a line. There is now also a
1262 `compilation-mode-font-lock-keywords' and it nicely handles all the checks
1263 that configure outputs and -o options so you see at a glance where you are.
1264
1265 The new file etc/compilation.txt gives examples of each type of message.
1266
1267 +++
1268 *** New user option `compilation-environment'.
1269 This option allows you to specify environment variables for inferior
1270 compilation processes without affecting the environment that all
1271 subprocesses inherit.
1272
1273 +++
1274 *** New options `next-error-highlight' and `next-error-highlight-no-select'
1275 specify the method of highlighting of the corresponding source line
1276 in new face `next-error'.
1277
1278 +++
1279 *** A new minor mode `next-error-follow-minor-mode' can be used in
1280 compilation-mode, grep-mode, occur-mode, and diff-mode (i.e. all the
1281 modes that can use `next-error'). In this mode, cursor motion in the
1282 buffer causes automatic display in another window of the corresponding
1283 matches, compilation errors, etc. This minor mode can be toggled with
1284 C-c C-f.
1285
1286 *** When the left fringe is displayed, an arrow points to current message in
1287 the compilation buffer.
1288
1289 *** The new variable `compilation-context-lines' controls lines of leading
1290 context before the current message. If nil and the left fringe is displayed,
1291 it doesn't scroll the compilation output window. If there is no left fringe,
1292 no arrow is displayed and a value of nil means display the message at the top
1293 of the window.
1294
1295 ** Occur mode changes:
1296
1297 +++
1298 *** In the *Occur* buffer, `o' switches to it in another window, and
1299 C-o displays the current line's occurrence in another window without
1300 switching to it.
1301
1302 +++
1303 *** You can now use next-error (C-x `) and previous-error to advance to
1304 the next/previous matching line found by M-x occur.
1305
1306 +++
1307 *** The new command `multi-occur' is just like `occur', except it can
1308 search multiple buffers. There is also a new command
1309 `multi-occur-by-filename-regexp' which allows you to specify the
1310 buffers to search by their filename. Internally, Occur mode has been
1311 rewritten, and now uses font-lock, among other changes.
1312
1313 ** Grep changes:
1314
1315 +++
1316 *** Grep has been decoupled from compilation mode setup.
1317
1318 There's a new separate package grep.el, with its own submenu and
1319 customization group.
1320
1321 ---
1322 *** M-x grep provides highlighting support.
1323
1324 Hits are fontified in green, and hits in binary files in orange. Grep buffers
1325 can be saved and automatically revisited.
1326
1327 +++
1328 *** `grep-find' is now also available under the name `find-grep' where
1329 people knowing `find-grep-dired' would probably expect it.
1330
1331 ---
1332 *** The new variables `grep-window-height', `grep-auto-highlight', and
1333 `grep-scroll-output' override the corresponding compilation mode
1334 settings, for grep commands only.
1335
1336 +++
1337 *** New option `grep-highlight-matches' highlightes matches in *grep*
1338 buffer. It uses a special feature of some grep programs which accept
1339 --color option to output markers around matches. When going to the next
1340 match with `next-error' the exact match is highlighted in the source
1341 buffer. Otherwise, if `grep-highlight-matches' is nil, the whole
1342 source line is highlighted.
1343
1344 +++
1345 *** New key bindings in grep output window:
1346 SPC and DEL scrolls window up and down. C-n and C-p moves to next and
1347 previous match in the grep window. RET jumps to the source line of
1348 the current match. `n' and `p' shows next and previous match in
1349 other window, but does not switch buffer. `{' and `}' jumps to the
1350 previous or next file in the grep output. TAB also jumps to the next
1351 file.
1352
1353 +++
1354 *** M-x grep now tries to avoid appending `/dev/null' to the command line
1355 by using GNU grep `-H' option instead. M-x grep automatically
1356 detects whether this is possible or not the first time it is invoked.
1357 When `-H' is used, the grep command line supplied by the user is passed
1358 unchanged to the system to execute, which allows more complicated
1359 command lines to be used than was possible before.
1360
1361 ** X Windows Support:
1362
1363 +++
1364 *** Emacs now supports drag and drop for X. Dropping a file on a window
1365 opens it, dropping text inserts the text. Dropping a file on a dired
1366 buffer copies or moves the file to that directory.
1367
1368 +++
1369 *** Under X11, it is possible to swap Alt and Meta (and Super and Hyper).
1370 The new variables `x-alt-keysym', `x-hyper-keysym', `x-meta-keysym',
1371 and `x-super-keysym' can be used to choose which keysyms Emacs should
1372 use for the modifiers. For example, the following two lines swap
1373 Meta and Alt:
1374 (setq x-alt-keysym 'meta)
1375 (setq x-meta-keysym 'alt)
1376
1377 +++
1378 *** The X resource useXIM can be used to turn off use of XIM, which can
1379 speed up Emacs with slow networking to the X server.
1380
1381 If the configure option `--without-xim' was used to turn off use of
1382 XIM by default, the X resource useXIM can be used to turn it on.
1383
1384 ---
1385 *** The new variable `x-select-request-type' controls how Emacs
1386 requests X selection. The default value is nil, which means that
1387 Emacs requests X selection with types COMPOUND_TEXT and UTF8_STRING,
1388 and use the more appropriately result.
1389
1390 ---
1391 *** The scrollbar under LessTif or Motif has a smoother drag-scrolling.
1392 On the other hand, the size of the thumb does not represent the actual
1393 amount of text shown any more (only a crude approximation of it).
1394
1395 ** Xterm support:
1396
1397 ---
1398 *** Emacs now responds to mouse-clicks on the mode-line, header-line and
1399 display margin, when run in an xterm.
1400
1401 ---
1402 *** Improved key bindings support when running in an xterm.
1403 When emacs is running in an xterm more key bindings are available. The
1404 following should work:
1405 {C,S,C-S,A}-{right,left,up,down,prior,next,delete,insert,F1-12}.
1406 These key bindings work on xterm from X.org 6.8, they might not work on
1407 some older versions of xterm, or on some proprietary versions.
1408
1409 ** Character terminal color support changes:
1410
1411 +++
1412 *** The new command-line option --color=MODE lets you specify a standard
1413 mode for a tty color support. It is meant to be used on character
1414 terminals whose capabilities are not set correctly in the terminal
1415 database, or with terminal emulators which support colors, but don't
1416 set the TERM environment variable to a name of a color-capable
1417 terminal. "emacs --color" uses the same color commands as GNU `ls'
1418 when invoked with "ls --color", so if your terminal can support colors
1419 in "ls --color", it will support "emacs --color" as well. See the
1420 user manual for the possible values of the MODE parameter.
1421
1422 ---
1423 *** Emacs now supports several character terminals which provide more
1424 than 8 colors. For example, for `xterm', 16-color, 88-color, and
1425 256-color modes are supported. Emacs automatically notes at startup
1426 the extended number of colors, and defines the appropriate entries for
1427 all of these colors.
1428
1429 +++
1430 *** Emacs now uses the full range of available colors for the default
1431 faces when running on a color terminal, including 16-, 88-, and
1432 256-color xterms. This means that when you run "emacs -nw" on an
1433 88-color or 256-color xterm, you will see essentially the same face
1434 colors as on X.
1435
1436 ---
1437 *** There's a new support for colors on `rxvt' terminal emulator.
1438 \f
1439 * New Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1
1440
1441 +++
1442 ** Filesets are collections of files. You can define a fileset in
1443 various ways, such as based on a directory tree or based on
1444 program files that include other program files.
1445
1446 Once you have defined a fileset, you can perform various operations on
1447 all the files in it, such as visiting them or searching and replacing
1448 in them.
1449
1450 +++
1451 ** Calc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1452
1453 Calc is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool written in
1454 Emacs Lisp. Its documentation is in a separate manual; within Emacs,
1455 type "C-h i m calc RET" to read that manual. A reference card is
1456 available in `etc/calccard.tex' and `etc/calccard.ps'.
1457
1458 ---
1459 ** The new package ibuffer provides a powerful, completely
1460 customizable replacement for buff-menu.el.
1461
1462 ---
1463 ** Ido mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1464
1465 The ido (interactively do) package is an extension of the iswitchb
1466 package to do interactive opening of files and directories in addition
1467 to interactive buffer switching. Ido is a superset of iswitchb (with
1468 a few exceptions), so don't enable both packages.
1469
1470 +++
1471 ** Image files are normally visited in Image mode, which lets you toggle
1472 between viewing the image and viewing the text using C-c C-c.
1473
1474 ---
1475 ** CUA mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1476
1477 The new cua package provides CUA-like keybindings using C-x for
1478 cut (kill), C-c for copy, C-v for paste (yank), and C-z for undo.
1479 With cua, the region can be set and extended using shifted movement
1480 keys (like pc-selection-mode) and typed text replaces the active
1481 region (like delete-selection-mode). Do not enable these modes with
1482 cua-mode. Customize the variable `cua-mode' to enable cua.
1483
1484 In addition, cua provides unified rectangle support with visible
1485 rectangle highlighting: Use C-return to start a rectangle, extend it
1486 using the movement commands (or mouse-3), and cut or copy it using C-x
1487 or C-c (using C-w and M-w also works).
1488
1489 Use M-o and M-c to `open' or `close' the rectangle, use M-b or M-f, to
1490 fill it with blanks or another character, use M-u or M-l to upcase or
1491 downcase the rectangle, use M-i to increment the numbers in the
1492 rectangle, use M-n to fill the rectangle with a numeric sequence (such
1493 as 10 20 30...), use M-r to replace a regexp in the rectangle, and use
1494 M-' or M-/ to restrict command on the rectangle to a subset of the
1495 rows. See the commentary in cua-base.el for more rectangle commands.
1496
1497 Cua also provides unified support for registers: Use a numeric
1498 prefix argument between 0 and 9, i.e. M-0 .. M-9, for C-x, C-c, and
1499 C-v to cut or copy into register 0-9, or paste from register 0-9.
1500
1501 The last text deleted (not killed) is automatically stored in
1502 register 0. This includes text deleted by typing text.
1503
1504 Finally, cua provides a global mark which is set using S-C-space.
1505 When the global mark is active, any text which is cut or copied is
1506 automatically inserted at the global mark position. See the
1507 commentary in cua-base.el for more global mark related commands.
1508
1509 The features of cua also works with the standard emacs bindings for
1510 kill, copy, yank, and undo. If you want to use cua mode, but don't
1511 want the C-x, C-c, C-v, and C-z bindings, you can customize the
1512 `cua-enable-cua-keys' variable.
1513
1514 Note: This version of cua mode is not backwards compatible with older
1515 versions of cua.el and cua-mode.el. To ensure proper operation, you
1516 must remove older versions of cua.el or cua-mode.el as well as the
1517 loading and customization of those packages from the .emacs file.
1518
1519 +++
1520 ** The new package dns-mode.el add syntax highlight of DNS master files.
1521 The key binding C-c C-s (`dns-mode-soa-increment-serial') can be used
1522 to increment the SOA serial.
1523
1524 ---
1525 ** The new global minor mode `file-name-shadow-mode' modifies the way
1526 filenames being entered by the user in the minibuffer are displayed, so
1527 that it's clear when part of the entered filename will be ignored due to
1528 emacs' filename parsing rules. The ignored portion can be made dim,
1529 invisible, or otherwise less visually noticable. The display method can
1530 be displayed by customizing the variable `file-name-shadow-properties'.
1531
1532 +++
1533 ** The new package flymake.el does on-the-fly syntax checking of program
1534 source files. See the Flymake's Info manual for more details.
1535
1536 +++
1537 ** The new keypad setup package provides several common bindings for
1538 the numeric keypad which is available on most keyboards. The numeric
1539 keypad typically has the digits 0 to 9, a decimal point, keys marked
1540 +, -, /, and *, an Enter key, and a NumLock toggle key. The keypad
1541 package only controls the use of the digit and decimal keys.
1542
1543 By customizing the variables `keypad-setup', `keypad-shifted-setup',
1544 `keypad-numlock-setup', and `keypad-numlock-shifted-setup', or by
1545 using the function `keypad-setup', you can rebind all digit keys and
1546 the decimal key of the keypad in one step for each of the four
1547 possible combinations of the Shift key state (not pressed/pressed) and
1548 the NumLock toggle state (off/on).
1549
1550 The choices for the keypad keys in each of the above states are:
1551 `Plain numeric keypad' where the keys generates plain digits,
1552 `Numeric keypad with decimal key' where the character produced by the
1553 decimal key can be customized individually (for internationalization),
1554 `Numeric Prefix Arg' where the keypad keys produce numeric prefix args
1555 for emacs editing commands, `Cursor keys' and `Shifted Cursor keys'
1556 where the keys work like (shifted) arrow keys, home/end, etc., and
1557 `Unspecified/User-defined' where the keypad keys (kp-0, kp-1, etc.)
1558 are left unspecified and can be bound individually through the global
1559 or local keymaps.
1560
1561 +++
1562 ** The new kmacro package provides a simpler user interface to
1563 emacs' keyboard macro facilities.
1564
1565 Basically, it uses two function keys (default F3 and F4) like this:
1566 F3 starts a macro, F4 ends the macro, and pressing F4 again executes
1567 the last macro. While defining the macro, F3 inserts a counter value
1568 which automatically increments every time the macro is executed.
1569
1570 There is now a keyboard macro ring which stores the most recently
1571 defined macros.
1572
1573 The C-x C-k sequence is now a prefix for the kmacro keymap which
1574 defines bindings for moving through the keyboard macro ring,
1575 C-x C-k C-p and C-x C-k C-n, editing the last macro C-x C-k C-e,
1576 manipulating the macro counter and format via C-x C-k C-c,
1577 C-x C-k C-a, and C-x C-k C-f. See the commentary in kmacro.el
1578 for more commands.
1579
1580 The normal macro bindings C-x (, C-x ), and C-x e now interfaces to
1581 the keyboard macro ring.
1582
1583 The C-x e command now automatically terminates the current macro
1584 before calling it, if used while defining a macro.
1585
1586 In addition, when ending or calling a macro with C-x e, the macro can
1587 be repeated immediately by typing just the `e'. You can customize
1588 this behavior via the variable kmacro-call-repeat-key and
1589 kmacro-call-repeat-with-arg.
1590
1591 Keyboard macros can now be debugged and edited interactively.
1592 C-x C-k SPC steps through the last keyboard macro one key sequence
1593 at a time, prompting for the actions to take.
1594
1595 ---
1596 ** New minor mode, Visible mode, toggles invisibility in the current buffer.
1597 When enabled, it makes all invisible text visible. When disabled, it
1598 restores the previous value of `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
1599
1600 +++
1601 ** The wdired.el package allows you to use normal editing commands on Dired
1602 buffers to change filenames, permissions, etc...
1603
1604 +++
1605 ** The new package longlines.el provides a minor mode for editing text
1606 files composed of long lines, based on the `use-hard-newlines'
1607 mechanism. The long lines are broken up by inserting soft newlines,
1608 which are automatically removed when saving the file to disk or
1609 copying into the kill ring, clipboard, etc. By default, Longlines
1610 mode inserts soft newlines automatically during editing, a behavior
1611 referred to as "soft word wrap" in other text editors. This is
1612 similar to Refill mode, but more reliable. To turn the word wrap
1613 feature off, set `longlines-auto-wrap' to nil.
1614
1615 ** The printing package is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1616
1617 If you enable the printing package by including (require 'printing) in
1618 the .emacs file, the normal Print item on the File menu is replaced
1619 with a Print sub-menu which allows you to preview output through
1620 ghostview, use ghostscript to print (if you don't have a PostScript
1621 printer) or send directly to printer a PostScript code generated by
1622 `ps-print' package. Use M-x pr-help for more information.
1623
1624 ---
1625 ** The minor mode Reveal mode makes text visible on the fly as you
1626 move your cursor into hidden regions of the buffer.
1627 It should work with any package that uses overlays to hide parts
1628 of a buffer, such as outline-minor-mode, hs-minor-mode, hide-ifdef-mode, ...
1629
1630 There is also Global Reveal mode which affects all buffers.
1631
1632 ---
1633 ** The ruler-mode.el library provides a minor mode for displaying an
1634 "active" ruler in the header line. You can use the mouse to visually
1635 change the `fill-column', `window-margins' and `tab-stop-list'
1636 settings.
1637
1638 +++
1639 ** SES mode (ses-mode) is a new major mode for creating and editing
1640 spreadsheet files. Besides the usual Emacs features (intuitive command
1641 letters, undo, cell formulas in Lisp, plaintext files, etc.) it also offers
1642 viral immunity and import/export of tab-separated values.
1643
1644 +++
1645 ** The new global minor mode `size-indication-mode' (off by default)
1646 shows the size of accessible part of the buffer on the mode line.
1647
1648 +++
1649 ** The new package table.el implements editable, WYSIWYG, embedded
1650 `text tables' in Emacs buffers. It simulates the effect of putting
1651 these tables in a special major mode. The package emulates WYSIWYG
1652 table editing available in modern word processors. The package also
1653 can generate a table source in typesetting and markup languages such
1654 as latex and html from the visually laid out text table.
1655
1656 +++
1657 ** The thumbs.el package allows you to preview image files as thumbnails
1658 and can be invoked from a Dired buffer.
1659
1660 +++
1661 ** Tramp is now part of the distribution.
1662
1663 This package is similar to Ange-FTP: it allows you to edit remote
1664 files. But whereas Ange-FTP uses FTP to access the remote host,
1665 Tramp uses a shell connection. The shell connection is always used
1666 for filename completion and directory listings and suchlike, but for
1667 the actual file transfer, you can choose between the so-called
1668 `inline' methods (which transfer the files through the shell
1669 connection using base64 or uu encoding) and the `out-of-band' methods
1670 (which invoke an external copying program such as `rcp' or `scp' or
1671 `rsync' to do the copying).
1672
1673 Shell connections can be acquired via `rsh', `ssh', `telnet' and also
1674 `su' and `sudo'. Ange-FTP is still supported via the `ftp' method.
1675
1676 If you want to disable Tramp you should set
1677
1678 (setq tramp-default-method "ftp")
1679
1680 ---
1681 ** The URL package (which had been part of W3) is now part of Emacs.
1682
1683 ---
1684 ** `cfengine-mode' is a major mode for editing GNU Cfengine
1685 configuration files.
1686
1687 +++
1688 ** The new package conf-mode.el handles thousands of configuration files, with
1689 varying syntaxes for comments (;, #, //, /* */ or !), assignment (var = value,
1690 var : value, var value or keyword var value) and sections ([section] or
1691 section { }). Many files under /etc/, or with suffixes like .cf through
1692 .config, .properties (Java), .desktop (KDE/Gnome), .ini and many others are
1693 recognized.
1694
1695 ---
1696 ** GDB-Script-mode is used for files like .gdbinit.
1697
1698 +++
1699 ** The new python.el package is used to edit Python and Jython programs.
1700
1701 ---
1702 ** The TCL package tcl-mode.el was replaced by tcl.el.
1703 This was actually done in Emacs-21.1, and was not documented.
1704 \f
1705 * Changes in Specialized Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1:
1706
1707 ** Makefile mode has submodes for automake, gmake, makepp and BSD make.
1708
1709 The former two couldn't be differentiated before, and the latter two
1710 are new. Font-locking is robust now and offers new customizable
1711 faces.
1712
1713 +++
1714 ** In Outline mode, `hide-body' no longer hides lines at the top
1715 of the file that precede the first header line.
1716
1717 +++
1718 ** Telnet now prompts you for a port number with C-u M-x telnet.
1719
1720 ---
1721 ** The terminal emulation code in term.el has been improved; it can
1722 run most curses applications now.
1723
1724 +++
1725 ** M-x diff uses Diff mode instead of Compilation mode.
1726
1727 +++
1728 ** You can now customize `fill-nobreak-predicate' to control where
1729 filling can break lines. The value is now normally a list of
1730 functions, but it can also be a single function, for compatibility.
1731
1732 Emacs provide two predicates, `fill-single-word-nobreak-p' and
1733 `fill-french-nobreak-p', for use as the value of
1734 `fill-nobreak-predicate'.
1735
1736 ---
1737 ** M-x view-file and commands that use it now avoid interfering
1738 with special modes such as Tar mode.
1739
1740 ---
1741 ** Commands `winner-redo' and `winner-undo', from winner.el, are now
1742 bound to C-c <left> and C-c <right>, respectively. This is an
1743 incompatible change.
1744
1745 ---
1746 ** `global-whitespace-mode' is a new alias for `whitespace-global-mode'.
1747
1748 +++
1749 ** M-x compare-windows now can automatically skip non-matching text to
1750 resync points in both windows.
1751
1752 +++
1753 ** New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
1754
1755 When this option is enabled, M-x add-change-log-entry always
1756 starts a new record regardless of when the last record is.
1757
1758 ---
1759 ** PO translation files are decoded according to their MIME headers
1760 when Emacs visits them.
1761
1762 ** Info mode changes:
1763
1764 +++
1765 *** A numeric prefix argument of `info' selects an Info buffer
1766 with the number appended to the `*info*' buffer name (e.g. "*info*<2>").
1767
1768 ---
1769 *** isearch in Info uses Info-search and searches through multiple nodes.
1770
1771 Before leaving the initial Info node isearch fails once with the error
1772 message [initial node], and with subsequent C-s/C-r continues through
1773 other nodes. When isearch fails for the rest of the manual, it wraps
1774 aroung the whole manual to the top/final node. The user option
1775 `Info-isearch-search' controls whether to use Info-search for isearch,
1776 or the default isearch search function that wraps around the current
1777 Info node.
1778
1779 *** New search commands: `Info-search-case-sensitively' (bound to S),
1780 `Info-search-backward', and `Info-search-next' which repeats the last
1781 search without prompting for a new search string.
1782
1783 *** New command `Info-history-forward' (bound to r and new toolbar icon)
1784 moves forward in history to the node you returned from after using
1785 `Info-history-back' (renamed from `Info-last').
1786
1787 *** New command `Info-history' (bound to L) displays a menu of visited nodes.
1788
1789 *** New command `Info-toc' (bound to T) creates a node with table of contents
1790 from the tree structure of menus of the current Info file.
1791
1792 *** New command `info-apropos' searches the indices of the known
1793 Info files on your system for a string, and builds a menu of the
1794 possible matches.
1795
1796 *** New command `Info-copy-current-node-name' (bound to w) copies
1797 the current Info node name into the kill ring. With a zero prefix
1798 arg, puts the node name inside the `info' function call.
1799
1800 ---
1801 *** New face `info-xref-visited' distinguishes visited nodes from unvisited
1802 and a new option `Info-fontify-visited-nodes' to control this.
1803
1804 *** http and ftp links in Info are now operational: they look like cross
1805 references and following them calls `browse-url'.
1806
1807 +++
1808 *** Info now hides node names in menus and cross references by default.
1809
1810 If you prefer the old behavior, you can set the new user option
1811 `Info-hide-note-references' to nil.
1812
1813 ---
1814 *** Images in Info pages are supported.
1815
1816 Info pages show embedded images, in Emacs frames with image support.
1817 Info documentation that includes images, processed with makeinfo
1818 version 4.7 or newer, compiles to Info pages with embedded images.
1819
1820 +++
1821 *** The default value for `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' is now nil.
1822
1823 ---
1824 *** `Info-index' offers completion.
1825
1826 ** Lisp mode changes:
1827
1828 ---
1829 *** Lisp mode now uses `font-lock-doc-face' for doc strings.
1830
1831 +++
1832 *** C-u C-M-q in Emacs Lisp mode pretty-prints the list after point.
1833
1834 *** New features in evaluation commands
1835
1836 +++
1837 **** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) called on defface reinitializes
1838 the face to the value specified in the defface expression.
1839
1840 +++
1841 **** Typing C-x C-e twice prints the value of the integer result
1842 in additional formats (octal, hexadecimal, character) specified
1843 by the new function `eval-expression-print-format'. The same
1844 function also defines the result format for `eval-expression' (M-:),
1845 `eval-print-last-sexp' (C-j) and some edebug evaluation functions.
1846
1847 +++
1848 ** CC mode changes.
1849
1850 *** Font lock support.
1851 CC Mode now provides font lock support for all its languages. This
1852 supersedes the font lock patterns that have been in the core font lock
1853 package for C, C++, Java and Objective-C. Like indentation, font
1854 locking is done in a uniform way across all languages (except the new
1855 AWK mode - see below). That means that the new font locking will be
1856 different from the old patterns in various details for most languages.
1857
1858 The main goal of the font locking in CC Mode is accuracy, to provide a
1859 dependable aid in recognizing the various constructs. Some, like
1860 strings and comments, are easy to recognize while others like
1861 declarations and types can be very tricky. CC Mode can go to great
1862 lengths to recognize declarations and casts correctly, especially when
1863 the types aren't recognized by standard patterns. This is a fairly
1864 demanding analysis which can be slow on older hardware, and it can
1865 therefore be disabled by choosing a lower decoration level with the
1866 variable font-lock-maximum-decoration.
1867
1868 Note that the most demanding font lock level has been tuned with lazy
1869 fontification in mind, i.e. there should be a support mode that waits
1870 with the fontification until the text is actually shown
1871 (e.g. Just-in-time Lock mode, which is the default, or Lazy Lock
1872 mode). Fontifying a file with several thousand lines in one go can
1873 take the better part of a minute.
1874
1875 **** The (c|c++|objc|java|idl|pike)-font-lock-extra-types variables
1876 are now used by CC Mode to recognize identifiers that are certain to
1877 be types. (They are also used in cases that aren't related to font
1878 locking.) At the maximum decoration level, types are often recognized
1879 properly anyway, so these variables should be fairly restrictive and
1880 not contain patterns for uncertain types.
1881
1882 **** Support for documentation comments.
1883 There is a "plugin" system to fontify documentation comments like
1884 Javadoc and the markup within them. It's independent of the host
1885 language, so it's possible to e.g. turn on Javadoc font locking in C
1886 buffers. See the variable c-doc-comment-style for details.
1887
1888 Currently two kinds of doc comment styles are recognized: Suns Javadoc
1889 and Autodoc which is used in Pike. This is by no means a complete
1890 list of the most common tools; if your doc comment extractor of choice
1891 is missing then please drop a note to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
1892
1893 **** Better handling of C++ templates.
1894 As a side effect of the more accurate font locking, C++ templates are
1895 now handled much better. The angle brackets that delimit them are
1896 given parenthesis syntax so that they can be navigated like other
1897 parens.
1898
1899 This also improves indentation of templates, although there still is
1900 work to be done in that area. E.g. it's required that multiline
1901 template clauses are written in full and then refontified to be
1902 recognized, and the indentation of nested templates is a bit odd and
1903 not as configurable as it ought to be.
1904
1905 **** Improved handling of Objective-C and CORBA IDL.
1906 Especially the support for Objective-C and IDL has gotten an overhaul.
1907 The special "@" declarations in Objective-C are handled correctly.
1908 All the keywords used in CORBA IDL, PSDL, and CIDL are recognized and
1909 handled correctly, also wrt indentation.
1910
1911 *** Support for the AWK language.
1912 Support for the AWK language has been introduced. The implementation is
1913 based around GNU AWK version 3.1, but it should work pretty well with
1914 any AWK. As yet, not all features of CC Mode have been adapted for AWK.
1915 Here is a summary:
1916
1917 **** Indentation Engine
1918 The CC Mode indentation engine fully supports AWK mode.
1919
1920 AWK mode handles code formatted in the conventional AWK fashion: `{'s
1921 which start actions, user-defined functions, or compound statements are
1922 placed on the same line as the associated construct; the matching `}'s
1923 are normally placed under the start of the respective pattern, function
1924 definition, or structured statement.
1925
1926 The predefined indentation functions haven't yet been adapted for AWK
1927 mode, though some of them may work serendipitously. There shouldn't be
1928 any problems writing custom indentation functions for AWK mode.
1929
1930 The command C-c C-q (c-indent-defun) hasn't yet been adapted for AWK,
1931 though in practice it works properly nearly all the time. Should it
1932 fail, explicitly set the region around the function (using C-u C-SPC:
1933 C-M-h probably won't work either) then do C-M-\ (indent-region).
1934
1935 **** Font Locking
1936 There is a single level of font locking in AWK mode, rather than the
1937 three distinct levels the other modes have. There are several
1938 idiosyncrasies in AWK mode's font-locking due to the peculiarities of
1939 the AWK language itself.
1940
1941 **** Comment Commands
1942 M-; (indent-for-comment) works fine. None of the other CC Mode
1943 comment formatting commands have yet been adapted for AWK mode.
1944
1945 **** Movement Commands
1946 Most of the movement commands work in AWK mode. The most important
1947 exceptions are M-a (c-beginning-of-statement) and M-e
1948 (c-end-of-statement) which haven't yet been adapted.
1949
1950 The notion of "defun" has been augmented to include AWK pattern-action
1951 pairs. C-M-a (c-awk-beginning-of-defun) and C-M-e (c-awk-end-of-defun)
1952 recognise these pattern-action pairs, as well as user defined
1953 functions.
1954
1955 **** Auto-newline Insertion and Clean-ups
1956 Auto-newline insertion hasn't yet been adapted for AWK. Some of
1957 the clean-ups can actually convert good AWK code into syntactically
1958 invalid code. These features are best disabled in AWK buffers.
1959
1960 *** New syntactic symbols in IDL mode.
1961 The top level constructs "module" and "composition" (from CIDL) are
1962 now handled like "namespace" in C++: They are given syntactic symbols
1963 module-open, module-close, inmodule, composition-open,
1964 composition-close, and incomposition.
1965
1966 *** New functions to do hungry delete without enabling hungry delete mode.
1967 The functions `c-hungry-backspace' and `c-hungry-delete-forward' can be
1968 bound to keys to get this feature without toggling a mode.
1969
1970 *** Better control over `require-final-newline'.
1971
1972 The variable `c-require-final-newline' specifies which of the modes
1973 implemented by CC mode should insert final newlines. Its value is a
1974 list of modes, and only those modes should do it. By default the list
1975 includes C, C++ and Objective-C modes.
1976
1977 Whichever modes are in this list will set `require-final-newline'
1978 based on `mode-require-final-newline'.
1979
1980 *** Format change for syntactic context elements.
1981
1982 The elements in the syntactic context returned by `c-guess-basic-syntax'
1983 and stored in `c-syntactic-context' has been changed somewhat to allow
1984 attaching more information. They are now lists instead of single cons
1985 cells. E.g. a line that previously had the syntactic analysis
1986
1987 ((inclass . 11) (topmost-intro . 13))
1988
1989 is now analysed as
1990
1991 ((inclass 11) (topmost-intro 13))
1992
1993 In some cases there are more than one position given for a syntactic
1994 symbol.
1995
1996 This change might affect code that call `c-guess-basic-syntax' directly,
1997 and custom lineup functions if they use `c-syntactic-context'. However,
1998 the argument given to lineup functions is still a single cons cell
1999 with nil or an integer in the cdr.
2000
2001 *** API changes for derived modes.
2002
2003 There have been extensive changes "under the hood" which can affect
2004 derived mode writers. Some of these changes are likely to cause
2005 incompatibilities with existing derived modes, but on the other hand
2006 care has now been taken to make it possible to extend and modify CC
2007 Mode with less risk of such problems in the future.
2008
2009 **** New language variable system.
2010 See the comment blurb near the top of cc-langs.el.
2011
2012 **** New initialization functions.
2013 The initialization procedure has been split up into more functions to
2014 give better control: `c-basic-common-init', `c-font-lock-init', and
2015 `c-init-language-vars'.
2016
2017 *** Changes in analysis of nested syntactic constructs.
2018 The syntactic analysis engine has better handling of cases where
2019 several syntactic constructs appear nested on the same line. They are
2020 now handled as if each construct started on a line of its own.
2021
2022 This means that CC Mode now indents some cases differently, and
2023 although it's more consistent there might be cases where the old way
2024 gave results that's more to one's liking. So if you find a situation
2025 where you think that the indentation has become worse, please report
2026 it to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
2027
2028 **** New syntactic symbol substatement-label.
2029 This symbol is used when a label is inserted between a statement and
2030 its substatement. E.g:
2031
2032 if (x)
2033 x_is_true:
2034 do_stuff();
2035
2036 *** Better handling of multiline macros.
2037
2038 **** Syntactic indentation inside macros.
2039 The contents of multiline #define's are now analyzed and indented
2040 syntactically just like other code. This can be disabled by the new
2041 variable `c-syntactic-indentation-in-macros'. A new syntactic symbol
2042 `cpp-define-intro' has been added to control the initial indentation
2043 inside `#define's.
2044
2045 **** New lineup function `c-lineup-cpp-define'.
2046
2047 Now used by default to line up macro continuation lines. The behavior
2048 of this function closely mimics the indentation one gets if the macro
2049 is indented while the line continuation backslashes are temporarily
2050 removed. If syntactic indentation in macros is turned off, it works
2051 much line `c-lineup-dont-change', which was used earlier, but handles
2052 empty lines within the macro better.
2053
2054 **** Automatically inserted newlines continues the macro if used within one.
2055 This applies to the newlines inserted by the auto-newline mode, and to
2056 `c-context-line-break' and `c-context-open-line'.
2057
2058 **** Better alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2059 `c-backslash-region' tries to adapt to surrounding backslashes. New
2060 variable `c-backslash-max-column' which put a limit on how far out
2061 backslashes can be moved.
2062
2063 **** Automatic alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2064 This is controlled by the new variable `c-auto-align-backslashes'. It
2065 affects `c-context-line-break', `c-context-open-line' and newlines
2066 inserted in Auto-Newline mode.
2067 **** Line indentation works better inside macros.
2068
2069 Regardless whether syntactic indentation and syntactic indentation
2070 inside macros are enabled or not, line indentation now ignores the
2071 line continuation backslashes. This is most noticeable when syntactic
2072 indentation is turned off and there are empty lines (save for the
2073 backslash) in the macro.
2074
2075 *** indent-for-comment is more customizable.
2076 The behavior of M-; (indent-for-comment) is now configurable through
2077 the variable `c-indent-comment-alist'. The indentation behavior based
2078 on the preceding code on the line, e.g. to get two spaces after #else
2079 and #endif but indentation to `comment-column' in most other cases
2080 (something which was hardcoded earlier).
2081
2082 *** New function `c-context-open-line'.
2083 It's the open-line equivalent of `c-context-line-break'.
2084
2085 *** New lineup functions
2086
2087 **** `c-lineup-string-cont'
2088 This lineup function lines up a continued string under the one it
2089 continues. E.g:
2090
2091 result = prefix + "A message "
2092 "string."; <- c-lineup-string-cont
2093
2094 **** `c-lineup-cascaded-calls'
2095 Lines up series of calls separated by "->" or ".".
2096
2097 **** `c-lineup-knr-region-comment'
2098 Gives (what most people think is) better indentation of comments in
2099 the "K&R region" between the function header and its body.
2100
2101 **** `c-lineup-gcc-asm-reg'
2102 Provides better indentation inside asm blocks.
2103
2104 **** `c-lineup-argcont'
2105 Lines up continued function arguments after the preceding comma.
2106
2107 *** Better caching of the syntactic context.
2108 CC Mode caches the positions of the opening parentheses (of any kind)
2109 of the lists surrounding the point. Those positions are used in many
2110 places as anchor points for various searches. The cache is now
2111 improved so that it can be reused to a large extent when the point is
2112 moved. The less it moves, the less needs to be recalculated.
2113
2114 The effect is that CC Mode should be fast most of the time even when
2115 opening parens are hung (i.e. aren't in column zero). It's typically
2116 only the first time after the point is moved far down in a complex
2117 file that it'll take noticeable time to find out the syntactic
2118 context.
2119
2120 *** Statements are recognized in a more robust way.
2121 Statements are recognized most of the time even when they occur in an
2122 "invalid" context, e.g. in a function argument. In practice that can
2123 happen when macros are involved.
2124
2125 *** Improved the way `c-indent-exp' chooses the block to indent.
2126 It now indents the block for the closest sexp following the point
2127 whose closing paren ends on a different line. This means that the
2128 point doesn't have to be immediately before the block to indent.
2129 Also, only the block and the closing line is indented; the current
2130 line is left untouched.
2131
2132 *** Added toggle for syntactic indentation.
2133 The function `c-toggle-syntactic-indentation' can be used to toggle
2134 syntactic indentation.
2135
2136 ---
2137 ** Perl mode has a new variable `perl-indent-continued-arguments'.
2138
2139 ---
2140 ** The old Octave mode bindings C-c f and C-c i have been changed
2141 to C-c C-f and C-c C-i. The C-c C-i subcommands now have duplicate
2142 bindings on control characters--thus, C-c C-i C-b is the same as
2143 C-c C-i b, and so on.
2144
2145 ** Fortran mode changes:
2146
2147 ---
2148 *** Fortran mode does more font-locking by default. Use level 3
2149 highlighting for the old default.
2150
2151 +++
2152 *** Fortran mode has a new variable `fortran-directive-re'.
2153 Adapt this to match the format of any compiler directives you use.
2154 Lines that match are never indented, and are given distinctive font-locking.
2155
2156 +++
2157 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have new navigation commands
2158 `f90-end-of-block', `f90-beginning-of-block', `f90-next-block',
2159 `f90-previous-block', `fortran-end-of-block',
2160 `fortran-beginning-of-block'.
2161
2162 ---
2163 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have support for `hs-minor-mode' (hideshow).
2164 It cannot deal with every code format, but ought to handle a sizeable
2165 majority.
2166
2167 ---
2168 *** The new function `f90-backslash-not-special' can be used to change
2169 the syntax of backslashes in F90 buffers.
2170
2171 ---
2172 ** Prolog mode has a new variable `prolog-font-lock-keywords'
2173 to support use of font-lock.
2174
2175 ** HTML/SGML changes:
2176
2177 ---
2178 *** Emacs now tries to set up buffer coding systems for HTML/XML files
2179 automatically.
2180
2181 +++
2182 *** SGML mode has indentation and supports XML syntax.
2183 The new variable `sgml-xml-mode' tells SGML mode to use XML syntax.
2184 When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style,
2185 i.e., there is always a closing tag.
2186 By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis
2187 from the file name or buffer contents.
2188
2189 +++
2190 *** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support.
2191
2192 ** TeX modes:
2193
2194 +++
2195 *** C-c C-c prompts for a command to run, and tries to offer a good default.
2196
2197 +++
2198 *** The user option `tex-start-options-string' has been replaced
2199 by two new user options: `tex-start-options', which should hold
2200 command-line options to feed to TeX, and `tex-start-commands' which should hold
2201 TeX commands to use at startup.
2202
2203 ---
2204 *** verbatim environments are now highlighted in courier by font-lock
2205 and super/sub-scripts are made into super/sub-scripts.
2206
2207 +++
2208 *** New major mode Doctex mode, for *.dtx files.
2209
2210 ** BibTeX mode:
2211
2212 *** The new command `bibtex-url' browses a URL for the BibTeX entry at
2213 point (bound to C-c C-l and mouse-2, RET on clickable fields).
2214
2215 *** The new command `bibtex-entry-update' (bound to C-c C-u) updates
2216 an existing BibTeX entry.
2217
2218 *** New `bibtex-entry-format' option `required-fields', enabled by default.
2219
2220 *** `bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries' can take values `plain',
2221 `crossref', and `entry-class' which control the sorting scheme used
2222 for BibTeX entries. `bibtex-sort-entry-class' controls the sorting
2223 scheme `entry-class'. TAB completion for reference keys and
2224 automatic detection of duplicates does not require anymore that
2225 `bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries' is non-nil.
2226
2227 *** If the new variable `bibtex-parse-keys-fast' is non-nil,
2228 use fast but simplified algorithm for parsing BibTeX keys.
2229
2230 *** If the new variable `bibtex-autoadd-commas' is non-nil,
2231 automatically add missing commas at end of BibTeX fields.
2232
2233 *** The new variable `bibtex-autofill-types' contains a list of entry
2234 types for which fields are filled automatically (if possible).
2235
2236 *** The new command `bibtex-complete' completes word fragment before
2237 point according to context (bound to M-tab).
2238
2239 *** The new commands `bibtex-find-entry' and `bibtex-find-crossref'
2240 locate entries and crossref'd entries (bound to C-c C-s and C-c C-x).
2241 Crossref fields are clickable (bound to mouse-2, RET).
2242
2243 *** In BibTeX mode the command `fill-paragraph' (M-q) fills
2244 individual fields of a BibTeX entry.
2245
2246 *** The new variables `bibtex-files' and `bibtex-file-path' define a set
2247 of BibTeX files that are searched for entry keys.
2248
2249 *** The new command `bibtex-validate-globally' checks for duplicate keys
2250 in multiple BibTeX files.
2251
2252 *** The new command `bibtex-copy-summary-as-kill' pushes summary
2253 of BibTeX entry to kill ring (bound to C-c C-t).
2254
2255 +++
2256 ** In Enriched mode, `set-left-margin' and `set-right-margin' are now
2257 by default bound to `C-c [' and `C-c ]' instead of the former `C-c C-l'
2258 and `C-c C-r'.
2259
2260 ** GUD changes:
2261
2262 +++
2263 *** In GUD mode, when talking to GDB, C-x C-a C-j "jumps" the program
2264 counter to the specified source line (the one where point is).
2265
2266 ---
2267 *** GUD mode has its own tool bar for controlling execution of the inferior
2268 and other common debugger commands.
2269
2270 +++
2271 *** The new package gdb-ui.el provides an enhanced graphical interface to
2272 GDB. You can interact with GDB through the GUD buffer in the usual way, but
2273 there are also further buffers which control the execution and describe the
2274 state of your program. It can separate the input/output of your program from
2275 that of GDB and watches expressions in the speedbar. It also uses features of
2276 Emacs 21/22 such as the the toolbar, and bitmaps in the fringe to indicate
2277 breakpoints.
2278
2279 Use M-x gdb to start GDB-UI.
2280
2281 *** The variable tooltip-gud-tips-p has been removed. GUD tooltips can now be
2282 toggled independently of normal tooltips with the minor mode
2283 `gud-tooltip-mode'.
2284
2285 +++
2286 *** In graphical mode, with a C program, GUD Tooltips have been extended to
2287 display the #define directive associated with an identifier when program is
2288 not executing.
2289
2290 ---
2291 ** GUD mode improvements for jdb:
2292
2293 *** Search for source files using jdb classpath and class
2294 information. Fast startup since there is no need to scan all
2295 source files up front. There is also no need to create and maintain
2296 lists of source directories to scan. Look at `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
2297 and `gud-jdb-classpath' customization variables documentation.
2298
2299 *** Supports the standard breakpoint (gud-break, gud-clear)
2300 set/clear operations from java source files under the classpath, stack
2301 traversal (gud-up, gud-down), and run until current stack finish
2302 (gud-finish).
2303
2304 *** Supports new jdb (Java 1.2 and later) in addition to oldjdb
2305 (Java 1.1 jdb).
2306
2307 *** The previous method of searching for source files has been
2308 preserved in case someone still wants/needs to use it.
2309 Set `gud-jdb-use-classpath' to nil.
2310
2311 Added Customization Variables
2312
2313 *** `gud-jdb-command-name'. What command line to use to invoke jdb.
2314
2315 *** `gud-jdb-use-classpath'. Allows selection of java source file searching
2316 method: set to t for new method, nil to scan `gud-jdb-directories' for
2317 java sources (previous method).
2318
2319 *** `gud-jdb-directories'. List of directories to scan and search for java
2320 classes using the original gud-jdb method (if `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
2321 is nil).
2322
2323 Minor Improvements
2324
2325 *** The STARTTLS wrapper (starttls.el) can now use GNUTLS
2326 instead of the OpenSSL based `starttls' tool. For backwards
2327 compatibility, it prefers `starttls', but you can toggle
2328 `starttls-use-gnutls' to switch to GNUTLS (or simply remove the
2329 `starttls' tool).
2330
2331 *** Do not allow debugger output history variable to grow without bounds.
2332
2333 ** Auto-Revert changes:
2334
2335 +++
2336 *** You can now use Auto Revert mode to `tail' a file.
2337
2338 If point is at the end of a file buffer before reverting, Auto Revert
2339 mode keeps it at the end after reverting. Similarly if point is
2340 displayed at the end of a file buffer in any window, it stays at
2341 the end of the buffer in that window. This allows to tail a file:
2342 just put point at the end of the buffer and it stays there. This
2343 rule applies to file buffers. For non-file buffers, the behavior can
2344 be mode dependent.
2345
2346 If you are sure that the file will only change by growing at the end,
2347 then you can tail the file more efficiently by using the new minor
2348 mode Auto Revert Tail mode. The function `auto-revert-tail-mode'
2349 toggles this mode.
2350
2351 +++
2352 *** Auto Revert mode is now more careful to avoid excessive reverts and
2353 other potential problems when deciding which non-file buffers to
2354 revert. This matters especially if Global Auto Revert mode is enabled
2355 and `global-auto-revert-non-file-buffers' is non-nil. Auto Revert
2356 mode only reverts a non-file buffer if the buffer has a non-nil
2357 `revert-buffer-function' and a non-nil `buffer-stale-function', which
2358 decides whether the buffer should be reverted. Currently, this means
2359 that auto reverting works for Dired buffers (although this may not
2360 work properly on all operating systems) and for the Buffer Menu.
2361
2362 +++
2363 *** If the new user option `auto-revert-check-vc-info' is non-nil, Auto
2364 Revert mode reliably updates version control info (such as the version
2365 control number in the mode line), in all version controlled buffers in
2366 which it is active. If the option is nil, the default, then this info
2367 only gets updated whenever the buffer gets reverted.
2368
2369 ---
2370 ** recentf changes.
2371
2372 The recent file list is now automatically cleanup when recentf mode is
2373 enabled. The new option `recentf-auto-cleanup' controls when to do
2374 automatic cleanup.
2375
2376 The `recentf-keep' option replaces `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-p'
2377 and provides a more general mechanism to customize which file names to
2378 keep in the recent list.
2379
2380 With the more advanced option: `recentf-filename-handler', you can
2381 specify a function that transforms filenames handled by recentf. For
2382 example, if set to `file-truename', the same file will not be in the
2383 recent list with different symbolic links.
2384
2385 To follow naming convention, `recentf-menu-append-commands-flag'
2386 replaces the misnamed option `recentf-menu-append-commands-p'. The
2387 old name remains available as alias, but has been marked obsolete.
2388
2389 +++
2390 ** Desktop package
2391
2392 +++
2393 *** Desktop saving is now a minor mode, `desktop-save-mode'.
2394
2395 *** The variable `desktop-enable' is obsolete.
2396
2397 Customize `desktop-save-mode' to enable desktop saving.
2398
2399 ---
2400 *** Buffers are saved in the desktop file in the same order as that in the
2401 buffer list.
2402
2403 +++
2404 *** The desktop package can be customized to restore only some buffers
2405 immediately, remaining buffers are restored lazily (when Emacs is
2406 idle).
2407
2408 +++
2409 *** New commands:
2410 - desktop-revert reverts to the last loaded desktop.
2411 - desktop-change-dir kills current desktop and loads a new.
2412 - desktop-save-in-desktop-dir saves desktop in the directory from which
2413 it was loaded.
2414 - desktop-lazy-complete runs the desktop load to completion.
2415 - desktop-lazy-abort aborts lazy loading of the desktop.
2416
2417 ---
2418 *** New customizable variables:
2419 - desktop-save. Determins whether the desktop should be saved when it is
2420 killed.
2421 - desktop-file-name-format. Format in which desktop file names should be saved.
2422 - desktop-path. List of directories in which to lookup the desktop file.
2423 - desktop-locals-to-save. List of local variables to save.
2424 - desktop-globals-to-clear. List of global variables that `desktop-clear' will clear.
2425 - desktop-clear-preserve-buffers-regexp. Regexp identifying buffers that `desktop-clear'
2426 should not delete.
2427 - desktop-restore-eager. Number of buffers to restore immediately. Remaining buffers are
2428 restored lazily (when Emacs is idle).
2429 - desktop-lazy-verbose. Verbose reporting of lazily created buffers.
2430 - desktop-lazy-idle-delay. Idle delay before starting to create buffers.
2431
2432 +++
2433 *** New command line option --no-desktop
2434
2435 ---
2436 *** New hooks:
2437 - desktop-after-read-hook run after a desktop is loaded.
2438 - desktop-no-desktop-file-hook run when no desktop file is found.
2439
2440 ---
2441 ** The saveplace.el package now filters out unreadable files.
2442
2443 When you exit Emacs, the saved positions in visited files no longer
2444 include files that aren't readable, e.g. files that don't exist.
2445 Customize the new option `save-place-forget-unreadable-files' to nil
2446 to get the old behavior. The new options `save-place-save-skipped'
2447 and `save-place-skip-check-regexp' allow further fine-tuning of this
2448 feature.
2449
2450 ** EDiff changes.
2451
2452 +++
2453 *** When comparing directories.
2454 Typing D brings up a buffer that lists the differences between the contents of
2455 directories. Now it is possible to use this buffer to copy the missing files
2456 from one directory to another.
2457
2458 +++
2459 *** When comparing files or buffers.
2460 Typing the = key now offers to perform the word-by-word comparison of the
2461 currently highlighted regions in an inferior Ediff session. If you answer 'n'
2462 then it reverts to the old behavior and asks the user to select regions for
2463 comparison.
2464
2465 *** The new command `ediff-backup' compares a file with its most recent
2466 backup using `ediff'. If you specify the name of a backup file,
2467 `ediff-backup' compares it with the file of which it is a backup.
2468
2469 +++
2470 ** Etags changes.
2471
2472 *** New regular expressions features
2473
2474 **** New syntax for regular expressions, multi-line regular expressions.
2475
2476 The syntax --ignore-case-regexp=/regex/ is now undocumented and retained
2477 only for backward compatibility. The new equivalent syntax is
2478 --regex=/regex/i. More generally, it is --regex=/TAGREGEX/TAGNAME/MODS,
2479 where `/TAGNAME' is optional, as usual, and MODS is a string of 0 or
2480 more characters among `i' (ignore case), `m' (multi-line) and `s'
2481 (single-line). The `m' and `s' modifiers behave as in Perl regular
2482 expressions: `m' allows regexps to match more than one line, while `s'
2483 (which implies `m') means that `.' matches newlines. The ability to
2484 span newlines allows writing of much more powerful regular expressions
2485 and rapid prototyping for tagging new languages.
2486
2487 **** Regular expressions can use char escape sequences as in GCC.
2488
2489 The escaped character sequence \a, \b, \d, \e, \f, \n, \r, \t, \v,
2490 respectively, stand for the ASCII characters BEL, BS, DEL, ESC, FF, NL,
2491 CR, TAB, VT,
2492
2493 **** Regular expressions can be bound to a given language.
2494
2495 The syntax --regex={LANGUAGE}REGEX means that REGEX is used to make tags
2496 only for files of language LANGUAGE, and ignored otherwise. This is
2497 particularly useful when storing regexps in a file.
2498
2499 **** Regular expressions can be read from a file.
2500
2501 The --regex=@regexfile option means read the regexps from a file, one
2502 per line. Lines beginning with space or tab are ignored.
2503
2504 *** New language parsing features
2505
2506 **** The `::' qualifier triggers C++ parsing in C file.
2507
2508 Previously, only the `template' and `class' keywords had this effect.
2509
2510 **** The GCC __attribute__ keyword is now recognised and ignored.
2511
2512 **** New language HTML.
2513
2514 Tags are generated for `title' as well as `h1', `h2', and `h3'. Also,
2515 when `name=' is used inside an anchor and whenever `id=' is used.
2516
2517 **** In Makefiles, constants are tagged.
2518
2519 If you want the old behavior instead, thus avoiding to increase the
2520 size of the tags file, use the --no-globals option.
2521
2522 **** New language Lua.
2523
2524 All functions are tagged.
2525
2526 **** In Perl, packages are tags.
2527
2528 Subroutine tags are named from their package. You can jump to sub tags
2529 as you did before, by the sub name, or additionally by looking for
2530 package::sub.
2531
2532 **** In Prolog, etags creates tags for rules in addition to predicates.
2533
2534 **** New language PHP.
2535
2536 Functions, classes and defines are tags. If the --members option is
2537 specified to etags, variables are tags also.
2538
2539 **** New default keywords for TeX.
2540
2541 The new keywords are def, newcommand, renewcommand, newenvironment and
2542 renewenvironment.
2543
2544 *** Honour #line directives.
2545
2546 When Etags parses an input file that contains C preprocessor's #line
2547 directives, it creates tags using the file name and line number
2548 specified in those directives. This is useful when dealing with code
2549 created from Cweb source files. When Etags tags the generated file, it
2550 writes tags pointing to the source file.
2551
2552 *** New option --parse-stdin=FILE.
2553
2554 This option is mostly useful when calling etags from programs. It can
2555 be used (only once) in place of a file name on the command line. Etags
2556 reads from standard input and marks the produced tags as belonging to
2557 the file FILE.
2558
2559 ** VC Changes
2560
2561 +++
2562 *** The key C-x C-q only changes the read-only state of the buffer
2563 (toggle-read-only). It no longer checks files in or out.
2564
2565 We made this change because we held a poll and found that many users
2566 were unhappy with the previous behavior. If you do prefer this
2567 behavior, you can bind `vc-toggle-read-only' to C-x C-q in your
2568 `.emacs' file:
2569
2570 (global-set-key "\C-x\C-q" 'vc-toggle-read-only)
2571
2572 The function `vc-toggle-read-only' will continue to exist.
2573
2574 +++
2575 *** The new variable `vc-cvs-global-switches' specifies switches that
2576 are passed to any CVS command invoked by VC.
2577
2578 These switches are used as "global options" for CVS, which means they
2579 are inserted before the command name. For example, this allows you to
2580 specify a compression level using the `-z#' option for CVS.
2581
2582 +++
2583 *** New backends for Subversion and Meta-CVS.
2584
2585 +++
2586 *** VC-Annotate mode enhancements
2587
2588 In VC-Annotate mode, you can now use the following key bindings for
2589 enhanced functionality to browse the annotations of past revisions, or
2590 to view diffs or log entries directly from vc-annotate-mode:
2591
2592 P: annotates the previous revision
2593 N: annotates the next revision
2594 J: annotates the revision at line
2595 A: annotates the revision previous to line
2596 D: shows the diff of the revision at line with its previous revision
2597 L: shows the log of the revision at line
2598 W: annotates the workfile (most up to date) version
2599
2600 ** pcl-cvs changes:
2601
2602 +++
2603 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d y' command to view the diffs
2604 between the local version of the file and yesterday's head revision
2605 in the repository.
2606
2607 +++
2608 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d r' command to view the changes
2609 anyone has committed to the repository since you last executed
2610 `checkout', `update' or `commit'. That means using cvs diff options
2611 -rBASE -rHEAD.
2612
2613 +++
2614 ** The new variable `mail-default-directory' specifies
2615 `default-directory' for mail buffers. This directory is used for
2616 auto-save files of mail buffers. It defaults to "~/".
2617
2618 +++
2619 ** The mode line can indicate new mail in a directory or file.
2620
2621 See the documentation of the user option
2622 `display-time-mail-directory'.
2623
2624 ** Rmail changes:
2625
2626 ---
2627 *** Rmail now displays 5-digit message ids in its summary buffer.
2628
2629 +++
2630 *** Support for `movemail' from GNU mailutils was added to Rmail.
2631
2632 This version of `movemail' allows to read mail from a wide range of
2633 mailbox formats, including remote POP3 and IMAP4 mailboxes with or
2634 without TLS encryption. If GNU mailutils is installed on the system
2635 and its version of `movemail' can be found in exec-path, it will be
2636 used instead of the native one.
2637
2638 ** Gnus package
2639
2640 ---
2641 *** Gnus now includes Sieve and PGG
2642
2643 Sieve is a library for managing Sieve scripts. PGG is a library to handle
2644 PGP/MIME.
2645
2646 ---
2647 *** There are many news features, bug fixes and improvements.
2648
2649 See the file GNUS-NEWS or the node "Oort Gnus" in the Gnus manual for details.
2650
2651 ---
2652 ** MH-E changes.
2653
2654 Upgraded to MH-E version 7.82. There have been major changes since
2655 version 5.0.2; see MH-E-NEWS for details.
2656
2657 ** Calendar changes:
2658
2659 +++
2660 *** There is a new calendar package, icalendar.el, that can be used to
2661 convert Emacs diary entries to/from the iCalendar format.
2662
2663 +++
2664 *** Diary sexp entries can have custom marking in the calendar.
2665 Diary sexp functions which only apply to certain days (such as
2666 `diary-block' or `diary-cyclic') now take an optional parameter MARK,
2667 which is the name of a face or a single-character string indicating
2668 how to highlight the day in the calendar display. Specifying a
2669 single-character string as @var{mark} places the character next to the
2670 day in the calendar. Specifying a face highlights the day with that
2671 face. This lets you have different colors or markings for vacations,
2672 appointments, paydays or anything else using a sexp.
2673
2674 +++
2675 *** The new function `calendar-goto-day-of-year' (g D) prompts for a
2676 year and day number, and moves to that date. Negative day numbers
2677 count backward from the end of the year.
2678
2679 +++
2680 *** The new Calendar function `calendar-goto-iso-week' (g w)
2681 prompts for a year and a week number, and moves to the first
2682 day of that ISO week.
2683
2684 ---
2685 *** The new variable `calendar-minimum-window-height' affects the
2686 window generated by the function `generate-calendar-window'.
2687
2688 ---
2689 *** The functions `holiday-easter-etc' and `holiday-advent' now take
2690 optional arguments, in order to only report on the specified holiday
2691 rather than all. This makes customization of variables such as
2692 `christian-holidays' simpler.
2693
2694 ---
2695 *** The function `simple-diary-display' now by default sets a header line.
2696 This can be controlled through the variables `diary-header-line-flag'
2697 and `diary-header-line-format'.
2698
2699 +++
2700 *** The procedure for activating appointment reminders has changed:
2701 use the new function `appt-activate'. The new variable
2702 `appt-display-format' controls how reminders are displayed, replacing
2703 `appt-issue-message', `appt-visible', and `appt-msg-window'.
2704
2705 +++
2706 *** The new functions `diary-from-outlook', `diary-from-outlook-gnus',
2707 and `diary-from-outlook-rmail' can be used to import diary entries
2708 from Outlook-format appointments in mail messages. The variable
2709 `diary-outlook-formats' can be customized to recognize additional
2710 formats.
2711
2712 ---
2713 ** sql changes.
2714
2715 *** The variable `sql-product' controls the highlightng of different
2716 SQL dialects. This variable can be set globally via Customize, on a
2717 buffer-specific basis via local variable settings, or for the current
2718 session using the new SQL->Product submenu. (This menu replaces the
2719 SQL->Highlighting submenu.)
2720
2721 The following values are supported:
2722
2723 ansi ANSI Standard (default)
2724 db2 DB2
2725 informix Informix
2726 ingres Ingres
2727 interbase Interbase
2728 linter Linter
2729 ms Microsoft
2730 mysql MySQL
2731 oracle Oracle
2732 postgres Postgres
2733 solid Solid
2734 sqlite SQLite
2735 sybase Sybase
2736
2737 The current product name will be shown on the mode line following the
2738 SQL mode indicator.
2739
2740 The technique of setting `sql-mode-font-lock-defaults' directly in
2741 your `.emacs' will no longer establish the default highlighting -- Use
2742 `sql-product' to accomplish this.
2743
2744 ANSI keywords are always highlighted.
2745
2746 *** The function `sql-add-product-keywords' can be used to add
2747 font-lock rules to the product specific rules. For example, to have
2748 all identifiers ending in `_t' under MS SQLServer treated as a type,
2749 you would use the following line in your .emacs file:
2750
2751 (sql-add-product-keywords 'ms
2752 '(("\\<\\w+_t\\>" . font-lock-type-face)))
2753
2754 *** Oracle support includes keyword highlighting for Oracle 9i.
2755
2756 Most SQL and PL/SQL keywords are implemented. SQL*Plus commands are
2757 highlighted in `font-lock-doc-face'.
2758
2759 *** Microsoft SQLServer support has been significantly improved.
2760
2761 Keyword highlighting for SqlServer 2000 is implemented.
2762 sql-interactive-mode defaults to use osql, rather than isql, because
2763 osql flushes its error stream more frequently. Thus error messages
2764 are displayed when they occur rather than when the session is
2765 terminated.
2766
2767 If the username and password are not provided to `sql-ms', osql is
2768 called with the `-E' command line argument to use the operating system
2769 credentials to authenticate the user.
2770
2771 *** Postgres support is enhanced.
2772 Keyword highlighting of Postgres 7.3 is implemented. Prompting for
2773 the username and the pgsql `-U' option is added.
2774
2775 *** MySQL support is enhanced.
2776 Keyword higlighting of MySql 4.0 is implemented.
2777
2778 *** Imenu support has been enhanced to locate tables, views, indexes,
2779 packages, procedures, functions, triggers, sequences, rules, and
2780 defaults.
2781
2782 *** Added SQL->Start SQLi Session menu entry which calls the
2783 appropriate `sql-interactive-mode' wrapper for the current setting of
2784 `sql-product'.
2785
2786 ---
2787 *** sql.el supports the SQLite interpreter--call 'sql-sqlite'.
2788
2789 ** FFAP changes:
2790
2791 +++
2792 *** New ffap commands and keybindings:
2793
2794 C-x C-r (`ffap-read-only'),
2795 C-x C-v (`ffap-alternate-file'), C-x C-d (`ffap-list-directory'),
2796 C-x 4 r (`ffap-read-only-other-window'), C-x 4 d (`ffap-dired-other-window'),
2797 C-x 5 r (`ffap-read-only-other-frame'), C-x 5 d (`ffap-dired-other-frame').
2798
2799 ---
2800 *** FFAP accepts wildcards in a file name by default.
2801
2802 C-x C-f passes the file name to `find-file' with non-nil WILDCARDS
2803 argument, which visits multiple files, and C-x d passes it to `dired'.
2804
2805 ---
2806 ** In skeleton.el, `-' marks the `skeleton-point' without interregion interaction.
2807
2808 `@' has reverted to only setting `skeleton-positions' and no longer
2809 sets `skeleton-point'. Skeletons which used @ to mark
2810 `skeleton-point' independent of `_' should now use `-' instead. The
2811 updated `skeleton-insert' docstring explains these new features along
2812 with other details of skeleton construction.
2813
2814 ---
2815 ** New variable `hs-set-up-overlay' allows customization of the overlay
2816 used to effect hiding for hideshow minor mode. Integration with isearch
2817 handles the overlay property `display' specially, preserving it during
2818 temporary overlay showing in the course of an isearch operation.
2819
2820 +++
2821 ** `hide-ifdef-mode' now uses overlays rather than selective-display
2822 to hide its text. This should be mostly transparent but slightly
2823 changes the behavior of motion commands like C-e and C-p.
2824
2825 ---
2826 ** `partial-completion-mode' now handles partial completion on directory names.
2827
2828 ---
2829 ** The type-break package now allows `type-break-file-name' to be nil
2830 and if so, doesn't store any data across sessions. This is handy if
2831 you don't want the `.type-break' file in your home directory or are
2832 annoyed by the need for interaction when you kill Emacs.
2833
2834 ---
2835 ** `ps-print' can now print characters from the mule-unicode charsets.
2836
2837 Printing text with characters from the mule-unicode-* sets works with
2838 `ps-print', provided that you have installed the appropriate BDF
2839 fonts. See the file INSTALL for URLs where you can find these fonts.
2840
2841 ---
2842 ** New command `strokes-global-set-stroke-string'.
2843 This is like `strokes-global-set-stroke', but it allows you to bind
2844 the stroke directly to a string to insert. This is convenient for
2845 using strokes as an input method.
2846
2847 ** Emacs server changes:
2848
2849 +++
2850 *** You can have several Emacs servers on the same machine.
2851
2852 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "foo")' -f server-start &
2853 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "bar")' -f server-start &
2854 % emacsclient -s foo file1
2855 % emacsclient -s bar file2
2856
2857 +++
2858 *** The `emacsclient' command understands the options `--eval' and
2859 `--display' which tell Emacs respectively to evaluate the given Lisp
2860 expression and to use the given display when visiting files.
2861
2862 +++
2863 *** User option `server-mode' can be used to start a server process.
2864
2865 ---
2866 ** LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
2867
2868 +++
2869 ** You can now disable pc-selection-mode after enabling it.
2870
2871 M-x pc-selection-mode behaves like a proper minor mode, and with no
2872 argument it toggles the mode. Turning off PC-Selection mode restores
2873 the global key bindings that were replaced by turning on the mode.
2874
2875 ---
2876 ** `uniquify-strip-common-suffix' tells uniquify to prefer
2877 `file|dir1' and `file|dir2' to `file|dir1/subdir' and `file|dir2/subdir'.
2878
2879 ---
2880 ** Support for `magic cookie' standout modes has been removed.
2881
2882 Emacs still works on terminals that require magic cookies in order to
2883 use standout mode, but they can no longer display mode-lines in
2884 inverse-video.
2885
2886 ---
2887 ** The game `mpuz' is enhanced.
2888
2889 `mpuz' now allows the 2nd factor not to have two identical digits. By
2890 default, all trivial operations involving whole lines are performed
2891 automatically. The game uses faces for better visual feedback.
2892
2893 ---
2894 ** display-battery-mode replaces display-battery.
2895
2896 ---
2897 ** calculator.el now has radix grouping mode.
2898
2899 To enable this, set `calculator-output-radix' non-nil. In this mode a
2900 separator character is used every few digits, making it easier to see
2901 byte boundries etc. For more info, see the documentation of the
2902 variable `calculator-radix-grouping-mode'.
2903
2904 ---
2905 ** fast-lock.el and lazy-lock.el are obsolete. Use jit-lock.el instead.
2906
2907 ---
2908 ** iso-acc.el is now obsolete. Use one of the latin input methods instead.
2909
2910 ---
2911 ** cplus-md.el has been deleted.
2912 \f
2913 * Changes in Emacs 22.1 on non-free operating systems
2914
2915 +++
2916 ** Passing resources on the command line now works on MS Windows.
2917
2918 You can use --xrm to pass resource settings to Emacs, overriding any
2919 existing values. For example:
2920
2921 emacs --xrm "Emacs.Background:red" --xrm "Emacs.Geometry:100x20"
2922
2923 will start up Emacs on an initial frame of 100x20 with red background,
2924 irrespective of geometry or background setting on the Windows registry.
2925
2926 ---
2927 ** On MS Windows, the "system caret" now follows the cursor.
2928
2929 This enables Emacs to work better with programs that need to track
2930 the cursor, for example screen magnifiers and text to speech programs.
2931
2932 ---
2933 ** Tooltips now work on MS Windows.
2934
2935 See the Emacs 21.1 NEWS entry for tooltips for details.
2936
2937 ---
2938 ** Images are now supported on MS Windows.
2939
2940 PBM and XBM images are supported out of the box. Other image formats
2941 depend on external libraries. All of these libraries have been ported
2942 to Windows, and can be found in both source and binary form at
2943 http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net/. Note that libpng also depends on
2944 zlib, and tiff depends on the version of jpeg that it was compiled
2945 against. For additional information, see nt/INSTALL.
2946
2947 ---
2948 ** Sound is now supported on MS Windows.
2949
2950 WAV format is supported on all versions of Windows, other formats such
2951 as AU, AIFF and MP3 may be supported in the more recent versions of
2952 Windows, or when other software provides hooks into the system level
2953 sound support for those formats.
2954
2955 ---
2956 ** Different shaped mouse pointers are supported on MS Windows.
2957
2958 The mouse pointer changes shape depending on what is under the pointer.
2959
2960 ---
2961 ** Pointing devices with more than 3 buttons are now supported on MS Windows.
2962
2963 The new variable `w32-pass-extra-mouse-buttons-to-system' controls
2964 whether Emacs should handle the extra buttons itself (the default), or
2965 pass them to Windows to be handled with system-wide functions.
2966
2967 ---
2968 ** Emacs takes note of colors defined in Control Panel on MS-Windows.
2969
2970 The Control Panel defines some default colors for applications in much
2971 the same way as wildcard X Resources do on X. Emacs now adds these
2972 colors to the colormap prefixed by System (eg SystemMenu for the
2973 default Menu background, SystemMenuText for the foreground), and uses
2974 some of them to initialize some of the default faces.
2975 `list-colors-display' shows the list of System color names, in case
2976 you wish to use them in other faces.
2977
2978 ---
2979 ** On MS Windows NT/W2K/XP, Emacs uses Unicode for clipboard operations.
2980
2981 Those systems use Unicode internally, so this allows Emacs to share
2982 multilingual text with other applications. On other versions of
2983 MS Windows, Emacs now uses the appropriate locale coding-system, so
2984 the clipboard should work correctly for your local language without
2985 any customizations.
2986
2987 ---
2988 ** On Mac OS, `keyboard-coding-system' changes based on the keyboard script.
2989
2990 ---
2991 ** The variable `mac-keyboard-text-encoding' and the constants
2992 `kTextEncodingMacRoman', `kTextEncodingISOLatin1', and
2993 `kTextEncodingISOLatin2' are obsolete.
2994 \f
2995 * Incompatible Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
2996
2997 ---
2998 ** The variables post-command-idle-hook and post-command-idle-delay have
2999 been removed. Use run-with-idle-timer instead.
3000
3001 +++
3002 ** `suppress-keymap' now works by remapping `self-insert-command' to
3003 the command `undefined'. (In earlier Emacs versions, it used
3004 `substitute-key-definition' to rebind self inserting characters to
3005 `undefined'.)
3006
3007 +++
3008 ** Mode line display ignores text properties as well as the
3009 :propertize and :eval forms in the value of a variable whose
3010 `risky-local-variable' property is nil.
3011
3012 ---
3013 ** Support for Mocklisp has been removed.
3014 \f
3015 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
3016
3017 ** General Lisp changes:
3018
3019 +++
3020 *** The function `eql' is now available without requiring the CL package.
3021
3022 +++
3023 *** `makehash' is now obsolete. Use `make-hash-table' instead.
3024
3025 +++
3026 *** `add-to-list' takes an optional third argument, APPEND.
3027
3028 If APPEND is non-nil, the new element gets added at the end of the
3029 list instead of at the beginning. This change actually occurred in
3030 Emacs 21.1, but was not documented then.
3031
3032 +++
3033 *** New function `copy-tree' makes a copy of a tree.
3034
3035 It recursively copyies through both CARs and CDRs.
3036
3037 +++
3038 *** New function `delete-dups' deletes `equal' duplicate elements from a list.
3039
3040 It modifies the list destructively, like `delete'. Of several `equal'
3041 occurrences of an element in the list, the one that's kept is the
3042 first one.
3043
3044 +++
3045 *** New function `rassq-delete-all'.
3046
3047 (rassq-delete-all VALUE ALIST) deletes, from ALIST, each element whose
3048 CDR is `eq' to the specified value.
3049
3050 +++
3051 *** The function `number-sequence' makes a list of equally-separated numbers.
3052
3053 For instance, (number-sequence 4 9) returns (4 5 6 7 8 9). By
3054 default, the separation is 1, but you can specify a different
3055 separation as the third argument. (number-sequence 1.5 6 2) returns
3056 (1.5 3.5 5.5).
3057
3058 +++
3059 *** New variables `most-positive-fixnum' and `most-negative-fixnum'.
3060
3061 They hold the largest and smallest possible integer values.
3062
3063 +++
3064 *** Minor change in the function `format'.
3065
3066 Some flags that were accepted but not implemented (such as "*") are no
3067 longer accepted.
3068
3069 +++
3070 *** Functions `get' and `plist-get' no longer give errors for bad plists.
3071
3072 They return nil for a malformed property list or if the list is
3073 cyclic.
3074
3075 +++
3076 *** New functions `lax-plist-get' and `lax-plist-put'.
3077
3078 They are like `plist-get' and `plist-put', except that they compare
3079 the property name using `equal' rather than `eq'.
3080
3081 +++
3082 *** New variable `print-continuous-numbering'.
3083
3084 When this is non-nil, successive calls to print functions use a single
3085 numbering scheme for circular structure references. This is only
3086 relevant when `print-circle' is non-nil.
3087
3088 When you bind `print-continuous-numbering' to t, you should
3089 also bind `print-number-table' to nil.
3090
3091 +++
3092 *** New function `macroexpand-all' expands all macros in a form.
3093
3094 It is similar to the Common-Lisp function of the same name.
3095 One difference is that it guarantees to return the original argument
3096 if no expansion is done, which can be tested using `eq'.
3097
3098 +++
3099 *** The function `atan' now accepts an optional second argument.
3100
3101 When called with 2 arguments, as in `(atan Y X)', `atan' returns the
3102 angle in radians between the vector [X, Y] and the X axis. (This is
3103 equivalent to the standard C library function `atan2'.)
3104
3105 +++
3106 *** A function or macro's doc string can now specify the calling pattern.
3107
3108 You put this info in the doc string's last line. It should be
3109 formatted so as to match the regexp "\n\n(fn .*)\\'". If you don't
3110 specify this explicitly, Emacs determines it from the actual argument
3111 names. Usually that default is right, but not always.
3112
3113 +++
3114 *** New macro `with-local-quit' temporarily allows quitting.
3115
3116 A quit inside the body of `with-local-quit' is caught by the
3117 `with-local-quit' form itself, but another quit will happen later once
3118 the code that has inhibitted quitting exits.
3119
3120 This is for use around potentially blocking or long-running code
3121 inside timer functions and `post-command-hook' functions.
3122
3123 +++
3124 *** New macro `define-obsolete-function-alias'.
3125
3126 This combines `defalias' and `make-obsolete'.
3127
3128 +++
3129 *** New function `unsafep' determines whether a Lisp form is safe.
3130
3131 It returns nil if the given Lisp form can't possibly do anything
3132 dangerous; otherwise it returns a reason why the form might be unsafe
3133 (calls unknown function, alters global variable, etc).
3134
3135 ** Lisp code indentation features:
3136
3137 +++
3138 *** The `defmacro' form can contain indentation and edebug declarations.
3139
3140 These declarations specify how to indent the macro calls in Lisp mode
3141 and how to debug them with Edebug. You write them like this:
3142
3143 (defmacro NAME LAMBDA-LIST [DOC-STRING] [DECLARATION ...] ...)
3144
3145 DECLARATION is a list `(declare DECLARATION-SPECIFIER ...)'. The
3146 possible declaration specifiers are:
3147
3148 (indent INDENT)
3149 Set NAME's `lisp-indent-function' property to INDENT.
3150
3151 (edebug DEBUG)
3152 Set NAME's `edebug-form-spec' property to DEBUG. (This is
3153 equivalent to writing a `def-edebug-spec' for the macro,
3154 but this is cleaner.)
3155
3156 ---
3157 *** cl-indent now allows customization of Indentation of backquoted forms.
3158
3159 See the new user option `lisp-backquote-indentation'.
3160
3161 ---
3162 *** cl-indent now handles indentation of simple and extended `loop' forms.
3163
3164 The new user options `lisp-loop-keyword-indentation',
3165 `lisp-loop-forms-indentation', and `lisp-simple-loop-indentation' can
3166 be used to customize the indentation of keywords and forms in loop
3167 forms.
3168
3169 +++
3170 ** Variable aliases:
3171
3172 *** New function: defvaralias ALIAS-VAR BASE-VAR [DOCSTRING]
3173
3174 This function defines the symbol ALIAS-VAR as a variable alias for
3175 symbol BASE-VAR. This means that retrieving the value of ALIAS-VAR
3176 returns the value of BASE-VAR, and changing the value of ALIAS-VAR
3177 changes the value of BASE-VAR.
3178
3179 DOCSTRING, if present, is the documentation for ALIAS-VAR; else it has
3180 the same documentation as BASE-VAR.
3181
3182 *** New function: indirect-variable VARIABLE
3183
3184 This function returns the variable at the end of the chain of aliases
3185 of VARIABLE. If VARIABLE is not a symbol, or if VARIABLE is not
3186 defined as an alias, the function returns VARIABLE.
3187
3188 It might be noteworthy that variables aliases work for all kinds of
3189 variables, including buffer-local and frame-local variables.
3190
3191 +++
3192 *** The macro `define-obsolete-variable-alias' combines `defvaralias' and
3193 `make-obsolete-variable'.
3194
3195 ** defcustom changes:
3196
3197 +++
3198 *** The new customization type `float' requires a floating point number.
3199
3200 ** String changes:
3201
3202 +++
3203 *** The escape sequence \s is now interpreted as a SPACE character.
3204
3205 Exception: In a character constant, if it is followed by a `-' in a
3206 character constant (e.g. ?\s-A), it is still interpreted as the super
3207 modifier. In strings, \s is always interpreted as a space.
3208
3209 +++
3210 *** A hex escape in a string constant forces the string to be multibyte.
3211
3212 +++
3213 *** An octal escape in a string constant forces the string to be unibyte.
3214
3215 +++
3216 *** `split-string' now includes null substrings in the returned list if
3217 the optional argument SEPARATORS is non-nil and there are matches for
3218 SEPARATORS at the beginning or end of the string. If SEPARATORS is
3219 nil, or if the new optional third argument OMIT-NULLS is non-nil, all
3220 empty matches are omitted from the returned list.
3221
3222 +++
3223 *** New function `string-to-multibyte' converts a unibyte string to a
3224 multibyte string with the same individual character codes.
3225
3226 +++
3227 *** New function `substring-no-properties' returns a substring without
3228 text properties.
3229
3230 +++
3231 *** The new function `assoc-string' replaces `assoc-ignore-case' and
3232 `assoc-ignore-representation', which are still available, but have
3233 been declared obsolete.
3234
3235 +++
3236 ** Displaying warnings to the user.
3237
3238 See the functions `warn' and `display-warning', or the Lisp Manual.
3239 If you want to be sure the warning will not be overlooked, this
3240 facility is much better than using `message', since it displays
3241 warnings in a separate window.
3242
3243 +++
3244 ** Progress reporters.
3245
3246 These provide a simple and uniform way for commands to present
3247 progress messages for the user.
3248
3249 See the new functions `make-progress-reporter',
3250 `progress-reporter-update', `progress-reporter-force-update',
3251 `progress-reporter-done', and `dotimes-with-progress-reporter'.
3252
3253 ** Buffer positions:
3254
3255 +++
3256 *** Function `compute-motion' now calculates the usable window
3257 width if the WIDTH argument is nil. If the TOPOS argument is nil,
3258 the usable window height and width is used.
3259
3260 +++
3261 *** The `line-move', `scroll-up', and `scroll-down' functions will now
3262 modify the window vscroll to scroll through display rows that are
3263 taller that the height of the window, for example in the presence of
3264 large images. To disable this feature, bind the new variable
3265 `auto-window-vscroll' to nil.
3266
3267 +++
3268 *** The argument to `forward-word', `backward-word' is optional.
3269
3270 It defaults to 1.
3271
3272 +++
3273 *** Argument to `forward-to-indentation' and `backward-to-indentation' is optional.
3274
3275 It defaults to 1.
3276
3277 +++
3278 *** New function `mouse-on-link-p' test if a position is in a clickable link.
3279
3280 This is the function used by the new `mouse-1-click-follows-link'
3281 functionality.
3282
3283 +++
3284 *** New function `line-number-at-pos' returns the line number of a position.
3285
3286 It an optional buffer position argument that defaults to point.
3287
3288 +++
3289 *** `field-beginning' and `field-end' take new optional argument, LIMIT.
3290
3291 This argument tells them not to search beyond LIMIT. Instead they
3292 give up and return LIMIT.
3293
3294 +++
3295 *** Function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now returns the pixel coordinates
3296 and partial visiblity state of the corresponding row, if the PARTIALLY
3297 arg is non-nil.
3298
3299 +++
3300 *** New functions `posn-at-point' and `posn-at-x-y' return
3301 click-event-style position information for a given visible buffer
3302 position or for a given window pixel coordinate.
3303
3304 ** Text modification:
3305
3306 +++
3307 *** The new function `insert-for-yank' normally works like `insert', but
3308 removes the text properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list
3309 and handles the `yank-handler' text property.
3310
3311 +++
3312 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-as-yank' is like
3313 `insert-for-yank' except that it gets the text from another buffer as
3314 in `insert-buffer-substring'.
3315
3316 +++
3317 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-no-properties' is like
3318 `insert-buffer-substring', but removes all text properties from the
3319 inserted substring.
3320
3321 +++
3322 *** The new function `filter-buffer-substring' extracts a buffer
3323 substring, passes it through a set of filter functions, and returns
3324 the filtered substring. Use it instead of `buffer-substring' or
3325 `delete-and-extract-region' when copying text into a user-accessible
3326 data structure, such as the kill-ring, X clipboard, or a register.
3327
3328 The list of filter function is specified by the new variable
3329 `buffer-substring-filters'. For example, Longlines mode adds to
3330 `buffer-substring-filters' to remove soft newlines from the copied
3331 text.
3332
3333 +++
3334 *** Function `translate-region' accepts also a char-table as TABLE
3335 argument.
3336
3337 +++
3338 *** The new translation table `translation-table-for-input'
3339 is used for customizing self-insertion. The character to
3340 be inserted is translated through it.
3341
3342 ---
3343 *** Text clones.
3344
3345 The new function `text-clone-create'. Text clones are chunks of text
3346 that are kept identical by transparently propagating changes from one
3347 clone to the other.
3348
3349 ---
3350 *** The function `insert-string' is now obsolete.
3351
3352 +++
3353 ** Atomic change groups.
3354
3355 To perform some changes in the current buffer "atomically" so that
3356 they either all succeed or are all undone, use `atomic-change-group'
3357 around the code that makes changes. For instance:
3358
3359 (atomic-change-group
3360 (insert foo)
3361 (delete-region x y))
3362
3363 If an error (or other nonlocal exit) occurs inside the body of
3364 `atomic-change-group', it unmakes all the changes in that buffer that
3365 were during the execution of the body. The change group has no effect
3366 on any other buffers--any such changes remain.
3367
3368 If you need something more sophisticated, you can directly call the
3369 lower-level functions that `atomic-change-group' uses. Here is how.
3370
3371 To set up a change group for one buffer, call `prepare-change-group'.
3372 Specify the buffer as argument; it defaults to the current buffer.
3373 This function returns a "handle" for the change group. You must save
3374 the handle to activate the change group and then finish it.
3375
3376 Before you change the buffer again, you must activate the change
3377 group. Pass the handle to `activate-change-group' afterward to
3378 do this.
3379
3380 After you make the changes, you must finish the change group. You can
3381 either accept the changes or cancel them all. Call
3382 `accept-change-group' to accept the changes in the group as final;
3383 call `cancel-change-group' to undo them all.
3384
3385 You should use `unwind-protect' to make sure the group is always
3386 finished. The call to `activate-change-group' should be inside the
3387 `unwind-protect', in case the user types C-g just after it runs.
3388 (This is one reason why `prepare-change-group' and
3389 `activate-change-group' are separate functions.) Once you finish the
3390 group, don't use the handle again--don't try to finish the same group
3391 twice.
3392
3393 To make a multibuffer change group, call `prepare-change-group' once
3394 for each buffer you want to cover, then use `nconc' to combine the
3395 returned values, like this:
3396
3397 (nconc (prepare-change-group buffer-1)
3398 (prepare-change-group buffer-2))
3399
3400 You can then activate the multibuffer change group with a single call
3401 to `activate-change-group', and finish it with a single call to
3402 `accept-change-group' or `cancel-change-group'.
3403
3404 Nested use of several change groups for the same buffer works as you
3405 would expect. Non-nested use of change groups for the same buffer
3406 will lead to undesirable results, so don't let it happen; the first
3407 change group you start for any given buffer should be the last one
3408 finished.
3409
3410 ** Buffer-related changes:
3411
3412 ---
3413 *** `list-buffers-noselect' now takes an additional argument, BUFFER-LIST.
3414
3415 If it is non-nil, it specifies which buffers to list.
3416
3417 +++
3418 *** `kill-buffer-hook' is now a permanent local.
3419
3420 +++
3421 *** The new function `buffer-local-value' returns the buffer-local
3422 binding of VARIABLE (a symbol) in buffer BUFFER. If VARIABLE does not
3423 have a buffer-local binding in buffer BUFFER, it returns the default
3424 value of VARIABLE instead.
3425
3426 ** Local variables lists:
3427
3428 +++
3429 *** Text properties in local variables.
3430
3431 A file local variables list cannot specify a string with text
3432 properties--any specified text properties are discarded.
3433
3434 +++
3435 *** The variable `safe-local-eval-forms' specifies a list of forms that
3436 are ok to evaluate when they appear in an `eval' local variables
3437 specification. Normally Emacs asks for confirmation before evaluating
3438 such a form, but if the form appears in this list, no confirmation is
3439 needed.
3440
3441 ---
3442 *** If a function has a non-nil `safe-local-eval-function' property,
3443 that means it is ok to evaluate some calls to that function when it
3444 appears in an `eval' local variables specification. If the property
3445 is t, then any form calling that function with constant arguments is
3446 ok. If the property is a function or list of functions, they are called
3447 with the form as argument, and if any returns t, the form is ok to call.
3448
3449 If the form is not "ok to call", that means Emacs asks for
3450 confirmation as before.
3451
3452 ** Searching and matching changes:
3453
3454 +++
3455 *** New function `looking-back' checks whether a regular expression matches
3456 the text before point. Specifying the LIMIT argument bounds how far
3457 back the match can start; this is a way to keep it from taking too long.
3458
3459 +++
3460 *** The new variable `search-spaces-regexp' controls how to search
3461 for spaces in a regular expression. If it is non-nil, it should be a
3462 regular expression, and any series of spaces stands for that regular
3463 expression. If it is nil, spaces stand for themselves.
3464
3465 Spaces inside of constructs such as `[..]' and inside loops such as
3466 `*', `+', and `?' are never replaced with `search-spaces-regexp'.
3467
3468 +++
3469 *** New regular expression operators, `\_<' and `\_>'.
3470
3471 These match the beginning and end of a symbol. A symbol is a
3472 non-empty sequence of either word or symbol constituent characters, as
3473 specified by the syntax table.
3474
3475 ---
3476 *** rx.el has new corresponding `symbol-end' and `symbol-start' elements.
3477
3478 +++
3479 *** `skip-chars-forward' and `skip-chars-backward' now handle
3480 character classes such as `[:alpha:]', along with individual
3481 characters and ranges.
3482
3483 ---
3484 *** In `replace-match', the replacement text no longer inherits
3485 properties from surrounding text.
3486
3487 +++
3488 *** The list returned by `(match-data t)' now has the buffer as a final
3489 element, if the last match was on a buffer. `set-match-data'
3490 accepts such a list for restoring the match state.
3491
3492 +++
3493 *** The default value of `sentence-end' is now defined using the new
3494 variable `sentence-end-without-space', which contains such characters
3495 that end a sentence without following spaces.
3496
3497 The function `sentence-end' should be used to obtain the value of the
3498 variable `sentence-end'. If the variable `sentence-end' is nil, then
3499 this function returns the regexp constructed from the variables
3500 `sentence-end-without-period', `sentence-end-double-space' and
3501 `sentence-end-without-space'.
3502
3503 ** Undo changes:
3504
3505 +++
3506 *** `buffer-undo-list' can allows programmable elements.
3507
3508 These elements have the form (apply FUNNAME . ARGS), where FUNNAME is
3509 a symbol other than t or nil. That stands for a high-level change
3510 that should be undone by evaluating (apply FUNNAME ARGS).
3511
3512 These entries can also have the form (apply DELTA BEG END FUNNAME . ARGS)
3513 which indicates that the change which took place was limited to the
3514 range BEG...END and increased the buffer size by DELTA.
3515
3516 +++
3517 *** If the buffer's undo list for the current command gets longer than
3518 `undo-outer-limit', garbage collection empties it. This is to prevent
3519 it from using up the available memory and choking Emacs.
3520
3521 +++
3522 ** New `yank-handler' text property can be used to control how
3523 previously killed text on the kill ring is reinserted.
3524
3525 The value of the `yank-handler' property must be a list with one to four
3526 elements with the following format:
3527 (FUNCTION PARAM NOEXCLUDE UNDO).
3528
3529 The `insert-for-yank' function looks for a yank-handler property on
3530 the first character on its string argument (typically the first
3531 element on the kill-ring). If a `yank-handler' property is found,
3532 the normal behavior of `insert-for-yank' is modified in various ways:
3533
3534 When FUNCTION is present and non-nil, it is called instead of `insert'
3535 to insert the string. FUNCTION takes one argument--the object to insert.
3536 If PARAM is present and non-nil, it replaces STRING as the object
3537 passed to FUNCTION (or `insert'); for example, if FUNCTION is
3538 `yank-rectangle', PARAM should be a list of strings to insert as a
3539 rectangle.
3540 If NOEXCLUDE is present and non-nil, the normal removal of the
3541 `yank-excluded-properties' is not performed; instead FUNCTION is
3542 responsible for removing those properties. This may be necessary
3543 if FUNCTION adjusts point before or after inserting the object.
3544 If UNDO is present and non-nil, it is a function that will be called
3545 by `yank-pop' to undo the insertion of the current object. It is
3546 called with two arguments, the start and end of the current region.
3547 FUNCTION can set `yank-undo-function' to override the UNDO value.
3548
3549 *** The functions `kill-new', `kill-append', and `kill-region' now have an
3550 optional argument to specify the `yank-handler' text property to put on
3551 the killed text.
3552
3553 *** The function `yank-pop' will now use a non-nil value of the variable
3554 `yank-undo-function' (instead of `delete-region') to undo the previous
3555 `yank' or `yank-pop' command (or a call to `insert-for-yank'). The function
3556 `insert-for-yank' automatically sets that variable according to the UNDO
3557 element of the string argument's `yank-handler' text property if present.
3558
3559 *** The function `insert-for-yank' now supports strings where the
3560 `yank-handler' property does not span the first character of the
3561 string. The old behavior is available if you call
3562 `insert-for-yank-1' instead.
3563
3564 ** Syntax table changes:
3565
3566 +++
3567 *** The macro `with-syntax-table' no longer copies the syntax table.
3568
3569 +++
3570 *** The new function `syntax-after' returns the syntax code
3571 of the character after a specified buffer position, taking account
3572 of text properties as well as the character code.
3573
3574 +++
3575 *** `syntax-class' extracts the class of a syntax code (as returned
3576 by `syntax-after').
3577
3578 *** The new function `syntax-ppss' rovides an efficient way to find the
3579 current syntactic context at point.
3580
3581 ** File operation changes:
3582
3583 +++
3584 *** New vars `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' used when
3585 searching for an executable or an Emacs Lisp file.
3586
3587 +++
3588 *** The new primitive `set-file-times' sets a file's access and
3589 modification times. Magic file name handlers can handle this
3590 operation.
3591
3592 +++
3593 *** The new function `file-remote-p' tests a file name and returns
3594 non-nil if it specifies a remote file (one that Emacs accesses using
3595 its own special methods and not directly through the file system).
3596 The value in that case is an identifier for the remote file system.
3597
3598 +++
3599 *** `buffer-auto-save-file-format' is the new name for what was
3600 formerly called `auto-save-file-format'. It is now a permanent local.
3601
3602 +++
3603 *** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now
3604 ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as
3605 `.emacs' are treated as extensionless.
3606
3607 +++
3608 *** `copy-file' now takes an additional option arg MUSTBENEW.
3609
3610 This argument works like the MUSTBENEW argument of write-file.
3611
3612 +++
3613 *** `visited-file-modtime' and `calendar-time-from-absolute' now return
3614 a list of two integers, instead of a cons.
3615
3616 +++
3617 *** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which
3618 specifies the maximum number of links to chase through. If after that
3619 many iterations the file name obtained is still a symbolic link,
3620 `file-chase-links' returns it anyway.
3621
3622 +++
3623 *** The new hook `before-save-hook' is invoked by `basic-save-buffer'
3624 before saving buffers. This allows packages to perform various final
3625 tasks, for example; it can be used by the copyright package to make
3626 sure saved files have the current year in any copyright headers.
3627
3628 +++
3629 *** If `buffer-save-without-query' is non-nil in some buffer,
3630 `save-some-buffers' will always save that buffer without asking (if
3631 it's modified).
3632
3633 +++
3634 *** New function `locate-file' searches for a file in a list of directories.
3635 `locate-file' accepts a name of a file to search (a string), and two
3636 lists: a list of directories to search in and a list of suffixes to
3637 try; typical usage might use `exec-path' and `load-path' for the list
3638 of directories, and `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' for the list
3639 of suffixes. The function also accepts a predicate argument to
3640 further filter candidate files.
3641
3642 One advantage of using this function is that the list of suffixes in
3643 `exec-suffixes' is OS-dependant, so this function will find
3644 executables without polluting Lisp code with OS dependancies.
3645
3646 ---
3647 *** The precedence of file name handlers has been changed.
3648
3649 Instead of choosing the first handler that matches,
3650 `find-file-name-handler' now gives precedence to a file name handler
3651 that matches nearest the end of the file name. More precisely, the
3652 handler whose (match-beginning 0) is the largest is chosen. In case
3653 of ties, the old "first matched" rule applies.
3654
3655 +++
3656 *** A file name handler can declare which operations it handles.
3657
3658 You do this by putting an `operation' property on the handler name
3659 symbol. The property value should be a list of the operations that
3660 the handler really handles. It won't be called for any other
3661 operations.
3662
3663 This is useful for autoloaded handlers, to prevent them from being
3664 autoloaded when not really necessary.
3665
3666 ** Input changes:
3667
3668 +++
3669 *** An interactive specification can now use the code letter 'U' to get
3670 the up-event that was discarded in case the last key sequence read for a
3671 previous `k' or `K' argument was a down-event; otherwise nil is used.
3672
3673 +++
3674 *** The new interactive-specification `G' reads a file name
3675 much like `F', but if the input is a directory name (even defaulted),
3676 it returns just the directory name.
3677
3678 ---
3679 *** Functions `y-or-n-p', `read-char', `read-key-sequence' and the like, that
3680 display a prompt but don't use the minibuffer, now display the prompt
3681 using the text properties (esp. the face) of the prompt string.
3682
3683 +++
3684 *** (while-no-input BODY...) runs BODY, but only so long as no input
3685 arrives. If the user types or clicks anything, BODY stops as if a
3686 quit had occurred. `while-no-input' returns the value of BODY, if BODY
3687 finishes. It returns nil if BODY was aborted.
3688
3689 ** Minibuffer changes:
3690
3691 +++
3692 *** The new function `minibufferp' returns non-nil if its optional
3693 buffer argument is a minibuffer. If the argument is omitted, it
3694 defaults to the current buffer.
3695
3696 +++
3697 *** New function `minibuffer-selected-window' returns the window which
3698 was selected when entering the minibuffer.
3699
3700 +++
3701 *** `read-from-minibuffer' now accepts an additional argument KEEP-ALL
3702 saying to put all inputs in the history list, even empty ones.
3703
3704 +++
3705 *** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which
3706 specifies a predicate which the file name read must satify. The
3707 new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument
3708 while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this
3709 variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list.
3710
3711 ---
3712 *** The new variable `read-file-name-function' can be used by Lisp code
3713 to override the built-in `read-file-name' function.
3714
3715 +++
3716 *** The new variable `read-file-name-completion-ignore-case' specifies
3717 whether completion ignores case when reading a file name with the
3718 `read-file-name' function.
3719
3720 +++
3721 *** The new function `read-directory-name' for reading a directory name.
3722
3723 It is like `read-file-name' except that the defaulting works better
3724 for directories, and completion inside it shows only directories.
3725
3726 ** Completion changes:
3727
3728 +++
3729 *** The functions `all-completions' and `try-completion' now accept lists
3730 of strings as well as hash-tables additionally to alists, obarrays
3731 and functions. Furthermore, the function `test-completion' is now
3732 exported to Lisp. The keys in alists and hash tables can be either
3733 strings or symbols, which are automatically converted with to strings.
3734
3735 +++
3736 *** The new macro `dynamic-completion-table' supports using functions
3737 as a dynamic completion table.
3738
3739 (dynamic-completion-table FUN)
3740
3741 FUN is called with one argument, the string for which completion is required,
3742 and it should return an alist containing all the intended possible
3743 completions. This alist can be a full list of possible completions so that FUN
3744 can ignore the value of its argument. If completion is performed in the
3745 minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer from which the minibuffer was
3746 entered. `dynamic-completion-table' then computes the completion.
3747
3748 +++
3749 *** The new macro `lazy-completion-table' initializes a variable
3750 as a lazy completion table.
3751
3752 (lazy-completion-table VAR FUN &rest ARGS)
3753
3754 If the completion table VAR is used for the first time (e.g., by passing VAR
3755 as an argument to `try-completion'), the function FUN is called with arguments
3756 ARGS. FUN must return the completion table that will be stored in VAR. If
3757 completion is requested in the minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer
3758 from which the minibuffer was entered. The return value of
3759 `lazy-completion-table' must be used to initialize the value of VAR.
3760
3761 +++
3762 ** Enhancements to keymaps.
3763
3764 *** Cleaner way to enter key sequences.
3765
3766 You can enter a constant key sequence in a more natural format, the
3767 same one used for saving keyboard macros, using the macro `kbd'. For
3768 example,
3769
3770 (kbd "C-x C-f") => "\^x\^f"
3771
3772 *** Interactive commands can be remapped through keymaps.
3773
3774 This is an alternative to using `defadvice' or `substitute-key-definition'
3775 to modify the behavior of a key binding using the normal keymap
3776 binding and lookup functionality.
3777
3778 When a key sequence is bound to a command, and that command is
3779 remapped to another command, that command is run instead of the
3780 original command.
3781
3782 Example:
3783 Suppose that minor mode `my-mode' has defined the commands
3784 `my-kill-line' and `my-kill-word', and it wants C-k (and any other key
3785 bound to `kill-line') to run the command `my-kill-line' instead of
3786 `kill-line', and likewise it wants to run `my-kill-word' instead of
3787 `kill-word'.
3788
3789 Instead of rebinding C-k and the other keys in the minor mode map,
3790 command remapping allows you to directly map `kill-line' into
3791 `my-kill-line' and `kill-word' into `my-kill-word' using `define-key':
3792
3793 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-line] 'my-kill-line)
3794 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-word] 'my-kill-word)
3795
3796 When `my-mode' is enabled, its minor mode keymap is enabled too. So
3797 when the user types C-k, that runs the command `my-kill-line'.
3798
3799 Only one level of remapping is supported. In the above example, this
3800 means that if `my-kill-line' is remapped to `other-kill', then C-k still
3801 runs `my-kill-line'.
3802
3803 The following changes have been made to provide command remapping:
3804
3805 - Command remappings are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
3806 `remap', i.e. `(define-key MAP [remap CMD] DEF)' remaps command CMD
3807 to definition DEF in keymap MAP. The definition is not limited to
3808 another command; it can be anything accepted for a normal binding.
3809
3810 - The new function `command-remapping' returns the binding for a
3811 remapped command in the current keymaps, or nil if not remapped.
3812
3813 - `key-binding' now remaps interactive commands unless the optional
3814 third argument NO-REMAP is non-nil.
3815
3816 - `where-is-internal' now returns nil for a remapped command (e.g.
3817 `kill-line', when `my-mode' is enabled), and the actual key binding for
3818 the command it is remapped to (e.g. C-k for my-kill-line).
3819 It also has a new optional fifth argument, NO-REMAP, which inhibits
3820 remapping if non-nil (e.g. it returns "C-k" for `kill-line', and
3821 "<kill-line>" for `my-kill-line').
3822
3823 - The new variable `this-original-command' contains the original
3824 command before remapping. It is equal to `this-command' when the
3825 command was not remapped.
3826
3827 *** If text has a `keymap' property, that keymap takes precedence
3828 over minor mode keymaps.
3829
3830 *** The `keymap' property now also works at the ends of overlays and
3831 text properties, according to their stickiness. This also means that it
3832 works with empty overlays. The same hold for the `local-map' property.
3833
3834 *** Dense keymaps now handle inheritance correctly.
3835
3836 Previously a dense keymap would hide all of the simple-char key
3837 bindings of the parent keymap.
3838
3839 *** `define-key-after' now accepts keys longer than 1.
3840
3841 *** New function `current-active-maps' returns a list of currently
3842 active keymaps.
3843
3844 *** New function `describe-buffer-bindings' inserts the list of all
3845 defined keys and their definitions.
3846
3847 *** New function `keymap-prompt' returns the prompt string of a keymap.
3848
3849 *** (map-keymap FUNCTION KEYMAP) applies the function to each binding
3850 in the keymap.
3851
3852 *** New variable `emulation-mode-map-alists'.
3853
3854 Lisp packages using many minor mode keymaps can now maintain their own
3855 keymap alist separate from `minor-mode-map-alist' by adding their
3856 keymap alist to this list.
3857
3858 ** Abbrev changes:
3859
3860 +++
3861 *** The new function `copy-abbrev-table' copies an abbrev table.
3862
3863 It returns a new abbrev table that is a copy of a given abbrev table.
3864
3865 +++
3866 *** `define-abbrev' now accepts an optional argument SYSTEM-FLAG.
3867
3868 If non-nil, this marks the abbrev as a "system" abbrev, which means
3869 that it won't be stored in the user's abbrevs file if he saves the
3870 abbrevs. Major modes that predefine some abbrevs should always
3871 specify this flag.
3872
3873 +++
3874 ** Enhancements to process support
3875
3876 *** Function `list-processes' now has an optional argument; if non-nil,
3877 it lists only the processes whose query-on-exit flag is set.
3878
3879 *** New fns `set-process-query-on-exit-flag' and `process-query-on-exit-flag'.
3880
3881 These replace the old function `process-kill-without-query'. That
3882 function is still supported, but new code should use the new
3883 functions.
3884
3885 *** Function `signal-process' now accepts a process object or process
3886 name in addition to a process id to identify the signalled process.
3887
3888 *** Processes now have an associated property list where programs can
3889 maintain process state and other per-process related information.
3890
3891 Use the new functions `process-get' and `process-put' to access, add,
3892 and modify elements on this property list. Use the new functions
3893 `process-plist' and `set-process-plist' to access and replace the
3894 entire property list of a process.
3895
3896 *** Function `accept-process-output' has a new optional fourth arg
3897 JUST-THIS-ONE. If non-nil, only output from the specified process
3898 is handled, suspending output from other processes. If value is an
3899 integer, also inhibit running timers. This feature is generally not
3900 recommended, but may be necessary for specific applications, such as
3901 speech synthesis.
3902
3903 *** Adaptive read buffering of subprocess output.
3904
3905 On some systems, when emacs reads the output from a subprocess, the
3906 output data is read in very small blocks, potentially resulting in
3907 very poor performance. This behavior can be remedied to some extent
3908 by setting the new variable `process-adaptive-read-buffering' to a
3909 non-nil value (the default), as it will automatically delay reading
3910 from such processes, to allowing them to produce more output before
3911 emacs tries to read it.
3912
3913 *** The new function `call-process-shell-command'.
3914
3915 This executes a shell command command synchronously in a separate
3916 process.
3917
3918 *** The new function `process-file' is similar to `call-process', but
3919 obeys file handlers. The file handler is chosen based on
3920 `default-directory'.
3921
3922 *** A process filter function gets the output as multibyte string
3923 if the process specifies t for its filter's multibyteness.
3924
3925 That multibyteness is decided by the value of
3926 `default-enable-multibyte-characters' when the process is created, and
3927 you can change it later with `set-process-filter-multibyte'.
3928
3929 *** The new function `set-process-filter-multibyte' sets the
3930 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
3931
3932 *** The new function `process-filter-multibyte-p' returns the
3933 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
3934
3935 *** If a process's coding system is `raw-text' or `no-conversion' and its
3936 buffer is multibyte, the output of the process is at first converted
3937 to multibyte by `string-to-multibyte' then inserted in the buffer.
3938 Previously, it was converted to multibyte by `string-as-multibyte',
3939 which was not compatible with the behavior of file reading.
3940
3941 +++
3942 ** Enhanced networking support.
3943
3944 *** The new `make-network-process' function makes network connections.
3945 It allows opening of stream and datagram connections to a server, as well as
3946 create a stream or datagram server inside emacs.
3947
3948 - A server is started using :server t arg.
3949 - Datagram connection is selected using :type 'datagram arg.
3950 - A server can open on a random port using :service t arg.
3951 - Local sockets are supported using :family 'local arg.
3952 - Non-blocking connect is supported using :nowait t arg.
3953 - The process' property list can be initialized using :plist PLIST arg;
3954 a copy of the server process' property list is automatically inherited
3955 by new client processes created to handle incoming connections.
3956
3957 To test for the availability of a given feature, use featurep like this:
3958 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:type datagram))
3959
3960 *** The old `open-network-stream' now uses `make-network-process'.
3961
3962 *** New functions `process-datagram-address', `set-process-datagram-address'.
3963
3964 These functions are used with datagram-based network processes to get
3965 and set the current address of the remote partner.
3966
3967 *** New function `format-network-address'.
3968
3969 This function reformats the Lisp representation of a network address
3970 to a printable string. For example, an IP address A.B.C.D and port
3971 number P is represented as a five element vector [A B C D P], and the
3972 printable string returned for this vector is "A.B.C.D:P". See the doc
3973 string for other formatting options.
3974
3975 *** `process-contact' has an optional KEY argument.
3976
3977 Depending on this argument, you can get the complete list of network
3978 process properties or a specific property. Using :local or :remote as
3979 the KEY, you get the address of the local or remote end-point.
3980
3981 An Inet address is represented as a 5 element vector, where the first
3982 4 elements contain the IP address and the fifth is the port number.
3983
3984 *** New functions `stop-process' and `continue-process'.
3985
3986 These functions stop and restart communication through a network
3987 connection. For a server process, no connections are accepted in the
3988 stopped state. For a client process, no input is received in the
3989 stopped state.
3990
3991 *** New function `network-interface-list'.
3992
3993 This function returns a list of network interface names and their
3994 current network addresses.
3995
3996 *** New function `network-interface-info'.
3997
3998 This function returns the network address, hardware address, current
3999 status, and other information about a specific network interface.
4000
4001 *** Deleting a network process with `delete-process' calls the sentinel.
4002
4003 The status message passed to the sentinel for a deleted network
4004 process is "deleted". The message passed to the sentinel when the
4005 connection is closed by the remote peer has been changed to
4006 "connection broken by remote peer".
4007
4008 ** Using window objects:
4009
4010 +++
4011 *** New function `window-body-height'.
4012
4013 This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line or the
4014 header line.
4015
4016 +++
4017 *** New function `window-body-height'.
4018
4019 This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line
4020 or the header line.
4021
4022 +++
4023 *** You can now make a window as short as one line.
4024
4025 A window that is just one line tall does not display either a mode
4026 line or a header line, even if the variables `mode-line-format' and
4027 `header-line-format' call for them. A window that is two lines tall
4028 cannot display both a mode line and a header line at once; if the
4029 variables call for both, only the mode line actually appears.
4030
4031 +++
4032 *** The new function `window-inside-edges' returns the edges of the
4033 actual text portion of the window, not including the scroll bar or
4034 divider line, the fringes, the display margins, the header line and
4035 the mode line.
4036
4037 +++
4038 *** The new functions `window-pixel-edges' and `window-inside-pixel-edges'
4039 return window edges in units of pixels, rather than columns and lines.
4040
4041 +++
4042 *** The new macro `with-selected-window' temporarily switches the
4043 selected window without impacting the order of `buffer-list'.
4044
4045 +++
4046 *** `select-window' takes an optional second argument NORECORD.
4047
4048 This is like `switch-to-buffer'.
4049
4050 +++
4051 *** `save-selected-window' now saves and restores the selected window
4052 of every frame. This way, it restores everything that can be changed
4053 by calling `select-window'.
4054
4055 +++
4056 *** `set-window-buffer' has an optional argument KEEP-MARGINS.
4057
4058 If non-nil, that says to preserve the window's current margin, fringe,
4059 and scroll-bar settings.
4060
4061 +++
4062 ** Customizable fringe bitmaps
4063
4064 *** New function `define-fringe-bitmap' can now be used to create new
4065 fringe bitmaps, as well as change the built-in fringe bitmaps.
4066
4067 To change a built-in bitmap, do (require 'fringe) and use the symbol
4068 identifing the bitmap such as `left-truncation or `continued-line'.
4069
4070 *** New function `destroy-fringe-bitmap' deletes a fringe bitmap
4071 or restores a built-in one to its default value.
4072
4073 *** New function `set-fringe-bitmap-face' specifies the face to be
4074 used for a specific fringe bitmap. The face is automatically merged
4075 with the `fringe' face, so normally, the face should only specify the
4076 foreground color of the bitmap.
4077
4078 *** There are new display properties, `left-fringe' and `right-fringe',
4079 that can be used to show a specific bitmap in the left or right fringe
4080 bitmap of the display line.
4081
4082 Format is `display (left-fringe BITMAP [FACE])', where BITMAP is a
4083 symbol identifying a fringe bitmap, either built-in or defined with
4084 `define-fringe-bitmap', and FACE is an optional face name to be used
4085 for displaying the bitmap instead of the default `fringe' face.
4086 When specified, FACE is automatically merged with the `fringe' face.
4087
4088 *** New function `fringe-bitmaps-at-pos' returns the current fringe
4089 bitmaps in the display line at a given buffer position.
4090
4091 ** Other window fringe features:
4092
4093 +++
4094 *** Controlling the default left and right fringe widths.
4095
4096 The default left and right fringe widths for all windows of a frame
4097 can now be controlled by setting the `left-fringe' and `right-fringe'
4098 frame parameters to an integer value specifying the width in pixels.
4099 Setting the width to 0 effectively removes the corresponding fringe.
4100
4101 The actual default fringe widths for the frame may deviate from the
4102 specified widths, since the combined fringe widths must match an
4103 integral number of columns. The extra width is distributed evenly
4104 between the left and right fringe. For force a specific fringe width,
4105 specify the width as a negative integer (if both widths are negative,
4106 only the left fringe gets the specified width).
4107
4108 Setting the width to nil (the default), restores the default fringe
4109 width which is the minimum number of pixels necessary to display any
4110 of the currently defined fringe bitmaps. The width of the built-in
4111 fringe bitmaps is 8 pixels.
4112
4113 +++
4114 *** Per-window fringe and scrollbar settings
4115
4116 **** Windows can now have their own individual fringe widths and
4117 position settings.
4118
4119 To control the fringe widths of a window, either set the buffer-local
4120 variables `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', or call
4121 `set-window-fringes'.
4122
4123 To control the fringe position in a window, that is, whether fringes
4124 are positioned between the display margins and the window's text area,
4125 or at the edges of the window, either set the buffer-local variable
4126 `fringes-outside-margins' or call `set-window-fringes'.
4127
4128 The function `window-fringes' can be used to obtain the current
4129 settings. To make `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', and
4130 `fringes-outside-margins' take effect, you must set them before
4131 displaying the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force
4132 an update of the display margins.
4133
4134 **** Windows can now have their own individual scroll-bar settings
4135 controlling the width and position of scroll-bars.
4136
4137 To control the scroll-bar of a window, either set the buffer-local
4138 variables `scroll-bar-mode' and `scroll-bar-width', or call
4139 `set-window-scroll-bars'. The function `window-scroll-bars' can be
4140 used to obtain the current settings. To make `scroll-bar-mode' and
4141 `scroll-bar-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
4142 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
4143 of the display margins.
4144
4145 ** Redisplay features:
4146
4147 +++
4148 *** `sit-for' can now be called with args (SECONDS &optional NODISP).
4149
4150 +++
4151 *** New function `force-window-update' can initiate a full redisplay of
4152 one or all windows. Normally, this is not needed as changes in window
4153 contents are detected automatically. However, certain implicit
4154 changes to mode lines, header lines, or display properties may require
4155 forcing an explicit window update.
4156
4157 +++
4158 *** (char-displayable-p CHAR) returns non-nil if Emacs ought to be able
4159 to display CHAR. More precisely, if the selected frame's fontset has
4160 a font to display the character set that CHAR belongs to.
4161
4162 Fontsets can specify a font on a per-character basis; when the fontset
4163 does that, this value cannot be accurate.
4164
4165 +++
4166 *** You can define multiple overlay arrows via the new
4167 variable `overlay-arrow-variable-list'.
4168
4169 It contains a list of varibles which contain overlay arrow position
4170 markers, including the original `overlay-arrow-position' variable.
4171
4172 Each variable on this list can have individual `overlay-arrow-string'
4173 and `overlay-arrow-bitmap' properties that specify an overlay arrow
4174 string (for non-window terminals) or fringe bitmap (for window
4175 systems) to display at the corresponding overlay arrow position.
4176 If either property is not set, the default `overlay-arrow-string' or
4177 'overlay-arrow-fringe-bitmap' will be used.
4178
4179 +++
4180 *** New `line-height' and `line-spacing' properties for newline characters
4181
4182 A newline can now have `line-height' and `line-spacing' text or overlay
4183 properties that control the height of the corresponding display row.
4184
4185 If the `line-height' property value is t, the newline does not
4186 contribute to the height of the display row; instead the height of the
4187 newline glyph is reduced. Also, a `line-spacing' property on this
4188 newline is ignored. This can be used to tile small images or image
4189 slices without adding blank areas between the images.
4190
4191 If the `line-height' property value is a positive integer, the value
4192 specifies the minimum line height in pixels. If necessary, the line
4193 height it increased by increasing the line's ascent.
4194
4195 If the `line-height' property value is a float, the minimum line
4196 height is calculated by multiplying the default frame line height by
4197 the given value.
4198
4199 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (FACE . RATIO), the
4200 minimum line height is calculated as RATIO * height of named FACE.
4201 RATIO is int or float. If FACE is t, it specifies the current face.
4202
4203 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (nil . RATIO), the line
4204 height is calculated as RATIO * actual height of the line's contents.
4205
4206 If the `line-height' value is a cons (HEIGHT . TOTAL), HEIGHT specifies
4207 the line height as described above, while TOTAL is any of the forms
4208 described above and specifies the total height of the line, causing a
4209 varying number of pixels to be inserted after the line to make it line
4210 exactly that many pixels high.
4211
4212 If the `line-spacing' property value is an positive integer, the value
4213 is used as additional pixels to insert after the display line; this
4214 overrides the default frame `line-spacing' and any buffer local value of
4215 the `line-spacing' variable.
4216
4217 If the `line-spacing' property is a float or cons, the line spacing
4218 is calculated as specified above for the `line-height' property.
4219
4220 +++
4221 *** The buffer local `line-spacing' variable can now have a float value,
4222 which is used as a height relative to the default frame line height.
4223
4224 +++
4225 *** Enhancements to stretch display properties
4226
4227 The display property stretch specification form `(space PROPS)', where
4228 PROPS is a property list now allows pixel based width and height
4229 specifications, as well as enhanced horizontal text alignment.
4230
4231 The value of these properties can now be a (primitive) expression
4232 which is evaluated during redisplay. The following expressions
4233 are supported:
4234
4235 EXPR ::= NUM | (NUM) | UNIT | ELEM | POS | IMAGE | FORM
4236 NUM ::= INTEGER | FLOAT | SYMBOL
4237 UNIT ::= in | mm | cm | width | height
4238 ELEM ::= left-fringe | right-fringe | left-margin | right-margin
4239 | scroll-bar | text
4240 POS ::= left | center | right
4241 FORM ::= (NUM . EXPR) | (OP EXPR ...)
4242 OP ::= + | -
4243
4244 The form `NUM' specifies a fractional width or height of the default
4245 frame font size. The form `(NUM)' specifies an absolute number of
4246 pixels. If a symbol is specified, its buffer-local variable binding
4247 is used. The `in', `mm', and `cm' units specifies the number of
4248 pixels per inch, milli-meter, and centi-meter, resp. The `width' and
4249 `height' units correspond to the width and height of the current face
4250 font. An image specification corresponds to the width or height of
4251 the image.
4252
4253 The `left-fringe', `right-fringe', `left-margin', `right-margin',
4254 `scroll-bar', and `text' elements specify to the width of the
4255 corresponding area of the window.
4256
4257 The `left', `center', and `right' positions can be used with :align-to
4258 to specify a position relative to the left edge, center, or right edge
4259 of the text area. One of the above window elements (except `text')
4260 can also be used with :align-to to specify that the position is
4261 relative to the left edge of the given area. Once the base offset for
4262 a relative position has been set (by the first occurrence of one of
4263 these symbols), further occurences of these symbols are interpreted as
4264 the width of the area.
4265
4266 For example, to align to the center of the left-margin, use
4267 :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin))
4268
4269 If no specific base offset is set for alignment, it is always relative
4270 to the left edge of the text area. For example, :align-to 0 in a
4271 header line aligns with the first text column in the text area.
4272
4273 The value of the form `(NUM . EXPR)' is the value of NUM multiplied by
4274 the value of the expression EXPR. For example, (2 . in) specifies a
4275 width of 2 inches, while (0.5 . IMAGE) specifies half the width (or
4276 height) of the specified image.
4277
4278 The form `(+ EXPR ...)' adds up the value of the expressions.
4279 The form `(- EXPR ...)' negates or subtracts the value of the expressions.
4280
4281 +++
4282 *** Normally, the cursor is displayed at the end of any overlay and
4283 text property string that may be present at the current window
4284 position. The cursor can now be placed on any character of such
4285 strings by giving that character a non-nil `cursor' text property.
4286
4287 +++
4288 *** The display space :width and :align-to text properties are now
4289 supported on text terminals.
4290
4291 +++
4292 *** Support for displaying image slices
4293
4294 **** New display property (slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT) can be used with
4295 an image property to display only a specific slice of the image.
4296
4297 **** Function `insert-image' has new optional fourth arg to
4298 specify image slice (X Y WIDTH HEIGHT).
4299
4300 **** New function `insert-sliced-image' inserts a given image as a
4301 specified number of evenly sized slices (rows x columns).
4302
4303 +++
4304 *** Images can now have an associated image map via the :map property.
4305
4306 An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
4307 An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
4308 A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((X0 . Y0) . (X1 . Y1))) specifying the
4309 pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
4310 A circle is a cons (circle . ((X0 . Y0) . R)) specifying the center
4311 and the radius of the circle; R can be a float or integer.
4312 A polygon is a cons (poly . [X0 Y0 X1 Y1 ...]) where each pair in the
4313 vector describes one corner in the polygon.
4314
4315 When the mouse pointer is above a hot-spot area of an image, the
4316 PLIST of that hot-spot is consulted; if it contains a `help-echo'
4317 property it defines a tool-tip for the hot-spot, and if it contains
4318 a `pointer' property, it defines the shape of the mouse cursor when
4319 it is over the hot-spot. See the variable `void-area-text-pointer'
4320 for possible pointer shapes.
4321
4322 When you click the mouse when the mouse pointer is over a hot-spot,
4323 an event is composed by combining the ID of the hot-spot with the
4324 mouse event, e.g. [area4 mouse-1] if the hot-spot's ID is `area4'.
4325
4326 ** Mouse pointer features:
4327
4328 +++ (lispref)
4329 ??? (man)
4330 *** The mouse pointer shape in void text areas (i.e. after the end of a
4331 line or below the last line in the buffer) of the text window is now
4332 controlled by the new variable `void-text-area-pointer'. The default
4333 is to use the `arrow' (non-text) pointer. Other choices are `text'
4334 (or nil), `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'.
4335
4336 +++
4337 *** The mouse pointer shape over an image can now be controlled by the
4338 :pointer image property.
4339
4340 +++
4341 *** The mouse pointer shape over ordinary text or images can now be
4342 controlled/overriden via the `pointer' text property.
4343
4344 ** Mouse event enhancements:
4345
4346 +++
4347 *** Mouse events for clicks on window fringes now specify `left-fringe'
4348 or `right-fringe' as the area.
4349
4350 +++
4351 *** All mouse events now include a buffer position regardless of where
4352 you clicked. For mouse clicks in window margins and fringes, this is
4353 a sensible buffer position corresponding to the surrounding text.
4354
4355 +++
4356 *** `posn-point' now returns buffer position for non-text area events.
4357
4358 +++
4359 *** Function `mouse-set-point' now works for events outside text area.
4360
4361 +++
4362 *** New function `posn-area' returns window area clicked on (nil means
4363 text area).
4364
4365 +++
4366 *** Mouse events include actual glyph column and row for all event types
4367 and all areas.
4368
4369 +++
4370 *** New function `posn-actual-col-row' returns the actual glyph coordinates
4371 of the mouse event position.
4372
4373 +++
4374 *** Mouse events can now indicate an image object clicked on.
4375
4376 +++
4377 *** Mouse events include relative X and Y pixel coordinates relative to
4378 the top left corner of the object (image or character) clicked on.
4379
4380 +++
4381 *** Mouse events include the pixel width and height of the object
4382 (image or character) clicked on.
4383
4384 +++
4385 *** New functions 'posn-object', 'posn-object-x-y', 'posn-object-width-height'.
4386
4387 These return the image or string object of a mouse click, the X and Y
4388 pixel coordinates relative to the top left corner of that object, and
4389 the total width and height of that object.
4390
4391 ** Text property and overlay changes:
4392
4393 +++
4394 *** Arguments for `remove-overlays' are now optional, so that you can
4395 remove all overlays in the buffer with just (remove-overlays).
4396
4397 +++
4398 *** New variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
4399
4400 This variable allows you to create alternative names for text
4401 properties. It works at the same level as `default-text-properties',
4402 although it applies to overlays as well. This variable was introduced
4403 to implement the `font-lock-face' property.
4404
4405 +++
4406 *** New function `get-char-property-and-overlay' accepts the same
4407 arguments as `get-char-property' and returns a cons whose car is the
4408 return value of `get-char-property' called with those arguments and
4409 whose cdr is the overlay in which the property was found, or nil if
4410 it was found as a text property or not found at all.
4411
4412 +++
4413 *** The new function `remove-list-of-text-properties'.
4414
4415 It is like `remove-text-properties' except that it takes a list of
4416 property names as argument rather than a property list.
4417
4418 ** Face changes
4419
4420 +++
4421 *** The new face attribute condition `min-colors' can be used to tailor
4422 the face color to the number of colors supported by a display, and
4423 define the foreground and background colors accordingly so that they
4424 look best on a terminal that supports at least this many colors. This
4425 is now the preferred method for defining default faces in a way that
4426 makes a good use of the capabilities of the display.
4427
4428 +++
4429 *** New function `display-supports-face-attributes-p' can be used to test
4430 whether a given set of face attributes is actually displayable.
4431
4432 A new predicate `supports' has also been added to the `defface' face
4433 specification language, which can be used to do this test for faces
4434 defined with `defface'.
4435
4436 ---
4437 *** The special treatment of faces whose names are of the form `fg:COLOR'
4438 or `bg:COLOR' has been removed. Lisp programs should use the
4439 `defface' facility for defining faces with specific colors, or use
4440 the feature of specifying the face attributes :foreground and :background
4441 directly in the `face' property instead of using a named face.
4442
4443 +++
4444 *** The first face specification element in a defface can specify
4445 `default' instead of frame classification. Then its attributes act as
4446 defaults that apply to all the subsequent cases (and can be overridden
4447 by them).
4448
4449 +++
4450 *** The variable `face-font-rescale-alist' specifies how much larger
4451 (or smaller) font we should use. For instance, if the value is
4452 '((SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN . 1.3)) and a face requests a font of 10
4453 point, we actually use a font of 13 point if the font matches
4454 SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN.
4455
4456 ---
4457 *** The function `face-differs-from-default-p' now truly checks
4458 whether the given face displays differently from the default face or
4459 not (previously it did only a very cursory check).
4460
4461 +++
4462 *** `face-attribute', `face-foreground', `face-background', `face-stipple'.
4463
4464 These now accept a new optional argument, INHERIT, which controls how
4465 face inheritance is used when determining the value of a face
4466 attribute.
4467
4468 +++
4469 *** New functions `face-attribute-relative-p' and `merge-face-attribute'
4470 help with handling relative face attributes.
4471
4472 +++
4473 *** The priority of faces in an :inherit attribute face list is reversed.
4474
4475 If a face contains an :inherit attribute with a list of faces, earlier
4476 faces in the list override later faces in the list; in previous
4477 releases of Emacs, the order was the opposite. This change was made
4478 so that :inherit face lists operate identically to face lists in text
4479 `face' properties.
4480
4481 ---
4482 *** `set-fontset-font', `fontset-info', `fontset-font' now operate on
4483 the default fontset if the argument NAME is nil..
4484
4485 ** Font-Lock changes:
4486
4487 +++
4488 *** New special text property `font-lock-face'.
4489
4490 This property acts like the `face' property, but it is controlled by
4491 M-x font-lock-mode. It is not, strictly speaking, a builtin text
4492 property. Instead, it is implemented inside font-core.el, using the
4493 new variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
4494
4495 +++
4496 *** font-lock can manage arbitrary text-properties beside `face'.
4497
4498 **** the FACENAME returned in `font-lock-keywords' can be a list of the
4499 form (face FACE PROP1 VAL1 PROP2 VAL2 ...) so you can set other
4500 properties than `face'.
4501
4502 **** `font-lock-extra-managed-props' can be set to make sure those
4503 extra properties are automatically cleaned up by font-lock.
4504
4505 ---
4506 *** jit-lock obeys a new text-property `jit-lock-defer-multiline'.
4507
4508 If a piece of text with that property gets contextually refontified
4509 (see `jit-lock-defer-contextually'), then all of that text will
4510 be refontified. This is useful when the syntax of a textual element
4511 depends on text several lines further down (and when `font-lock-multiline'
4512 is not appropriate to solve that problem). For example in Perl:
4513
4514 s{
4515 foo
4516 }{
4517 bar
4518 }e
4519
4520 Adding/removing the last `e' changes the `bar' from being a piece of
4521 text to being a piece of code, so you'd put a `jit-lock-defer-multiline'
4522 property over the second half of the command to force (deferred)
4523 refontification of `bar' whenever the `e' is added/removed.
4524
4525 ** Major mode mechanism changes:
4526
4527 +++
4528 *** `set-auto-mode' now gives the interpreter magic line (if present)
4529 precedence over the file name. Likewise an `<?xml' or `<!DOCTYPE'
4530 declaration will give the buffer XML or SGML mode, based on the new
4531 var `magic-mode-alist'.
4532
4533 +++
4534 *** Use the new function `run-mode-hooks' to run the major mode's mode hook.
4535
4536 +++
4537 *** All major mode functions should now run the new normal hook
4538 `after-change-major-mode-hook', at their very end, after the mode
4539 hooks. `run-mode-hooks' does this automatically.
4540
4541 ---
4542 *** If a major mode function has a non-nil `no-clone-indirect'
4543 property, `clone-indirect-buffer' signals an error if you use
4544 it in that buffer.
4545
4546 +++
4547 *** Major modes can define `eldoc-documentation-function'
4548 locally to provide Eldoc functionality by some method appropriate to
4549 the language.
4550
4551 +++
4552 *** `define-derived-mode' by default creates a new empty abbrev table.
4553 It does not copy abbrevs from the parent mode's abbrev table.
4554
4555 +++
4556 *** The new function `run-mode-hooks' and the new macro `delay-mode-hooks'
4557 are used by `define-derived-mode' to make sure the mode hook for the
4558 parent mode is run at the end of the child mode.
4559
4560 ** Minor mode changes:
4561
4562 +++
4563 *** `define-minor-mode' now accepts arbitrary additional keyword arguments
4564 and simply passes them to `defcustom', if applicable.
4565
4566 +++
4567 *** `minor-mode-list' now holds a list of minor mode commands.
4568
4569 +++
4570 *** `define-global-minor-mode'.
4571
4572 This is a new name for what was formerly called
4573 `easy-mmode-define-global-mode'. The old name remains as an alias.
4574
4575 ** Command loop changes:
4576
4577 +++
4578 *** The new function `called-interactively-p' does what many people
4579 have mistakenly believed `interactive-p' to do: it returns t if the
4580 calling function was called through `call-interactively'.
4581
4582 Only use this when you cannot solve the problem by adding a new
4583 INTERACTIVE argument to the command.
4584
4585 +++
4586 *** The function `commandp' takes an additional optional argument.
4587
4588 If it is non-nil, then `commandp' checks for a function that could be
4589 called with `call-interactively', and does not return t for keyboard
4590 macros.
4591
4592 +++
4593 *** When a command returns, the command loop moves point out from
4594 within invisible text, in the same way it moves out from within text
4595 covered by an image or composition property.
4596
4597 This makes it generally unnecessary to mark invisible text as intangible.
4598 This is particularly good because the intangible property often has
4599 unexpected side-effects since the property applies to everything
4600 (including `goto-char', ...) whereas this new code is only run after
4601 `post-command-hook' and thus does not care about intermediate states.
4602
4603 +++
4604 *** If a command sets `transient-mark-mode' to `only', that
4605 enables Transient Mark mode for the following command only.
4606 During that following command, the value of `transient-mark-mode'
4607 is `identity'. If it is still `identity' at the end of the command,
4608 the next return to the command loop changes to nil.
4609
4610 +++
4611 *** Both the variable and the function `disabled-command-hook' have
4612 been renamed to `disabled-command-function'. The variable
4613 `disabled-command-hook' has been kept as an obsolete alias.
4614
4615 +++
4616 *** `emacsserver' now runs `pre-command-hook' and `post-command-hook'
4617 when it receives a request from emacsclient.
4618
4619 ** Lisp file loading changes:
4620
4621 +++
4622 *** `load-history' can now have elements of the form (t . FUNNAME),
4623 which means FUNNAME was previously defined as an autoload (before the
4624 current file redefined it).
4625
4626 +++
4627 *** `load-history' now records (defun . FUNNAME) when a function is
4628 defined. For a variable, it records just the variable name.
4629
4630 +++
4631 *** The function `symbol-file' can now search specifically for function,
4632 variable or face definitions.
4633
4634 +++
4635 *** `provide' and `featurep' now accept an optional second argument
4636 to test/provide subfeatures. Also `provide' now checks `after-load-alist'
4637 and runs any code associated with the provided feature.
4638
4639 ---
4640 *** The variable `recursive-load-depth-limit' has been deleted.
4641 Emacs now signals an error if the same file is loaded with more
4642 than 3 levels of nesting.
4643
4644 +++
4645 ** Byte compiler changes:
4646
4647 *** The byte compiler now displays the actual line and character
4648 position of errors, where possible. Additionally, the form of its
4649 warning and error messages have been brought into line with GNU standards
4650 for these. As a result, you can use next-error and friends on the
4651 compilation output buffer.
4652
4653 *** The new macro `with-no-warnings' suppresses all compiler warnings
4654 inside its body. In terms of execution, it is equivalent to `progn'.
4655
4656 *** You can avoid warnings for possibly-undefined symbols with a
4657 simple convention that the compiler understands. (This is mostly
4658 useful in code meant to be portable to different Emacs versions.)
4659 Write forms like the following, or code that macroexpands into such
4660 forms:
4661
4662 (if (fboundp 'foo) <then> <else>)
4663 (if (boundp 'foo) <then> <else)
4664
4665 In the first case, using `foo' as a function inside the <then> form
4666 won't produce a warning if it's not defined as a function, and in the
4667 second case, using `foo' as a variable won't produce a warning if it's
4668 unbound. The test must be in exactly one of the above forms (after
4669 macro expansion), but such tests can be nested. Note that `when' and
4670 `unless' expand to `if', but `cond' doesn't.
4671
4672 *** `(featurep 'xemacs)' is treated by the compiler as nil. This
4673 helps to avoid noisy compiler warnings in code meant to run under both
4674 Emacs and XEmacs and can sometimes make the result significantly more
4675 efficient. Since byte code from recent versions of XEmacs won't
4676 generally run in Emacs and vice versa, this optimization doesn't lose
4677 you anything.
4678
4679 *** The local variable `no-byte-compile' in Lisp files is now obeyed.
4680
4681 ---
4682 *** When a Lisp file uses CL functions at run-time, compiling the file
4683 now issues warnings about these calls, unless the file performs
4684 (require 'cl) when loaded.
4685
4686 ** Frame operations:
4687
4688 +++
4689 *** New functions `frame-current-scroll-bars' and `window-current-scroll-bars'.
4690
4691 These functions return the current locations of the vertical and
4692 horizontal scroll bars in a frame or window.
4693
4694 +++
4695 *** The new function `modify-all-frames-parameters' modifies parameters
4696 for all (existing and future) frames.
4697
4698 +++
4699 *** The new frame parameter `tty-color-mode' specifies the mode to use
4700 for color support on character terminal frames. Its value can be a
4701 number of colors to support, or a symbol. See the Emacs Lisp
4702 Reference manual for more detailed documentation.
4703
4704 +++
4705 *** When using non-toolkit scroll bars with the default width,
4706 the `scroll-bar-width' frame parameter value is nil.
4707
4708 ** Mule changes:
4709
4710 +++
4711 *** Already true in Emacs 21.1, but not emphasized clearly enough:
4712
4713 Multibyte buffers can now faithfully record all 256 character codes
4714 from 0 to 255. As a result, most of the past reasons to use unibyte
4715 buffers no longer exist. We only know of three reasons to use them
4716 now:
4717
4718 1. If you prefer to use unibyte text all of the time.
4719
4720 2. For reading files into temporary buffers, when you want to avoid
4721 the time it takes to convert the format.
4722
4723 3. For binary files where format conversion would be pointless and
4724 wasteful.
4725
4726 ---
4727 *** `set-buffer-file-coding-system' now takes an additional argument,
4728 NOMODIFY. If it is non-nil, it means don't mark the buffer modified.
4729
4730 +++
4731 *** The new variable `auto-coding-functions' lets you specify functions
4732 to examine a file being visited and deduce the proper coding system
4733 for it. (If the coding system is detected incorrectly for a specific
4734 file, you can put a `coding:' tags to override it.)
4735
4736 ---
4737 *** The new function `merge-coding-systems' fills in unspecified aspects
4738 of one coding system from another coding system.
4739
4740 ---
4741 *** New coding system property `mime-text-unsuitable' indicates that
4742 the coding system's `mime-charset' is not suitable for MIME text
4743 parts, e.g. utf-16.
4744
4745 +++
4746 *** New function `decode-coding-inserted-region' decodes a region as if
4747 it is read from a file without decoding.
4748
4749 ---
4750 *** New CCL functions `lookup-character' and `lookup-integer' access
4751 hash tables defined by the Lisp function `define-translation-hash-table'.
4752
4753 ---
4754 *** New function `quail-find-key' returns a list of keys to type in the
4755 current input method to input a character.
4756
4757 ** Mode line changes:
4758
4759 +++
4760 *** New function `format-mode-line'.
4761
4762 This returns the mode line or header line of the selected (or a
4763 specified) window as a string with or without text properties.
4764
4765 +++
4766 *** The new mode-line construct `(:propertize ELT PROPS...)' can be
4767 used to add text properties to mode-line elements.
4768
4769 +++
4770 *** The new `%i' and `%I' constructs for `mode-line-format' can be used
4771 to display the size of the accessible part of the buffer on the mode
4772 line.
4773
4774 ** Menu manipulation changes:
4775
4776 ---
4777 *** To manipulate the File menu using easy-menu, you must specify the
4778 proper name "file". In previous Emacs versions, you had to specify
4779 "files", even though the menu item itself was changed to say "File"
4780 several versions ago.
4781
4782 ---
4783 *** The dummy function keys made by easy-menu are now always lower case.
4784 If you specify the menu item name "Ada", for instance, it uses `ada'
4785 as the "key" bound by that key binding.
4786
4787 This is relevant only if Lisp code looks for the bindings that were
4788 made with easy-menu.
4789
4790 ---
4791 *** `easy-menu-define' now allows you to use nil for the symbol name
4792 if you don't need to give the menu a name. If you install the menu
4793 into other keymaps right away (MAPS is non-nil), it usually doesn't
4794 need to have a name.
4795
4796 ** Operating system access:
4797
4798 +++
4799 *** The new primitive `get-internal-run-time' returns the processor
4800 run time used by Emacs since start-up.
4801
4802 +++
4803 *** Functions `user-uid' and `user-real-uid' now return floats if the
4804 user UID doesn't fit in a Lisp integer. Function `user-full-name'
4805 accepts a float as UID parameter.
4806
4807 +++
4808 *** New function `locale-info' accesses locale information.
4809
4810 ---
4811 *** On MS Windows, locale-coding-system is used to interact with the OS.
4812 The Windows specific variable w32-system-coding-system, which was
4813 formerly used for that purpose is now an alias for locale-coding-system.
4814
4815 ---
4816 *** New function `redirect-debugging-output' can be used to redirect
4817 debugging output on the stderr file handle to a file.
4818
4819 ** Miscellaneous:
4820
4821 +++
4822 *** A number of hooks have been renamed to better follow the conventions:
4823
4824 `find-file-hooks' to `find-file-hook',
4825 `find-file-not-found-hooks' to `find-file-not-found-functions',
4826 `write-file-hooks' to `write-file-functions',
4827 `write-contents-hooks' to `write-contents-functions',
4828 `x-lost-selection-hooks' to `x-lost-selection-functions',
4829 `x-sent-selection-hooks' to `x-sent-selection-functions',
4830 `delete-frame-hook' to `delete-frame-functions'.
4831
4832 In each case the old name remains as an alias for the moment.
4833
4834 +++
4835 *** local-write-file-hooks is marked obsolete
4836
4837 Use the LOCAL arg of `add-hook'.
4838
4839 ---
4840 *** New function `x-send-client-message' sends a client message when
4841 running under X.
4842
4843 ** GC changes:
4844
4845 +++
4846 *** New variables `gc-elapsed' and `gcs-done' provide extra information
4847 on garbage collection.
4848
4849 +++
4850 *** The normal hook `post-gc-hook' is run at the end of garbage collection.
4851
4852 The hook is run with GC inhibited, so use it with care.
4853 \f
4854 * New Packages for Lisp Programming in Emacs 22.1
4855
4856 +++
4857 ** The new library button.el implements simple and fast `clickable
4858 buttons' in emacs buffers. Buttons are much lighter-weight than the
4859 `widgets' implemented by widget.el, and can be used by lisp code that
4860 doesn't require the full power of widgets. Emacs uses buttons for
4861 such things as help and apropos buffers.
4862
4863 ---
4864 ** The new library tree-widget.el provides a widget to display a set
4865 of hierarchical data as an outline. For example, the tree-widget is
4866 well suited to display a hierarchy of directories and files.
4867
4868 ** The new library bindat.el provides functions to unpack and pack
4869 binary data structures, such as network packets, to and from Lisp
4870 data structures.
4871
4872 ---
4873 ** master-mode.el implements a minor mode for scrolling a slave
4874 buffer without leaving your current buffer, the master buffer.
4875
4876 It can be used by sql.el, for example: the SQL buffer is the master
4877 and its SQLi buffer is the slave. This allows you to scroll the SQLi
4878 buffer containing the output from the SQL buffer containing the
4879 commands.
4880
4881 This is how to use sql.el and master.el together: the variable
4882 sql-buffer contains the slave buffer. It is a local variable in the
4883 SQL buffer.
4884
4885 (add-hook 'sql-mode-hook
4886 (function (lambda ()
4887 (master-mode t)
4888 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
4889 (add-hook 'sql-set-sqli-hook
4890 (function (lambda ()
4891 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
4892
4893 +++
4894 ** The new library benchmark.el does timing measurements on Lisp code.
4895
4896 This includes measuring garbage collection time.
4897
4898 +++
4899 ** The new library testcover.el does test coverage checking.
4900
4901 This is so you can tell whether you've tested all paths in your Lisp
4902 code. It works with edebug.
4903
4904 The function `testcover-start' instruments all functions in a given
4905 file. Then test your code. The function `testcover-mark-all' adds
4906 overlay "splotches" to the Lisp file's buffer to show where coverage
4907 is lacking. The command `testcover-next-mark' (bind it to a key!)
4908 will move point forward to the next spot that has a splotch.
4909
4910 Normally, a red splotch indicates the form was never completely
4911 evaluated; a brown splotch means it always evaluated to the same
4912 value. The red splotches are skipped for forms that can't possibly
4913 complete their evaluation, such as `error'. The brown splotches are
4914 skipped for forms that are expected to always evaluate to the same
4915 value, such as (setq x 14).
4916
4917 For difficult cases, you can add do-nothing macros to your code to
4918 help out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a
4919 red splotch. It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does
4920 return. The macro `1value' suppresses a brown splotch for its argument.
4921 This macro is a no-op except during test-coverage -- then it signals
4922 an error if the argument actually returns differing values.
4923 \f
4924 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.3
4925
4926 ** Support for GNU/Linux on little-endian MIPS and on IBM S390 has
4927 been added.
4928
4929 \f
4930 * Changes in Emacs 21.3
4931
4932 ** The obsolete C mode (c-mode.el) has been removed to avoid problems
4933 with Custom.
4934
4935 ** UTF-16 coding systems are available, encoding the same characters
4936 as mule-utf-8.
4937
4938 ** There is a new language environment for UTF-8 (set up automatically
4939 in UTF-8 locales).
4940
4941 ** Translation tables are available between equivalent characters in
4942 different Emacs charsets -- for instance `e with acute' coming from the
4943 Latin-1 and Latin-2 charsets. User options `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode'
4944 and `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' respectively turn on translation
4945 between ISO 8859 character sets (`unification') on encoding
4946 (e.g. writing a file) and decoding (e.g. reading a file). Note that
4947 `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is useful and safe, but
4948 `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' can cause text to change when you read
4949 it and write it out again without edits, so it is not generally advisable.
4950 By default `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is turned on.
4951
4952 ** In Emacs running on the X window system, the default value of
4953 `selection-coding-system' is now `compound-text-with-extensions'.
4954
4955 If you want the old behavior, set selection-coding-system to
4956 compound-text, which may be significantly more efficient. Using
4957 compound-text-with-extensions seems to be necessary only for decoding
4958 text from applications under XFree86 4.2, whose behavior is actually
4959 contrary to the compound text specification.
4960
4961 \f
4962 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.2
4963
4964 ** Support for BSD/OS 5.0 has been added.
4965
4966 ** Support for AIX 5.1 was added.
4967
4968 \f
4969 * Changes in Emacs 21.2
4970
4971 ** Emacs now supports compound-text extended segments in X selections.
4972
4973 X applications can use `extended segments' to encode characters in
4974 compound text that belong to character sets which are not part of the
4975 list of approved standard encodings for X, e.g. Big5. To paste
4976 selections with such characters into Emacs, use the new coding system
4977 compound-text-with-extensions as the value of selection-coding-system.
4978
4979 ** The default values of `tooltip-delay' and `tooltip-hide-delay'
4980 were changed.
4981
4982 ** On terminals whose erase-char is ^H (Backspace), Emacs
4983 now uses normal-erase-is-backspace-mode.
4984
4985 ** When the *scratch* buffer is recreated, its mode is set from
4986 initial-major-mode, which normally is lisp-interaction-mode,
4987 instead of using default-major-mode.
4988
4989 ** The new option `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' causes Info to behave
4990 like the stand-alone Info reader (from the GNU Texinfo package) as far
4991 as motion between nodes and their subnodes is concerned. If it is t
4992 (the default), Emacs behaves as before when you type SPC in a menu: it
4993 visits the subnode pointed to by the first menu entry. If this option
4994 is nil, SPC scrolls to the end of the current node, and only then goes
4995 to the first menu item, like the stand-alone reader does.
4996
4997 This change was already in Emacs 21.1, but wasn't advertised in the
4998 NEWS.
4999
5000 \f
5001 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.2
5002
5003 ** The meanings of scroll-up-aggressively and scroll-down-aggressively
5004 have been interchanged, so that the former now controls scrolling up,
5005 and the latter now controls scrolling down.
5006
5007 ** The variable `compilation-parse-errors-filename-function' can
5008 be used to transform filenames found in compilation output.
5009
5010 \f
5011 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.1
5012
5013 See the INSTALL file for information on installing extra libraries and
5014 fonts to take advantage of the new graphical features and extra
5015 charsets in this release.
5016
5017 ** Support for GNU/Linux on IA64 machines has been added.
5018
5019 ** Support for LynxOS has been added.
5020
5021 ** There are new configure options associated with the support for
5022 images and toolkit scrollbars. Use the --help option in `configure'
5023 to list them.
5024
5025 ** You can build a 64-bit Emacs for SPARC/Solaris systems which
5026 support 64-bit executables and also on Irix 6.5. This increases the
5027 maximum buffer size. See etc/MACHINES for instructions. Changes to
5028 build on other 64-bit systems should be straightforward modulo any
5029 necessary changes to unexec.
5030
5031 ** There is a new configure option `--disable-largefile' to omit
5032 Unix-98-style support for large files if that is available.
5033
5034 ** There is a new configure option `--without-xim' that instructs
5035 Emacs to not use X Input Methods (XIM), if these are available.
5036
5037 ** `movemail' defaults to supporting POP. You can turn this off using
5038 the --without-pop configure option, should that be necessary.
5039
5040 ** This version can be built for the Macintosh, but does not implement
5041 all of the new display features described below. The port currently
5042 lacks unexec, asynchronous processes, and networking support. See the
5043 "Emacs and the Mac OS" appendix in the Emacs manual, for the
5044 description of aspects specific to the Mac.
5045
5046 ** Note that the MS-Windows port does not yet implement various of the
5047 new display features described below.
5048
5049 \f
5050 * Changes in Emacs 21.1
5051
5052 ** Emacs has a new redisplay engine.
5053
5054 The new redisplay handles characters of variable width and height.
5055 Italic text can be used without redisplay problems. Fonts containing
5056 oversized characters, i.e. characters larger than the logical height
5057 of a font can be used. Images of various formats can be displayed in
5058 the text.
5059
5060 ** Emacs has a new face implementation.
5061
5062 The new faces no longer fundamentally use X font names to specify the
5063 font. Instead, each face has several independent attributes--family,
5064 height, width, weight and slant--that it may or may not specify.
5065 These attributes can be merged from various faces, and then together
5066 specify a font.
5067
5068 Faces are supported on terminals that can display color or fonts.
5069 These terminal capabilities are auto-detected. Details can be found
5070 under Lisp changes, below.
5071
5072 ** Emacs can display faces on TTY frames.
5073
5074 Emacs automatically detects terminals that are able to display colors.
5075 Faces with a weight greater than normal are displayed extra-bright, if
5076 the terminal supports it. Faces with a weight less than normal and
5077 italic faces are displayed dimmed, if the terminal supports it.
5078 Underlined faces are displayed underlined if possible. Other face
5079 attributes such as `overline', `strike-through', and `box' are ignored
5080 on terminals.
5081
5082 The command-line options `-fg COLOR', `-bg COLOR', and `-rv' are now
5083 supported on character terminals.
5084
5085 Emacs automatically remaps all X-style color specifications to one of
5086 the colors supported by the terminal. This means you could have the
5087 same color customizations that work both on a windowed display and on
5088 a TTY or when Emacs is invoked with the -nw option.
5089
5090 ** New default font is Courier 12pt under X.
5091
5092 ** Sound support
5093
5094 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and FreeBSD (Voxware
5095 driver and native BSD driver, a.k.a. Luigi's driver). Currently
5096 supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio (*.au).
5097 You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' to enable
5098 sound support.
5099
5100 ** Emacs now resizes mini-windows if appropriate.
5101
5102 If a message is longer than one line, or minibuffer contents are
5103 longer than one line, Emacs can resize the minibuffer window unless it
5104 is on a frame of its own. You can control resizing and the maximum
5105 minibuffer window size by setting the following variables:
5106
5107 - User option: max-mini-window-height
5108
5109 Maximum height for resizing mini-windows. If a float, it specifies a
5110 fraction of the mini-window frame's height. If an integer, it
5111 specifies a number of lines.
5112
5113 Default is 0.25.
5114
5115 - User option: resize-mini-windows
5116
5117 How to resize mini-windows. If nil, don't resize. If t, always
5118 resize to fit the size of the text. If `grow-only', let mini-windows
5119 grow only, until they become empty, at which point they are shrunk
5120 again.
5121
5122 Default is `grow-only'.
5123
5124 ** LessTif support.
5125
5126 Emacs now runs with the LessTif toolkit (see
5127 <http://www.lesstif.org>). You will need version 0.92.26, or later.
5128
5129 ** LessTif/Motif file selection dialog.
5130
5131 When Emacs is configured to use LessTif or Motif, reading a file name
5132 from a menu will pop up a file selection dialog if `use-dialog-box' is
5133 non-nil.
5134
5135 ** File selection dialog on MS-Windows is supported.
5136
5137 When a file is visited by clicking File->Open, the MS-Windows version
5138 now pops up a standard file selection dialog where you can select a
5139 file to visit. File->Save As also pops up that dialog.
5140
5141 ** Toolkit scroll bars.
5142
5143 Emacs now uses toolkit scroll bars if available. When configured for
5144 LessTif/Motif, it will use that toolkit's scroll bar. Otherwise, when
5145 configured for Lucid and Athena widgets, it will use the Xaw3d scroll
5146 bar if Xaw3d is available. You can turn off the use of toolkit scroll
5147 bars by specifying `--with-toolkit-scroll-bars=no' when configuring
5148 Emacs.
5149
5150 When you encounter problems with the Xaw3d scroll bar, watch out how
5151 Xaw3d is compiled on your system. If the Makefile generated from
5152 Xaw3d's Imakefile contains a `-DNARROWPROTO' compiler option, and your
5153 Emacs system configuration file `s/your-system.h' does not contain a
5154 define for NARROWPROTO, you might consider adding it. Take
5155 `s/freebsd.h' as an example.
5156
5157 Alternatively, if you don't have access to the Xaw3d source code, take
5158 a look at your system's imake configuration file, for example in the
5159 directory `/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/config' (paths are different on
5160 different systems). You will find files `*.cf' there. If your
5161 system's cf-file contains a line like `#define NeedWidePrototypes NO',
5162 add a `#define NARROWPROTO' to your Emacs system configuration file.
5163
5164 The reason for this is that one Xaw3d function uses `double' or
5165 `float' function parameters depending on the setting of NARROWPROTO.
5166 This is not a problem when Imakefiles are used because each system's
5167 imake configuration file contains the necessary information. Since
5168 Emacs doesn't use imake, this has do be done manually.
5169
5170 ** Tool bar support.
5171
5172 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. For details
5173 of how to define a tool bar, see the page describing Lisp-level
5174 changes. Tool-bar global minor mode controls whether or not it is
5175 displayed and is on by default. The appearance of the bar is improved
5176 if Emacs has been built with XPM image support. Otherwise monochrome
5177 icons will be used.
5178
5179 To make the tool bar more useful, we need contributions of extra icons
5180 for specific modes (with copyright assignments).
5181
5182 ** Tooltips.
5183
5184 Tooltips are small X windows displaying a help string at the current
5185 mouse position. The Lisp package `tooltip' implements them. You can
5186 turn them off via the user option `tooltip-mode'.
5187
5188 Tooltips also provides support for GUD debugging. If activated,
5189 variable values can be displayed in tooltips by pointing at them with
5190 the mouse in source buffers. You can customize various aspects of the
5191 tooltip display in the group `tooltip'.
5192
5193 ** Automatic Hscrolling
5194
5195 Horizontal scrolling now happens automatically if
5196 `automatic-hscrolling' is set (the default). This setting can be
5197 customized.
5198
5199 If a window is scrolled horizontally with set-window-hscroll, or
5200 scroll-left/scroll-right (C-x <, C-x >), this serves as a lower bound
5201 for automatic horizontal scrolling. Automatic scrolling will scroll
5202 the text more to the left if necessary, but won't scroll the text more
5203 to the right than the column set with set-window-hscroll etc.
5204
5205 ** When using a windowing terminal, each Emacs window now has a cursor
5206 of its own. By default, when a window is selected, the cursor is
5207 solid; otherwise, it is hollow. The user-option
5208 `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' controls how to display the
5209 cursor in non-selected windows. If nil, no cursor is shown, if
5210 non-nil a hollow box cursor is shown.
5211
5212 ** Fringes to the left and right of windows are used to display
5213 truncation marks, continuation marks, overlay arrows and alike. The
5214 foreground, background, and stipple of these areas can be changed by
5215 customizing face `fringe'.
5216
5217 ** The mode line under X is now drawn with shadows by default.
5218 You can change its appearance by modifying the face `mode-line'.
5219 In particular, setting the `:box' attribute to nil turns off the 3D
5220 appearance of the mode line. (The 3D appearance makes the mode line
5221 occupy more space, and thus might cause the first or the last line of
5222 the window to be partially obscured.)
5223
5224 The variable `mode-line-inverse-video', which was used in older
5225 versions of emacs to make the mode-line stand out, is now deprecated.
5226 However, setting it to nil will cause the `mode-line' face to be
5227 ignored, and mode-lines to be drawn using the default text face.
5228
5229 ** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
5230
5231 Different parts of the mode line have been made mouse-sensitive on all
5232 systems which support the mouse. Moving the mouse to a
5233 mouse-sensitive part in the mode line changes the appearance of the
5234 mouse pointer to an arrow, and help about available mouse actions is
5235 displayed either in the echo area, or in the tooltip window if you
5236 have enabled one.
5237
5238 Currently, the following actions have been defined:
5239
5240 - Mouse-1 on the buffer name in the mode line goes to the next buffer.
5241
5242 - Mouse-3 on the buffer-name goes to the previous buffer.
5243
5244 - Mouse-2 on the read-only or modified status in the mode line (`%' or
5245 `*') toggles the status.
5246
5247 - Mouse-3 on the mode name displays a minor-mode menu.
5248
5249 ** Hourglass pointer
5250
5251 Emacs can optionally display an hourglass pointer under X. You can
5252 turn the display on or off by customizing group `cursor'.
5253
5254 ** Blinking cursor
5255
5256 M-x blink-cursor-mode toggles a blinking cursor under X and on
5257 terminals having terminal capabilities `vi', `vs', and `ve'. Blinking
5258 and related parameters like frequency and delay can be customized in
5259 the group `cursor'.
5260
5261 ** New font-lock support mode `jit-lock-mode'.
5262
5263 This support mode is roughly equivalent to `lazy-lock' but is
5264 generally faster. It supports stealth and deferred fontification.
5265 See the documentation of the function `jit-lock-mode' for more
5266 details.
5267
5268 Font-lock uses jit-lock-mode as default support mode, so you don't
5269 have to do anything to activate it.
5270
5271 ** The default binding of the Delete key has changed.
5272
5273 The new user-option `normal-erase-is-backspace' can be set to
5274 determine the effect of the Delete and Backspace function keys.
5275
5276 On window systems, the default value of this option is chosen
5277 according to the keyboard used. If the keyboard has both a Backspace
5278 key and a Delete key, and both are mapped to their usual meanings, the
5279 option's default value is set to t, so that Backspace can be used to
5280 delete backward, and Delete can be used to delete forward. On
5281 keyboards which either have only one key (usually labeled DEL), or two
5282 keys DEL and BS which produce the same effect, the option's value is
5283 set to nil, and these keys delete backward.
5284
5285 If not running under a window system, setting this option accomplishes
5286 a similar effect by mapping C-h, which is usually generated by the
5287 Backspace key, to DEL, and by mapping DEL to C-d via
5288 `keyboard-translate'. The former functionality of C-h is available on
5289 the F1 key. You should probably not use this setting on a text-only
5290 terminal if you don't have both Backspace, Delete and F1 keys.
5291
5292 Programmatically, you can call function normal-erase-is-backspace-mode
5293 to toggle the behavior of the Delete and Backspace keys.
5294
5295 ** The default for user-option `next-line-add-newlines' has been
5296 changed to nil, i.e. C-n will no longer add newlines at the end of a
5297 buffer by default.
5298
5299 ** The <home> and <end> keys now move to the beginning or end of the
5300 current line, respectively. C-<home> and C-<end> move to the
5301 beginning and end of the buffer.
5302
5303 ** Emacs now checks for recursive loads of Lisp files. If the
5304 recursion depth exceeds `recursive-load-depth-limit', an error is
5305 signaled.
5306
5307 ** When an error is signaled during the loading of the user's init
5308 file, Emacs now pops up the *Messages* buffer.
5309
5310 ** Emacs now refuses to load compiled Lisp files which weren't
5311 compiled with Emacs. Set `load-dangerous-libraries' to t to change
5312 this behavior.
5313
5314 The reason for this change is an incompatible change in XEmacs's byte
5315 compiler. Files compiled with XEmacs can contain byte codes that let
5316 Emacs dump core.
5317
5318 ** Toggle buttons and radio buttons in menus.
5319
5320 When compiled with LessTif (or Motif) support, Emacs uses toolkit
5321 widgets for radio and toggle buttons in menus. When configured for
5322 Lucid, Emacs draws radio buttons and toggle buttons similar to Motif.
5323
5324 ** The menu bar configuration has changed. The new configuration is
5325 more CUA-compliant. The most significant change is that Options is
5326 now a separate menu-bar item, with Mule and Customize as its submenus.
5327
5328 ** Item Save Options on the Options menu allows saving options set
5329 using that menu.
5330
5331 ** Highlighting of trailing whitespace.
5332
5333 When `show-trailing-whitespace' is non-nil, Emacs displays trailing
5334 whitespace in the face `trailing-whitespace'. Trailing whitespace is
5335 defined as spaces or tabs at the end of a line. To avoid busy
5336 highlighting when entering new text, trailing whitespace is not
5337 displayed if point is at the end of the line containing the
5338 whitespace.
5339
5340 ** C-x 5 1 runs the new command delete-other-frames which deletes
5341 all frames except the selected one.
5342
5343 ** The new user-option `confirm-kill-emacs' can be customized to
5344 let Emacs ask for confirmation before exiting.
5345
5346 ** The header line in an Info buffer is now displayed as an emacs
5347 header-line (which is like a mode-line, but at the top of the window),
5348 so that it remains visible even when the buffer has been scrolled.
5349 This behavior may be disabled by customizing the option
5350 `Info-use-header-line'.
5351
5352 ** Polish, Czech, German, and French translations of Emacs' reference card
5353 have been added. They are named `pl-refcard.tex', `cs-refcard.tex',
5354 `de-refcard.tex' and `fr-refcard.tex'. Postscript files are included.
5355
5356 ** An `Emacs Survival Guide', etc/survival.tex, is available.
5357
5358 ** A reference card for Dired has been added. Its name is
5359 `dired-ref.tex'. A French translation is available in
5360 `fr-drdref.tex'.
5361
5362 ** C-down-mouse-3 is bound differently. Now if the menu bar is not
5363 displayed it pops up a menu containing the items which would be on the
5364 menu bar. If the menu bar is displayed, it pops up the major mode
5365 menu or the Edit menu if there is no major mode menu.
5366
5367 ** Variable `load-path' is no longer customizable through Customize.
5368
5369 You can no longer use `M-x customize-variable' to customize `load-path'
5370 because it now contains a version-dependent component. You can still
5371 use `add-to-list' and `setq' to customize this variable in your
5372 `~/.emacs' init file or to modify it from any Lisp program in general.
5373
5374 ** C-u C-x = provides detailed information about the character at
5375 point in a pop-up window.
5376
5377 ** Emacs can now support 'wheeled' mice (such as the MS IntelliMouse)
5378 under XFree86. To enable this, use the `mouse-wheel-mode' command, or
5379 customize the variable `mouse-wheel-mode'.
5380
5381 The variables `mouse-wheel-follow-mouse' and `mouse-wheel-scroll-amount'
5382 determine where and by how much buffers are scrolled.
5383
5384 ** Emacs' auto-save list files are now by default stored in a
5385 sub-directory `.emacs.d/auto-save-list/' of the user's home directory.
5386 (On MS-DOS, this subdirectory's name is `_emacs.d/auto-save.list/'.)
5387 You can customize `auto-save-list-file-prefix' to change this location.
5388
5389 ** The function `getenv' is now callable interactively.
5390
5391 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
5392 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
5393
5394 ** The new command M-x delete-trailing-whitespace RET will delete the
5395 trailing whitespace within the current restriction. You can also add
5396 this function to `write-file-hooks' or `local-write-file-hooks'.
5397
5398 ** When visiting a file with M-x find-file-literally, no newlines will
5399 be added to the end of the buffer even if `require-final-newline' is
5400 non-nil.
5401
5402 ** The new user-option `find-file-suppress-same-file-warnings' can be
5403 set to suppress warnings ``X and Y are the same file'' when visiting a
5404 file that is already visited under a different name.
5405
5406 ** The new user-option `electric-help-shrink-window' can be set to
5407 nil to prevent adjusting the help window size to the buffer size.
5408
5409 ** New command M-x describe-character-set reads a character set name
5410 and displays information about that.
5411
5412 ** The new variable `auto-mode-interpreter-regexp' contains a regular
5413 expression matching interpreters, for file mode determination.
5414
5415 This regular expression is matched against the first line of a file to
5416 determine the file's mode in `set-auto-mode' when Emacs can't deduce a
5417 mode from the file's name. If it matches, the file is assumed to be
5418 interpreted by the interpreter matched by the second group of the
5419 regular expression. The mode is then determined as the mode
5420 associated with that interpreter in `interpreter-mode-alist'.
5421
5422 ** New function executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p is
5423 suitable as an after-save-hook as an alternative to `executable-chmod'.
5424
5425 ** The most preferred coding-system is now used to save a buffer if
5426 buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and it is safe for the buffer
5427 contents. (The most preferred is set by set-language-environment or
5428 by M-x prefer-coding-system.) Thus if you visit an ASCII file and
5429 insert a non-ASCII character from your current language environment,
5430 the file will be saved silently with the appropriate coding.
5431 Previously you would be prompted for a safe coding system.
5432
5433 ** The many obsolete language `setup-...-environment' commands have
5434 been removed -- use `set-language-environment'.
5435
5436 ** The new Custom option `keyboard-coding-system' specifies a coding
5437 system for keyboard input.
5438
5439 ** New variable `inhibit-iso-escape-detection' determines if Emacs'
5440 coding system detection algorithm should pay attention to ISO2022's
5441 escape sequences. If this variable is non-nil, the algorithm ignores
5442 such escape sequences. The default value is nil, and it is
5443 recommended not to change it except for the special case that you
5444 always want to read any escape code verbatim. If you just want to
5445 read a specific file without decoding escape codes, use C-x RET c
5446 (`universal-coding-system-argument'). For instance, C-x RET c latin-1
5447 RET C-x C-f filename RET.
5448
5449 ** Variable `default-korean-keyboard' is initialized properly from the
5450 environment variable `HANGUL_KEYBOARD_TYPE'.
5451
5452 ** New command M-x list-charset-chars reads a character set name and
5453 displays all characters in that character set.
5454
5455 ** M-x set-terminal-coding-system (C-x RET t) now allows CCL-based
5456 coding systems such as cpXXX and cyrillic-koi8.
5457
5458 ** Emacs now attempts to determine the initial language environment
5459 and preferred and locale coding systems systematically from the
5460 LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG environment variables during startup.
5461
5462 ** New language environments `Polish', `Latin-8' and `Latin-9'.
5463 Latin-8 and Latin-9 correspond respectively to the ISO character sets
5464 8859-14 (Celtic) and 8859-15 (updated Latin-1, with the Euro sign).
5465 GNU Intlfonts doesn't support these yet but recent X releases have
5466 8859-15. See etc/INSTALL for information on obtaining extra fonts.
5467 There are new Leim input methods for Latin-8 and Latin-9 prefix (only)
5468 and Polish `slash'.
5469
5470 ** New language environments `Dutch' and `Spanish'.
5471 These new environments mainly select appropriate translations
5472 of the tutorial.
5473
5474 ** In Ethiopic language environment, special key bindings for
5475 function keys are changed as follows. This is to conform to "Emacs
5476 Lisp Coding Convention".
5477
5478 new command old-binding
5479 --- ------- -----------
5480 f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-buffer f5
5481 S-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-region f5
5482 C-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-mail-or-marker f5
5483
5484 f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-buffer unchanged
5485 S-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-region unchanged
5486 C-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-mail-or-marker unchanged
5487
5488 S-f5 ethio-toggle-punctuation f3
5489 S-f6 ethio-modify-vowel f6
5490 S-f7 ethio-replace-space f7
5491 S-f8 ethio-input-special-character f8
5492 S-f9 ethio-replace-space unchanged
5493 C-f9 ethio-toggle-space f2
5494
5495 ** There are new Leim input methods.
5496 New input methods "turkish-postfix", "turkish-alt-postfix",
5497 "greek-mizuochi", "TeX", and "greek-babel" are now part of the Leim
5498 package.
5499
5500 ** The rule of input method "slovak" is slightly changed. Now the
5501 rules for translating "q" and "Q" to "`" (backquote) are deleted, thus
5502 typing them inserts "q" and "Q" respectively. Rules for translating
5503 "=q", "+q", "=Q", and "+Q" to "`" are also deleted. Now, to input
5504 "`", you must type "=q".
5505
5506 ** When your terminal can't display characters from some of the ISO
5507 8859 character sets but can display Latin-1, you can display
5508 more-or-less mnemonic sequences of ASCII/Latin-1 characters instead of
5509 empty boxes (under a window system) or question marks (not under a
5510 window system). Customize the option `latin1-display' to turn this
5511 on.
5512
5513 ** M-; now calls comment-dwim which tries to do something clever based
5514 on the context. M-x kill-comment is now an alias to comment-kill,
5515 defined in newcomment.el. You can choose different styles of region
5516 commenting with the variable `comment-style'.
5517
5518 ** New user options `display-time-mail-face' and
5519 `display-time-use-mail-icon' control the appearance of mode-line mail
5520 indicator used by the display-time package. On a suitable display the
5521 indicator can be an icon and is mouse-sensitive.
5522
5523 ** On window-systems, additional space can be put between text lines
5524 on the display using several methods
5525
5526 - By setting frame parameter `line-spacing' to PIXELS. PIXELS must be
5527 a positive integer, and specifies that PIXELS number of pixels should
5528 be put below text lines on the affected frame or frames.
5529
5530 - By setting X resource `lineSpacing', class `LineSpacing'. This is
5531 equivalent to specifying the frame parameter.
5532
5533 - By specifying `--line-spacing=N' or `-lsp N' on the command line.
5534
5535 - By setting buffer-local variable `line-spacing'. The meaning is
5536 the same, but applies to the a particular buffer only.
5537
5538 ** The new command `clone-indirect-buffer' can be used to create
5539 an indirect buffer that is a twin copy of the current buffer. The
5540 command `clone-indirect-buffer-other-window', bound to C-x 4 c,
5541 does the same but displays the indirect buffer in another window.
5542
5543 ** New user options `backup-directory-alist' and
5544 `make-backup-file-name-function' control the placement of backups,
5545 typically in a single directory or in an invisible sub-directory.
5546
5547 ** New commands iso-iso2sgml and iso-sgml2iso convert between Latin-1
5548 characters and the corresponding SGML (HTML) entities.
5549
5550 ** New X resources recognized
5551
5552 *** The X resource `synchronous', class `Synchronous', specifies
5553 whether Emacs should run in synchronous mode. Synchronous mode
5554 is useful for debugging X problems.
5555
5556 Example:
5557
5558 emacs.synchronous: true
5559
5560 *** The X resource `visualClass, class `VisualClass', specifies the
5561 visual Emacs should use. The resource's value should be a string of
5562 the form `CLASS-DEPTH', where CLASS is the name of the visual class,
5563 and DEPTH is the requested color depth as a decimal number. Valid
5564 visual class names are
5565
5566 TrueColor
5567 PseudoColor
5568 DirectColor
5569 StaticColor
5570 GrayScale
5571 StaticGray
5572
5573 Visual class names specified as X resource are case-insensitive, i.e.
5574 `pseudocolor', `Pseudocolor' and `PseudoColor' all have the same
5575 meaning.
5576
5577 The program `xdpyinfo' can be used to list the visual classes
5578 supported on your display, and which depths they have. If
5579 `visualClass' is not specified, Emacs uses the display's default
5580 visual.
5581
5582 Example:
5583
5584 emacs.visualClass: TrueColor-8
5585
5586 *** The X resource `privateColormap', class `PrivateColormap',
5587 specifies that Emacs should use a private colormap if it is using the
5588 default visual, and that visual is of class PseudoColor. Recognized
5589 resource values are `true' or `on'.
5590
5591 Example:
5592
5593 emacs.privateColormap: true
5594
5595 ** Faces and frame parameters.
5596
5597 There are four new faces `scroll-bar', `border', `cursor' and `mouse'.
5598 Setting the frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
5599 `scroll-bar-background' sets foreground and background color of face
5600 `scroll-bar' and vice versa. Setting frame parameter `border-color'
5601 sets the background color of face `border' and vice versa. Likewise
5602 for frame parameters `cursor-color' and face `cursor', and frame
5603 parameter `mouse-color' and face `mouse'.
5604
5605 Changing frame parameter `font' sets font-related attributes of the
5606 `default' face and vice versa. Setting frame parameters
5607 `foreground-color' or `background-color' sets the colors of the
5608 `default' face and vice versa.
5609
5610 ** New face `menu'.
5611
5612 The face `menu' can be used to change colors and font of Emacs' menus.
5613
5614 ** New frame parameter `screen-gamma' for gamma correction.
5615
5616 The new frame parameter `screen-gamma' specifies gamma-correction for
5617 colors. Its value may be nil, the default, in which case no gamma
5618 correction occurs, or a number > 0, usually a float, that specifies
5619 the screen gamma of a frame's display.
5620
5621 PC monitors usually have a screen gamma of 2.2. smaller values result
5622 in darker colors. You might want to try a screen gamma of 1.5 for LCD
5623 color displays. The viewing gamma Emacs uses is 0.4545. (1/2.2).
5624
5625 The X resource name of this parameter is `screenGamma', class
5626 `ScreenGamma'.
5627
5628 ** Tabs and variable-width text.
5629
5630 Tabs are now displayed with stretch properties; the width of a tab is
5631 defined as a multiple of the normal character width of a frame, and is
5632 independent of the fonts used in the text where the tab appears.
5633 Thus, tabs can be used to line up text in different fonts.
5634
5635 ** Enhancements of the Lucid menu bar
5636
5637 *** The Lucid menu bar now supports the resource "margin".
5638
5639 emacs.pane.menubar.margin: 5
5640
5641 The default margin is 4 which makes the menu bar appear like the
5642 LessTif/Motif one.
5643
5644 *** Arrows that indicate sub-menus are now drawn with shadows, as in
5645 LessTif and Motif.
5646
5647 ** A block cursor can be drawn as wide as the glyph under it under X.
5648
5649 As an example: if a block cursor is over a tab character, it will be
5650 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. To do this, set
5651 `x-stretch-cursor' to a non-nil value.
5652
5653 ** Empty display lines at the end of a buffer may be marked with a
5654 bitmap (this is similar to the tilde displayed by vi and Less).
5655
5656 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
5657 `indicate-empty-lines' to a non-nil value. The default value of this
5658 variable is found in `default-indicate-empty-lines'.
5659
5660 ** There is a new "aggressive" scrolling method.
5661
5662 When scrolling up because point is above the window start, if the
5663 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-up-aggressively' is a
5664 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
5665 fraction of the window's height from the top of the window.
5666
5667 When scrolling down because point is below the window end, if the
5668 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-down-aggressively' is a
5669 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
5670 fraction of the window's height from the bottom of the window.
5671
5672 ** You can now easily create new *Info* buffers using either
5673 M-x clone-buffer, C-u m <entry> RET or C-u g <entry> RET.
5674 M-x clone-buffer can also be used on *Help* and several other special
5675 buffers.
5676
5677 ** The command `Info-search' now uses a search history.
5678
5679 ** Listing buffers with M-x list-buffers (C-x C-b) now shows
5680 abbreviated file names. Abbreviations can be customized by changing
5681 `directory-abbrev-alist'.
5682
5683 ** A new variable, backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch, gives
5684 the highest file uid for which backup-by-copying-when-mismatch will be
5685 forced on. The assumption is that uids less than or equal to this
5686 value are special uids (root, bin, daemon, etc.--not real system
5687 users) and that files owned by these users should not change ownership,
5688 even if your system policy allows users other than root to edit them.
5689
5690 The default is 200; set the variable to nil to disable the feature.
5691
5692 ** The rectangle commands now avoid inserting undesirable spaces,
5693 notably at the end of lines.
5694
5695 All these functions have been rewritten to avoid inserting unwanted
5696 spaces, and an optional prefix now allows them to behave the old way.
5697
5698 ** The function `replace-rectangle' is an alias for `string-rectangle'.
5699
5700 ** The new command M-x string-insert-rectangle is like `string-rectangle',
5701 but inserts text instead of replacing it.
5702
5703 ** The new command M-x query-replace-regexp-eval acts like
5704 query-replace-regexp, but takes a Lisp expression which is evaluated
5705 after each match to get the replacement text.
5706
5707 ** M-x query-replace recognizes a new command `e' (or `E') that lets
5708 you edit the replacement string.
5709
5710 ** The new command mail-abbrev-complete-alias, bound to `M-TAB'
5711 (if you load the library `mailabbrev'), lets you complete mail aliases
5712 in the text, analogous to lisp-complete-symbol.
5713
5714 ** The variable `echo-keystrokes' may now have a floating point value.
5715
5716 ** If your init file is compiled (.emacs.elc), `user-init-file' is set
5717 to the source name (.emacs.el), if that exists, after loading it.
5718
5719 ** The help string specified for a menu-item whose definition contains
5720 the property `:help HELP' is now displayed under X, on MS-Windows, and
5721 MS-DOS, either in the echo area or with tooltips. Many standard menus
5722 displayed by Emacs now have help strings.
5723
5724 --
5725 ** New user option `read-mail-command' specifies a command to use to
5726 read mail from the menu etc.
5727
5728 ** The environment variable `EMACSLOCKDIR' is no longer used on MS-Windows.
5729 This environment variable was used when creating lock files. Emacs on
5730 MS-Windows does not use this variable anymore. This change was made
5731 before Emacs 21.1, but wasn't documented until now.
5732
5733 ** Highlighting of mouse-sensitive regions is now supported in the
5734 MS-DOS version of Emacs.
5735
5736 ** The new command `msdos-set-mouse-buttons' forces the MS-DOS version
5737 of Emacs to behave as if the mouse had a specified number of buttons.
5738 This comes handy with mice that don't report their number of buttons
5739 correctly. One example is the wheeled mice, which report 3 buttons,
5740 but clicks on the middle button are not passed to the MS-DOS version
5741 of Emacs.
5742
5743 ** Customize changes
5744
5745 *** Customize now supports comments about customized items. Use the
5746 `State' menu to add comments, or give a prefix argument to
5747 M-x customize-set-variable or M-x customize-set-value. Note that
5748 customization comments will cause the customizations to fail in
5749 earlier versions of Emacs.
5750
5751 *** The new option `custom-buffer-done-function' says whether to kill
5752 Custom buffers when you've done with them or just bury them (the
5753 default).
5754
5755 *** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
5756 does not allow you to save customizations in your `~/.emacs' init
5757 file. This is because saving customizations from such a session would
5758 wipe out all the other customizationss you might have on your init
5759 file.
5760
5761 ** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
5762 does not save disabled and enabled commands for future sessions, to
5763 avoid overwriting existing customizations of this kind that are
5764 already in your init file.
5765
5766 ** New features in evaluation commands
5767
5768 *** The commands to evaluate Lisp expressions, such as C-M-x in Lisp
5769 modes, C-j in Lisp Interaction mode, and M-:, now bind the variables
5770 print-level, print-length, and debug-on-error based on the new
5771 customizable variables eval-expression-print-level,
5772 eval-expression-print-length, and eval-expression-debug-on-error.
5773
5774 The default values for the first two of these variables are 12 and 4
5775 respectively, which means that `eval-expression' now prints at most
5776 the first 12 members of a list and at most 4 nesting levels deep (if
5777 the list is longer or deeper than that, an ellipsis `...' is
5778 printed).
5779
5780 <RET> or <mouse-2> on the printed text toggles between an abbreviated
5781 printed representation and an unabbreviated one.
5782
5783 The default value of eval-expression-debug-on-error is t, so any error
5784 during evaluation produces a backtrace.
5785
5786 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) now loads Edebug and instruments
5787 code when called with a prefix argument.
5788
5789 ** CC mode changes.
5790
5791 Note: This release contains changes that might not be compatible with
5792 current user setups (although it's believed that these
5793 incompatibilities will only show in very uncommon circumstances).
5794 However, since the impact is uncertain, these changes may be rolled
5795 back depending on user feedback. Therefore there's no forward
5796 compatibility guarantee wrt the new features introduced in this
5797 release.
5798
5799 *** The hardcoded switch to "java" style in Java mode is gone.
5800 CC Mode used to automatically set the style to "java" when Java mode
5801 is entered. This has now been removed since it caused too much
5802 confusion.
5803
5804 However, to keep backward compatibility to a certain extent, the
5805 default value for c-default-style now specifies the "java" style for
5806 java-mode, but "gnu" for all other modes (as before). So you won't
5807 notice the change if you haven't touched that variable.
5808
5809 *** New cleanups, space-before-funcall and compact-empty-funcall.
5810 Two new cleanups have been added to c-cleanup-list:
5811
5812 space-before-funcall causes a space to be inserted before the opening
5813 parenthesis of a function call, which gives the style "foo (bar)".
5814
5815 compact-empty-funcall causes any space before a function call opening
5816 parenthesis to be removed if there are no arguments to the function.
5817 It's typically useful together with space-before-funcall to get the
5818 style "foo (bar)" and "foo()".
5819
5820 *** Some keywords now automatically trigger reindentation.
5821 Keywords like "else", "while", "catch" and "finally" have been made
5822 "electric" to make them reindent automatically when they continue an
5823 earlier statement. An example:
5824
5825 for (i = 0; i < 17; i++)
5826 if (a[i])
5827 res += a[i]->offset;
5828 else
5829
5830 Here, the "else" should be indented like the preceding "if", since it
5831 continues that statement. CC Mode will automatically reindent it after
5832 the "else" has been typed in full, since it's not until then it's
5833 possible to decide whether it's a new statement or a continuation of
5834 the preceding "if".
5835
5836 CC Mode uses Abbrev mode to achieve this, which is therefore turned on
5837 by default.
5838
5839 *** M-a and M-e now moves by sentence in multiline strings.
5840 Previously these two keys only moved by sentence in comments, which
5841 meant that sentence movement didn't work in strings containing
5842 documentation or other natural language text.
5843
5844 The reason it's only activated in multiline strings (i.e. strings that
5845 contain a newline, even when escaped by a '\') is to avoid stopping in
5846 the short strings that often reside inside statements. Multiline
5847 strings almost always contain text in a natural language, as opposed
5848 to other strings that typically contain format specifications,
5849 commands, etc. Also, it's not that bothersome that M-a and M-e misses
5850 sentences in single line strings, since they're short anyway.
5851
5852 *** Support for autodoc comments in Pike mode.
5853 Autodoc comments for Pike are used to extract documentation from the
5854 source, like Javadoc in Java. Pike mode now recognize this markup in
5855 comment prefixes and paragraph starts.
5856
5857 *** The comment prefix regexps on c-comment-prefix may be mode specific.
5858 When c-comment-prefix is an association list, it specifies the comment
5859 line prefix on a per-mode basis, like c-default-style does. This
5860 change came about to support the special autodoc comment prefix in
5861 Pike mode only.
5862
5863 *** Better handling of syntactic errors.
5864 The recovery after unbalanced parens earlier in the buffer has been
5865 improved; CC Mode now reports them by dinging and giving a message
5866 stating the offending line, but still recovers and indent the
5867 following lines in a sane way (most of the time). An "else" with no
5868 matching "if" is handled similarly. If an error is discovered while
5869 indenting a region, the whole region is still indented and the error
5870 is reported afterwards.
5871
5872 *** Lineup functions may now return absolute columns.
5873 A lineup function can give an absolute column to indent the line to by
5874 returning a vector with the desired column as the first element.
5875
5876 *** More robust and warning-free byte compilation.
5877 Although this is strictly not a user visible change (well, depending
5878 on the view of a user), it's still worth mentioning that CC Mode now
5879 can be compiled in the standard ways without causing trouble. Some
5880 code have also been moved between the subpackages to enhance the
5881 modularity somewhat. Thanks to Martin Buchholz for doing the
5882 groundwork.
5883
5884 *** c-style-variables-are-local-p now defaults to t.
5885 This is an incompatible change that has been made to make the behavior
5886 of the style system wrt global variable settings less confusing for
5887 non-advanced users. If you know what this variable does you might
5888 want to set it to nil in your .emacs, otherwise you probably don't
5889 have to bother.
5890
5891 Defaulting c-style-variables-are-local-p to t avoids the confusing
5892 situation that occurs when a user sets some style variables globally
5893 and edits both a Java and a non-Java file in the same Emacs session.
5894 If the style variables aren't buffer local in this case, loading of
5895 the second file will cause the default style (either "gnu" or "java"
5896 by default) to override the global settings made by the user.
5897
5898 *** New initialization procedure for the style system.
5899 When the initial style for a buffer is determined by CC Mode (from the
5900 variable c-default-style), the global values of style variables now
5901 take precedence over the values specified by the chosen style. This
5902 is different than the old behavior: previously, the style-specific
5903 settings would override the global settings. This change makes it
5904 possible to do simple configuration in the intuitive way with
5905 Customize or with setq lines in one's .emacs file.
5906
5907 By default, the global value of every style variable is the new
5908 special symbol set-from-style, which causes the value to be taken from
5909 the style system. This means that in effect, only an explicit setting
5910 of a style variable will cause the "overriding" behavior described
5911 above.
5912
5913 Also note that global settings override style-specific settings *only*
5914 when the initial style of a buffer is chosen by a CC Mode major mode
5915 function. When a style is chosen in other ways --- for example, by a
5916 call like (c-set-style "gnu") in a hook, or via M-x c-set-style ---
5917 then the style-specific values take precedence over any global style
5918 values. In Lisp terms, global values override style-specific values
5919 only when the new second argument to c-set-style is non-nil; see the
5920 function documentation for more info.
5921
5922 The purpose of these changes is to make it easier for users,
5923 especially novice users, to do simple customizations with Customize or
5924 with setq in their .emacs files. On the other hand, the new system is
5925 intended to be compatible with advanced users' customizations as well,
5926 such as those that choose styles in hooks or whatnot. This new system
5927 is believed to be almost entirely compatible with current
5928 configurations, in spite of the changed precedence between style and
5929 global variable settings when a buffer's default style is set.
5930
5931 (Thanks to Eric Eide for clarifying this explanation a bit.)
5932
5933 **** c-offsets-alist is now a customizable variable.
5934 This became possible as a result of the new initialization behavior.
5935
5936 This variable is treated slightly differently from the other style
5937 variables; instead of using the symbol set-from-style, it will be
5938 completed with the syntactic symbols it doesn't already contain when
5939 the style is first initialized. This means it now defaults to the
5940 empty list to make all syntactic elements get their values from the
5941 style system.
5942
5943 **** Compatibility variable to restore the old behavior.
5944 In case your configuration doesn't work with this change, you can set
5945 c-old-style-variable-behavior to non-nil to get the old behavior back
5946 as far as possible.
5947
5948 *** Improvements to line breaking and text filling.
5949 CC Mode now handles this more intelligently and seamlessly wrt the
5950 surrounding code, especially inside comments. For details see the new
5951 chapter about this in the manual.
5952
5953 **** New variable to recognize comment line prefix decorations.
5954 The variable c-comment-prefix-regexp has been added to properly
5955 recognize the line prefix in both block and line comments. It's
5956 primarily used to initialize the various paragraph recognition and
5957 adaptive filling variables that the text handling functions uses.
5958
5959 **** New variable c-block-comment-prefix.
5960 This is a generalization of the now obsolete variable
5961 c-comment-continuation-stars to handle arbitrary strings.
5962
5963 **** CC Mode now uses adaptive fill mode.
5964 This to make it adapt better to the paragraph style inside comments.
5965
5966 It's also possible to use other adaptive filling packages inside CC
5967 Mode, notably Kyle E. Jones' Filladapt mode (http://wonderworks.com/).
5968 A new convenience function c-setup-filladapt sets up Filladapt for use
5969 inside CC Mode.
5970
5971 Note though that the 2.12 version of Filladapt lacks a feature that
5972 causes it to work suboptimally when c-comment-prefix-regexp can match
5973 the empty string (which it commonly does). A patch for that is
5974 available from the CC Mode web site (http://www.python.org/emacs/
5975 cc-mode/).
5976
5977 **** The variables `c-hanging-comment-starter-p' and
5978 `c-hanging-comment-ender-p', which controlled how comment starters and
5979 enders were filled, are not used anymore. The new version of the
5980 function `c-fill-paragraph' keeps the comment starters and enders as
5981 they were before the filling.
5982
5983 **** It's now possible to selectively turn off auto filling.
5984 The variable c-ignore-auto-fill is used to ignore auto fill mode in
5985 specific contexts, e.g. in preprocessor directives and in string
5986 literals.
5987
5988 **** New context sensitive line break function c-context-line-break.
5989 It works like newline-and-indent in normal code, and adapts the line
5990 prefix according to the comment style when used inside comments. If
5991 you're normally using newline-and-indent, you might want to switch to
5992 this function.
5993
5994 *** Fixes to IDL mode.
5995 It now does a better job in recognizing only the constructs relevant
5996 to IDL. E.g. it no longer matches "class" as the beginning of a
5997 struct block, but it does match the CORBA 2.3 "valuetype" keyword.
5998 Thanks to Eric Eide.
5999
6000 *** Improvements to the Whitesmith style.
6001 It now keeps the style consistently on all levels and both when
6002 opening braces hangs and when they don't.
6003
6004 **** New lineup function c-lineup-whitesmith-in-block.
6005
6006 *** New lineup functions c-lineup-template-args and c-indent-multi-line-block.
6007 See their docstrings for details. c-lineup-template-args does a
6008 better job of tracking the brackets used as parens in C++ templates,
6009 and is used by default to line up continued template arguments.
6010
6011 *** c-lineup-comment now preserves alignment with a comment on the
6012 previous line. It used to instead preserve comments that started in
6013 the column specified by comment-column.
6014
6015 *** c-lineup-C-comments handles "free form" text comments.
6016 In comments with a long delimiter line at the start, the indentation
6017 is kept unchanged for lines that start with an empty comment line
6018 prefix. This is intended for the type of large block comments that
6019 contain documentation with its own formatting. In these you normally
6020 don't want CC Mode to change the indentation.
6021
6022 *** The `c' syntactic symbol is now relative to the comment start
6023 instead of the previous line, to make integers usable as lineup
6024 arguments.
6025
6026 *** All lineup functions have gotten docstrings.
6027
6028 *** More preprocessor directive movement functions.
6029 c-down-conditional does the reverse of c-up-conditional.
6030 c-up-conditional-with-else and c-down-conditional-with-else are
6031 variants of these that also stops at "#else" lines (suggested by Don
6032 Provan).
6033
6034 *** Minor improvements to many movement functions in tricky situations.
6035
6036 ** Dired changes
6037
6038 *** New variable `dired-recursive-deletes' determines if the delete
6039 command will delete non-empty directories recursively. The default
6040 is, delete only empty directories.
6041
6042 *** New variable `dired-recursive-copies' determines if the copy
6043 command will copy directories recursively. The default is, do not
6044 copy directories recursively.
6045
6046 *** In command `dired-do-shell-command' (usually bound to `!') a `?'
6047 in the shell command has a special meaning similar to `*', but with
6048 the difference that the command will be run on each file individually.
6049
6050 *** The new command `dired-find-alternate-file' (usually bound to `a')
6051 replaces the Dired buffer with the buffer for an alternate file or
6052 directory.
6053
6054 *** The new command `dired-show-file-type' (usually bound to `y') shows
6055 a message in the echo area describing what type of file the point is on.
6056 This command invokes the external program `file' do its work, and so
6057 will only work on systems with that program, and will be only as
6058 accurate or inaccurate as it is.
6059
6060 *** Dired now properly handles undo changes of adding/removing `-R'
6061 from ls switches.
6062
6063 *** Dired commands that prompt for a destination file now allow the use
6064 of the `M-n' command in the minibuffer to insert the source filename,
6065 which the user can then edit. This only works if there is a single
6066 source file, not when operating on multiple marked files.
6067
6068 ** Gnus changes.
6069
6070 The Gnus NEWS entries are short, but they reflect sweeping changes in
6071 four areas: Article display treatment, MIME treatment,
6072 internationalization and mail-fetching.
6073
6074 *** The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
6075 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
6076
6077 If you used procmail like in
6078
6079 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
6080 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
6081 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
6082 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
6083
6084 this now has changed to
6085
6086 (setq mail-sources
6087 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
6088 :suffix ".in")))
6089
6090 More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
6091 Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
6092
6093 *** Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of
6094 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
6095 Separate MIME packages like RMIME, mime-compose etc., will probably no
6096 longer work; remove them and use the native facilities.
6097
6098 The FLIM/SEMI package still works with Emacs 21, but if you want to
6099 use the native facilities, you must remove any mailcap.el[c] that was
6100 installed by FLIM/SEMI version 1.13 or earlier.
6101
6102 *** Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too many
6103 parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables. There
6104 are built-in facilities equivalent to those of gnus-mule.el, which is
6105 now just a compatibility layer.
6106
6107 *** gnus-mule.el is now just a compatibility layer over the built-in
6108 Gnus facilities.
6109
6110 *** gnus-auto-select-first can now be a function to be
6111 called to position point.
6112
6113 *** The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
6114 summary buffers and NOV files.
6115
6116 *** `gnus-article-display-hook' has been removed. Instead, a number
6117 of variables starting with `gnus-treat-' have been added.
6118
6119 *** The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now work in a
6120 subtly different manner.
6121
6122 *** New web-based backends have been added: nnslashdot, nnwarchive
6123 and nnultimate. nnweb has been revamped, again, to keep up with
6124 ever-changing layouts.
6125
6126 *** Gnus can now read IMAP mail via nnimap.
6127
6128 *** There is image support of various kinds and some sound support.
6129
6130 ** Changes in Texinfo mode.
6131
6132 *** A couple of new key bindings have been added for inserting Texinfo
6133 macros
6134
6135 Key binding Macro
6136 -------------------------
6137 C-c C-c C-s @strong
6138 C-c C-c C-e @emph
6139 C-c C-c u @uref
6140 C-c C-c q @quotation
6141 C-c C-c m @email
6142 C-c C-o @<block> ... @end <block>
6143 M-RET @item
6144
6145 *** The " key now inserts either " or `` or '' depending on context.
6146
6147 ** Changes in Outline mode.
6148
6149 There is now support for Imenu to index headings. A new command
6150 `outline-headers-as-kill' copies the visible headings in the region to
6151 the kill ring, e.g. to produce a table of contents.
6152
6153 ** Changes to Emacs Server
6154
6155 *** The new option `server-kill-new-buffers' specifies what to do
6156 with buffers when done with them. If non-nil, the default, buffers
6157 are killed, unless they were already present before visiting them with
6158 Emacs Server. If nil, `server-temp-file-regexp' specifies which
6159 buffers to kill, as before.
6160
6161 Please note that only buffers are killed that still have a client,
6162 i.e. buffers visited with `emacsclient --no-wait' are never killed in
6163 this way.
6164
6165 ** Both emacsclient and Emacs itself now accept command line options
6166 of the form +LINE:COLUMN in addition to +LINE.
6167
6168 ** Changes to Show Paren mode.
6169
6170 *** Overlays used by Show Paren mode now use a priority property.
6171 The new user option show-paren-priority specifies the priority to
6172 use. Default is 1000.
6173
6174 ** New command M-x check-parens can be used to find unbalanced paren
6175 groups and strings in buffers in Lisp mode (or other modes).
6176
6177 ** Changes to hideshow.el
6178
6179 *** Generalized block selection and traversal
6180
6181 A block is now recognized by its start and end regexps (both strings),
6182 and an integer specifying which sub-expression in the start regexp
6183 serves as the place where a `forward-sexp'-like function can operate.
6184 See the documentation of variable `hs-special-modes-alist'.
6185
6186 *** During incremental search, if Hideshow minor mode is active,
6187 hidden blocks are temporarily shown. The variable `hs-headline' can
6188 be used in the mode line format to show the line at the beginning of
6189 the open block.
6190
6191 *** User option `hs-hide-all-non-comment-function' specifies a
6192 function to be called at each top-level block beginning, instead of
6193 the normal block-hiding function.
6194
6195 *** The command `hs-show-region' has been removed.
6196
6197 *** The key bindings have changed to fit the Emacs conventions,
6198 roughly imitating those of Outline minor mode. Notably, the prefix
6199 for all bindings is now `C-c @'. For details, see the documentation
6200 for `hs-minor-mode'.
6201
6202 *** The variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' has been removed, and
6203 hideshow.el now always behaves as if this variable were set to t.
6204
6205 ** Changes to Change Log mode and Add-Log functions
6206
6207 *** If you invoke `add-change-log-entry' from a backup file, it makes
6208 an entry appropriate for the file's parent. This is useful for making
6209 log entries by comparing a version with deleted functions.
6210
6211 **** New command M-x change-log-merge merges another log into the
6212 current buffer.
6213
6214 *** New command M-x change-log-redate fixes any old-style date entries
6215 in a log file.
6216
6217 *** Change Log mode now adds a file's version number to change log
6218 entries if user-option `change-log-version-info-enabled' is non-nil.
6219 Unless the file is under version control the search for a file's
6220 version number is performed based on regular expressions from
6221 `change-log-version-number-regexp-list' which can be customized.
6222 Version numbers are only found in the first 10 percent of a file.
6223
6224 *** Change Log mode now defines its own faces for font-lock highlighting.
6225
6226 ** Changes to cmuscheme
6227
6228 *** The user-option `scheme-program-name' has been renamed
6229 `cmuscheme-program-name' due to conflicts with xscheme.el.
6230
6231 ** Changes in Font Lock
6232
6233 *** The new function `font-lock-remove-keywords' can be used to remove
6234 font-lock keywords from the current buffer or from a specific major mode.
6235
6236 *** Multi-line patterns are now supported. Modes using this, should
6237 set font-lock-multiline to t in their font-lock-defaults.
6238
6239 *** `font-lock-syntactic-face-function' allows major-modes to choose
6240 the face used for each string/comment.
6241
6242 *** A new standard face `font-lock-doc-face'.
6243 Meant for Lisp docstrings, Javadoc comments and other "documentation in code".
6244
6245 ** Changes to Shell mode
6246
6247 *** The `shell' command now accepts an optional argument to specify the buffer
6248 to use, which defaults to "*shell*". When used interactively, a
6249 non-default buffer may be specified by giving the `shell' command a
6250 prefix argument (causing it to prompt for the buffer name).
6251
6252 ** Comint (subshell) changes
6253
6254 These changes generally affect all modes derived from comint mode, which
6255 include shell-mode, gdb-mode, scheme-interaction-mode, etc.
6256
6257 *** Comint now by default interprets some carriage-control characters.
6258 Comint now removes CRs from CR LF sequences, and treats single CRs and
6259 BSs in the output in a way similar to a terminal (by deleting to the
6260 beginning of the line, or deleting the previous character,
6261 respectively). This is achieved by adding `comint-carriage-motion' to
6262 the `comint-output-filter-functions' hook by default.
6263
6264 *** By default, comint no longer uses the variable `comint-prompt-regexp'
6265 to distinguish prompts from user-input. Instead, it notices which
6266 parts of the text were output by the process, and which entered by the
6267 user, and attaches `field' properties to allow emacs commands to use
6268 this information. Common movement commands, notably beginning-of-line,
6269 respect field boundaries in a fairly natural manner. To disable this
6270 feature, and use the old behavior, customize the user option
6271 `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields'.
6272
6273 *** Comint now includes new features to send commands to running processes
6274 and redirect the output to a designated buffer or buffers.
6275
6276 *** The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command reads a command and
6277 buffer name from the mini-buffer. The command is sent to the current
6278 buffer's process, and its output is inserted into the specified buffer.
6279
6280 The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command-to-process acts like
6281 M-x comint-redirect-send-command but additionally reads the name of
6282 the buffer whose process should be used from the mini-buffer.
6283
6284 *** Packages based on comint now highlight user input and program prompts,
6285 and support choosing previous input with mouse-2. To control these features,
6286 see the user-options `comint-highlight-input' and `comint-highlight-prompt'.
6287
6288 *** The new command `comint-write-output' (usually bound to `C-c C-s')
6289 saves the output from the most recent command to a file. With a prefix
6290 argument, it appends to the file.
6291
6292 *** The command `comint-kill-output' has been renamed `comint-delete-output'
6293 (usually bound to `C-c C-o'); the old name is aliased to it for
6294 compatibility.
6295
6296 *** The new function `comint-add-to-input-history' adds commands to the input
6297 ring (history).
6298
6299 *** The new variable `comint-input-history-ignore' is a regexp for
6300 identifying history lines that should be ignored, like tcsh time-stamp
6301 strings, starting with a `#'. The default value of this variable is "^#".
6302
6303 ** Changes to Rmail mode
6304
6305 *** The new user-option rmail-user-mail-address-regexp can be
6306 set to fine tune the identification of the correspondent when
6307 receiving new mail. If it matches the address of the sender, the
6308 recipient is taken as correspondent of a mail. If nil, the default,
6309 `user-login-name' and `user-mail-address' are used to exclude yourself
6310 as correspondent.
6311
6312 Usually you don't have to set this variable, except if you collect
6313 mails sent by you under different user names. Then it should be a
6314 regexp matching your mail addresses.
6315
6316 *** The new user-option rmail-confirm-expunge controls whether and how
6317 to ask for confirmation before expunging deleted messages from an
6318 Rmail file. You can choose between no confirmation, confirmation
6319 with y-or-n-p, or confirmation with yes-or-no-p. Default is to ask
6320 for confirmation with yes-or-no-p.
6321
6322 *** RET is now bound in the Rmail summary to rmail-summary-goto-msg,
6323 like `j'.
6324
6325 *** There is a new user option `rmail-digest-end-regexps' that
6326 specifies the regular expressions to detect the line that ends a
6327 digest message.
6328
6329 *** The new user option `rmail-automatic-folder-directives' specifies
6330 in which folder to put messages automatically.
6331
6332 *** The new function `rmail-redecode-body' allows to fix a message
6333 with non-ASCII characters if Emacs happens to decode it incorrectly
6334 due to missing or malformed "charset=" header.
6335
6336 ** The new user-option `mail-envelope-from' can be used to specify
6337 an envelope-from address different from user-mail-address.
6338
6339 ** The variable mail-specify-envelope-from controls whether to
6340 use the -f option when sending mail.
6341
6342 ** The Rmail command `o' (`rmail-output-to-rmail-file') now writes the
6343 current message in the internal `emacs-mule' encoding, rather than in
6344 the encoding taken from the variable `buffer-file-coding-system'.
6345 This allows to save messages whose characters cannot be safely encoded
6346 by the buffer's coding system, and makes sure the message will be
6347 displayed correctly when you later visit the target Rmail file.
6348
6349 If you want your Rmail files be encoded in a specific coding system
6350 other than `emacs-mule', you can customize the variable
6351 `rmail-file-coding-system' to set its value to that coding system.
6352
6353 ** Changes to TeX mode
6354
6355 *** The default mode has been changed from `plain-tex-mode' to
6356 `latex-mode'.
6357
6358 *** latex-mode now has a simple indentation algorithm.
6359
6360 *** M-f and M-p jump around \begin...\end pairs.
6361
6362 *** Added support for outline-minor-mode.
6363
6364 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
6365
6366 *** RefTeX has new support for index generation. Index entries can be
6367 created with `C-c <', with completion available on index keys.
6368 Pressing `C-c /' indexes the word at the cursor with a default
6369 macro. `C-c >' compiles all index entries into an alphabetically
6370 sorted *Index* buffer which looks like the final index. Entries
6371 can be edited from that buffer.
6372
6373 *** Label and citation key selection now allow to select several
6374 items and reference them together (use `m' to mark items, `a' or
6375 `A' to use all marked entries).
6376
6377 *** reftex.el has been split into a number of smaller files to reduce
6378 memory use when only a part of RefTeX is being used.
6379
6380 *** a new command `reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex' (bound to `C-c &'
6381 in BibTeX-mode) can be called in a BibTeX database buffer in order
6382 to show locations in LaTeX documents where a particular entry has
6383 been cited.
6384
6385 ** Emacs Lisp mode now allows multiple levels of outline headings.
6386 The level of a heading is determined from the number of leading
6387 semicolons in a heading line. Toplevel forms starting with a `('
6388 in column 1 are always made leaves.
6389
6390 ** The M-x time-stamp command (most commonly used on write-file-hooks)
6391 has the following new features:
6392
6393 *** The patterns for finding the time stamp and for updating a pattern
6394 may match text spanning multiple lines. For example, some people like
6395 to have the filename and date on separate lines. The new variable
6396 time-stamp-inserts-lines controls the matching for multi-line patterns.
6397
6398 *** More than one time stamp can be updated in the same file. This
6399 feature is useful if you need separate time stamps in a program source
6400 file to both include in formatted documentation and insert in the
6401 compiled binary. The same time-stamp will be written at each matching
6402 pattern. The variable time-stamp-count enables this new feature; it
6403 defaults to 1.
6404
6405 ** Partial Completion mode now completes environment variables in
6406 file names.
6407
6408 ** Ispell changes
6409
6410 *** The command `ispell' now spell-checks a region if
6411 transient-mark-mode is on, and the mark is active. Otherwise it
6412 spell-checks the current buffer.
6413
6414 *** Support for synchronous subprocesses - DOS/Windoze - has been
6415 added.
6416
6417 *** An "alignment error" bug was fixed when a manual spelling
6418 correction is made and re-checked.
6419
6420 *** Italian, Portuguese, and Slovak dictionary definitions have been added.
6421
6422 *** Region skipping performance has been vastly improved in some
6423 cases.
6424
6425 *** Spell checking HTML buffers has been improved and isn't so strict
6426 on syntax errors.
6427
6428 *** The buffer-local words are now always placed on a new line at the
6429 end of the buffer.
6430
6431 *** Spell checking now works in the MS-DOS version of Emacs.
6432
6433 ** Makefile mode changes
6434
6435 *** The mode now uses the abbrev table `makefile-mode-abbrev-table'.
6436
6437 *** Conditionals and include statements are now highlighted when
6438 Fontlock mode is active.
6439
6440 ** Isearch changes
6441
6442 *** Isearch now puts a call to `isearch-resume' in the command history,
6443 so that searches can be resumed.
6444
6445 *** In Isearch mode, C-M-s and C-M-r are now bound like C-s and C-r,
6446 respectively, i.e. you can repeat a regexp isearch with the same keys
6447 that started the search.
6448
6449 *** In Isearch mode, mouse-2 in the echo area now yanks the current
6450 selection into the search string rather than giving an error.
6451
6452 *** There is a new lazy highlighting feature in incremental search.
6453
6454 Lazy highlighting is switched on/off by customizing variable
6455 `isearch-lazy-highlight'. When active, all matches for the current
6456 search string are highlighted. The current match is highlighted as
6457 before using face `isearch' or `region'. All other matches are
6458 highlighted using face `isearch-lazy-highlight-face' which defaults to
6459 `secondary-selection'.
6460
6461 The extra highlighting makes it easier to anticipate where the cursor
6462 will end up each time you press C-s or C-r to repeat a pending search.
6463 Highlighting of these additional matches happens in a deferred fashion
6464 using "idle timers," so the cycles needed do not rob isearch of its
6465 usual snappy response.
6466
6467 If `isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup' is set to t, highlights for
6468 matches are automatically cleared when you end the search. If it is
6469 set to nil, you can remove the highlights manually with `M-x
6470 isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup'.
6471
6472 ** VC Changes
6473
6474 VC has been overhauled internally. It is now modular, making it
6475 easier to plug-in arbitrary version control backends. (See Lisp
6476 Changes for details on the new structure.) As a result, the mechanism
6477 to enable and disable support for particular version systems has
6478 changed: everything is now controlled by the new variable
6479 `vc-handled-backends'. Its value is a list of symbols that identify
6480 version systems; the default is '(RCS CVS SCCS). When finding a file,
6481 each of the backends in that list is tried in order to see whether the
6482 file is registered in that backend.
6483
6484 When registering a new file, VC first tries each of the listed
6485 backends to see if any of them considers itself "responsible" for the
6486 directory of the file (e.g. because a corresponding subdirectory for
6487 master files exists). If none of the backends is responsible, then
6488 the first backend in the list that could register the file is chosen.
6489 As a consequence, the variable `vc-default-back-end' is now obsolete.
6490
6491 The old variable `vc-master-templates' is also obsolete, although VC
6492 still supports it for backward compatibility. To define templates for
6493 RCS or SCCS, you should rather use the new variables
6494 vc-{rcs,sccs}-master-templates. (There is no such feature under CVS
6495 where it doesn't make sense.)
6496
6497 The variables `vc-ignore-vc-files' and `vc-handle-cvs' are also
6498 obsolete now, you must set `vc-handled-backends' to nil or exclude
6499 `CVS' from the list, respectively, to achieve their effect now.
6500
6501 *** General Changes
6502
6503 The variable `vc-checkout-carefully' is obsolete: the corresponding
6504 checks are always done now.
6505
6506 VC Dired buffers are now kept up-to-date during all version control
6507 operations.
6508
6509 `vc-diff' output is now displayed in `diff-mode'.
6510 `vc-print-log' uses `log-view-mode'.
6511 `vc-log-mode' (used for *VC-Log*) has been replaced by `log-edit-mode'.
6512
6513 The command C-x v m (vc-merge) now accepts an empty argument as the
6514 first revision number. This means that any recent changes on the
6515 current branch should be picked up from the repository and merged into
6516 the working file (``merge news'').
6517
6518 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
6519 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) now ask for a directory name from which to work
6520 downwards.
6521
6522 *** Multiple Backends
6523
6524 VC now lets you register files in more than one backend. This is
6525 useful, for example, if you are working with a slow remote CVS
6526 repository. You can then use RCS for local editing, and occasionally
6527 commit your changes back to CVS, or pick up changes from CVS into your
6528 local RCS archives.
6529
6530 To make this work, the ``more local'' backend (RCS in our example)
6531 should come first in `vc-handled-backends', and the ``more remote''
6532 backend (CVS) should come later. (The default value of
6533 `vc-handled-backends' already has it that way.)
6534
6535 You can then commit changes to another backend (say, RCS), by typing
6536 C-u C-x v v RCS RET (i.e. vc-next-action now accepts a backend name as
6537 a revision number). VC registers the file in the more local backend
6538 if that hasn't already happened, and commits to a branch based on the
6539 current revision number from the more remote backend.
6540
6541 If a file is registered in multiple backends, you can switch to
6542 another one using C-x v b (vc-switch-backend). This does not change
6543 any files, it only changes VC's perspective on the file. Use this to
6544 pick up changes from CVS while working under RCS locally.
6545
6546 After you are done with your local RCS editing, you can commit your
6547 changes back to CVS using C-u C-x v v CVS RET. In this case, the
6548 local RCS archive is removed after the commit, and the log entry
6549 buffer is initialized to contain the entire RCS change log of the file.
6550
6551 *** Changes for CVS
6552
6553 There is a new user option, `vc-cvs-stay-local'. If it is `t' (the
6554 default), then VC avoids network queries for files registered in
6555 remote repositories. The state of such files is then only determined
6556 by heuristics and past information. `vc-cvs-stay-local' can also be a
6557 regexp to match against repository hostnames; only files from hosts
6558 that match it are treated locally. If the variable is nil, then VC
6559 queries the repository just as often as it does for local files.
6560
6561 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, then VC also makes local backups of
6562 repository versions. This means that ordinary diffs (C-x v =) and
6563 revert operations (C-x v u) can be done completely locally, without
6564 any repository interactions at all. The name of a local version
6565 backup of FILE is FILE.~REV.~, where REV is the repository version
6566 number. This format is similar to that used by C-x v ~
6567 (vc-version-other-window), except for the trailing dot. As a matter
6568 of fact, the two features can each use the files created by the other,
6569 the only difference being that files with a trailing `.' are deleted
6570 automatically after commit. (This feature doesn't work on MS-DOS,
6571 since DOS disallows more than a single dot in the trunk of a file
6572 name.)
6573
6574 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, and there have been changes in the
6575 repository, VC notifies you about it when you actually try to commit.
6576 If you want to check for updates from the repository without trying to
6577 commit, you can either use C-x v m RET to perform an update on the
6578 current file, or you can use C-x v r RET to get an update for an
6579 entire directory tree.
6580
6581 The new user option `vc-cvs-use-edit' indicates whether VC should call
6582 "cvs edit" to make files writeable; it defaults to `t'. (This option
6583 is only meaningful if the CVSREAD variable is set, or if files are
6584 "watched" by other developers.)
6585
6586 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
6587 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) are now also implemented for CVS. If you give
6588 an empty snapshot name to the latter, that performs a `cvs update',
6589 starting at the given directory.
6590
6591 *** Lisp Changes in VC
6592
6593 VC has been restructured internally to make it modular. You can now
6594 add support for arbitrary version control backends by writing a
6595 library that provides a certain set of backend-specific functions, and
6596 then telling VC to use that library. For example, to add support for
6597 a version system named SYS, you write a library named vc-sys.el, which
6598 provides a number of functions vc-sys-... (see commentary at the top
6599 of vc.el for a detailed list of them). To make VC use that library,
6600 you need to put it somewhere into Emacs' load path and add the symbol
6601 `SYS' to the list `vc-handled-backends'.
6602
6603 ** The customizable EDT emulation package now supports the EDT
6604 SUBS command and EDT scroll margins. It also works with more
6605 terminal/keyboard configurations and it now works under XEmacs.
6606 See etc/edt-user.doc for more information.
6607
6608 ** New modes and packages
6609
6610 *** The new global minor mode `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'
6611 automatically hides the `(default ...)' part of minibuffer prompts when
6612 the default is not applicable.
6613
6614 *** Artist is an Emacs lisp package that allows you to draw lines,
6615 rectangles and ellipses by using your mouse and/or keyboard. The
6616 shapes are made up with the ascii characters |, -, / and \.
6617
6618 Features are:
6619
6620 - Intersecting: When a `|' intersects with a `-', a `+' is
6621 drawn, like this: | \ /
6622 --+-- X
6623 | / \
6624
6625 - Rubber-banding: When drawing lines you can interactively see the
6626 result while holding the mouse button down and moving the mouse. If
6627 your machine is not fast enough (a 386 is a bit too slow, but a
6628 pentium is well enough), you can turn this feature off. You will
6629 then see 1's and 2's which mark the 1st and 2nd endpoint of the line
6630 you are drawing.
6631
6632 - Arrows: After having drawn a (straight) line or a (straight)
6633 poly-line, you can set arrows on the line-ends by typing < or >.
6634
6635 - Flood-filling: You can fill any area with a certain character by
6636 flood-filling.
6637
6638 - Cut copy and paste: You can cut, copy and paste rectangular
6639 regions. Artist also interfaces with the rect package (this can be
6640 turned off if it causes you any trouble) so anything you cut in
6641 artist can be yanked with C-x r y and vice versa.
6642
6643 - Drawing with keys: Everything you can do with the mouse, you can
6644 also do without the mouse.
6645
6646 - Aspect-ratio: You can set the variable artist-aspect-ratio to
6647 reflect the height-width ratio for the font you are using. Squares
6648 and circles are then drawn square/round. Note, that once your
6649 ascii-file is shown with font with a different height-width ratio,
6650 the squares won't be square and the circles won't be round.
6651
6652 - Drawing operations: The following drawing operations are implemented:
6653
6654 lines straight-lines
6655 rectangles squares
6656 poly-lines straight poly-lines
6657 ellipses circles
6658 text (see-thru) text (overwrite)
6659 spray-can setting size for spraying
6660 vaporize line vaporize lines
6661 erase characters erase rectangles
6662
6663 Straight lines are lines that go horizontally, vertically or
6664 diagonally. Plain lines go in any direction. The operations in
6665 the right column are accessed by holding down the shift key while
6666 drawing.
6667
6668 It is possible to vaporize (erase) entire lines and connected lines
6669 (rectangles for example) as long as the lines being vaporized are
6670 straight and connected at their endpoints. Vaporizing is inspired
6671 by the drawrect package by Jari Aalto <jari.aalto@poboxes.com>.
6672
6673 - Picture mode compatibility: Artist is picture mode compatible (this
6674 can be turned off).
6675
6676 *** The new package Eshell is an operating system command shell
6677 implemented entirely in Emacs Lisp. Use `M-x eshell' to invoke it.
6678 It functions similarly to bash and zsh, and allows running of Lisp
6679 functions and external commands using the same syntax. It supports
6680 history lists, aliases, extended globbing, smart scrolling, etc. It
6681 will work on any platform Emacs has been ported to. And since most of
6682 the basic commands -- ls, rm, mv, cp, ln, du, cat, etc. -- have been
6683 rewritten in Lisp, it offers an operating-system independent shell,
6684 all within the scope of your Emacs process.
6685
6686 *** The new package timeclock.el is a mode is for keeping track of time
6687 intervals. You can use it for whatever purpose you like, but the
6688 typical scenario is to keep track of how much time you spend working
6689 on certain projects.
6690
6691 *** The new package hi-lock.el provides commands to highlight matches
6692 of interactively entered regexps. For example,
6693
6694 M-x highlight-regexp RET clearly RET RET
6695
6696 will highlight all occurrences of `clearly' using a yellow background
6697 face. New occurrences of `clearly' will be highlighted as they are
6698 typed. `M-x unhighlight-regexp RET' will remove the highlighting.
6699 Any existing face can be used for highlighting and a set of
6700 appropriate faces is provided. The regexps can be written into the
6701 current buffer in a form that will be recognized the next time the
6702 corresponding file is read. There are commands to highlight matches
6703 to phrases and to highlight entire lines containing a match.
6704
6705 *** The new package zone.el plays games with Emacs' display when
6706 Emacs is idle.
6707
6708 *** The new package tildify.el allows to add hard spaces or other text
6709 fragments in accordance with the current major mode.
6710
6711 *** The new package xml.el provides a simple but generic XML
6712 parser. It doesn't parse the DTDs however.
6713
6714 *** The comment operations are now provided by the newcomment.el
6715 package which allows different styles of comment-region and should
6716 be more robust while offering the same functionality.
6717 `comment-region' now doesn't always comment a-line-at-a-time, but only
6718 comments the region, breaking the line at point if necessary.
6719
6720 *** The Ebrowse package implements a C++ class browser and tags
6721 facilities tailored for use with C++. It is documented in a
6722 separate Texinfo file.
6723
6724 *** The PCL-CVS package available by either running M-x cvs-examine or
6725 by visiting a CVS administrative directory (with a prefix argument)
6726 provides an alternative interface to VC-dired for CVS. It comes with
6727 `log-view-mode' to view RCS and SCCS logs and `log-edit-mode' used to
6728 enter check-in log messages.
6729
6730 *** The new package called `woman' allows to browse Unix man pages
6731 without invoking external programs.
6732
6733 The command `M-x woman' formats manual pages entirely in Emacs Lisp
6734 and then displays them, like `M-x manual-entry' does. Unlike
6735 `manual-entry', `woman' does not invoke any external programs, so it
6736 is useful on systems such as MS-DOS/MS-Windows where the `man' and
6737 Groff or `troff' commands are not readily available.
6738
6739 The command `M-x woman-find-file' asks for the file name of a man
6740 page, then formats and displays it like `M-x woman' does.
6741
6742 *** The new command M-x re-builder offers a convenient interface for
6743 authoring regular expressions with immediate visual feedback.
6744
6745 The buffer from which the command was called becomes the target for
6746 the regexp editor popping up in a separate window. Matching text in
6747 the target buffer is immediately color marked during the editing.
6748 Each sub-expression of the regexp will show up in a different face so
6749 even complex regexps can be edited and verified on target data in a
6750 single step.
6751
6752 On displays not supporting faces the matches instead blink like
6753 matching parens to make them stand out. On such a setup you will
6754 probably also want to use the sub-expression mode when the regexp
6755 contains such to get feedback about their respective limits.
6756
6757 *** glasses-mode is a minor mode that makes
6758 unreadableIdentifiersLikeThis readable. It works as glasses, without
6759 actually modifying content of a buffer.
6760
6761 *** The package ebnf2ps translates an EBNF to a syntactic chart in
6762 PostScript.
6763
6764 Currently accepts ad-hoc EBNF, ISO EBNF and Bison/Yacc.
6765
6766 The ad-hoc default EBNF syntax has the following elements:
6767
6768 ; comment (until end of line)
6769 A non-terminal
6770 "C" terminal
6771 ?C? special
6772 $A default non-terminal
6773 $"C" default terminal
6774 $?C? default special
6775 A = B. production (A is the header and B the body)
6776 C D sequence (C occurs before D)
6777 C | D alternative (C or D occurs)
6778 A - B exception (A excluding B, B without any non-terminal)
6779 n * A repetition (A repeats n (integer) times)
6780 (C) group (expression C is grouped together)
6781 [C] optional (C may or not occurs)
6782 C+ one or more occurrences of C
6783 {C}+ one or more occurrences of C
6784 {C}* zero or more occurrences of C
6785 {C} zero or more occurrences of C
6786 C / D equivalent to: C {D C}*
6787 {C || D}+ equivalent to: C {D C}*
6788 {C || D}* equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
6789 {C || D} equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
6790
6791 Please, see ebnf2ps documentation for EBNF syntax and how to use it.
6792
6793 *** The package align.el will align columns within a region, using M-x
6794 align. Its mode-specific rules, based on regular expressions,
6795 determine where the columns should be split. In C and C++, for
6796 example, it will align variable names in declaration lists, or the
6797 equal signs of assignments.
6798
6799 *** `paragraph-indent-minor-mode' is a new minor mode supporting
6800 paragraphs in the same style as `paragraph-indent-text-mode'.
6801
6802 *** bs.el is a new package for buffer selection similar to
6803 list-buffers or electric-buffer-list. Use M-x bs-show to display a
6804 buffer menu with this package. See the Custom group `bs'.
6805
6806 *** find-lisp.el is a package emulating the Unix find command in Lisp.
6807
6808 *** calculator.el is a small calculator package that is intended to
6809 replace desktop calculators such as xcalc and calc.exe. Actually, it
6810 is not too small - it has more features than most desktop calculators,
6811 and can be customized easily to get many more functions. It should
6812 not be confused with "calc" which is a much bigger mathematical tool
6813 which answers different needs.
6814
6815 *** The minor modes cwarn-mode and global-cwarn-mode highlights
6816 suspicious C and C++ constructions. Currently, assignments inside
6817 expressions, semicolon following `if', `for' and `while' (except, of
6818 course, after a `do .. while' statement), and C++ functions with
6819 reference parameters are recognized. The modes require font-lock mode
6820 to be enabled.
6821
6822 *** smerge-mode.el provides `smerge-mode', a simple minor-mode for files
6823 containing diff3-style conflict markers, such as generated by RCS.
6824
6825 *** 5x5.el is a simple puzzle game.
6826
6827 *** hl-line.el provides `hl-line-mode', a minor mode to highlight the
6828 current line in the current buffer. It also provides
6829 `global-hl-line-mode' to provide the same behavior in all buffers.
6830
6831 *** ansi-color.el translates ANSI terminal escapes into text-properties.
6832
6833 Please note: if `ansi-color-for-comint-mode' and
6834 `global-font-lock-mode' are non-nil, loading ansi-color.el will
6835 disable font-lock and add `ansi-color-apply' to
6836 `comint-preoutput-filter-functions' for all shell-mode buffers. This
6837 displays the output of "ls --color=yes" using the correct foreground
6838 and background colors.
6839
6840 *** delphi.el provides a major mode for editing the Delphi (Object
6841 Pascal) language.
6842
6843 *** quickurl.el provides a simple method of inserting a URL based on
6844 the text at point.
6845
6846 *** sql.el provides an interface to SQL data bases.
6847
6848 *** fortune.el uses the fortune program to create mail/news signatures.
6849
6850 *** whitespace.el is a package for warning about and cleaning bogus
6851 whitespace in a file.
6852
6853 *** PostScript mode (ps-mode) is a new major mode for editing PostScript
6854 files. It offers: interaction with a PostScript interpreter, including
6855 (very basic) error handling; fontification, easily customizable for
6856 interpreter messages; auto-indentation; insertion of EPSF templates and
6857 often used code snippets; viewing of BoundingBox; commenting out /
6858 uncommenting regions; conversion of 8bit characters to PostScript octal
6859 codes. All functionality is accessible through a menu.
6860
6861 *** delim-col helps to prettify columns in a text region or rectangle.
6862
6863 Here is an example of columns:
6864
6865 horse apple bus
6866 dog pineapple car EXTRA
6867 porcupine strawberry airplane
6868
6869 Doing the following settings:
6870
6871 (setq delimit-columns-str-before "[ ")
6872 (setq delimit-columns-str-after " ]")
6873 (setq delimit-columns-str-separator ", ")
6874 (setq delimit-columns-separator "\t")
6875
6876
6877 Selecting the lines above and typing:
6878
6879 M-x delimit-columns-region
6880
6881 It results:
6882
6883 [ horse , apple , bus , ]
6884 [ dog , pineapple , car , EXTRA ]
6885 [ porcupine, strawberry, airplane, ]
6886
6887 delim-col has the following options:
6888
6889 delimit-columns-str-before Specify a string to be inserted
6890 before all columns.
6891
6892 delimit-columns-str-separator Specify a string to be inserted
6893 between each column.
6894
6895 delimit-columns-str-after Specify a string to be inserted
6896 after all columns.
6897
6898 delimit-columns-separator Specify a regexp which separates
6899 each column.
6900
6901 delim-col has the following commands:
6902
6903 delimit-columns-region Prettify all columns in a text region.
6904 delimit-columns-rectangle Prettify all columns in a text rectangle.
6905
6906 *** Recentf mode maintains a menu for visiting files that were
6907 operated on recently. User option recentf-menu-filter specifies a
6908 menu filter function to change the menu appearance. For example, the
6909 recent file list can be displayed:
6910
6911 - organized by major modes, directories or user defined rules.
6912 - sorted by file paths, file names, ascending or descending.
6913 - showing paths relative to the current default-directory
6914
6915 The `recentf-filter-changer' menu filter function allows to
6916 dynamically change the menu appearance.
6917
6918 *** elide-head.el provides a mechanism for eliding boilerplate header
6919 text.
6920
6921 *** footnote.el provides `footnote-mode', a minor mode supporting use
6922 of footnotes. It is intended for use with Message mode, but isn't
6923 specific to Message mode.
6924
6925 *** diff-mode.el provides `diff-mode', a major mode for
6926 viewing/editing context diffs (patches). It is selected for files
6927 with extension `.diff', `.diffs', `.patch' and `.rej'.
6928
6929 *** EUDC, the Emacs Unified Directory Client, provides a common user
6930 interface to access directory servers using different directory
6931 protocols. It has a separate manual.
6932
6933 *** autoconf.el provides a major mode for editing configure.in files
6934 for Autoconf, selected automatically.
6935
6936 *** windmove.el provides moving between windows.
6937
6938 *** crm.el provides a facility to read multiple strings from the
6939 minibuffer with completion.
6940
6941 *** todo-mode.el provides management of TODO lists and integration
6942 with the diary features.
6943
6944 *** autoarg.el provides a feature reported from Twenex Emacs whereby
6945 numeric keys supply prefix args rather than self inserting.
6946
6947 *** The function `turn-off-auto-fill' unconditionally turns off Auto
6948 Fill mode.
6949
6950 *** pcomplete.el is a library that provides programmable completion
6951 facilities for Emacs, similar to what zsh and tcsh offer. The main
6952 difference is that completion functions are written in Lisp, meaning
6953 they can be profiled, debugged, etc.
6954
6955 *** antlr-mode is a new major mode for editing ANTLR grammar files.
6956 It is automatically turned on for files whose names have the extension
6957 `.g'.
6958
6959 ** Changes in sort.el
6960
6961 The function sort-numeric-fields interprets numbers starting with `0'
6962 as octal and numbers starting with `0x' or `0X' as hexadecimal. The
6963 new user-option sort-numeric-base can be used to specify a default
6964 numeric base.
6965
6966 ** Changes to Ange-ftp
6967
6968 *** Ange-ftp allows you to specify of a port number in remote file
6969 names cleanly. It is appended to the host name, separated by a hash
6970 sign, e.g. `/foo@bar.org#666:mumble'. (This syntax comes from EFS.)
6971
6972 *** If the new user-option `ange-ftp-try-passive-mode' is set, passive
6973 ftp mode will be used if the ftp client supports that.
6974
6975 *** Ange-ftp handles the output of the w32-style clients which
6976 output ^M at the end of lines.
6977
6978 ** The recommended way of using Iswitchb is via the new global minor
6979 mode `iswitchb-mode'.
6980
6981 ** Just loading the msb package doesn't switch on Msb mode anymore.
6982 If you have `(require 'msb)' in your .emacs, please replace it with
6983 `(msb-mode 1)'.
6984
6985 ** Flyspell mode has various new options. See the `flyspell' Custom
6986 group.
6987
6988 ** The user option `backward-delete-char-untabify-method' controls the
6989 behavior of `backward-delete-char-untabify'. The following values
6990 are recognized:
6991
6992 `untabify' -- turn a tab to many spaces, then delete one space;
6993 `hungry' -- delete all whitespace, both tabs and spaces;
6994 `all' -- delete all whitespace, including tabs, spaces and newlines;
6995 nil -- just delete one character.
6996
6997 Default value is `untabify'.
6998
6999 [This change was made in Emacs 20.3 but not mentioned then.]
7000
7001 ** In Cperl mode `cperl-invalid-face' should now be a normal face
7002 symbol, not double-quoted.
7003
7004 ** Some packages are declared obsolete, to be removed in a future
7005 version. They are: auto-show, c-mode, hilit19, hscroll, ooutline,
7006 profile, rnews, rnewspost, and sc. Their implementations have been
7007 moved to lisp/obsolete.
7008
7009 ** auto-compression mode is no longer enabled just by loading jka-compr.el.
7010 To control it, set `auto-compression-mode' via Custom or use the
7011 `auto-compression-mode' command.
7012
7013 ** `browse-url-gnome-moz' is a new option for
7014 `browse-url-browser-function', invoking Mozilla in GNOME, and
7015 `browse-url-kde' can be chosen for invoking the KDE browser.
7016
7017 ** The user-option `browse-url-new-window-p' has been renamed to
7018 `browse-url-new-window-flag'.
7019
7020 ** The functions `keep-lines', `flush-lines' and `how-many' now
7021 operate on the active region in Transient Mark mode.
7022
7023 ** `gnus-user-agent' is a new possibility for `mail-user-agent'. It
7024 is like `message-user-agent', but with all the Gnus paraphernalia.
7025
7026 ** The Strokes package has been updated. If your Emacs has XPM
7027 support, you can use it for pictographic editing. In Strokes mode,
7028 use C-mouse-2 to compose a complex stoke and insert it into the
7029 buffer. You can encode or decode a strokes buffer with new commands
7030 M-x strokes-encode-buffer and M-x strokes-decode-buffer. There is a
7031 new command M-x strokes-list-strokes.
7032
7033 ** Hexl contains a new command `hexl-insert-hex-string' which inserts
7034 a string of hexadecimal numbers read from the mini-buffer.
7035
7036 ** Hexl mode allows to insert non-ASCII characters.
7037
7038 The non-ASCII characters are encoded using the same encoding as the
7039 file you are visiting in Hexl mode.
7040
7041 ** Shell script mode changes.
7042
7043 Shell script mode (sh-script) can now indent scripts for shells
7044 derived from sh and rc. The indentation style is customizable, and
7045 sh-script can attempt to "learn" the current buffer's style.
7046
7047 ** Etags changes.
7048
7049 *** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c.
7050
7051 *** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now
7052 possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with
7053 {lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out.
7054 This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains
7055 a regular expression. The manual contains details.
7056
7057 *** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function
7058 declarations when given the --declarations option.
7059
7060 *** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form
7061 "operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator.
7062
7063 *** You shouldn't generally need any more the -C or -c++ option: etags
7064 automatically switches to C++ parsing when it meets the `class' or
7065 `template' keywords.
7066
7067 *** Etags now is able to delve at arbitrary deeps into nested structures in
7068 C-like languages. Previously, it was limited to one or two brace levels.
7069
7070 *** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and
7071 types.
7072
7073 *** In Fortran, `procedure' is not tagged.
7074
7075 *** In Java, tags are created for "interface".
7076
7077 *** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs
7078 are now tagged.
7079
7080 *** In makefiles, tags the targets.
7081
7082 *** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local
7083 variables are tagged.
7084
7085 *** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags.
7086
7087 *** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is
7088 for PSWrap.
7089
7090 ** Changes in etags.el
7091
7092 *** The new user-option tags-case-fold-search can be used to make
7093 tags operations case-sensitive or case-insensitive. The default
7094 is to use the same setting as case-fold-search.
7095
7096 *** You can display additional output with M-x tags-apropos by setting
7097 the new variable tags-apropos-additional-actions.
7098
7099 If non-nil, the variable's value should be a list of triples (TITLE
7100 FUNCTION TO-SEARCH). For each triple, M-x tags-apropos processes
7101 TO-SEARCH and lists tags from it. TO-SEARCH should be an alist,
7102 obarray, or symbol. If it is a symbol, the symbol's value is used.
7103
7104 TITLE is a string to use to label the list of tags from TO-SEARCH.
7105
7106 FUNCTION is a function to call when an entry is selected in the Tags
7107 List buffer. It is called with one argument, the selected symbol.
7108
7109 A useful example value for this variable might be something like:
7110
7111 '(("Emacs Lisp" Info-goto-emacs-command-node obarray)
7112 ("Common Lisp" common-lisp-hyperspec common-lisp-hyperspec-obarray)
7113 ("SCWM" scwm-documentation scwm-obarray))
7114
7115 *** The face tags-tag-face can be used to customize the appearance
7116 of tags in the output of M-x tags-apropos.
7117
7118 *** Setting tags-apropos-verbose to a non-nil value displays the
7119 names of tags files in the *Tags List* buffer.
7120
7121 *** You can now search for tags that are part of the filename itself.
7122 If you have tagged the files topfile.c subdir/subfile.c
7123 /tmp/tempfile.c, you can now search for tags "topfile.c", "subfile.c",
7124 "dir/sub", "tempfile", "tempfile.c". If the tag matches the file name,
7125 point will go to the beginning of the file.
7126
7127 *** Compressed files are now transparently supported if
7128 auto-compression-mode is active. You can tag (with Etags) and search
7129 (with find-tag) both compressed and uncompressed files.
7130
7131 *** Tags commands like M-x tags-search no longer change point
7132 in buffers where no match is found. In buffers where a match is
7133 found, the original value of point is pushed on the marker ring.
7134
7135 ** Fortran mode has a new command `fortran-strip-sequence-nos' to
7136 remove text past column 72. The syntax class of `\' in Fortran is now
7137 appropriate for C-style escape sequences in strings.
7138
7139 ** SGML mode's default `sgml-validate-command' is now `nsgmls'.
7140
7141 ** A new command `view-emacs-problems' (C-h P) displays the PROBLEMS file.
7142
7143 ** The Dabbrev package has a new user-option `dabbrev-ignored-regexps'
7144 containing a list of regular expressions. Buffers matching a regular
7145 expression from that list, are not checked.
7146
7147 ** Emacs can now figure out modification times of remote files.
7148 When you do C-x C-f /user@host:/path/file RET and edit the file,
7149 and someone else modifies the file, you will be prompted to revert
7150 the buffer, just like for the local files.
7151
7152 ** The buffer menu (C-x C-b) no longer lists the *Buffer List* buffer.
7153
7154 ** When invoked with a prefix argument, the command `list-abbrevs' now
7155 displays local abbrevs, only.
7156
7157 ** Refill minor mode provides preliminary support for keeping
7158 paragraphs filled as you modify them.
7159
7160 ** The variable `double-click-fuzz' specifies how much the mouse
7161 may be moved between clicks that are recognized as a pair. Its value
7162 is measured in pixels.
7163
7164 ** The new global minor mode `auto-image-file-mode' allows image files
7165 to be visited as images.
7166
7167 ** Two new user-options `grep-command' and `grep-find-command'
7168 were added to compile.el.
7169
7170 ** Withdrawn packages
7171
7172 *** mldrag.el has been removed. mouse.el provides the same
7173 functionality with aliases for the mldrag functions.
7174
7175 *** eval-reg.el has been obsoleted by changes to edebug.el and removed.
7176
7177 *** ph.el has been obsoleted by EUDC and removed.
7178
7179 \f
7180 * Incompatible Lisp changes
7181
7182 There are a few Lisp changes which are not backwards-compatible and
7183 may require changes to existing code. Here is a list for reference.
7184 See the sections below for details.
7185
7186 ** Since `format' preserves text properties, the idiom
7187 `(format "%s" foo)' no longer works to copy and remove properties.
7188 Use `copy-sequence' to copy the string, then use `set-text-properties'
7189 to remove the properties of the copy.
7190
7191 ** Since the `keymap' text property now has significance, some code
7192 which uses both `local-map' and `keymap' properties (for portability)
7193 may, for instance, give rise to duplicate menus when the keymaps from
7194 these properties are active.
7195
7196 ** The change in the treatment of non-ASCII characters in search
7197 ranges may affect some code.
7198
7199 ** A non-nil value for the LOCAL arg of add-hook makes the hook
7200 buffer-local even if `make-local-hook' hasn't been called, which might
7201 make a difference to some code.
7202
7203 ** The new treatment of the minibuffer prompt might affect code which
7204 operates on the minibuffer.
7205
7206 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
7207 cause `no-conversion' and `emacs-mule-unix' coding systems to produce
7208 different results when reading files with non-ASCII characters
7209 (previously, both coding systems would produce the same results).
7210 Specifically, `no-conversion' interprets each 8-bit byte as a separate
7211 character. This makes `no-conversion' inappropriate for reading
7212 multibyte text, e.g. buffers written to disk in their internal MULE
7213 encoding (auto-saving does that, for example). If a Lisp program
7214 reads such files with `no-conversion', each byte of the multibyte
7215 sequence, including the MULE leading codes such as \201, is treated as
7216 a separate character, which prevents them from being interpreted in
7217 the buffer as multibyte characters.
7218
7219 Therefore, Lisp programs that read files which contain the internal
7220 MULE encoding should use `emacs-mule-unix'. `no-conversion' is only
7221 appropriate for reading truly binary files.
7222
7223 ** Code that relies on the obsolete `before-change-function' and
7224 `after-change-function' to detect buffer changes will now fail. Use
7225 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' instead.
7226
7227 ** Code that uses `concat' with integer args now gets an error, as
7228 long promised. So does any code that uses derivatives of `concat',
7229 such as `mapconcat'.
7230
7231 ** The function base64-decode-string now always returns a unibyte
7232 string.
7233
7234 ** Not a Lisp incompatibility as such but, with the introduction of
7235 extra private charsets, there is now only one slot free for a new
7236 dimension-2 private charset. User code which tries to add more than
7237 one extra will fail unless you rebuild Emacs with some standard
7238 charset(s) removed; that is probably inadvisable because it changes
7239 the emacs-mule encoding. Also, files stored in the emacs-mule
7240 encoding using Emacs 20 with additional private charsets defined will
7241 probably not be read correctly by Emacs 21.
7242
7243 ** The variable `directory-sep-char' is slated for removal.
7244 Not really a change (yet), but a projected one that you should be
7245 aware of: The variable `directory-sep-char' is deprecated, and should
7246 not be used. It was always ignored on GNU/Linux and Unix systems and
7247 on MS-DOS, but the MS-Windows port tried to support it by adapting the
7248 behavior of certain primitives to the value of this variable. It
7249 turned out that such support cannot be reliable, so it was decided to
7250 remove this variable in the near future. Lisp programs are well
7251 advised not to set it to anything but '/', because any different value
7252 will not have any effect when support for this variable is removed.
7253
7254 \f
7255 * Lisp changes made after edition 2.6 of the Emacs Lisp Manual,
7256 (Display-related features are described in a page of their own below.)
7257
7258 ** Function assq-delete-all replaces function assoc-delete-all.
7259
7260 ** The new function animate-string, from lisp/play/animate.el
7261 allows the animated display of strings.
7262
7263 ** The new function `interactive-form' can be used to obtain the
7264 interactive form of a function.
7265
7266 ** The keyword :set-after in defcustom allows to specify dependencies
7267 between custom options. Example:
7268
7269 (defcustom default-input-method nil
7270 "*Default input method for multilingual text (a string).
7271 This is the input method activated automatically by the command
7272 `toggle-input-method' (\\[toggle-input-method])."
7273 :group 'mule
7274 :type '(choice (const nil) string)
7275 :set-after '(current-language-environment))
7276
7277 This specifies that default-input-method should be set after
7278 current-language-environment even if default-input-method appears
7279 first in a custom-set-variables statement.
7280
7281 ** The new hook `kbd-macro-termination-hook' is run at the end of
7282 function execute-kbd-macro. Functions on this hook are called with no
7283 args. The hook is run independent of how the macro was terminated
7284 (signal or normal termination).
7285
7286 ** Functions `butlast' and `nbutlast' for removing trailing elements
7287 from a list are now available without requiring the CL package.
7288
7289 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
7290 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
7291
7292 ** The user-option `face-font-registry-alternatives' specifies
7293 alternative font registry names to try when looking for a font.
7294
7295 ** Function `md5' calculates the MD5 "message digest"/"checksum".
7296
7297 ** Function `delete-frame' runs `delete-frame-hook' before actually
7298 deleting the frame. The hook is called with one arg, the frame
7299 being deleted.
7300
7301 ** `add-hook' now makes the hook local if called with a non-nil LOCAL arg.
7302
7303 ** The treatment of non-ASCII characters in search ranges has changed.
7304 If a range in a regular expression or the arg of
7305 skip-chars-forward/backward starts with a unibyte character C and ends
7306 with a multibyte character C2, the range is divided into two: one is
7307 C..?\377, the other is C1..C2, where C1 is the first character of C2's
7308 charset.
7309
7310 ** The new function `display-message-or-buffer' displays a message in
7311 the echo area or pops up a buffer, depending on the length of the
7312 message.
7313
7314 ** The new macro `with-auto-compression-mode' allows evaluating an
7315 expression with auto-compression-mode enabled.
7316
7317 ** In image specifications, `:heuristic-mask' has been replaced
7318 with the more general `:mask' property.
7319
7320 ** Image specifications accept more `:conversion's.
7321
7322 ** A `?' can be used in a symbol name without escaping it with a
7323 backslash.
7324
7325 ** Reading from the mini-buffer now reads from standard input if Emacs
7326 is running in batch mode. For example,
7327
7328 (message "%s" (read t))
7329
7330 will read a Lisp expression from standard input and print the result
7331 to standard output.
7332
7333 ** The argument of `down-list', `backward-up-list', `up-list',
7334 `kill-sexp', `backward-kill-sexp' and `mark-sexp' is now optional.
7335
7336 ** If `display-buffer-reuse-frames' is set, function `display-buffer'
7337 will raise frames displaying a buffer, instead of creating a new
7338 frame or window.
7339
7340 ** Two new functions for removing elements from lists/sequences
7341 were added
7342
7343 - Function: remove ELT SEQ
7344
7345 Return a copy of SEQ with all occurrences of ELT removed. SEQ must be
7346 a list, vector, or string. The comparison is done with `equal'.
7347
7348 - Function: remq ELT LIST
7349
7350 Return a copy of LIST with all occurrences of ELT removed. The
7351 comparison is done with `eq'.
7352
7353 ** The function `delete' now also works with vectors and strings.
7354
7355 ** The meaning of the `:weakness WEAK' argument of make-hash-table
7356 has been changed: WEAK can now have new values `key-or-value' and
7357 `key-and-value', in addition to `nil', `key', `value', and `t'.
7358
7359 ** Function `aset' stores any multibyte character in any string
7360 without signaling "Attempt to change char length of a string". It may
7361 convert a unibyte string to multibyte if necessary.
7362
7363 ** The value of the `help-echo' text property is called as a function
7364 or evaluated, if it is not a string already, to obtain a help string.
7365
7366 ** Function `make-obsolete' now has an optional arg to say when the
7367 function was declared obsolete.
7368
7369 ** Function `plist-member' is renamed from `widget-plist-member' (which is
7370 retained as an alias).
7371
7372 ** Easy-menu's :filter now takes the unconverted form of the menu and
7373 the result is automatically converted to Emacs' form.
7374
7375 ** The new function `window-list' has been defined
7376
7377 - Function: window-list &optional FRAME WINDOW MINIBUF
7378
7379 Return a list of windows on FRAME, starting with WINDOW. FRAME nil or
7380 omitted means use the selected frame. WINDOW nil or omitted means use
7381 the selected window. MINIBUF t means include the minibuffer window,
7382 even if it isn't active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means include the
7383 minibuffer window only if it's active. MINIBUF neither nil nor t
7384 means never include the minibuffer window.
7385
7386 ** There's a new function `get-window-with-predicate' defined as follows
7387
7388 - Function: get-window-with-predicate PREDICATE &optional MINIBUF ALL-FRAMES DEFAULT
7389
7390 Return a window satisfying PREDICATE.
7391
7392 This function cycles through all visible windows using `walk-windows',
7393 calling PREDICATE on each one. PREDICATE is called with a window as
7394 argument. The first window for which PREDICATE returns a non-nil
7395 value is returned. If no window satisfies PREDICATE, DEFAULT is
7396 returned.
7397
7398 Optional second arg MINIBUF t means count the minibuffer window even
7399 if not active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means count the minibuffer iff
7400 it is active. MINIBUF neither t nor nil means not to count the
7401 minibuffer even if it is active.
7402
7403 Several frames may share a single minibuffer; if the minibuffer
7404 counts, all windows on all frames that share that minibuffer count
7405 too. Therefore, if you are using a separate minibuffer frame
7406 and the minibuffer is active and MINIBUF says it counts,
7407 `walk-windows' includes the windows in the frame from which you
7408 entered the minibuffer, as well as the minibuffer window.
7409
7410 ALL-FRAMES is the optional third argument.
7411 ALL-FRAMES nil or omitted means cycle within the frames as specified above.
7412 ALL-FRAMES = `visible' means include windows on all visible frames.
7413 ALL-FRAMES = 0 means include windows on all visible and iconified frames.
7414 ALL-FRAMES = t means include windows on all frames including invisible frames.
7415 If ALL-FRAMES is a frame, it means include windows on that frame.
7416 Anything else means restrict to the selected frame.
7417
7418 ** The function `single-key-description' now encloses function key and
7419 event names in angle brackets. When called with a second optional
7420 argument non-nil, angle brackets won't be printed.
7421
7422 ** If the variable `message-truncate-lines' is bound to t around a
7423 call to `message', the echo area will not be resized to display that
7424 message; it will be truncated instead, as it was done in 20.x.
7425 Default value is nil.
7426
7427 ** The user option `line-number-display-limit' can now be set to nil,
7428 meaning no limit.
7429
7430 ** The new user option `line-number-display-limit-width' controls
7431 the maximum width of lines in a buffer for which Emacs displays line
7432 numbers in the mode line. The default is 200.
7433
7434 ** `select-safe-coding-system' now also checks the most preferred
7435 coding-system if buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and
7436 DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM is not specified,
7437
7438 ** The function `subr-arity' provides information about the argument
7439 list of a primitive.
7440
7441 ** `where-is-internal' now also accepts a list of keymaps.
7442
7443 ** The text property `keymap' specifies a key map which overrides the
7444 buffer's local map and the map specified by the `local-map' property.
7445 This is probably what most current uses of `local-map' want, rather
7446 than replacing the local map.
7447
7448 ** The obsolete variables `before-change-function' and
7449 `after-change-function' are no longer acted upon and have been
7450 removed. Use `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions'
7451 instead.
7452
7453 ** The function `apropos-mode' runs the hook `apropos-mode-hook'.
7454
7455 ** `concat' no longer accepts individual integer arguments,
7456 as promised long ago.
7457
7458 ** The new function `float-time' returns the current time as a float.
7459
7460 ** The new variable auto-coding-regexp-alist specifies coding systems
7461 for reading specific files, analogous to auto-coding-alist, but
7462 patterns are checked against file contents instead of file names.
7463
7464 \f
7465 * Lisp changes in Emacs 21.1 (see following page for display-related features)
7466
7467 ** The new package rx.el provides an alternative sexp notation for
7468 regular expressions.
7469
7470 - Function: rx-to-string SEXP
7471
7472 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
7473
7474 - Macro: rx SEXP
7475
7476 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
7477
7478 The following are valid subforms of regular expressions in sexp
7479 notation.
7480
7481 STRING
7482 matches string STRING literally.
7483
7484 CHAR
7485 matches character CHAR literally.
7486
7487 `not-newline'
7488 matches any character except a newline.
7489 .
7490 `anything'
7491 matches any character
7492
7493 `(any SET)'
7494 matches any character in SET. SET may be a character or string.
7495 Ranges of characters can be specified as `A-Z' in strings.
7496
7497 '(in SET)'
7498 like `any'.
7499
7500 `(not (any SET))'
7501 matches any character not in SET
7502
7503 `line-start'
7504 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of a line
7505 in the text being matched
7506
7507 `line-end'
7508 is similar to `line-start' but matches only at the end of a line
7509
7510 `string-start'
7511 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
7512 string being matched against.
7513
7514 `string-end'
7515 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
7516 string being matched against.
7517
7518 `buffer-start'
7519 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
7520 buffer being matched against.
7521
7522 `buffer-end'
7523 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
7524 buffer being matched against.
7525
7526 `point'
7527 matches the empty string, but only at point.
7528
7529 `word-start'
7530 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
7531 word.
7532
7533 `word-end'
7534 matches the empty string, but only at the end of a word.
7535
7536 `word-boundary'
7537 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
7538 word.
7539
7540 `(not word-boundary)'
7541 matches the empty string, but not at the beginning or end of a
7542 word.
7543
7544 `digit'
7545 matches 0 through 9.
7546
7547 `control'
7548 matches ASCII control characters.
7549
7550 `hex-digit'
7551 matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
7552
7553 `blank'
7554 matches space and tab only.
7555
7556 `graphic'
7557 matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
7558 space, and DEL.
7559
7560 `printing'
7561 matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
7562 and DEL.
7563
7564 `alphanumeric'
7565 matches letters and digits. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7566 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7567
7568 `letter'
7569 matches letters. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7570 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7571
7572 `ascii'
7573 matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
7574
7575 `nonascii'
7576 matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
7577
7578 `lower'
7579 matches anything lower-case.
7580
7581 `upper'
7582 matches anything upper-case.
7583
7584 `punctuation'
7585 matches punctuation. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7586 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
7587
7588 `space'
7589 matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
7590
7591 `word'
7592 matches anything that has word syntax.
7593
7594 `(syntax SYNTAX)'
7595 matches a character with syntax SYNTAX. SYNTAX must be one
7596 of the following symbols.
7597
7598 `whitespace' (\\s- in string notation)
7599 `punctuation' (\\s.)
7600 `word' (\\sw)
7601 `symbol' (\\s_)
7602 `open-parenthesis' (\\s()
7603 `close-parenthesis' (\\s))
7604 `expression-prefix' (\\s')
7605 `string-quote' (\\s\")
7606 `paired-delimiter' (\\s$)
7607 `escape' (\\s\\)
7608 `character-quote' (\\s/)
7609 `comment-start' (\\s<)
7610 `comment-end' (\\s>)
7611
7612 `(not (syntax SYNTAX))'
7613 matches a character that has not syntax SYNTAX.
7614
7615 `(category CATEGORY)'
7616 matches a character with category CATEGORY. CATEGORY must be
7617 either a character to use for C, or one of the following symbols.
7618
7619 `consonant' (\\c0 in string notation)
7620 `base-vowel' (\\c1)
7621 `upper-diacritical-mark' (\\c2)
7622 `lower-diacritical-mark' (\\c3)
7623 `tone-mark' (\\c4)
7624 `symbol' (\\c5)
7625 `digit' (\\c6)
7626 `vowel-modifying-diacritical-mark' (\\c7)
7627 `vowel-sign' (\\c8)
7628 `semivowel-lower' (\\c9)
7629 `not-at-end-of-line' (\\c<)
7630 `not-at-beginning-of-line' (\\c>)
7631 `alpha-numeric-two-byte' (\\cA)
7632 `chinse-two-byte' (\\cC)
7633 `greek-two-byte' (\\cG)
7634 `japanese-hiragana-two-byte' (\\cH)
7635 `indian-two-byte' (\\cI)
7636 `japanese-katakana-two-byte' (\\cK)
7637 `korean-hangul-two-byte' (\\cN)
7638 `cyrillic-two-byte' (\\cY)
7639 `ascii' (\\ca)
7640 `arabic' (\\cb)
7641 `chinese' (\\cc)
7642 `ethiopic' (\\ce)
7643 `greek' (\\cg)
7644 `korean' (\\ch)
7645 `indian' (\\ci)
7646 `japanese' (\\cj)
7647 `japanese-katakana' (\\ck)
7648 `latin' (\\cl)
7649 `lao' (\\co)
7650 `tibetan' (\\cq)
7651 `japanese-roman' (\\cr)
7652 `thai' (\\ct)
7653 `vietnamese' (\\cv)
7654 `hebrew' (\\cw)
7655 `cyrillic' (\\cy)
7656 `can-break' (\\c|)
7657
7658 `(not (category CATEGORY))'
7659 matches a character that has not category CATEGORY.
7660
7661 `(and SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7662 matches what SEXP1 matches, followed by what SEXP2 matches, etc.
7663
7664 `(submatch SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7665 like `and', but makes the match accessible with `match-end',
7666 `match-beginning', and `match-string'.
7667
7668 `(group SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7669 another name for `submatch'.
7670
7671 `(or SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7672 matches anything that matches SEXP1 or SEXP2, etc. If all
7673 args are strings, use `regexp-opt' to optimize the resulting
7674 regular expression.
7675
7676 `(minimal-match SEXP)'
7677 produce a non-greedy regexp for SEXP. Normally, regexps matching
7678 zero or more occurrences of something are \"greedy\" in that they
7679 match as much as they can, as long as the overall regexp can
7680 still match. A non-greedy regexp matches as little as possible.
7681
7682 `(maximal-match SEXP)'
7683 produce a greedy regexp for SEXP. This is the default.
7684
7685 `(zero-or-more SEXP)'
7686 matches zero or more occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7687
7688 `(0+ SEXP)'
7689 like `zero-or-more'.
7690
7691 `(* SEXP)'
7692 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7693
7694 `(*? SEXP)'
7695 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7696
7697 `(one-or-more SEXP)'
7698 matches one or more occurrences of A.
7699
7700 `(1+ SEXP)'
7701 like `one-or-more'.
7702
7703 `(+ SEXP)'
7704 like `one-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7705
7706 `(+? SEXP)'
7707 like `one-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7708
7709 `(zero-or-one SEXP)'
7710 matches zero or one occurrences of A.
7711
7712 `(optional SEXP)'
7713 like `zero-or-one'.
7714
7715 `(? SEXP)'
7716 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7717
7718 `(?? SEXP)'
7719 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7720
7721 `(repeat N SEXP)'
7722 matches N occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7723
7724 `(repeat N M SEXP)'
7725 matches N to M occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7726
7727 `(eval FORM)'
7728 evaluate FORM and insert result. If result is a string,
7729 `regexp-quote' it.
7730
7731 `(regexp REGEXP)'
7732 include REGEXP in string notation in the result.
7733
7734 *** The features `md5' and `overlay' are now provided by default.
7735
7736 *** The special form `save-restriction' now works correctly even if the
7737 buffer is widened inside the save-restriction and changes made outside
7738 the original restriction. Previously, doing this would cause the saved
7739 restriction to be restored incorrectly.
7740
7741 *** The functions `find-charset-region' and `find-charset-string' include
7742 `eight-bit-control' and/or `eight-bit-graphic' in the returned list
7743 when they find 8-bit characters. Previously, they included `ascii' in a
7744 multibyte buffer and `unknown' in a unibyte buffer.
7745
7746 *** The functions `set-buffer-multibyte', `string-as-multibyte' and
7747 `string-as-unibyte' change the byte sequence of a buffer or a string
7748 if it contains a character from the `eight-bit-control' character set.
7749
7750 *** The handling of multibyte sequences in a multibyte buffer is
7751 changed. Previously, a byte sequence matching the pattern
7752 [\200-\237][\240-\377]+ was interpreted as a single character
7753 regardless of the length of the trailing bytes [\240-\377]+. Thus, if
7754 the sequence was longer than what the leading byte indicated, the
7755 extra trailing bytes were ignored by Lisp functions. Now such extra
7756 bytes are independent 8-bit characters belonging to the charset
7757 eight-bit-graphic.
7758
7759 ** Fontsets are now implemented using char-tables.
7760
7761 A fontset can now be specified for each independent character, for
7762 a group of characters or for a character set rather than just for a
7763 character set as previously.
7764
7765 *** The arguments of the function `set-fontset-font' are changed.
7766 They are NAME, CHARACTER, FONTNAME, and optional FRAME. The function
7767 modifies fontset NAME to use FONTNAME for CHARACTER.
7768
7769 CHARACTER may be a cons (FROM . TO), where FROM and TO are non-generic
7770 characters. In that case FONTNAME is used for all characters in the
7771 range FROM and TO (inclusive). CHARACTER may be a charset. In that
7772 case FONTNAME is used for all character in the charset.
7773
7774 FONTNAME may be a cons (FAMILY . REGISTRY), where FAMILY is the family
7775 name of a font and REGISTRY is a registry name of a font.
7776
7777 *** Variable x-charset-registry has been deleted. The default charset
7778 registries of character sets are set in the default fontset
7779 "fontset-default".
7780
7781 *** The function `create-fontset-from-fontset-spec' ignores the second
7782 argument STYLE-VARIANT. It never creates style-variant fontsets.
7783
7784 ** The method of composing characters is changed. Now character
7785 composition is done by a special text property `composition' in
7786 buffers and strings.
7787
7788 *** Charset composition is deleted. Emacs never creates a `composite
7789 character' which is an independent character with a unique character
7790 code. Thus the following functions handling `composite characters'
7791 have been deleted: composite-char-component,
7792 composite-char-component-count, composite-char-composition-rule,
7793 composite-char-composition-rule and decompose-composite-char delete.
7794 The variables leading-code-composition and min-composite-char have
7795 also been deleted.
7796
7797 *** Three more glyph reference points are added. They can be used to
7798 specify a composition rule. See the documentation of the variable
7799 `reference-point-alist' for more detail.
7800
7801 *** The function `compose-region' takes new arguments COMPONENTS and
7802 MODIFICATION-FUNC. With COMPONENTS, you can specify not only a
7803 composition rule but also characters to be composed. Such characters
7804 may differ between buffer and string text.
7805
7806 *** The function `compose-string' takes new arguments START, END,
7807 COMPONENTS, and MODIFICATION-FUNC.
7808
7809 *** The function `compose-string' puts text property `composition'
7810 directly on the argument STRING instead of returning a new string.
7811 Likewise, the function `decompose-string' just removes text property
7812 `composition' from STRING.
7813
7814 *** The new function `find-composition' returns information about
7815 a composition at a specified position in a buffer or a string.
7816
7817 *** The function `decompose-composite-char' is now labeled as
7818 obsolete.
7819
7820 ** The new coding system `mac-roman' is primarily intended for use on
7821 the Macintosh but may be used generally for Macintosh-encoded text.
7822
7823 ** The new character sets `mule-unicode-0100-24ff',
7824 `mule-unicode-2500-33ff', and `mule-unicode-e000-ffff' have been
7825 introduced for Unicode characters in the range U+0100..U+24FF,
7826 U+2500..U+33FF, U+E000..U+FFFF respectively.
7827
7828 Note that the character sets are not yet unified in Emacs, so
7829 characters which belong to charsets such as Latin-2, Greek, Hebrew,
7830 etc. and the same characters in the `mule-unicode-*' charsets are
7831 different characters, as far as Emacs is concerned. For example, text
7832 which includes Unicode characters from the Latin-2 locale cannot be
7833 encoded by Emacs with ISO 8859-2 coding system.
7834
7835 ** The new coding system `mule-utf-8' has been added.
7836 It provides limited support for decoding/encoding UTF-8 text. For
7837 details, please see the documentation string of this coding system.
7838
7839 ** The new character sets `japanese-jisx0213-1' and
7840 `japanese-jisx0213-2' have been introduced for the new Japanese
7841 standard JIS X 0213 Plane 1 and Plane 2.
7842
7843 ** The new character sets `latin-iso8859-14' and `latin-iso8859-15'
7844 have been introduced.
7845
7846 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
7847 have been introduced for 8-bit characters in the ranges 0x80..0x9F and
7848 0xA0..0xFF respectively. Note that the multibyte representation of
7849 eight-bit-control is never exposed; this leads to an exception in the
7850 emacs-mule coding system, which encodes everything else to the
7851 buffer/string internal representation. Note that to search for
7852 eight-bit-graphic characters in a multibyte buffer, the search string
7853 must be multibyte, otherwise such characters will be converted to
7854 their multibyte equivalent.
7855
7856 ** If the APPEND argument of `write-region' is an integer, it seeks to
7857 that offset in the file before writing.
7858
7859 ** The function `add-minor-mode' has been added for convenience and
7860 compatibility with XEmacs (and is used internally by define-minor-mode).
7861
7862 ** The function `shell-command' now sets the default directory of the
7863 `*Shell Command Output*' buffer to the default directory of the buffer
7864 from which the command was issued.
7865
7866 ** The functions `query-replace', `query-replace-regexp',
7867 `query-replace-regexp-eval' `map-query-replace-regexp',
7868 `replace-string', `replace-regexp', and `perform-replace' take two
7869 additional optional arguments START and END that specify the region to
7870 operate on.
7871
7872 ** The new function `count-screen-lines' is a more flexible alternative
7873 to `window-buffer-height'.
7874
7875 - Function: count-screen-lines &optional BEG END COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE WINDOW
7876
7877 Return the number of screen lines in the region between BEG and END.
7878 The number of screen lines may be different from the number of actual
7879 lines, due to line breaking, display table, etc.
7880
7881 Optional arguments BEG and END default to `point-min' and `point-max'
7882 respectively.
7883
7884 If region ends with a newline, ignore it unless optional third argument
7885 COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE is non-nil.
7886
7887 The optional fourth argument WINDOW specifies the window used for
7888 obtaining parameters such as width, horizontal scrolling, and so
7889 on. The default is to use the selected window's parameters.
7890
7891 Like `vertical-motion', `count-screen-lines' always uses the current
7892 buffer, regardless of which buffer is displayed in WINDOW. This makes
7893 possible to use `count-screen-lines' in any buffer, whether or not it
7894 is currently displayed in some window.
7895
7896 ** The new function `mapc' is like `mapcar' but doesn't collect the
7897 argument function's results.
7898
7899 ** The functions base64-decode-region and base64-decode-string now
7900 signal an error instead of returning nil if decoding fails. Also,
7901 `base64-decode-string' now always returns a unibyte string (in Emacs
7902 20, it returned a multibyte string when the result was a valid multibyte
7903 sequence).
7904
7905 ** The function sendmail-user-agent-compose now recognizes a `body'
7906 header in the list of headers passed to it.
7907
7908 ** The new function member-ignore-case works like `member', but
7909 ignores differences in case and text representation.
7910
7911 ** The buffer-local variable cursor-type can be used to specify the
7912 cursor to use in windows displaying a buffer. Values are interpreted
7913 as follows:
7914
7915 t use the cursor specified for the frame (default)
7916 nil don't display a cursor
7917 `bar' display a bar cursor with default width
7918 (bar . WIDTH) display a bar cursor with width WIDTH
7919 others display a box cursor.
7920
7921 ** The variable open-paren-in-column-0-is-defun-start controls whether
7922 an open parenthesis in column 0 is considered to be the start of a
7923 defun. If set, the default, it is considered a defun start. If not
7924 set, an open parenthesis in column 0 has no special meaning.
7925
7926 ** The new function `string-to-syntax' can be used to translate syntax
7927 specifications in string form as accepted by `modify-syntax-entry' to
7928 the cons-cell form that is used for the values of the `syntax-table'
7929 text property, and in `font-lock-syntactic-keywords'.
7930
7931 Example:
7932
7933 (string-to-syntax "()")
7934 => (4 . 41)
7935
7936 ** Emacs' reader supports CL read syntax for integers in bases
7937 other than 10.
7938
7939 *** `#BINTEGER' or `#bINTEGER' reads INTEGER in binary (radix 2).
7940 INTEGER optionally contains a sign.
7941
7942 #b1111
7943 => 15
7944 #b-1111
7945 => -15
7946
7947 *** `#OINTEGER' or `#oINTEGER' reads INTEGER in octal (radix 8).
7948
7949 #o666
7950 => 438
7951
7952 *** `#XINTEGER' or `#xINTEGER' reads INTEGER in hexadecimal (radix 16).
7953
7954 #xbeef
7955 => 48815
7956
7957 *** `#RADIXrINTEGER' reads INTEGER in radix RADIX, 2 <= RADIX <= 36.
7958
7959 #2R-111
7960 => -7
7961 #25rah
7962 => 267
7963
7964 ** The function `documentation-property' now evaluates the value of
7965 the given property to obtain a string if it doesn't refer to etc/DOC
7966 and isn't a string.
7967
7968 ** If called for a symbol, the function `documentation' now looks for
7969 a `function-documentation' property of that symbol. If it has a non-nil
7970 value, the documentation is taken from that value. If the value is
7971 not a string, it is evaluated to obtain a string.
7972
7973 ** The last argument of `define-key-after' defaults to t for convenience.
7974
7975 ** The new function `replace-regexp-in-string' replaces all matches
7976 for a regexp in a string.
7977
7978 ** `mouse-position' now runs the abnormal hook
7979 `mouse-position-function'.
7980
7981 ** The function string-to-number now returns a float for numbers
7982 that don't fit into a Lisp integer.
7983
7984 ** The variable keyword-symbols-constants-flag has been removed.
7985 Keywords are now always considered constants.
7986
7987 ** The new function `delete-and-extract-region' deletes text and
7988 returns it.
7989
7990 ** The function `clear-this-command-keys' now also clears the vector
7991 returned by function `recent-keys'.
7992
7993 ** Variables `beginning-of-defun-function' and `end-of-defun-function'
7994 can be used to define handlers for the functions that find defuns.
7995 Major modes can define these locally instead of rebinding C-M-a
7996 etc. if the normal conventions for defuns are not appropriate for the
7997 mode.
7998
7999 ** easy-mmode-define-minor-mode now takes an additional BODY argument
8000 and is renamed `define-minor-mode'.
8001
8002 ** If an abbrev has a hook function which is a symbol, and that symbol
8003 has a non-nil `no-self-insert' property, the return value of the hook
8004 function specifies whether an expansion has been done or not. If it
8005 returns nil, abbrev-expand also returns nil, meaning "no expansion has
8006 been performed."
8007
8008 When abbrev expansion is done by typing a self-inserting character,
8009 and the abbrev has a hook with the `no-self-insert' property, and the
8010 hook function returns non-nil meaning expansion has been done,
8011 then the self-inserting character is not inserted.
8012
8013 ** The function `intern-soft' now accepts a symbol as first argument.
8014 In this case, that exact symbol is looked up in the specified obarray,
8015 and the function's value is nil if it is not found.
8016
8017 ** The new macro `with-syntax-table' can be used to evaluate forms
8018 with the syntax table of the current buffer temporarily set to a
8019 specified table.
8020
8021 (with-syntax-table TABLE &rest BODY)
8022
8023 Evaluate BODY with syntax table of current buffer set to a copy of
8024 TABLE. The current syntax table is saved, BODY is evaluated, and the
8025 saved table is restored, even in case of an abnormal exit. Value is
8026 what BODY returns.
8027
8028 ** Regular expressions now support intervals \{n,m\} as well as
8029 Perl's shy-groups \(?:...\) and non-greedy *? +? and ?? operators.
8030 Also back-references like \2 are now considered as an error if the
8031 corresponding subgroup does not exist (or is not closed yet).
8032 Previously it would have been silently turned into `2' (ignoring the `\').
8033
8034 ** The optional argument BUFFER of function file-local-copy has been
8035 removed since it wasn't used by anything.
8036
8037 ** The file name argument of function `file-locked-p' is now required
8038 instead of being optional.
8039
8040 ** The new built-in error `text-read-only' is signaled when trying to
8041 modify read-only text.
8042
8043 ** New functions and variables for locales.
8044
8045 The new variable `locale-coding-system' specifies how to encode and
8046 decode strings passed to low-level message functions like strerror and
8047 time functions like strftime. The new variables
8048 `system-messages-locale' and `system-time-locale' give the system
8049 locales to be used when invoking these two types of functions.
8050
8051 The new function `set-locale-environment' sets the language
8052 environment, preferred coding system, and locale coding system from
8053 the system locale as specified by the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG
8054 environment variables. Normally, it is invoked during startup and need
8055 not be invoked thereafter. It uses the new variables
8056 `locale-language-names', `locale-charset-language-names', and
8057 `locale-preferred-coding-systems' to make its decisions.
8058
8059 ** syntax tables now understand nested comments.
8060 To declare a comment syntax as allowing nesting, just add an `n'
8061 modifier to either of the characters of the comment end and the comment
8062 start sequences.
8063
8064 ** The function `pixmap-spec-p' has been renamed `bitmap-spec-p'
8065 because `bitmap' is more in line with the usual X terminology.
8066
8067 ** New function `propertize'
8068
8069 The new function `propertize' can be used to conveniently construct
8070 strings with text properties.
8071
8072 - Function: propertize STRING &rest PROPERTIES
8073
8074 Value is a copy of STRING with text properties assigned as specified
8075 by PROPERTIES. PROPERTIES is a sequence of pairs PROPERTY VALUE, with
8076 PROPERTY being the name of a text property and VALUE being the
8077 specified value of that property. Example:
8078
8079 (propertize "foo" 'face 'bold 'read-only t)
8080
8081 ** push and pop macros.
8082
8083 Simple versions of the push and pop macros of Common Lisp
8084 are now defined in Emacs Lisp. These macros allow only symbols
8085 as the place that holds the list to be changed.
8086
8087 (push NEWELT LISTNAME) add NEWELT to the front of LISTNAME's value.
8088 (pop LISTNAME) return first elt of LISTNAME, and remove it
8089 (thus altering the value of LISTNAME).
8090
8091 ** New dolist and dotimes macros.
8092
8093 Simple versions of the dolist and dotimes macros of Common Lisp
8094 are now defined in Emacs Lisp.
8095
8096 (dolist (VAR LIST [RESULT]) BODY...)
8097 Execute body once for each element of LIST,
8098 using the variable VAR to hold the current element.
8099 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8100
8101 (dotimes (VAR COUNT [RESULT]) BODY...)
8102 Execute BODY with VAR bound to successive integers running from 0,
8103 inclusive, to COUNT, exclusive.
8104 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8105
8106 ** Regular expressions now support Posix character classes such as
8107 [:alpha:], [:space:] and so on. These must be used within a character
8108 class--for instance, [-[:digit:].+] matches digits or a period
8109 or a sign.
8110
8111 [:digit:] matches 0 through 9
8112 [:cntrl:] matches ASCII control characters
8113 [:xdigit:] matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
8114 [:blank:] matches space and tab only
8115 [:graph:] matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
8116 space, and DEL.
8117 [:print:] matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
8118 and DEL.
8119 [:alnum:] matches letters and digits.
8120 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8121 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8122 [:alpha:] matches letters.
8123 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8124 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8125 [:ascii:] matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
8126 [:nonascii:] matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
8127 [:lower:] matches anything lower-case.
8128 [:punct:] matches punctuation.
8129 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8130 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
8131 [:space:] matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
8132 [:upper:] matches anything upper-case.
8133 [:word:] matches anything that has word syntax.
8134
8135 ** Emacs now has built-in hash tables.
8136
8137 The following functions are defined for hash tables:
8138
8139 - Function: make-hash-table ARGS
8140
8141 The argument list ARGS consists of keyword/argument pairs. All arguments
8142 are optional. The following arguments are defined:
8143
8144 :test TEST
8145
8146 TEST must be a symbol specifying how to compare keys. Default is `eql'.
8147 Predefined are `eq', `eql' and `equal'. If TEST is not predefined,
8148 it must have been defined with `define-hash-table-test'.
8149
8150 :size SIZE
8151
8152 SIZE must be an integer > 0 giving a hint to the implementation how
8153 many elements will be put in the hash table. Default size is 65.
8154
8155 :rehash-size REHASH-SIZE
8156
8157 REHASH-SIZE specifies by how much to grow a hash table once it becomes
8158 full. If REHASH-SIZE is an integer, add that to the hash table's old
8159 size to get the new size. Otherwise, REHASH-SIZE must be a float >
8160 1.0, and the new size is computed by multiplying REHASH-SIZE with the
8161 old size. Default rehash size is 1.5.
8162
8163 :rehash-threshold THRESHOLD
8164
8165 THRESHOLD must be a float > 0 and <= 1.0 specifying when to resize the
8166 hash table. It is resized when the ratio of (number of entries) /
8167 (size of hash table) is >= THRESHOLD. Default threshold is 0.8.
8168
8169 :weakness WEAK
8170
8171 WEAK must be either nil, one of the symbols `key, `value',
8172 `key-or-value', `key-and-value', or t, meaning the same as
8173 `key-and-value'. Entries are removed from weak tables during garbage
8174 collection if their key and/or value are not referenced elsewhere
8175 outside of the hash table. Default are non-weak hash tables.
8176
8177 - Function: makehash &optional TEST
8178
8179 Similar to make-hash-table, but only TEST can be specified.
8180
8181 - Function: hash-table-p TABLE
8182
8183 Returns non-nil if TABLE is a hash table object.
8184
8185 - Function: copy-hash-table TABLE
8186
8187 Returns a copy of TABLE. Only the table itself is copied, keys and
8188 values are shared.
8189
8190 - Function: hash-table-count TABLE
8191
8192 Returns the number of entries in TABLE.
8193
8194 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8195
8196 Returns the rehash size of TABLE.
8197
8198 - Function: hash-table-rehash-threshold TABLE
8199
8200 Returns the rehash threshold of TABLE.
8201
8202 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8203
8204 Returns the size of TABLE.
8205
8206 - Function: hash-table-test TABLE
8207
8208 Returns the test TABLE uses to compare keys.
8209
8210 - Function: hash-table-weakness TABLE
8211
8212 Returns the weakness specified for TABLE.
8213
8214 - Function: clrhash TABLE
8215
8216 Clear TABLE.
8217
8218 - Function: gethash KEY TABLE &optional DEFAULT
8219
8220 Look up KEY in TABLE and return its associated VALUE or DEFAULT if
8221 not found.
8222
8223 - Function: puthash KEY VALUE TABLE
8224
8225 Associate KEY with VALUE in TABLE. If KEY is already associated with
8226 another value, replace the old value with VALUE.
8227
8228 - Function: remhash KEY TABLE
8229
8230 Remove KEY from TABLE if it is there.
8231
8232 - Function: maphash FUNCTION TABLE
8233
8234 Call FUNCTION for all elements in TABLE. FUNCTION must take two
8235 arguments KEY and VALUE.
8236
8237 - Function: sxhash OBJ
8238
8239 Return a hash code for Lisp object OBJ.
8240
8241 - Function: define-hash-table-test NAME TEST-FN HASH-FN
8242
8243 Define a new hash table test named NAME. If NAME is specified as
8244 a test in `make-hash-table', the table created will use TEST-FN for
8245 comparing keys, and HASH-FN to compute hash codes for keys. Test
8246 and hash function are stored as symbol property `hash-table-test'
8247 of NAME with a value of (TEST-FN HASH-FN).
8248
8249 TEST-FN must take two arguments and return non-nil if they are the same.
8250
8251 HASH-FN must take one argument and return an integer that is the hash
8252 code of the argument. The function should use the whole range of
8253 integer values for hash code computation, including negative integers.
8254
8255 Example: The following creates a hash table whose keys are supposed to
8256 be strings that are compared case-insensitively.
8257
8258 (defun case-fold-string= (a b)
8259 (compare-strings a nil nil b nil nil t))
8260
8261 (defun case-fold-string-hash (a)
8262 (sxhash (upcase a)))
8263
8264 (define-hash-table-test 'case-fold 'case-fold-string=
8265 'case-fold-string-hash))
8266
8267 (make-hash-table :test 'case-fold)
8268
8269 ** The Lisp reader handles circular structure.
8270
8271 It now works to use the #N= and #N# constructs to represent
8272 circular structures. For example, #1=(a . #1#) represents
8273 a cons cell which is its own cdr.
8274
8275 ** The Lisp printer handles circular structure.
8276
8277 If you bind print-circle to a non-nil value, the Lisp printer outputs
8278 #N= and #N# constructs to represent circular and shared structure.
8279
8280 ** If the second argument to `move-to-column' is anything but nil or
8281 t, that means replace a tab with spaces if necessary to reach the
8282 specified column, but do not add spaces at the end of the line if it
8283 is too short to reach that column.
8284
8285 ** perform-replace has a new feature: the REPLACEMENTS argument may
8286 now be a cons cell (FUNCTION . DATA). This means to call FUNCTION
8287 after each match to get the replacement text. FUNCTION is called with
8288 two arguments: DATA, and the number of replacements already made.
8289
8290 If the FROM-STRING contains any upper-case letters,
8291 perform-replace also turns off `case-fold-search' temporarily
8292 and inserts the replacement text without altering case in it.
8293
8294 ** The function buffer-size now accepts an optional argument
8295 to specify which buffer to return the size of.
8296
8297 ** The calendar motion commands now run the normal hook
8298 calendar-move-hook after moving point.
8299
8300 ** The new variable small-temporary-file-directory specifies a
8301 directory to use for creating temporary files that are likely to be
8302 small. (Certain Emacs features use this directory.) If
8303 small-temporary-file-directory is nil, they use
8304 temporary-file-directory instead.
8305
8306 ** The variable `inhibit-modification-hooks', if non-nil, inhibits all
8307 the hooks that track changes in the buffer. This affects
8308 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions', as well as
8309 hooks attached to text properties and overlay properties.
8310
8311 ** assq-delete-all is a new function that deletes all the
8312 elements of an alist which have a car `eq' to a particular value.
8313
8314 ** make-temp-file provides a more reliable way to create a temporary file.
8315
8316 make-temp-file is used like make-temp-name, except that it actually
8317 creates the file before it returns. This prevents a timing error,
8318 ensuring that no other job can use the same name for a temporary file.
8319
8320 ** New exclusive-open feature in `write-region'
8321
8322 The optional seventh arg is now called MUSTBENEW. If non-nil, it insists
8323 on a check for an existing file with the same name. If MUSTBENEW
8324 is `excl', that means to get an error if the file already exists;
8325 never overwrite. If MUSTBENEW is neither nil nor `excl', that means
8326 ask for confirmation before overwriting, but do go ahead and
8327 overwrite the file if the user gives confirmation.
8328
8329 If the MUSTBENEW argument in `write-region' is `excl',
8330 that means to use a special feature in the `open' system call
8331 to get an error if the file exists at that time.
8332 The error reported is `file-already-exists'.
8333
8334 ** Function `format' now handles text properties.
8335
8336 Text properties of the format string are applied to the result string.
8337 If the result string is longer than the format string, text properties
8338 ending at the end of the format string are extended to the end of the
8339 result string.
8340
8341 Text properties from string arguments are applied to the result
8342 string where arguments appear in the result string.
8343
8344 Example:
8345
8346 (let ((s1 "hello, %s")
8347 (s2 "world"))
8348 (put-text-property 0 (length s1) 'face 'bold s1)
8349 (put-text-property 0 (length s2) 'face 'italic s2)
8350 (format s1 s2))
8351
8352 results in a bold-face string with an italic `world' at the end.
8353
8354 ** Messages can now be displayed with text properties.
8355
8356 Text properties are handled as described above for function `format'.
8357 The following example displays a bold-face message with an italic
8358 argument in it.
8359
8360 (let ((msg "hello, %s!")
8361 (arg "world"))
8362 (put-text-property 0 (length msg) 'face 'bold msg)
8363 (put-text-property 0 (length arg) 'face 'italic arg)
8364 (message msg arg))
8365
8366 ** Sound support
8367
8368 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and the free BSDs
8369 (Voxware driver and native BSD driver, aka as Luigi's driver).
8370
8371 Currently supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio
8372 (*.au). You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes'
8373 to enable sound support.
8374
8375 Sound files can be played by calling (play-sound SOUND). SOUND is a
8376 list of the form `(sound PROPERTY...)'. The function is only defined
8377 when sound support is present for the system on which Emacs runs. The
8378 functions runs `play-sound-functions' with one argument which is the
8379 sound to play, before playing the sound.
8380
8381 The following sound properties are supported:
8382
8383 - `:file FILE'
8384
8385 FILE is a file name. If FILE isn't an absolute name, it will be
8386 searched relative to `data-directory'.
8387
8388 - `:data DATA'
8389
8390 DATA is a string containing sound data. Either :file or :data
8391 may be present, but not both.
8392
8393 - `:volume VOLUME'
8394
8395 VOLUME must be an integer in the range 0..100 or a float in the range
8396 0..1. This property is optional.
8397
8398 - `:device DEVICE'
8399
8400 DEVICE is a string specifying the system device on which to play the
8401 sound. The default device is system-dependent.
8402
8403 Other properties are ignored.
8404
8405 An alternative interface is called as
8406 (play-sound-file FILE &optional VOLUME DEVICE).
8407
8408 ** `multimedia' is a new Finder keyword and Custom group.
8409
8410 ** keywordp is a new predicate to test efficiently for an object being
8411 a keyword symbol.
8412
8413 ** Changes to garbage collection
8414
8415 *** The function garbage-collect now additionally returns the number
8416 of live and free strings.
8417
8418 *** There is a new variable `strings-consed' holding the number of
8419 strings that have been consed so far.
8420
8421 \f
8422 * Lisp-level Display features added after release 2.6 of the Emacs
8423 Lisp Manual
8424
8425 ** The user-option `resize-mini-windows' controls how Emacs resizes
8426 mini-windows.
8427
8428 ** The function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now has a third optional
8429 argument, PARTIALLY. If a character is only partially visible, nil is
8430 returned, unless PARTIALLY is non-nil.
8431
8432 ** On window systems, `glyph-table' is no longer used.
8433
8434 ** Help strings in menu items are now used to provide `help-echo' text.
8435
8436 ** The function `image-size' can be used to determine the size of an
8437 image.
8438
8439 - Function: image-size SPEC &optional PIXELS FRAME
8440
8441 Return the size of an image as a pair (WIDTH . HEIGHT).
8442
8443 SPEC is an image specification. PIXELS non-nil means return sizes
8444 measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical
8445 character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default
8446 font). FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed.
8447 FRAME nil or omitted means use the selected frame.
8448
8449 ** The function `image-mask-p' can be used to determine if an image
8450 has a mask bitmap.
8451
8452 - Function: image-mask-p SPEC &optional FRAME
8453
8454 Return t if image SPEC has a mask bitmap.
8455 FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. FRAME nil
8456 or omitted means use the selected frame.
8457
8458 ** The function `find-image' can be used to find a usable image
8459 satisfying one of a list of specifications.
8460
8461 ** The STRING argument of `put-image' and `insert-image' is now
8462 optional.
8463
8464 ** Image specifications may contain the property `:ascent center' (see
8465 below).
8466
8467 \f
8468 * New Lisp-level Display features in Emacs 21.1
8469
8470 ** The function tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors can be used
8471 to make Emacs avoid displaying text with bold black foreground on TTYs.
8472
8473 Some terminals, notably PC consoles, emulate bold text by displaying
8474 text in brighter colors. On such a console, a bold black foreground
8475 is displayed in a gray color. If this turns out to be hard to read on
8476 your monitor---the problem occurred with the mode line on
8477 laptops---you can instruct Emacs to ignore the text's boldness, and to
8478 just display it black instead.
8479
8480 This situation can't be detected automatically. You will have to put
8481 a line like
8482
8483 (tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors t)
8484
8485 in your `.emacs'.
8486
8487 ** New face implementation.
8488
8489 Emacs faces have been reimplemented from scratch. They don't use XLFD
8490 font names anymore and face merging now works as expected.
8491
8492 *** New faces.
8493
8494 Each face can specify the following display attributes:
8495
8496 1. Font family or fontset alias name.
8497
8498 2. Relative proportionate width, aka character set width or set
8499 width (swidth), e.g. `semi-compressed'.
8500
8501 3. Font height in 1/10pt
8502
8503 4. Font weight, e.g. `bold'.
8504
8505 5. Font slant, e.g. `italic'.
8506
8507 6. Foreground color.
8508
8509 7. Background color.
8510
8511 8. Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color.
8512
8513 9. Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video.
8514
8515 10. A background stipple, a bitmap.
8516
8517 11. Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color.
8518
8519 12. Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what
8520 color.
8521
8522 13. Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its
8523 color, the width of the box lines, and 3D appearance.
8524
8525 Faces are frame-local by nature because Emacs allows to define the
8526 same named face (face names are symbols) differently for different
8527 frames. Each frame has an alist of face definitions for all named
8528 faces. The value of a named face in such an alist is a Lisp vector
8529 with the symbol `face' in slot 0, and a slot for each of the face
8530 attributes mentioned above.
8531
8532 There is also a global face alist `face-new-frame-defaults'. Face
8533 definitions from this list are used to initialize faces of newly
8534 created frames.
8535
8536 A face doesn't have to specify all attributes. Those not specified
8537 have a nil value. Faces specifying all attributes are called
8538 `fully-specified'.
8539
8540 *** Face merging.
8541
8542 The display style of a given character in the text is determined by
8543 combining several faces. This process is called `face merging'. Any
8544 aspect of the display style that isn't specified by overlays or text
8545 properties is taken from the `default' face. Since it is made sure
8546 that the default face is always fully-specified, face merging always
8547 results in a fully-specified face.
8548
8549 *** Face realization.
8550
8551 After all face attributes for a character have been determined by
8552 merging faces of that character, that face is `realized'. The
8553 realization process maps face attributes to what is physically
8554 available on the system where Emacs runs. The result is a `realized
8555 face' in form of an internal structure which is stored in the face
8556 cache of the frame on which it was realized.
8557
8558 Face realization is done in the context of the charset of the
8559 character to display because different fonts and encodings are used
8560 for different charsets. In other words, for characters of different
8561 charsets, different realized faces are needed to display them.
8562
8563 Except for composite characters, faces are always realized for a
8564 specific character set and contain a specific font, even if the face
8565 being realized specifies a fontset. The reason is that the result of
8566 the new font selection stage is better than what can be done with
8567 statically defined font name patterns in fontsets.
8568
8569 In unibyte text, Emacs' charsets aren't applicable; function
8570 `char-charset' reports ASCII for all characters, including those >
8571 0x7f. The X registry and encoding of fonts to use is determined from
8572 the variable `face-default-registry' in this case. The variable is
8573 initialized at Emacs startup time from the font the user specified for
8574 Emacs.
8575
8576 Currently all unibyte text, i.e. all buffers with
8577 `enable-multibyte-characters' nil are displayed with fonts of the same
8578 registry and encoding `face-default-registry'. This is consistent
8579 with the fact that languages can also be set globally, only.
8580
8581 **** Clearing face caches.
8582
8583 The Lisp function `clear-face-cache' can be called to clear face caches
8584 on all frames. If called with a non-nil argument, it will also unload
8585 unused fonts.
8586
8587 *** Font selection.
8588
8589 Font selection tries to find the best available matching font for a
8590 given (charset, face) combination. This is done slightly differently
8591 for faces specifying a fontset, or a font family name.
8592
8593 If the face specifies a fontset name, that fontset determines a
8594 pattern for fonts of the given charset. If the face specifies a font
8595 family, a font pattern is constructed. Charset symbols have a
8596 property `x-charset-registry' for that purpose that maps a charset to
8597 an XLFD registry and encoding in the font pattern constructed.
8598
8599 Available fonts on the system on which Emacs runs are then matched
8600 against the font pattern. The result of font selection is the best
8601 match for the given face attributes in this font list.
8602
8603 Font selection can be influenced by the user.
8604
8605 The user can specify the relative importance he gives the face
8606 attributes width, height, weight, and slant by setting
8607 face-font-selection-order (faces.el) to a list of face attribute
8608 names. The default is (:width :height :weight :slant), and means
8609 that font selection first tries to find a good match for the font
8610 width specified by a face, then---within fonts with that width---tries
8611 to find a best match for the specified font height, etc.
8612
8613 Setting `face-font-family-alternatives' allows the user to specify
8614 alternative font families to try if a family specified by a face
8615 doesn't exist.
8616
8617 Setting `face-font-registry-alternatives' allows the user to specify
8618 all alternative font registry names to try for a face specifying a
8619 registry.
8620
8621 Please note that the interpretations of the above two variables are
8622 slightly different.
8623
8624 Setting face-ignored-fonts allows the user to ignore specific fonts.
8625
8626
8627 **** Scalable fonts
8628
8629 Emacs can make use of scalable fonts but doesn't do so by default,
8630 since the use of too many or too big scalable fonts may crash XFree86
8631 servers.
8632
8633 To enable scalable font use, set the variable
8634 `scalable-fonts-allowed'. A value of nil, the default, means never use
8635 scalable fonts. A value of t means any scalable font may be used.
8636 Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. A
8637 scalable font may then be used if it matches a regular expression from
8638 that list. Example:
8639
8640 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$"))
8641
8642 allows the use of scalable fonts with registry `muleindian-2'.
8643
8644 *** Functions and variables related to font selection.
8645
8646 - Function: x-family-fonts &optional FAMILY FRAME
8647
8648 Return a list of available fonts of family FAMILY on FRAME. If FAMILY
8649 is omitted or nil, list all families. Otherwise, FAMILY must be a
8650 string, possibly containing wildcards `?' and `*'.
8651
8652 If FRAME is omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Each element of
8653 the result is a vector [FAMILY WIDTH POINT-SIZE WEIGHT SLANT FIXED-P
8654 FULL REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING]. FAMILY is the font family name.
8655 POINT-SIZE is the size of the font in 1/10 pt. WIDTH, WEIGHT, and
8656 SLANT are symbols describing the width, weight and slant of the font.
8657 These symbols are the same as for face attributes. FIXED-P is non-nil
8658 if the font is fixed-pitch. FULL is the full name of the font, and
8659 REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING is a string giving the registry and encoding of
8660 the font. The result list is sorted according to the current setting
8661 of the face font sort order.
8662
8663 - Function: x-font-family-list
8664
8665 Return a list of available font families on FRAME. If FRAME is
8666 omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Value is a list of conses
8667 (FAMILY . FIXED-P) where FAMILY is a font family, and FIXED-P is
8668 non-nil if fonts of that family are fixed-pitch.
8669
8670 - Variable: font-list-limit
8671
8672 Limit for font matching. If an integer > 0, font matching functions
8673 won't load more than that number of fonts when searching for a
8674 matching font. The default is currently 100.
8675
8676 *** Setting face attributes.
8677
8678 For the most part, the new face implementation is interface-compatible
8679 with the old one. Old face attribute related functions are now
8680 implemented in terms of the new functions `set-face-attribute' and
8681 `face-attribute'.
8682
8683 Face attributes are identified by their names which are keyword
8684 symbols. All attributes can be set to `unspecified'.
8685
8686 The following attributes are recognized:
8687
8688 `:family'
8689
8690 VALUE must be a string specifying the font family, e.g. ``courier'',
8691 or a fontset alias name. If a font family is specified, wild-cards `*'
8692 and `?' are allowed.
8693
8694 `:width'
8695
8696 VALUE specifies the relative proportionate width of the font to use.
8697 It must be one of the symbols `ultra-condensed', `extra-condensed',
8698 `condensed', `semi-condensed', `normal', `semi-expanded', `expanded',
8699 `extra-expanded', or `ultra-expanded'.
8700
8701 `:height'
8702
8703 VALUE must be either an integer specifying the height of the font to use
8704 in 1/10 pt, a floating point number specifying the amount by which to
8705 scale any underlying face, or a function, which is called with the old
8706 height (from the underlying face), and should return the new height.
8707
8708 `:weight'
8709
8710 VALUE specifies the weight of the font to use. It must be one of the
8711 symbols `ultra-bold', `extra-bold', `bold', `semi-bold', `normal',
8712 `semi-light', `light', `extra-light', `ultra-light'.
8713
8714 `:slant'
8715
8716 VALUE specifies the slant of the font to use. It must be one of the
8717 symbols `italic', `oblique', `normal', `reverse-italic', or
8718 `reverse-oblique'.
8719
8720 `:foreground', `:background'
8721
8722 VALUE must be a color name, a string.
8723
8724 `:underline'
8725
8726 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be underlined. If
8727 VALUE is t, underline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is
8728 a string, underline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly
8729 don't underline.
8730
8731 `:overline'
8732
8733 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be overlined. If
8734 VALUE is t, overline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is a
8735 string, overline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't
8736 overline.
8737
8738 `:strike-through'
8739
8740 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be drawn with a line
8741 striking through them. If VALUE is t, use the foreground color of the
8742 face. If VALUE is a string, strike-through with that color. If VALUE
8743 is nil, explicitly don't strike through.
8744
8745 `:box'
8746
8747 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should have a box drawn
8748 around them. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't draw boxes. If
8749 VALUE is t, draw a box with lines of width 1 in the foreground color
8750 of the face. If VALUE is a string, the string must be a color name,
8751 and the box is drawn in that color with a line width of 1. Otherwise,
8752 VALUE must be a property list of the form `(:line-width WIDTH
8753 :color COLOR :style STYLE)'. If a keyword/value pair is missing from
8754 the property list, a default value will be used for the value, as
8755 specified below. WIDTH specifies the width of the lines to draw; it
8756 defaults to 1. COLOR is the name of the color to draw in, default is
8757 the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background
8758 color of the face for 3D boxes. STYLE specifies whether a 3D box
8759 should be draw. If STYLE is `released-button', draw a box looking
8760 like a released 3D button. If STYLE is `pressed-button' draw a box
8761 that appears like a pressed button. If STYLE is nil, the default if
8762 the property list doesn't contain a style specification, draw a 2D
8763 box.
8764
8765 `:inverse-video'
8766
8767 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be displayed in
8768 inverse video. VALUE must be one of t or nil.
8769
8770 `:stipple'
8771
8772 If VALUE is a string, it must be the name of a file of pixmap data.
8773 The directories listed in the `x-bitmap-file-path' variable are
8774 searched. Alternatively, VALUE may be a list of the form (WIDTH
8775 HEIGHT DATA) where WIDTH and HEIGHT are the size in pixels, and DATA
8776 is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap. VALUE nil means
8777 explicitly don't use a stipple pattern.
8778
8779 For convenience, attributes `:family', `:width', `:height', `:weight',
8780 and `:slant' may also be set in one step from an X font name:
8781
8782 `:font'
8783
8784 Set font-related face attributes from VALUE. VALUE must be a valid
8785 XLFD font name. If it is a font name pattern, the first matching font
8786 is used--this is for compatibility with the behavior of previous
8787 versions of Emacs.
8788
8789 For compatibility with Emacs 20, keywords `:bold' and `:italic' can
8790 be used to specify that a bold or italic font should be used. VALUE
8791 must be t or nil in that case. A value of `unspecified' is not allowed."
8792
8793 Please see also the documentation of `set-face-attribute' and
8794 `defface'.
8795
8796 `:inherit'
8797
8798 VALUE is the name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list
8799 of face names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face
8800 like an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying faces.
8801
8802 *** Face attributes and X resources
8803
8804 The following X resource names can be used to set face attributes
8805 from X resources:
8806
8807 Face attribute X resource class
8808 -----------------------------------------------------------------------
8809 :family attributeFamily . Face.AttributeFamily
8810 :width attributeWidth Face.AttributeWidth
8811 :height attributeHeight Face.AttributeHeight
8812 :weight attributeWeight Face.AttributeWeight
8813 :slant attributeSlant Face.AttributeSlant
8814 foreground attributeForeground Face.AttributeForeground
8815 :background attributeBackground . Face.AttributeBackground
8816 :overline attributeOverline Face.AttributeOverline
8817 :strike-through attributeStrikeThrough Face.AttributeStrikeThrough
8818 :box attributeBox Face.AttributeBox
8819 :underline attributeUnderline Face.AttributeUnderline
8820 :inverse-video attributeInverse Face.AttributeInverse
8821 :stipple attributeStipple Face.AttributeStipple
8822 or attributeBackgroundPixmap
8823 Face.AttributeBackgroundPixmap
8824 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
8825 :bold attributeBold Face.AttributeBold
8826 :italic attributeItalic . Face.AttributeItalic
8827 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
8828
8829 *** Text property `face'.
8830
8831 The value of the `face' text property can now be a single face
8832 specification or a list of such specifications. Each face
8833 specification can be
8834
8835 1. A symbol or string naming a Lisp face.
8836
8837 2. A property list of the form (KEYWORD VALUE ...) where each
8838 KEYWORD is a face attribute name, and VALUE is an appropriate value
8839 for that attribute. Please see the doc string of `set-face-attribute'
8840 for face attribute names.
8841
8842 3. Conses of the form (FOREGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) or
8843 (BACKGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) where COLOR is a color name. This is
8844 for compatibility with previous Emacs versions.
8845
8846 ** Support functions for colors on text-only terminals.
8847
8848 The function `tty-color-define' can be used to define colors for use
8849 on TTY and MSDOS frames. It maps a color name to a color number on
8850 the terminal. Emacs defines a couple of common color mappings by
8851 default. You can get defined colors with a call to
8852 `defined-colors'. The function `tty-color-clear' can be
8853 used to clear the mapping table.
8854
8855 ** Unified support for colors independent of frame type.
8856
8857 The new functions `defined-colors', `color-defined-p', `color-values',
8858 and `display-color-p' work for any type of frame. On frames whose
8859 type is neither x nor w32, these functions transparently map X-style
8860 color specifications to the closest colors supported by the frame
8861 display. Lisp programs should use these new functions instead of the
8862 old `x-defined-colors', `x-color-defined-p', `x-color-values', and
8863 `x-display-color-p'. (The old function names are still available for
8864 compatibility; they are now aliases of the new names.) Lisp programs
8865 should no more look at the value of the variable window-system to
8866 modify their color-related behavior.
8867
8868 The primitives `color-gray-p' and `color-supported-p' also work for
8869 any frame type.
8870
8871 ** Platform-independent functions to describe display capabilities.
8872
8873 The new functions `display-mouse-p', `display-popup-menus-p',
8874 `display-graphic-p', `display-selections-p', `display-screens',
8875 `display-pixel-width', `display-pixel-height', `display-mm-width',
8876 `display-mm-height', `display-backing-store', `display-save-under',
8877 `display-planes', `display-color-cells', `display-visual-class', and
8878 `display-grayscale-p' describe the basic capabilities of a particular
8879 display. Lisp programs should call these functions instead of testing
8880 the value of the variables `window-system' or `system-type', or calling
8881 platform-specific functions such as `x-display-pixel-width'.
8882
8883 The new function `display-images-p' returns non-nil if a particular
8884 display can display image files.
8885
8886 ** The minibuffer prompt is now actually inserted in the minibuffer.
8887
8888 This makes it possible to scroll through the prompt, if you want to.
8889 To disallow this completely (like previous versions of emacs), customize
8890 the variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', and turn on the
8891 `Inviolable' option.
8892
8893 The function `minibuffer-prompt-end' returns the current position of the
8894 end of the minibuffer prompt, if the minibuffer is current.
8895 Otherwise, it returns `(point-min)'.
8896
8897 ** New `field' abstraction in buffers.
8898
8899 There is now code to support an abstraction called `fields' in emacs
8900 buffers. A field is a contiguous region of text with the same `field'
8901 property (which can be a text property or an overlay).
8902
8903 Many emacs functions, such as forward-word, forward-sentence,
8904 forward-paragraph, beginning-of-line, etc., stop moving when they come
8905 to the boundary between fields; beginning-of-line and end-of-line will
8906 not let the point move past the field boundary, but other movement
8907 commands continue into the next field if repeated. Stopping at field
8908 boundaries can be suppressed programmatically by binding
8909 `inhibit-field-text-motion' to a non-nil value around calls to these
8910 functions.
8911
8912 Now that the minibuffer prompt is inserted into the minibuffer, it is in
8913 a separate field from the user-input part of the buffer, so that common
8914 editing commands treat the user's text separately from the prompt.
8915
8916 The following functions are defined for operating on fields:
8917
8918 - Function: constrain-to-field NEW-POS OLD-POS &optional ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE ONLY-IN-LINE INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY
8919
8920 Return the position closest to NEW-POS that is in the same field as OLD-POS.
8921
8922 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8923 If NEW-POS is nil, then the current point is used instead, and set to the
8924 constrained position if that is different.
8925
8926 If OLD-POS is at the boundary of two fields, then the allowable
8927 positions for NEW-POS depends on the value of the optional argument
8928 ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE: If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is nil, then NEW-POS is
8929 constrained to the field that has the same `field' char-property
8930 as any new characters inserted at OLD-POS, whereas if ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8931 is non-nil, NEW-POS is constrained to the union of the two adjacent
8932 fields. Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with
8933 the special value `boundary', then any point within this special field is
8934 also considered to be `on the boundary'.
8935
8936 If the optional argument ONLY-IN-LINE is non-nil and constraining
8937 NEW-POS would move it to a different line, NEW-POS is returned
8938 unconstrained. This useful for commands that move by line, like
8939 C-n or C-a, which should generally respect field boundaries
8940 only in the case where they can still move to the right line.
8941
8942 If the optional argument INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY is non-nil, and OLD-POS has
8943 a non-nil property of that name, then any field boundaries are ignored.
8944
8945 Field boundaries are not noticed if `inhibit-field-text-motion' is non-nil.
8946
8947 - Function: delete-field &optional POS
8948
8949 Delete the field surrounding POS.
8950 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8951 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8952
8953 - Function: field-beginning &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8954
8955 Return the beginning of the field surrounding POS.
8956 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8957 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8958 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the beginning of its
8959 field, then the beginning of the *previous* field is returned.
8960
8961 - Function: field-end &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8962
8963 Return the end of the field surrounding POS.
8964 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8965 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8966 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the end of its field,
8967 then the end of the *following* field is returned.
8968
8969 - Function: field-string &optional POS
8970
8971 Return the contents of the field surrounding POS as a string.
8972 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8973 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8974
8975 - Function: field-string-no-properties &optional POS
8976
8977 Return the contents of the field around POS, without text-properties.
8978 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8979 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8980
8981 ** Image support.
8982
8983 Emacs can now display images. Images are inserted into text by giving
8984 strings or buffer text a `display' text property containing one of
8985 (AREA IMAGE) or IMAGE. The display of the `display' property value
8986 replaces the display of the characters having that property.
8987
8988 If the property value has the form (AREA IMAGE), AREA must be one of
8989 `(margin left-margin)', `(margin right-margin)' or `(margin nil)'. If
8990 AREA is `(margin nil)', IMAGE will be displayed in the text area of a
8991 window, otherwise it will be displayed in the left or right marginal
8992 area.
8993
8994 IMAGE is an image specification.
8995
8996 *** Image specifications
8997
8998 Image specifications are lists of the form `(image PROPS)' where PROPS
8999 is a property list whose keys are keyword symbols. Each
9000 specifications must contain a property `:type TYPE' with TYPE being a
9001 symbol specifying the image type, e.g. `xbm'. Properties not
9002 described below are ignored.
9003
9004 The following is a list of properties all image types share.
9005
9006 `:ascent ASCENT'
9007
9008 ASCENT must be a number in the range 0..100, or the symbol `center'.
9009 If it is a number, it specifies the percentage of the image's height
9010 to use for its ascent.
9011
9012 If not specified, ASCENT defaults to the value 50 which means that the
9013 image will be centered with the base line of the row it appears in.
9014
9015 If ASCENT is `center' the image is vertically centered around a
9016 centerline which is the vertical center of text drawn at the position
9017 of the image, in the manner specified by the text properties and
9018 overlays that apply to the image.
9019
9020 `:margin MARGIN'
9021
9022 MARGIN must be either a number >= 0 specifying how many pixels to put
9023 as margin around the image, or a pair (X . Y) with X specifying the
9024 horizontal margin and Y specifying the vertical margin. Default is 0.
9025
9026 `:relief RELIEF'
9027
9028 RELIEF is analogous to the `:relief' attribute of faces. Puts a relief
9029 around an image.
9030
9031 `:conversion ALGO'
9032
9033 Apply an image algorithm to the image before displaying it.
9034
9035 ALGO `laplace' or `emboss' means apply a Laplace or ``emboss''
9036 edge-detection algorithm to the image.
9037
9038 ALGO `(edge-detection :matrix MATRIX :color-adjust ADJUST)' means
9039 apply a general edge-detection algorithm. MATRIX must be either a
9040 nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel at
9041 position x/y in the transformed image is computed from original pixels
9042 around that position. MATRIX specifies, for each pixel in the
9043 neighborhood of x/y, a factor with which that pixel will influence the
9044 transformed pixel; element 0 specifies the factor for the pixel at
9045 x-1/y-1, element 1 the factor for the pixel at x/y-1 etc. as shown
9046 below.
9047
9048 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1
9049 x-1/y x/y x+1/y
9050 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1)
9051
9052 The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color
9053 resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels,
9054 multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum
9055 of the factors' absolute values.
9056
9057 Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of
9058
9059 (1 0 0
9060 0 0 0
9061 9 9 -1)
9062
9063 Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of
9064
9065 ( 2 -1 0
9066 -1 0 1
9067 0 1 -2)
9068
9069 ALGO `disabled' means transform the image so that it looks
9070 ``disabled''.
9071
9072 `:mask MASK'
9073
9074 If MASK is `heuristic' or `(heuristic BG)', build a clipping mask for
9075 the image, so that the background of a frame is visible behind the
9076 image. If BG is not specified, or if BG is t, determine the
9077 background color of the image by looking at the 4 corners of the
9078 image, assuming the most frequently occurring color from the corners is
9079 the background color of the image. Otherwise, BG must be a list `(RED
9080 GREEN BLUE)' specifying the color to assume for the background of the
9081 image.
9082
9083 If MASK is nil, remove a mask from the image, if it has one. Images
9084 in some formats include a mask which can be removed by specifying
9085 `:mask nil'.
9086
9087 `:file FILE'
9088
9089 Load image from FILE. If FILE is not absolute after expanding it,
9090 search for the image in `data-directory'. Some image types support
9091 building images from data. When this is done, no `:file' property
9092 may be present in the image specification.
9093
9094 `:data DATA'
9095
9096 Get image data from DATA. (As of this writing, this is not yet
9097 supported for image type `postscript'). Either :file or :data may be
9098 present in an image specification, but not both. All image types
9099 support strings as DATA, some types allow additional types of DATA.
9100
9101 *** Supported image types
9102
9103 **** XBM, image type `xbm'.
9104
9105 XBM images don't require an external library. Additional image
9106 properties supported are:
9107
9108 `:foreground FG'
9109
9110 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9111 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9112
9113 `:background BG'
9114
9115 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9116 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9117
9118 XBM images can be constructed from data instead of file. In this
9119 case, the image specification must contain the following properties
9120 instead of a `:file' property.
9121
9122 `:width WIDTH'
9123
9124 WIDTH specifies the width of the image in pixels.
9125
9126 `:height HEIGHT'
9127
9128 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pixels.
9129
9130 `:data DATA'
9131
9132 DATA must be either
9133
9134 1. a string large enough to hold the bitmap data, i.e. it must
9135 have a size >= (WIDTH + 7) / 8 * HEIGHT
9136
9137 2. a bool-vector of size >= WIDTH * HEIGHT
9138
9139 3. a vector of strings or bool-vectors, one for each line of the
9140 bitmap.
9141
9142 4. a string that's an in-memory XBM file. Neither width nor
9143 height may be specified in this case because these are defined
9144 in the file.
9145
9146 **** XPM, image type `xpm'
9147
9148 XPM images require the external library `libXpm', package
9149 `xpm-3.4k.tar.gz', version 3.4k or later. Make sure the library is
9150 found when Emacs is configured by supplying appropriate paths via
9151 `--x-includes' and `--x-libraries'.
9152
9153 Additional image properties supported are:
9154
9155 `:color-symbols SYMBOLS'
9156
9157 SYMBOLS must be a list of pairs (NAME . COLOR), with NAME being the
9158 name of color as it appears in an XPM file, and COLOR being an X color
9159 name.
9160
9161 XPM images can be built from memory instead of files. In that case,
9162 add a `:data' property instead of a `:file' property.
9163
9164 The XPM library uses libz in its implementation so that it is able
9165 to display compressed images.
9166
9167 **** PBM, image type `pbm'
9168
9169 PBM images don't require an external library. Color, gray-scale and
9170 mono images are supported. Additional image properties supported for
9171 mono images are:
9172
9173 `:foreground FG'
9174
9175 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9176 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9177
9178 `:background FG'
9179
9180 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9181 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9182
9183 **** JPEG, image type `jpeg'
9184
9185 Support for JPEG images requires the external library `libjpeg',
9186 package `jpegsrc.v6a.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9187 properties defined.
9188
9189 **** TIFF, image type `tiff'
9190
9191 Support for TIFF images requires the external library `libtiff',
9192 package `tiff-v3.4-tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9193 properties defined.
9194
9195 **** GIF, image type `gif'
9196
9197 Support for GIF images requires the external library `libungif', package
9198 `libungif-4.1.0', or later.
9199
9200 Additional image properties supported are:
9201
9202 `:index INDEX'
9203
9204 INDEX must be an integer >= 0. Load image number INDEX from a
9205 multi-image GIF file. If INDEX is too large, the image displays
9206 as a hollow box.
9207
9208 This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs.
9209 For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file
9210 at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images
9211 every 0.1 seconds.
9212
9213 (defun show-anim (file max)
9214 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages."
9215 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t))
9216
9217 (defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time)
9218 (when (= idx max)
9219 (setq idx 0))
9220 (let ((img (create-image file nil nil :index idx)))
9221 (save-excursion
9222 (set-buffer buffer)
9223 (goto-char (point-min))
9224 (unless first-time (delete-char 1))
9225 (insert-image img "x"))
9226 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil)))
9227
9228 **** PNG, image type `png'
9229
9230 Support for PNG images requires the external library `libpng',
9231 package `libpng-1.0.2.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9232 properties defined.
9233
9234 **** Ghostscript, image type `postscript'.
9235
9236 Additional image properties supported are:
9237
9238 `:pt-width WIDTH'
9239
9240 WIDTH is width of the image in pt (1/72 inch). WIDTH must be an
9241 integer. This is a required property.
9242
9243 `:pt-height HEIGHT'
9244
9245 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pt (1/72 inch). HEIGHT
9246 must be a integer. This is an required property.
9247
9248 `:bounding-box BOX'
9249
9250 BOX must be a list or vector of 4 integers giving the bounding box of
9251 the PS image, analogous to the `BoundingBox' comment found in PS
9252 files. This is an required property.
9253
9254 Part of the Ghostscript interface is implemented in Lisp. See
9255 lisp/gs.el.
9256
9257 *** Lisp interface.
9258
9259 The variable `image-types' contains a list of those image types
9260 which are supported in the current configuration.
9261
9262 Images are stored in an image cache and removed from the cache when
9263 they haven't been displayed for `image-cache-eviction-delay seconds.
9264 The function `clear-image-cache' can be used to clear the image cache
9265 manually. Images in the cache are compared with `equal', i.e. all
9266 images with `equal' specifications share the same image.
9267
9268 *** Simplified image API, image.el
9269
9270 The new Lisp package image.el contains functions that simplify image
9271 creation and putting images into text. The function `create-image'
9272 can be used to create images. The macro `defimage' can be used to
9273 define an image based on available image types. The functions
9274 `put-image' and `insert-image' can be used to insert an image into a
9275 buffer.
9276
9277 ** Display margins.
9278
9279 Windows can now have margins which are used for special text
9280 and images.
9281
9282 To give a window margins, either set the buffer-local variables
9283 `left-margin-width' and `right-margin-width', or call
9284 `set-window-margins'. The function `window-margins' can be used to
9285 obtain the current settings. To make `left-margin-width' and
9286 `right-margin-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
9287 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
9288 of the display margins.
9289
9290 You can put text in margins by giving it a `display' text property
9291 containing a pair of the form `(LOCATION . VALUE)', where LOCATION is
9292 one of `left-margin' or `right-margin' or nil. VALUE can be either a
9293 string, an image specification or a stretch specification (see later
9294 in this file).
9295
9296 ** Help display
9297
9298 Emacs displays short help messages in the echo area, when the mouse
9299 moves over a tool-bar item or a piece of text that has a text property
9300 `help-echo'. This feature also applies to strings in the mode line
9301 that have a `help-echo' property.
9302
9303 If the value of the `help-echo' property is a function, that function
9304 is called with three arguments WINDOW, OBJECT and POSITION. WINDOW is
9305 the window in which the help was found.
9306
9307 If OBJECT is a buffer, POS is the position in the buffer where the
9308 `help-echo' text property was found.
9309
9310 If OBJECT is an overlay, that overlay has a `help-echo' property, and
9311 POS is the position in the overlay's buffer under the mouse.
9312
9313 If OBJECT is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed with
9314 the `display' property), POS is the position in that string under the
9315 mouse.
9316
9317 If the value of the `help-echo' property is neither a function nor a
9318 string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string.
9319
9320 For tool-bar and menu-bar items, their key definition is used to
9321 determine the help to display. If their definition contains a
9322 property `:help FORM', FORM is evaluated to determine the help string.
9323 For tool-bar items without a help form, the caption of the item is
9324 used as help string.
9325
9326 The hook `show-help-function' can be set to a function that displays
9327 the help string differently. For example, enabling a tooltip window
9328 causes the help display to appear there instead of in the echo area.
9329
9330 ** Vertical fractional scrolling.
9331
9332 The display of text in windows can be scrolled smoothly in pixels.
9333 This is useful, for example, for making parts of large images visible.
9334
9335 The function `window-vscroll' returns the current value of vertical
9336 scrolling, a non-negative fraction of the canonical character height.
9337 The function `set-window-vscroll' can be used to set the vertical
9338 scrolling value. Here is an example of how these function might be
9339 used.
9340
9341 (global-set-key [A-down]
9342 #'(lambda ()
9343 (interactive)
9344 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9345 (+ 0.5 (window-vscroll)))))
9346 (global-set-key [A-up]
9347 #'(lambda ()
9348 (interactive)
9349 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9350 (- (window-vscroll) 0.5)))))
9351
9352 ** New hook `fontification-functions'.
9353
9354 Functions from `fontification-functions' are called from redisplay
9355 when it encounters a region of text that is not yet fontified. This
9356 variable automatically becomes buffer-local when set. Each function
9357 is called with one argument, POS.
9358
9359 At least one of the hook functions should fontify one or more
9360 characters starting at POS in the current buffer. It should mark them
9361 as fontified by giving them a non-nil value of the `fontified' text
9362 property. It may be reasonable for these functions to check for the
9363 `fontified' property and not put it back on, but they do not have to.
9364
9365 ** Tool bar support.
9366
9367 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. The frame
9368 parameter `tool-bar-lines' (X resource "toolBar", class "ToolBar")
9369 controls how may lines to reserve for the tool bar. A zero value
9370 suppresses the tool bar. If the value is non-zero and
9371 `auto-resize-tool-bars' is non-nil the tool bar's size will be changed
9372 automatically so that all tool bar items are visible.
9373
9374 *** Tool bar item definitions
9375
9376 Tool bar items are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
9377 `tool-bar'. For example `(define-key global-map [tool-bar item1] ITEM)'
9378 where ITEM is a list `(menu-item CAPTION BINDING PROPS...)'.
9379
9380 CAPTION is the caption of the item, If it's not a string, it is
9381 evaluated to get a string. The caption is currently not displayed in
9382 the tool bar, but it is displayed if the item doesn't have a `:help'
9383 property (see below).
9384
9385 BINDING is the tool bar item's binding. Tool bar items with keymaps as
9386 binding are currently ignored.
9387
9388 The following properties are recognized:
9389
9390 `:enable FORM'.
9391
9392 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is enabled
9393 or disabled.
9394
9395 `:visible FORM'
9396
9397 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is displayed.
9398
9399 `:filter FUNCTION'
9400
9401 FUNCTION is called with one parameter, the same list BINDING in which
9402 FUNCTION is specified as the filter. The value FUNCTION returns is
9403 used instead of BINDING to display this item.
9404
9405 `:button (TYPE SELECTED)'
9406
9407 TYPE must be one of `:radio' or `:toggle'. SELECTED is evaluated
9408 and specifies whether the button is selected (pressed) or not.
9409
9410 `:image IMAGES'
9411
9412 IMAGES is either a single image specification or a vector of four
9413 image specifications. If it is a vector, this table lists the
9414 meaning of each of the four elements:
9415
9416 Index Use when item is
9417 ----------------------------------------
9418 0 enabled and selected
9419 1 enabled and deselected
9420 2 disabled and selected
9421 3 disabled and deselected
9422
9423 If IMAGE is a single image specification, a Laplace edge-detection
9424 algorithm is used on that image to draw the image in disabled state.
9425
9426 `:help HELP-STRING'.
9427
9428 Gives a help string to display for the tool bar item. This help
9429 is displayed when the mouse is moved over the item.
9430
9431 The function `toolbar-add-item' is a convenience function for adding
9432 toolbar items generally, and `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' can be used
9433 to define a toolbar item with a binding copied from an item on the
9434 menu bar.
9435
9436 The default bindings use a menu-item :filter to derive the tool-bar
9437 dynamically from variable `tool-bar-map' which may be set
9438 buffer-locally to override the global map.
9439
9440 *** Tool-bar-related variables.
9441
9442 If `auto-resize-tool-bar' is non-nil, the tool bar will automatically
9443 resize to show all defined tool bar items. It will never grow larger
9444 than 1/4 of the frame's size.
9445
9446 If `auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons' is non-nil, tool bar buttons will be
9447 raised when the mouse moves over them.
9448
9449 You can add extra space between tool bar items by setting
9450 `tool-bar-button-margin' to a positive integer specifying a number of
9451 pixels, or a pair of integers (X . Y) specifying horizontal and
9452 vertical margins . Default is 1.
9453
9454 You can change the shadow thickness of tool bar buttons by setting
9455 `tool-bar-button-relief' to an integer. Default is 3.
9456
9457 *** Tool-bar clicks with modifiers.
9458
9459 You can bind commands to clicks with control, shift, meta etc. on
9460 a tool bar item. If
9461
9462 (define-key global-map [tool-bar shell]
9463 '(menu-item "Shell" shell
9464 :image (image :type xpm :file "shell.xpm")))
9465
9466 is the original tool bar item definition, then
9467
9468 (define-key global-map [tool-bar S-shell] 'some-command)
9469
9470 makes a binding to run `some-command' for a shifted click on the same
9471 item.
9472
9473 ** Mode line changes.
9474
9475 *** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
9476
9477 The mode line can be made mouse-sensitive by displaying strings there
9478 that have a `local-map' text property. There are three ways to display
9479 a string with a `local-map' property in the mode line.
9480
9481 1. The mode line spec contains a variable whose string value has
9482 a `local-map' text property.
9483
9484 2. The mode line spec contains a format specifier (e.g. `%12b'), and
9485 that format specifier has a `local-map' property.
9486
9487 3. The mode line spec contains a list containing `:eval FORM'. FORM
9488 is evaluated. If the result is a string, and that string has a
9489 `local-map' property.
9490
9491 The same mechanism is used to determine the `face' and `help-echo'
9492 properties of strings in the mode line. See `bindings.el' for an
9493 example.
9494
9495 *** If a mode line element has the form `(:eval FORM)', FORM is
9496 evaluated and the result is used as mode line element.
9497
9498 *** You can suppress mode-line display by setting the buffer-local
9499 variable mode-line-format to nil.
9500
9501 *** A headerline can now be displayed at the top of a window.
9502
9503 This mode line's contents are controlled by the new variable
9504 `header-line-format' and `default-header-line-format' which are
9505 completely analogous to `mode-line-format' and
9506 `default-mode-line-format'. A value of nil means don't display a top
9507 line.
9508
9509 The appearance of top mode lines is controlled by the face
9510 `header-line'.
9511
9512 The function `coordinates-in-window-p' returns `header-line' for a
9513 position in the header-line.
9514
9515 ** Text property `display'
9516
9517 The `display' text property is used to insert images into text,
9518 replace text with other text, display text in marginal area, and it is
9519 also used to control other aspects of how text displays. The value of
9520 the `display' property should be a display specification, as described
9521 below, or a list or vector containing display specifications.
9522
9523 *** Replacing text, displaying text in marginal areas
9524
9525 To replace the text having the `display' property with some other
9526 text, use a display specification of the form `(LOCATION STRING)'.
9527
9528 If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', STRING is displayed in the left
9529 marginal area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in
9530 the right marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' STRING
9531 is displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
9532 simpler form STRING as property value.
9533
9534 *** Variable width and height spaces
9535
9536 To display a space of fractional width or height, use a display
9537 specification of the form `(LOCATION STRECH)'. If LOCATION is
9538 `(margin left-margin)', the space is displayed in the left marginal
9539 area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in the right
9540 marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the space is
9541 displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
9542 simpler form STRETCH as property value.
9543
9544 The stretch specification STRETCH itself is a list of the form `(space
9545 PROPS)', where PROPS is a property list which can contain the
9546 properties described below.
9547
9548 The display of the fractional space replaces the display of the
9549 characters having the `display' property.
9550
9551 - :width WIDTH
9552
9553 Specifies that the space width should be WIDTH times the normal
9554 character width. WIDTH can be an integer or floating point number.
9555
9556 - :relative-width FACTOR
9557
9558 Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the
9559 first character in a group of consecutive characters that have the
9560 same `display' property. The computation is done by multiplying the
9561 width of that character by FACTOR.
9562
9563 - :align-to HPOS
9564
9565 Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach HPOS. The
9566 value HPOS is measured in units of the normal character width.
9567
9568 Exactly one of the above properties should be used.
9569
9570 - :height HEIGHT
9571
9572 Specifies the height of the space, as HEIGHT, measured in terms of the
9573 normal line height.
9574
9575 - :relative-height FACTOR
9576
9577 The height of the space is computed as the product of the height
9578 of the text having the `display' property and FACTOR.
9579
9580 - :ascent ASCENT
9581
9582 Specifies that ASCENT percent of the height of the stretch should be
9583 used for the ascent of the stretch, i.e. for the part above the
9584 baseline. The value of ASCENT must be a non-negative number less or
9585 equal to 100.
9586
9587 You should not use both `:height' and `:relative-height' together.
9588
9589 *** Images
9590
9591 A display specification for an image has the form `(LOCATION
9592 . IMAGE)', where IMAGE is an image specification. The image replaces,
9593 in the display, the characters having this display specification in
9594 their `display' text property. If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)',
9595 the image will be displayed in the left marginal area, if it is
9596 `(margin right-margin)' it will be displayed in the right marginal
9597 area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the image will be displayed in
9598 the text. In the latter case you can also use the simpler form IMAGE
9599 as display specification.
9600
9601 *** Other display properties
9602
9603 - (space-width FACTOR)
9604
9605 Specifies that space characters in the text having that property
9606 should be displayed FACTOR times as wide as normal; FACTOR must be an
9607 integer or float.
9608
9609 - (height HEIGHT)
9610
9611 Display text having this property in a font that is smaller or larger.
9612
9613 If HEIGHT is a list of the form `(+ N)', where N is an integer, that
9614 means to use a font that is N steps larger. If HEIGHT is a list of
9615 the form `(- N)', that means to use a font that is N steps smaller. A
9616 ``step'' is defined by the set of available fonts; each size for which
9617 a font is available counts as a step.
9618
9619 If HEIGHT is a number, that means to use a font that is HEIGHT times
9620 as tall as the frame's default font.
9621
9622 If HEIGHT is a symbol, it is called as a function with the current
9623 height as argument. The function should return the new height to use.
9624
9625 Otherwise, HEIGHT is evaluated to get the new height, with the symbol
9626 `height' bound to the current specified font height.
9627
9628 - (raise FACTOR)
9629
9630 FACTOR must be a number, specifying a multiple of the current
9631 font's height. If it is positive, that means to display the characters
9632 raised. If it is negative, that means to display them lower down. The
9633 amount of raising or lowering is computed without taking account of the
9634 `height' subproperty.
9635
9636 *** Conditional display properties
9637
9638 All display specifications can be conditionalized. If a specification
9639 has the form `(when CONDITION . SPEC)', the specification SPEC applies
9640 only when CONDITION yields a non-nil value when evaluated. During the
9641 evaluation, `object' is bound to the string or buffer having the
9642 conditional display property; `position' and `buffer-position' are
9643 bound to the position within `object' and the buffer position where
9644 the display property was found, respectively. Both positions can be
9645 different when object is a string.
9646
9647 The normal specification consisting of SPEC only is equivalent to
9648 `(when t . SPEC)'.
9649
9650 ** New menu separator types.
9651
9652 Emacs now supports more than one menu separator type. Menu items with
9653 item names consisting of dashes only (including zero dashes) are
9654 treated like before. In addition, the following item names are used
9655 to specify other menu separator types.
9656
9657 - `--no-line' or `--space', or `--:space', or `--:noLine'
9658
9659 No separator lines are drawn, but a small space is inserted where the
9660 separator occurs.
9661
9662 - `--single-line' or `--:singleLine'
9663
9664 A single line in the menu's foreground color.
9665
9666 - `--double-line' or `--:doubleLine'
9667
9668 A double line in the menu's foreground color.
9669
9670 - `--single-dashed-line' or `--:singleDashedLine'
9671
9672 A single dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
9673
9674 - `--double-dashed-line' or `--:doubleDashedLine'
9675
9676 A double dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
9677
9678 - `--shadow-etched-in' or `--:shadowEtchedIn'
9679
9680 A single line with 3D sunken appearance. This is the form
9681 displayed for item names consisting of dashes only.
9682
9683 - `--shadow-etched-out' or `--:shadowEtchedOut'
9684
9685 A single line with 3D raised appearance.
9686
9687 - `--shadow-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedInDash'
9688
9689 A single dashed line with 3D sunken appearance.
9690
9691 - `--shadow-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedOutDash'
9692
9693 A single dashed line with 3D raise appearance.
9694
9695 - `--shadow-double-etched-in' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedIn'
9696
9697 Two lines with 3D sunken appearance.
9698
9699 - `--shadow-double-etched-out' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOut'
9700
9701 Two lines with 3D raised appearance.
9702
9703 - `--shadow-double-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedInDash'
9704
9705 Two dashed lines with 3D sunken appearance.
9706
9707 - `--shadow-double-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOutDash'
9708
9709 Two dashed lines with 3D raised appearance.
9710
9711 Under LessTif/Motif, the last four separator types are displayed like
9712 the corresponding single-line separators.
9713
9714 ** New frame parameters for scroll bar colors.
9715
9716 The new frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
9717 `scroll-bar-background' can be used to change scroll bar colors.
9718 Their value must be either a color name, a string, or nil to specify
9719 that scroll bars should use a default color. For toolkit scroll bars,
9720 default colors are toolkit specific. For non-toolkit scroll bars, the
9721 default background is the background color of the frame, and the
9722 default foreground is black.
9723
9724 The X resource name of these parameters are `scrollBarForeground'
9725 (class ScrollBarForeground) and `scrollBarBackground' (class
9726 `ScrollBarBackground').
9727
9728 Setting these parameters overrides toolkit specific X resource
9729 settings for scroll bar colors.
9730
9731 ** You can set `redisplay-dont-pause' to a non-nil value to prevent
9732 display updates from being interrupted when input is pending.
9733
9734 ** Changing a window's width may now change its window start if it
9735 starts on a continuation line. The new window start is computed based
9736 on the window's new width, starting from the start of the continued
9737 line as the start of the screen line with the minimum distance from
9738 the original window start.
9739
9740 ** The variable `hscroll-step' and the functions
9741 `hscroll-point-visible' and `hscroll-window-column' have been removed
9742 now that proper horizontal scrolling is implemented.
9743
9744 ** Windows can now be made fixed-width and/or fixed-height.
9745
9746 A window is fixed-size if its buffer has a buffer-local variable
9747 `window-size-fixed' whose value is not nil. A value of `height' makes
9748 windows fixed-height, a value of `width' makes them fixed-width, any
9749 other non-nil value makes them both fixed-width and fixed-height.
9750
9751 The following code makes all windows displaying the current buffer
9752 fixed-width and fixed-height.
9753
9754 (set (make-local-variable 'window-size-fixed) t)
9755
9756 A call to enlarge-window on a window gives an error if that window is
9757 fixed-width and it is tried to change the window's width, or if the
9758 window is fixed-height, and it is tried to change its height. To
9759 change the size of a fixed-size window, bind `window-size-fixed'
9760 temporarily to nil, for example
9761
9762 (let ((window-size-fixed nil))
9763 (enlarge-window 10))
9764
9765 Likewise, an attempt to split a fixed-height window vertically,
9766 or a fixed-width window horizontally results in a error.
9767
9768 ** The cursor-type frame parameter is now supported on MS-DOS
9769 terminals. When Emacs starts, it by default changes the cursor shape
9770 to a solid box, as it does on Unix. The `cursor-type' frame parameter
9771 overrides this as it does on Unix, except that the bar cursor is
9772 horizontal rather than vertical (since the MS-DOS display doesn't
9773 support a vertical-bar cursor).
9774
9775
9776 \f
9777 * Emacs 20.7 is a bug-fix release with few user-visible changes
9778
9779 ** It is now possible to use CCL-based coding systems for keyboard
9780 input.
9781
9782 ** ange-ftp now handles FTP security extensions, like Kerberos.
9783
9784 ** Rmail has been extended to recognize more forms of digest messages.
9785
9786 ** Now, most coding systems set in keyboard coding system work not
9787 only for character input, but also in incremental search. The
9788 exceptions are such coding systems that handle 2-byte character sets
9789 (e.g euc-kr, euc-jp) and that use ISO's escape sequence
9790 (e.g. iso-2022-jp). They are ignored in incremental search.
9791
9792 ** Support for Macintosh PowerPC-based machines running GNU/Linux has
9793 been added.
9794
9795 \f
9796 * Emacs 20.6 is a bug-fix release with one user-visible change
9797
9798 ** Support for ARM-based non-RISCiX machines has been added.
9799
9800
9801 \f
9802 * Emacs 20.5 is a bug-fix release with no user-visible changes.
9803
9804 ** Not new, but not mentioned before:
9805 M-w when Transient Mark mode is enabled disables the mark.
9806 \f
9807 * Changes in Emacs 20.4
9808
9809 ** Init file may be called .emacs.el.
9810
9811 You can now call the Emacs init file `.emacs.el'.
9812 Formerly the name had to be `.emacs'. If you use the name
9813 `.emacs.el', you can byte-compile the file in the usual way.
9814
9815 If both `.emacs' and `.emacs.el' exist, the latter file
9816 is the one that is used.
9817
9818 ** shell-command, and shell-command-on-region, now return
9819 the exit code of the command (unless it is asynchronous).
9820 Also, you can specify a place to put the error output,
9821 separate from the command's regular output.
9822 Interactively, the variable shell-command-default-error-buffer
9823 says where to put error output; set it to a buffer name.
9824 In calls from Lisp, an optional argument ERROR-BUFFER specifies
9825 the buffer name.
9826
9827 When you specify a non-nil error buffer (or buffer name), any error
9828 output is inserted before point in that buffer, with \f\n to separate
9829 it from the previous batch of error output. The error buffer is not
9830 cleared, so error output from successive commands accumulates there.
9831
9832 ** Setting the default value of enable-multibyte-characters to nil in
9833 the .emacs file, either explicitly using setq-default, or via Custom,
9834 is now essentially equivalent to using --unibyte: all buffers
9835 created during startup will be made unibyte after loading .emacs.
9836
9837 ** C-x C-f now handles the wildcards * and ? in file names. For
9838 example, typing C-x C-f c*.c RET visits all the files whose names
9839 match c*.c. To visit a file whose name contains * or ?, add the
9840 quoting sequence /: to the beginning of the file name.
9841
9842 ** The M-x commands keep-lines, flush-lines and count-matches
9843 now have the same feature as occur and query-replace:
9844 if the pattern contains any upper case letters, then
9845 they never ignore case.
9846
9847 ** The end-of-line format conversion feature previously mentioned
9848 under `* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows' actually
9849 applies to all operating systems. Emacs recognizes from the contents
9850 of a file what convention it uses to separate lines--newline, CRLF, or
9851 just CR--and automatically converts the contents to the normal Emacs
9852 convention (using newline to separate lines) for editing. This is a
9853 part of the general feature of coding system conversion.
9854
9855 If you subsequently save the buffer, Emacs converts the text back to
9856 the same format that was used in the file before.
9857
9858 You can turn off end-of-line conversion by setting the variable
9859 `inhibit-eol-conversion' to non-nil, e.g. with Custom in the MULE group.
9860
9861 ** The character set property `prefered-coding-system' has been
9862 renamed to `preferred-coding-system', for the sake of correct spelling.
9863 This is a fairly internal feature, so few programs should be affected.
9864
9865 ** Mode-line display of end-of-line format is changed.
9866 The indication of the end-of-line format of the file visited by a
9867 buffer is now more explicit when that format is not the usual one for
9868 your operating system. For example, the DOS-style end-of-line format
9869 is displayed as "(DOS)" on Unix and GNU/Linux systems. The usual
9870 end-of-line format is still displayed as a single character (colon for
9871 Unix, backslash for DOS and Windows, and forward slash for the Mac).
9872
9873 The values of the variables eol-mnemonic-unix, eol-mnemonic-dos,
9874 eol-mnemonic-mac, and eol-mnemonic-undecided, which are strings,
9875 control what is displayed in the mode line for each end-of-line
9876 format. You can now customize these variables.
9877
9878 ** In the previous version of Emacs, tar-mode didn't work well if a
9879 filename contained non-ASCII characters. Now this is fixed. Such a
9880 filename is decoded by file-name-coding-system if the default value of
9881 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil.
9882
9883 ** The command temp-buffer-resize-mode toggles a minor mode
9884 in which temporary buffers (such as help buffers) are given
9885 windows just big enough to hold the whole contents.
9886
9887 ** If you use completion.el, you must now run the function
9888 dynamic-completion-mode to enable it. Just loading the file
9889 doesn't have any effect.
9890
9891 ** In Flyspell mode, the default is now to make just one Ispell process,
9892 not one per buffer.
9893
9894 ** If you use iswitchb but do not call (iswitchb-default-keybindings) to
9895 use the default keybindings, you will need to add the following line:
9896 (add-hook 'minibuffer-setup-hook 'iswitchb-minibuffer-setup)
9897
9898 ** Auto-show mode is no longer enabled just by loading auto-show.el.
9899 To control it, set `auto-show-mode' via Custom or use the
9900 `auto-show-mode' command.
9901
9902 ** Handling of X fonts' ascent/descent parameters has been changed to
9903 avoid redisplay problems. As a consequence, compared with previous
9904 versions the line spacing and frame size now differ with some font
9905 choices, typically increasing by a pixel per line. This change
9906 occurred in version 20.3 but was not documented then.
9907
9908 ** If you select the bar cursor style, it uses the frame's
9909 cursor-color, rather than the cursor foreground pixel.
9910
9911 ** In multibyte mode, Rmail decodes incoming MIME messages using the
9912 character set specified in the message. If you want to disable this
9913 feature, set the variable rmail-decode-mime-charset to nil.
9914
9915 ** Not new, but not mentioned previously in NEWS: when you use #! at
9916 the beginning of a file to make it executable and specify an
9917 interpreter program, Emacs looks on the second line for the -*- mode
9918 and variable specification, as well as on the first line.
9919
9920 ** Support for IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters.
9921
9922 The new command M-x codepage-setup creates a special coding system
9923 that can be used to convert text between a specific IBM codepage and
9924 one of the character sets built into Emacs which matches that
9925 codepage. For example, codepage 850 corresponds to Latin-1 character
9926 set, codepage 855 corresponds to Cyrillic-ISO character set, etc.
9927
9928 Windows codepages 1250, 1251 and some others, where Windows deviates
9929 from the corresponding ISO character set, are also supported.
9930
9931 IBM box-drawing characters and other glyphs which don't have
9932 equivalents in the corresponding ISO character set, are converted to
9933 a character defined by dos-unsupported-char-glyph on MS-DOS, and to
9934 `?' on other systems.
9935
9936 IBM codepages are widely used on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, so this
9937 feature is most useful on those platforms, but it can also be used on
9938 Unix.
9939
9940 Emacs compiled for MS-DOS automatically loads the support for the
9941 current codepage when it starts.
9942
9943 ** Mail changes
9944
9945 *** When mail is sent using compose-mail (C-x m), and if
9946 `mail-send-nonascii' is set to the new default value `mime',
9947 appropriate MIME headers are added. The headers are added only if
9948 non-ASCII characters are present in the body of the mail, and no other
9949 MIME headers are already present. For example, the following three
9950 headers are added if the coding system used in the *mail* buffer is
9951 latin-1:
9952
9953 MIME-version: 1.0
9954 Content-type: text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1
9955 Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit
9956
9957 *** The new variable default-sendmail-coding-system specifies the
9958 default way to encode outgoing mail. This has higher priority than
9959 default-buffer-file-coding-system but has lower priority than
9960 sendmail-coding-system and the local value of
9961 buffer-file-coding-system.
9962
9963 You should not set this variable manually. Instead, set
9964 sendmail-coding-system to specify a fixed encoding for all outgoing
9965 mail.
9966
9967 *** When you try to send a message that contains non-ASCII characters,
9968 if the coding system specified by those variables doesn't handle them,
9969 Emacs will ask you to select a suitable coding system while showing a
9970 list of possible coding systems.
9971
9972 ** CC Mode changes
9973
9974 *** c-default-style can now take an association list that maps major
9975 modes to style names. When this variable is an alist, Java mode no
9976 longer hardcodes a setting to "java" style. See the variable's
9977 docstring for details.
9978
9979 *** It's now possible to put a list as the offset on a syntactic
9980 symbol. The list is evaluated recursively until a non-nil offset is
9981 found. This is useful to combine several lineup functions to act in a
9982 prioritized order on a single line. However, none of the supplied
9983 lineup functions use this feature currently.
9984
9985 *** New syntactic symbol catch-clause, which is used on the "catch" and
9986 "finally" lines in try-catch constructs in C++ and Java.
9987
9988 *** New cleanup brace-catch-brace on c-cleanup-list, which does for
9989 "catch" lines what brace-elseif-brace does for "else if" lines.
9990
9991 *** The braces of Java anonymous inner classes are treated separately
9992 from the braces of other classes in auto-newline mode. Two new
9993 symbols inexpr-class-open and inexpr-class-close may be used on
9994 c-hanging-braces-alist to control the automatic newlines used for
9995 anonymous classes.
9996
9997 *** Support for the Pike language added, along with new Pike specific
9998 syntactic symbols: inlambda, lambda-intro-cont
9999
10000 *** Support for Java anonymous classes via new syntactic symbol
10001 inexpr-class. New syntactic symbol inexpr-statement for Pike
10002 support and gcc-style statements inside expressions. New lineup
10003 function c-lineup-inexpr-block.
10004
10005 *** New syntactic symbol brace-entry-open which is used in brace lists
10006 (i.e. static initializers) when a list entry starts with an open
10007 brace. These used to be recognized as brace-list-entry's.
10008 c-electric-brace also recognizes brace-entry-open braces
10009 (brace-list-entry's can no longer be electrified).
10010
10011 *** New command c-indent-line-or-region, not bound by default.
10012
10013 *** `#' is only electric when typed in the indentation of a line.
10014
10015 *** Parentheses are now electric (via the new command c-electric-paren)
10016 for auto-reindenting lines when parens are typed.
10017
10018 *** In "gnu" style, inline-open offset is now set to zero.
10019
10020 *** Uniform handling of the inclass syntactic symbol. The indentation
10021 associated with it is now always relative to the class opening brace.
10022 This means that the indentation behavior has changed in some
10023 circumstances, but only if you've put anything besides 0 on the
10024 class-open syntactic symbol (none of the default styles do that).
10025
10026 ** Gnus changes.
10027
10028 *** New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
10029 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See the
10030 Gnus manual for the full story.
10031
10032 *** The nndraft backend has returned, but works differently than
10033 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the nndraft
10034 group, which is created automatically.
10035
10036 *** `gnus-alter-header-function' can now be used to alter header
10037 values.
10038
10039 *** `gnus-summary-goto-article' now accept Message-ID's.
10040
10041 *** A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
10042 outside the region: `C-c C-v'.
10043
10044 *** You can now post to component group in nnvirtual groups with
10045 `C-u C-c C-c'.
10046
10047 *** `nntp-rlogin-program' -- new variable to ease customization.
10048
10049 *** `C-u C-c C-c' in `gnus-article-edit-mode' will now inhibit
10050 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
10051
10052 *** New element in `gnus-boring-article-headers' -- `long-to'.
10053
10054 *** `M-i' symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
10055 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
10056
10057 *** `L' and `I' in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
10058 `a' to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
10059
10060 *** `gnus-simplify-subject-functions' variable to allow greater
10061 control over simplification.
10062
10063 *** `A T' -- new command for fetching the current thread.
10064
10065 *** `/ T' -- new command for including the current thread in the
10066 limit.
10067
10068 *** `M-RET' is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
10069
10070 *** \\1-expressions are now valid in `nnmail-split-methods'.
10071
10072 *** The `custom-face-lookup' function has been removed.
10073 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
10074 rewrite them to use `face-spec-set' instead.
10075
10076 *** Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
10077 `a' forces normal posting method.
10078
10079 *** New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper text
10080 -- `W d'.
10081
10082 *** For easier debugging of nntp, you can set `nntp-record-commands'
10083 to a non-nil value.
10084
10085 *** nntp now uses ~/.authinfo, a .netrc-like file, for controlling
10086 where and how to send AUTHINFO to NNTP servers.
10087
10088 *** A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
10089 has been added.
10090
10091 *** A history of where mails have been split is available.
10092
10093 *** A new article date command has been added -- `article-date-iso8601'.
10094
10095 *** Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
10096 `gnus-score-thread-simplify'.
10097
10098 *** A new function for citing in Message has been added --
10099 `message-cite-original-without-signature'.
10100
10101 *** `article-strip-all-blank-lines' -- new article command.
10102
10103 *** A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
10104 been added.
10105
10106 *** A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
10107 `gnus-adaptive-word-minimum' variable.
10108
10109 *** The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
10110 updated by the `gnus-start-date-timer' command.
10111
10112 *** Web listserv archives can be read with the nnlistserv backend.
10113
10114 *** Old dejanews archives can now be read by nnweb.
10115
10116 *** `gnus-posting-styles' has been re-activated.
10117
10118 ** Changes to TeX and LaTeX mode
10119
10120 *** The new variable `tex-start-options-string' can be used to give
10121 options for the TeX run. The default value causes TeX to run in
10122 nonstopmode. For an interactive TeX run set it to nil or "".
10123
10124 *** The command `tex-feed-input' sends input to the Tex Shell. In a
10125 TeX buffer it is bound to the keys C-RET, C-c RET, and C-c C-m (some
10126 of these keys may not work on all systems). For instance, if you run
10127 TeX interactively and if the TeX run stops because of an error, you
10128 can continue it without leaving the TeX buffer by typing C-RET.
10129
10130 *** The Tex Shell Buffer is now in `compilation-shell-minor-mode'.
10131 All error-parsing commands of the Compilation major mode are available
10132 but bound to keys that don't collide with the shell. Thus you can use
10133 the Tex Shell for command line executions like a usual shell.
10134
10135 *** The commands `tex-validate-region' and `tex-validate-buffer' check
10136 the matching of braces and $'s. The errors are listed in a *Occur*
10137 buffer and you can use C-c C-c or mouse-2 to go to a particular
10138 mismatch.
10139
10140 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
10141
10142 *** The table of contents buffer can now also display labels and
10143 file boundaries in addition to sections. Use `l', `i', and `c' keys.
10144
10145 *** Labels derived from context (the section heading) are now
10146 lowercase by default. To make the label legal in LaTeX, latin-1
10147 characters will lose their accent. All Mule characters will be
10148 removed from the label.
10149
10150 *** The automatic display of cross reference information can also use
10151 a window instead of the echo area. See variable `reftex-auto-view-crossref'.
10152
10153 *** kpsewhich can be used by RefTeX to find TeX and BibTeX files. See the
10154 customization group `reftex-finding-files'.
10155
10156 *** The option `reftex-bibfile-ignore-list' has been renamed to
10157 `reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps' and indeed can be fed with regular
10158 expressions.
10159
10160 *** Multiple Selection buffers are now hidden buffers.
10161
10162 ** New/deleted modes and packages
10163
10164 *** The package snmp-mode.el provides major modes for editing SNMP and
10165 SNMPv2 MIBs. It has entries on `auto-mode-alist'.
10166
10167 *** The package sql.el provides a major mode, M-x sql-mode, for
10168 editing SQL files, and M-x sql-interactive-mode for interacting with
10169 SQL interpreters. It has an entry on `auto-mode-alist'.
10170
10171 *** M-x highlight-changes-mode provides a minor mode displaying buffer
10172 changes with a special face.
10173
10174 *** ispell4.el has been deleted. It got in the way of ispell.el and
10175 this was hard to fix reliably. It has long been obsolete -- use
10176 Ispell 3.1 and ispell.el.
10177 \f
10178 * MS-DOS changes in Emacs 20.4
10179
10180 ** Emacs compiled for MS-DOS now supports MULE features better.
10181 This includes support for display of all ISO 8859-N character sets,
10182 conversion to and from IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters,
10183 and automatic setup of the MULE environment at startup. For details,
10184 check out the section `MS-DOS and MULE' in the manual.
10185
10186 The MS-DOS installation procedure automatically configures and builds
10187 Emacs with input method support if it finds an unpacked Leim
10188 distribution when the config.bat script is run.
10189
10190 ** Formerly, the value of lpr-command did not affect printing on
10191 MS-DOS unless print-region-function was set to nil, but now it
10192 controls whether an external program is invoked or output is written
10193 directly to a printer port. Similarly, in the previous version of
10194 Emacs, the value of ps-lpr-command did not affect PostScript printing
10195 on MS-DOS unless ps-printer-name was set to something other than a
10196 string (eg. t or `pipe'), but now it controls whether an external
10197 program is used. (These changes were made so that configuration of
10198 printing variables would be almost identical across all platforms.)
10199
10200 ** In the previous version of Emacs, PostScript and non-PostScript
10201 output was piped to external programs, but because most print programs
10202 available for MS-DOS and MS-Windows cannot read data from their standard
10203 input, on those systems the data to be output is now written to a
10204 temporary file whose name is passed as the last argument to the external
10205 program.
10206
10207 An exception is made for `print', a standard program on Windows NT,
10208 and `nprint', a standard program on Novell Netware. For both of these
10209 programs, the command line is constructed in the appropriate syntax
10210 automatically, using only the value of printer-name or ps-printer-name
10211 as appropriate--the value of the relevant `-switches' variable is
10212 ignored, as both programs have no useful switches.
10213
10214 ** The value of the variable dos-printer (cf. dos-ps-printer), if it has
10215 a value, overrides the value of printer-name (cf. ps-printer-name), on
10216 MS-DOS and MS-Windows only. This has been true since version 20.3, but
10217 was not documented clearly before.
10218
10219 ** All the Emacs games now work on MS-DOS terminals.
10220 This includes Tetris and Snake.
10221 \f
10222 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.4
10223
10224 ** New functions line-beginning-position and line-end-position
10225 return the position of the beginning or end of the current line.
10226 They both accept an optional argument, which has the same
10227 meaning as the argument to beginning-of-line or end-of-line.
10228
10229 ** find-file and allied functions now have an optional argument
10230 WILDCARD. If this is non-nil, they do wildcard processing,
10231 and visit all files that match the wildcard pattern.
10232
10233 ** Changes in the file-attributes function.
10234
10235 *** The file size returned by file-attributes may be an integer or a float.
10236 It is an integer if the size fits in a Lisp integer, float otherwise.
10237
10238 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
10239 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a cons cell containing two
10240 integers.
10241
10242 ** The new function directory-files-and-attributes returns a list of
10243 files in a directory and their attributes. It accepts the same
10244 arguments as directory-files and has similar semantics, except that
10245 file names and attributes are returned.
10246
10247 ** The new function file-attributes-lessp is a helper function for
10248 sorting the list generated by directory-files-and-attributes. It
10249 accepts two arguments, each a list of a file name and its attributes.
10250 It compares the file names of each according to string-lessp and
10251 returns the result.
10252
10253 ** The new function file-expand-wildcards expands a wildcard-pattern
10254 to produce a list of existing files that match the pattern.
10255
10256 ** New functions for base64 conversion:
10257
10258 The function base64-encode-region converts a part of the buffer
10259 into the base64 code used in MIME. base64-decode-region
10260 performs the opposite conversion. Line-breaking is supported
10261 optionally.
10262
10263 Functions base64-encode-string and base64-decode-string do a similar
10264 job on the text in a string. They return the value as a new string.
10265
10266 **
10267 The new function process-running-child-p
10268 will tell you if a subprocess has given control of its
10269 terminal to its own child process.
10270
10271 ** interrupt-process and such functions have a new feature:
10272 when the second argument is `lambda', they send a signal
10273 to the running child of the subshell, if any, but if the shell
10274 itself owns its terminal, no signal is sent.
10275
10276 ** There are new widget types `plist' and `alist' which can
10277 be used for customizing variables whose values are plists or alists.
10278
10279 ** easymenu.el now understands `:key-sequence' and `:style button'.
10280 :included is an alias for :visible.
10281
10282 easy-menu-add-item now understands the values returned by
10283 easy-menu-remove-item and easy-menu-item-present-p. This can be used
10284 to move or copy menu entries.
10285
10286 ** Multibyte editing changes
10287
10288 *** The definitions of sref and char-bytes are changed. Now, sref is
10289 an alias of aref and char-bytes always returns 1. This change is to
10290 make some Emacs Lisp code which works on 20.2 and earlier also
10291 work on the latest Emacs. Such code uses a combination of sref and
10292 char-bytes in a loop typically as below:
10293 (setq char (sref str idx)
10294 idx (+ idx (char-bytes idx)))
10295 The byte-compiler now warns that this is obsolete.
10296
10297 If you want to know how many bytes a specific multibyte character
10298 (say, CH) occupies in a multibyte buffer, use this code:
10299 (charset-bytes (char-charset ch))
10300
10301 *** In multibyte mode, when you narrow a buffer to some region, and the
10302 region is preceded or followed by non-ASCII codes, inserting or
10303 deleting at the head or the end of the region may signal this error:
10304
10305 Byte combining across boundary of accessible buffer text inhibited
10306
10307 This is to avoid some bytes being combined together into a character
10308 across the boundary.
10309
10310 *** The functions find-charset-region and find-charset-string include
10311 `unknown' in the returned list in the following cases:
10312 o The current buffer or the target string is unibyte and
10313 contains 8-bit characters.
10314 o The current buffer or the target string is multibyte and
10315 contains invalid characters.
10316
10317 *** The functions decode-coding-region and encode-coding-region remove
10318 text properties of the target region. Ideally, they should correctly
10319 preserve text properties, but for the moment, it's hard. Removing
10320 text properties is better than preserving them in a less-than-correct
10321 way.
10322
10323 *** prefer-coding-system sets EOL conversion of default coding systems.
10324 If the argument to prefer-coding-system specifies a certain type of
10325 end of line conversion, the default coding systems set by
10326 prefer-coding-system will specify that conversion type for end of line.
10327
10328 *** The new function thai-compose-string can be used to properly
10329 compose Thai characters in a string.
10330
10331 ** The primitive `define-prefix-command' now takes an optional third
10332 argument NAME, which should be a string. It supplies the menu name
10333 for the created keymap. Keymaps created in order to be displayed as
10334 menus should always use the third argument.
10335
10336 ** The meanings of optional second arguments for read-char,
10337 read-event, and read-char-exclusive are flipped. Now the second
10338 arguments are INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. These functions use the current
10339 input method (if any) if and only if INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD is non-nil.
10340
10341 ** The new function clear-this-command-keys empties out the contents
10342 of the vector that (this-command-keys) returns. This is useful in
10343 programs that read passwords, to prevent the passwords from echoing
10344 inadvertently as part of the next command in certain cases.
10345
10346 ** The new macro `with-temp-message' displays a temporary message in
10347 the echo area, while executing some Lisp code. Like `progn', it
10348 returns the value of the last form, but it also restores the previous
10349 echo area contents.
10350
10351 (with-temp-message MESSAGE &rest BODY)
10352
10353 ** The function `require' now takes an optional third argument
10354 NOERROR. If it is non-nil, then there is no error if the
10355 requested feature cannot be loaded.
10356
10357 ** In the function modify-face, an argument of (nil) for the
10358 foreground color, background color or stipple pattern
10359 means to clear out that attribute.
10360
10361 ** The `outer-window-id' frame property of an X frame
10362 gives the window number of the outermost X window for the frame.
10363
10364 ** Temporary buffers made with with-output-to-temp-buffer are now
10365 read-only by default, and normally use the major mode Help mode
10366 unless you put them in some other non-Fundamental mode before the
10367 end of with-output-to-temp-buffer.
10368
10369 ** The new functions gap-position and gap-size return information on
10370 the gap of the current buffer.
10371
10372 ** The new functions position-bytes and byte-to-position provide a way
10373 to convert between character positions and byte positions in the
10374 current buffer.
10375
10376 ** vc.el defines two new macros, `edit-vc-file' and `with-vc-file', to
10377 facilitate working with version-controlled files from Lisp programs.
10378 These macros check out a given file automatically if needed, and check
10379 it back in after any modifications have been made.
10380 \f
10381 * Installation Changes in Emacs 20.3
10382
10383 ** The default value of load-path now includes most subdirectories of
10384 the site-specific directories /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp and
10385 /usr/local/share/emacs/VERSION/site-lisp, in addition to those
10386 directories themselves. Both immediate subdirectories and
10387 subdirectories multiple levels down are added to load-path.
10388
10389 Not all subdirectories are included, though. Subdirectories whose
10390 names do not start with a letter or digit are excluded.
10391 Subdirectories named RCS or CVS are excluded. Also, a subdirectory
10392 which contains a file named `.nosearch' is excluded. You can use
10393 these methods to prevent certain subdirectories from being searched.
10394
10395 Emacs finds these subdirectories and adds them to load-path when it
10396 starts up. While it would be cleaner to find the subdirectories each
10397 time Emacs loads a file, that would be much slower.
10398
10399 This feature is an incompatible change. If you have stored some Emacs
10400 Lisp files in a subdirectory of the site-lisp directory specifically
10401 to prevent them from being used, you will need to rename the
10402 subdirectory to start with a non-alphanumeric character, or create a
10403 `.nosearch' file in it, in order to continue to achieve the desired
10404 results.
10405
10406 ** Emacs no longer includes an old version of the C preprocessor from
10407 GCC. This was formerly used to help compile Emacs with C compilers
10408 that had limits on the significant length of an identifier, but in
10409 fact we stopped supporting such compilers some time ago.
10410 \f
10411 * Changes in Emacs 20.3
10412
10413 ** The new command C-x z (repeat) repeats the previous command
10414 including its argument. If you repeat the z afterward,
10415 it repeats the command additional times; thus, you can
10416 perform many repetitions with one keystroke per repetition.
10417
10418 ** Emacs now supports "selective undo" which undoes only within a
10419 specified region. To do this, set point and mark around the desired
10420 region and type C-u C-x u (or C-u C-_). You can then continue undoing
10421 further, within the same region, by repeating the ordinary undo
10422 command C-x u or C-_. This will keep undoing changes that were made
10423 within the region you originally specified, until either all of them
10424 are undone, or it encounters a change which crosses the edge of that
10425 region.
10426
10427 In Transient Mark mode, undoing when a region is active requests
10428 selective undo.
10429
10430 ** If you specify --unibyte when starting Emacs, then all buffers are
10431 unibyte, except when a Lisp program specifically creates a multibyte
10432 buffer. Setting the environment variable EMACS_UNIBYTE has the same
10433 effect. The --no-unibyte option overrides EMACS_UNIBYTE and directs
10434 Emacs to run normally in multibyte mode.
10435
10436 The option --unibyte does not affect the reading of Emacs Lisp files,
10437 though. If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, use
10438 -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. That will force Emacs to
10439 load that file in unibyte mode, regardless of how Emacs was started.
10440
10441 ** toggle-enable-multibyte-characters no longer has a key binding and
10442 no longer appears in the menu bar. We've realized that changing the
10443 enable-multibyte-characters variable in an existing buffer is
10444 something that most users not do.
10445
10446 ** You can specify a coding system to use for the next cut or paste
10447 operations through the window system with the command C-x RET X.
10448 The coding system can make a difference for communication with other
10449 applications.
10450
10451 C-x RET x specifies a coding system for all subsequent cutting and
10452 pasting operations.
10453
10454 ** You can specify the printer to use for commands that do printing by
10455 setting the variable `printer-name'. Just what a printer name looks
10456 like depends on your operating system. You can specify a different
10457 printer for the Postscript printing commands by setting
10458 `ps-printer-name'.
10459
10460 ** Emacs now supports on-the-fly spell checking by the means of a
10461 minor mode. It is called M-x flyspell-mode. You don't have to remember
10462 any other special commands to use it, and you will hardly notice it
10463 except when you make a spelling error. Flyspell works by highlighting
10464 incorrect words as soon as they are completed or as soon as the cursor
10465 hits a new word.
10466
10467 Flyspell mode works with whichever dictionary you have selected for
10468 Ispell in Emacs. In TeX mode, it understands TeX syntax so as not
10469 to be confused by TeX commands.
10470
10471 You can correct a misspelled word by editing it into something
10472 correct. You can also correct it, or accept it as correct, by
10473 clicking on the word with Mouse-2; that gives you a pop-up menu
10474 of various alternative replacements and actions.
10475
10476 Flyspell mode also proposes "automatic" corrections. M-TAB replaces
10477 the current misspelled word with a possible correction. If several
10478 corrections are made possible, M-TAB cycles through them in
10479 alphabetical order, or in order of decreasing likelihood if
10480 flyspell-sort-corrections is nil.
10481
10482 Flyspell mode also flags an error when a word is repeated, if
10483 flyspell-mark-duplications-flag is non-nil.
10484
10485 ** Changes in input method usage.
10486
10487 Now you can use arrow keys (right, left, down, up) for selecting among
10488 the alternatives just the same way as you do by C-f, C-b, C-n, and C-p
10489 respectively.
10490
10491 You can use the ENTER key to accept the current conversion.
10492
10493 If you type TAB to display a list of alternatives, you can select one
10494 of the alternatives with Mouse-2.
10495
10496 The meaning of the variable `input-method-verbose-flag' is changed so
10497 that you can set it to t, nil, `default', or `complex-only'.
10498
10499 If the value is nil, extra guidance is never given.
10500
10501 If the value is t, extra guidance is always given.
10502
10503 If the value is `complex-only', extra guidance is always given only
10504 when you are using complex input methods such as chinese-py.
10505
10506 If the value is `default' (this is the default), extra guidance is
10507 given in the following case:
10508 o When you are using a complex input method.
10509 o When you are using a simple input method but not in the minibuffer.
10510
10511 If you are using Emacs through a very slow line, setting
10512 input-method-verbose-flag to nil or to complex-only is a good choice,
10513 and if you are using an input method you are not familiar with,
10514 setting it to t is helpful.
10515
10516 The old command select-input-method is now called set-input-method.
10517
10518 In the language environment "Korean", you can use the following
10519 keys:
10520 Shift-SPC toggle-korean-input-method
10521 C-F9 quail-hangul-switch-symbol-ksc
10522 F9 quail-hangul-switch-hanja
10523 These key bindings are canceled when you switch to another language
10524 environment.
10525
10526 ** The minibuffer history of file names now records the specified file
10527 names, not the entire minibuffer input. For example, if the
10528 minibuffer starts out with /usr/foo/, you might type in /etc/passwd to
10529 get
10530
10531 /usr/foo//etc/passwd
10532
10533 which stands for the file /etc/passwd.
10534
10535 Formerly, this used to put /usr/foo//etc/passwd in the history list.
10536 Now this puts just /etc/passwd in the history list.
10537
10538 ** If you are root, Emacs sets backup-by-copying-when-mismatch to t
10539 at startup, so that saving a file will be sure to preserve
10540 its owner and group.
10541
10542 ** find-func.el can now also find the place of definition of Emacs
10543 Lisp variables in user-loaded libraries.
10544
10545 ** C-x r t (string-rectangle) now deletes the existing rectangle
10546 contents before inserting the specified string on each line.
10547
10548 ** There is a new command delete-whitespace-rectangle
10549 which deletes whitespace starting from a particular column
10550 in all the lines on a rectangle. The column is specified
10551 by the left edge of the rectangle.
10552
10553 ** You can now store a number into a register with C-u NUMBER C-x r n REG,
10554 increment it by INC with C-u INC C-x r + REG (to increment by one, omit
10555 C-u INC), and insert it in the buffer with C-x r g REG. This is useful
10556 for writing keyboard macros.
10557
10558 ** The new command M-x speedbar displays a frame in which directories,
10559 files, and tags can be displayed, manipulated, and jumped to. The
10560 frame defaults to 20 characters in width, and is the same height as
10561 the frame that it was started from. Some major modes define
10562 additional commands for the speedbar, including Rmail, GUD/GDB, and
10563 info.
10564
10565 ** query-replace-regexp is now bound to C-M-%.
10566
10567 ** In Transient Mark mode, when the region is active, M-x
10568 query-replace and the other replace commands now operate on the region
10569 contents only.
10570
10571 ** M-x write-region, when used interactively, now asks for
10572 confirmation before overwriting an existing file. When you call
10573 the function from a Lisp program, a new optional argument CONFIRM
10574 says whether to ask for confirmation in this case.
10575
10576 ** If you use find-file-literally and the file is already visited
10577 non-literally, the command asks you whether to revisit the file
10578 literally. If you say no, it signals an error.
10579
10580 ** Major modes defined with the "derived mode" feature
10581 now use the proper name for the mode hook: WHATEVER-mode-hook.
10582 Formerly they used the name WHATEVER-mode-hooks, but that is
10583 inconsistent with Emacs conventions.
10584
10585 ** shell-command-on-region (and shell-command) reports success or
10586 failure if the command produces no output.
10587
10588 ** Set focus-follows-mouse to nil if your window system or window
10589 manager does not transfer focus to another window when you just move
10590 the mouse.
10591
10592 ** mouse-menu-buffer-maxlen has been renamed to
10593 mouse-buffer-menu-maxlen to be consistent with the other related
10594 function and variable names.
10595
10596 ** The new variable auto-coding-alist specifies coding systems for
10597 reading specific files. This has higher priority than
10598 file-coding-system-alist.
10599
10600 ** If you set the variable unibyte-display-via-language-environment to
10601 t, then Emacs displays non-ASCII characters are displayed by
10602 converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters according to
10603 the current language environment. As a result, they are displayed
10604 according to the current fontset.
10605
10606 ** C-q's handling of codes in the range 0200 through 0377 is changed.
10607
10608 The codes in the range 0200 through 0237 are inserted as one byte of
10609 that code regardless of the values of nonascii-translation-table and
10610 nonascii-insert-offset.
10611
10612 For the codes in the range 0240 through 0377, if
10613 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil and nonascii-translation-table
10614 nor nonascii-insert-offset can't convert them to valid multibyte
10615 characters, they are converted to Latin-1 characters.
10616
10617 ** If you try to find a file that is not read-accessible, you now get
10618 an error, rather than an empty buffer and a warning.
10619
10620 ** In the minibuffer history commands M-r and M-s, an upper case
10621 letter in the regular expression forces case-sensitive search.
10622
10623 ** In the *Help* buffer, cross-references to commands and variables
10624 are inferred and hyperlinked. Use C-h m in Help mode for the relevant
10625 command keys.
10626
10627 ** M-x apropos-command, with a prefix argument, no longer looks for
10628 user option variables--instead it looks for noninteractive functions.
10629
10630 Meanwhile, the command apropos-variable normally searches for
10631 user option variables; with a prefix argument, it looks at
10632 all variables that have documentation.
10633
10634 ** When you type a long line in the minibuffer, and the minibuffer
10635 shows just one line, automatically scrolling works in a special way
10636 that shows you overlap with the previous line of text. The variable
10637 minibuffer-scroll-overlap controls how many characters of overlap
10638 it should show; the default is 20.
10639
10640 Meanwhile, Resize Minibuffer mode is still available; in that mode,
10641 the minibuffer grows taller (up to a point) as needed to show the whole
10642 of your input.
10643
10644 ** The new command M-x customize-changed-options lets you customize
10645 all the options whose meanings or default values have changed in
10646 recent Emacs versions. You specify a previous Emacs version number as
10647 argument, and the command creates a customization buffer showing all
10648 the customizable options which were changed since that version.
10649 Newly added options are included as well.
10650
10651 If you don't specify a particular version number argument,
10652 then the customization buffer shows all the customizable options
10653 for which Emacs versions of changes are recorded.
10654
10655 This function is also bound to the Changed Options entry in the
10656 Customize menu.
10657
10658 ** When you run M-x grep with a prefix argument, it figures out
10659 the tag around point and puts that into the default grep command.
10660
10661 ** The new command M-* (pop-tag-mark) pops back through a history of
10662 buffer positions from which M-. or other tag-finding commands were
10663 invoked.
10664
10665 ** The new variable comment-padding specifies the number of spaces
10666 that `comment-region' will insert before the actual text of the comment.
10667 The default is 1.
10668
10669 ** In Fortran mode the characters `.', `_' and `$' now have symbol
10670 syntax, not word syntax. Fortran mode now supports `imenu' and has
10671 new commands fortran-join-line (M-^) and fortran-narrow-to-subprogram
10672 (C-x n d). M-q can be used to fill a statement or comment block
10673 sensibly.
10674
10675 ** GUD now supports jdb, the Java debugger, and pdb, the Python debugger.
10676
10677 ** If you set the variable add-log-keep-changes-together to a non-nil
10678 value, the command `C-x 4 a' will automatically notice when you make
10679 two entries in one day for one file, and combine them.
10680
10681 ** You can use the command M-x diary-mail-entries to mail yourself a
10682 reminder about upcoming diary entries. See the documentation string
10683 for a sample shell script for calling this function automatically
10684 every night.
10685
10686 ** Desktop changes
10687
10688 *** All you need to do to enable use of the Desktop package, is to set
10689 the variable desktop-enable to t with Custom.
10690
10691 *** Minor modes are now restored. Which minor modes are restored
10692 and how modes are restored is controlled by `desktop-minor-mode-table'.
10693
10694 ** There is no need to do anything special, now, to enable Gnus to
10695 read and post multi-lingual articles.
10696
10697 ** Outline mode has now support for showing hidden outlines when
10698 doing an isearch. In order for this to happen search-invisible should
10699 be set to open (the default). If an isearch match is inside a hidden
10700 outline the outline is made visible. If you continue pressing C-s and
10701 the match moves outside the formerly invisible outline, the outline is
10702 made invisible again.
10703
10704 ** Mail reading and sending changes
10705
10706 *** The Rmail e command now switches to displaying the whole header of
10707 the message before it lets you edit the message. This is so that any
10708 changes you make in the header will not be lost if you subsequently
10709 toggle.
10710
10711 *** The w command in Rmail, which writes the message body into a file,
10712 now works in the summary buffer as well. (The command to delete the
10713 summary buffer is now Q.) The default file name for the w command, if
10714 the message has no subject, is stored in the variable
10715 rmail-default-body-file.
10716
10717 *** Most of the commands and modes that operate on mail and netnews no
10718 longer depend on the value of mail-header-separator. Instead, they
10719 handle whatever separator the buffer happens to use.
10720
10721 *** If you set mail-signature to a value which is not t, nil, or a string,
10722 it should be an expression. When you send a message, this expression
10723 is evaluated to insert the signature.
10724
10725 *** The new Lisp library feedmail.el (version 8) enhances processing of
10726 outbound email messages. It works in coordination with other email
10727 handling packages (e.g., rmail, VM, gnus) and is responsible for
10728 putting final touches on messages and actually submitting them for
10729 transmission. Users of the emacs program "fakemail" might be
10730 especially interested in trying feedmail.
10731
10732 feedmail is not enabled by default. See comments at the top of
10733 feedmail.el for set-up instructions. Among the bigger features
10734 provided by feedmail are:
10735
10736 **** you can park outgoing messages into a disk-based queue and
10737 stimulate sending some or all of them later (handy for laptop users);
10738 there is also a queue for draft messages
10739
10740 **** you can get one last look at the prepped outbound message and
10741 be prompted for confirmation
10742
10743 **** does smart filling of address headers
10744
10745 **** can generate a MESSAGE-ID: line and a DATE: line; the date can be
10746 the time the message was written or the time it is being sent; this
10747 can make FCC copies more closely resemble copies that recipients get
10748
10749 **** you can specify an arbitrary function for actually transmitting
10750 the message; included in feedmail are interfaces for /bin/[r]mail,
10751 /usr/lib/sendmail, and Emacs Lisp smtpmail; it's easy to write a new
10752 function for something else (10-20 lines of Lisp code).
10753
10754 ** Dired changes
10755
10756 *** The Dired function dired-do-toggle, which toggles marked and unmarked
10757 files, is now bound to "t" instead of "T".
10758
10759 *** dired-at-point has been added to ffap.el. It allows one to easily
10760 run Dired on the directory name at point.
10761
10762 *** Dired has a new command: %g. It searches the contents of
10763 files in the directory and marks each file that contains a match
10764 for a specified regexp.
10765
10766 ** VC Changes
10767
10768 *** New option vc-ignore-vc-files lets you turn off version control
10769 conveniently.
10770
10771 *** VC Dired has been completely rewritten. It is now much
10772 faster, especially for CVS, and works very similar to ordinary
10773 Dired.
10774
10775 VC Dired is invoked by typing C-x v d and entering the name of the
10776 directory to display. By default, VC Dired gives you a recursive
10777 listing of all files at or below the given directory which are
10778 currently locked (for CVS, all files not up-to-date are shown).
10779
10780 You can change the listing format by setting vc-dired-recurse to nil,
10781 then it shows only the given directory, and you may also set
10782 vc-dired-terse-display to nil, then it shows all files under version
10783 control plus the names of any subdirectories, so that you can type `i'
10784 on such lines to insert them manually, as in ordinary Dired.
10785
10786 All Dired commands operate normally in VC Dired, except for `v', which
10787 is redefined as the version control prefix. That means you may type
10788 `v l', `v =' etc. to invoke `vc-print-log', `vc-diff' and the like on
10789 the file named in the current Dired buffer line. `v v' invokes
10790 `vc-next-action' on this file, or on all files currently marked.
10791
10792 The new command `v t' (vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode) allows you to
10793 toggle between terse display (only locked files) and full display (all
10794 VC files plus subdirectories). There is also a special command,
10795 `* l', to mark all files currently locked.
10796
10797 Giving a prefix argument to C-x v d now does the same thing as in
10798 ordinary Dired: it allows you to supply additional options for the ls
10799 command in the minibuffer, to fine-tune VC Dired's output.
10800
10801 *** Under CVS, if you merge changes from the repository into a working
10802 file, and CVS detects conflicts, VC now offers to start an ediff
10803 session to resolve them.
10804
10805 Alternatively, you can use the new command `vc-resolve-conflicts' to
10806 resolve conflicts in a file at any time. It works in any buffer that
10807 contains conflict markers as generated by rcsmerge (which is what CVS
10808 uses as well).
10809
10810 *** You can now transfer changes between branches, using the new
10811 command vc-merge (C-x v m). It is implemented for RCS and CVS. When
10812 you invoke it in a buffer under version-control, you can specify
10813 either an entire branch or a pair of versions, and the changes on that
10814 branch or between the two versions are merged into the working file.
10815 If this results in any conflicts, they may be resolved interactively,
10816 using ediff.
10817
10818 ** Changes in Font Lock
10819
10820 *** The face and variable previously known as font-lock-reference-face
10821 are now called font-lock-constant-face to better reflect their typical
10822 use for highlighting constants and labels. (Its face properties are
10823 unchanged.) The variable font-lock-reference-face remains for now for
10824 compatibility reasons, but its value is font-lock-constant-face.
10825
10826 ** Frame name display changes
10827
10828 *** The command set-frame-name lets you set the name of the current
10829 frame. You can use the new command select-frame-by-name to select and
10830 raise a frame; this is mostly useful on character-only terminals, or
10831 when many frames are invisible or iconified.
10832
10833 *** On character-only terminal (not a window system), changing the
10834 frame name is now reflected on the mode line and in the Buffers/Frames
10835 menu.
10836
10837 ** Comint (subshell) changes
10838
10839 *** In Comint modes, the commands to kill, stop or interrupt a
10840 subjob now also kill pending input. This is for compatibility
10841 with ordinary shells, where the signal characters do this.
10842
10843 *** There are new commands in Comint mode.
10844
10845 C-c C-x fetches the "next" line from the input history;
10846 that is, the line after the last line you got.
10847 You can use this command to fetch successive lines, one by one.
10848
10849 C-c SPC accumulates lines of input. More precisely, it arranges to
10850 send the current line together with the following line, when you send
10851 the following line.
10852
10853 C-c C-a if repeated twice consecutively now moves to the process mark,
10854 which separates the pending input from the subprocess output and the
10855 previously sent input.
10856
10857 C-c M-r now runs comint-previous-matching-input-from-input;
10858 it searches for a previous command, using the current pending input
10859 as the search string.
10860
10861 *** New option compilation-scroll-output can be set to scroll
10862 automatically in compilation-mode windows.
10863
10864 ** C mode changes
10865
10866 *** Multiline macros are now handled, both as they affect indentation,
10867 and as recognized syntax. New syntactic symbol cpp-macro-cont is
10868 assigned to second and subsequent lines of a multiline macro
10869 definition.
10870
10871 *** A new style "user" which captures all non-hook-ified
10872 (i.e. top-level) .emacs file variable settings and customizations.
10873 Style "cc-mode" is an alias for "user" and is deprecated. "gnu"
10874 style is still the default however.
10875
10876 *** "java" style now conforms to Sun's JDK coding style.
10877
10878 *** There are new commands c-beginning-of-defun, c-end-of-defun which
10879 are alternatives which you could bind to C-M-a and C-M-e if you prefer
10880 them. They do not have key bindings by default.
10881
10882 *** New and improved implementations of M-a (c-beginning-of-statement)
10883 and M-e (c-end-of-statement).
10884
10885 *** C++ namespace blocks are supported, with new syntactic symbols
10886 namespace-open, namespace-close, and innamespace.
10887
10888 *** File local variable settings of c-file-style and c-file-offsets
10889 makes the style variables local to that buffer only.
10890
10891 *** New indentation functions c-lineup-close-paren,
10892 c-indent-one-line-block, c-lineup-dont-change.
10893
10894 *** Improvements (hopefully!) to the way CC Mode is loaded. You
10895 should now be able to do a (require 'cc-mode) to get the entire
10896 package loaded properly for customization in your .emacs file. A new
10897 variable c-initialize-on-load controls this and is t by default.
10898
10899 ** Changes to hippie-expand.
10900
10901 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-skip-space'. If
10902 non-nil, trailing spaces may be included in the abbreviation to search for,
10903 which then gives the same behavior as the original `dabbrev-expand'.
10904
10905 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-as-symbol'. If
10906 non-nil, characters of syntax '_' is considered part of the word when
10907 expanding dynamically.
10908
10909 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-no-restriction'. If
10910 non-nil, narrowed buffers are widened before they are searched.
10911
10912 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-only-buffers'. If
10913 non-empty, buffers searched are restricted to the types specified in
10914 this list. Useful for example when constructing new special-purpose
10915 expansion functions with `make-hippie-expand-function'.
10916
10917 *** Text properties of the expansion are no longer copied.
10918
10919 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
10920
10921 *** Any titleword matching a regexp in the new variable
10922 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore (case sensitive) is ignored during
10923 automatic key generation. This replaces variable
10924 bibtex-autokey-titleword-first-ignore, which only checked for matches
10925 against the first word in the title.
10926
10927 *** Autokey generation now uses all words from the title, not just
10928 capitalized words. To avoid conflicts with existing customizations,
10929 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore is set up such that words starting with
10930 lowerkey characters will still be ignored. Thus, if you want to use
10931 lowercase words from the title, you will have to overwrite the
10932 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore standard setting.
10933
10934 *** Case conversion of names and title words for automatic key
10935 generation is more flexible. Variable bibtex-autokey-preserve-case is
10936 replaced by bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert and
10937 bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert.
10938
10939 ** Changes in vcursor.el.
10940
10941 *** Support for character terminals is available: there is a new keymap
10942 and the vcursor will appear as an arrow between buffer text. A
10943 variable `vcursor-interpret-input' allows input from the vcursor to be
10944 entered exactly as if typed. Numerous functions, including
10945 `vcursor-compare-windows', have been rewritten to improve consistency
10946 in the selection of windows and corresponding keymaps.
10947
10948 *** vcursor options can now be altered with M-x customize under the
10949 Editing group once the package is loaded.
10950
10951 *** Loading vcursor now does not define keys by default, as this is
10952 generally a bad side effect. Use M-x customize to set
10953 vcursor-key-bindings to t to restore the old behavior.
10954
10955 *** vcursor-auto-disable can be `copy', which turns off copying from the
10956 vcursor, but doesn't disable it, after any non-vcursor command.
10957
10958 ** Ispell changes.
10959
10960 *** You can now spell check comments and strings in the current
10961 buffer with M-x ispell-comments-and-strings. Comments and strings
10962 are identified by syntax tables in effect.
10963
10964 *** Generic region skipping implemented.
10965 A single buffer can be broken into a number of regions where text will
10966 and will not be checked. The definitions of the regions can be user
10967 defined. New applications and improvements made available by this
10968 include:
10969
10970 o URLs are automatically skipped
10971 o EMail message checking is vastly improved.
10972
10973 *** Ispell can highlight the erroneous word even on non-window terminals.
10974
10975 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
10976
10977 RefTeX has been updated in order to make it more usable with very
10978 large projects (like a several volume math book). The parser has been
10979 re-written from scratch. To get maximum speed from RefTeX, check the
10980 section `Optimizations' in the manual.
10981
10982 *** New recursive parser.
10983
10984 The old version of RefTeX created a single large buffer containing the
10985 entire multifile document in order to parse the document. The new
10986 recursive parser scans the individual files.
10987
10988 *** Parsing only part of a document.
10989
10990 Reparsing of changed document parts can now be made faster by enabling
10991 partial scans. To use this feature, read the documentation string of
10992 the variable `reftex-enable-partial-scans' and set the variable to t.
10993
10994 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t)
10995
10996 *** Storing parsing information in a file.
10997
10998 This can improve startup times considerably. To turn it on, use
10999
11000 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t)
11001
11002 *** Using multiple selection buffers
11003
11004 If the creation of label selection buffers is too slow (this happens
11005 for large documents), you can reuse these buffers by setting
11006
11007 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
11008
11009 *** References to external documents.
11010
11011 The LaTeX package `xr' allows to cross-reference labels in external
11012 documents. RefTeX can provide information about the external
11013 documents as well. To use this feature, set up the \externaldocument
11014 macros required by the `xr' package and rescan the document with
11015 RefTeX. The external labels can then be accessed with the `x' key in
11016 the selection buffer provided by `reftex-reference' (bound to `C-c )').
11017 The `x' key also works in the table of contents buffer.
11018
11019 *** Many more labeled LaTeX environments are recognized by default.
11020
11021 The built-in command list now covers all the standard LaTeX commands,
11022 and all of the major packages included in the LaTeX distribution.
11023
11024 Also, RefTeX now understands the \appendix macro and changes
11025 the enumeration of sections in the *toc* buffer accordingly.
11026
11027 *** Mouse support for selection and *toc* buffers
11028
11029 The mouse can now be used to select items in the selection and *toc*
11030 buffers. See also the new option `reftex-highlight-selection'.
11031
11032 *** New keymaps for selection and table of contents modes.
11033
11034 The selection processes for labels and citation keys, and the table of
11035 contents buffer now have their own keymaps: `reftex-select-label-map',
11036 `reftex-select-bib-map', `reftex-toc-map'. The selection processes
11037 have a number of new keys predefined. In particular, TAB lets you
11038 enter a label with completion. Check the on-the-fly help (press `?'
11039 at the selection prompt) or read the Info documentation to find out
11040 more.
11041
11042 *** Support for the varioref package
11043
11044 The `v' key in the label selection buffer toggles \ref versus \vref.
11045
11046 *** New hooks
11047
11048 Three new hooks can be used to redefine the way labels, references,
11049 and citations are created. These hooks are
11050 `reftex-format-label-function', `reftex-format-ref-function',
11051 `reftex-format-cite-function'.
11052
11053 *** Citations outside LaTeX
11054
11055 The command `reftex-citation' may also be used outside LaTeX (e.g. in
11056 a mail buffer). See the Info documentation for details.
11057
11058 *** Short context is no longer fontified.
11059
11060 The short context in the label menu no longer copies the
11061 fontification from the text in the buffer. If you prefer it to be
11062 fontified, use
11063
11064 (setq reftex-refontify-context t)
11065
11066 ** file-cache-minibuffer-complete now accepts a prefix argument.
11067 With a prefix argument, it does not try to do completion of
11068 the file name within its directory; it only checks for other
11069 directories that contain the same file name.
11070
11071 Thus, given the file name Makefile, and assuming that a file
11072 Makefile.in exists in the same directory, ordinary
11073 file-cache-minibuffer-complete will try to complete Makefile to
11074 Makefile.in and will therefore never look for other directories that
11075 have Makefile. A prefix argument tells it not to look for longer
11076 names such as Makefile.in, so that instead it will look for other
11077 directories--just as if the name were already complete in its present
11078 directory.
11079
11080 ** New modes and packages
11081
11082 *** There is a new alternative major mode for Perl, Cperl mode.
11083 It has many more features than Perl mode, and some people prefer
11084 it, but some do not.
11085
11086 *** There is a new major mode, M-x vhdl-mode, for editing files of VHDL
11087 code.
11088
11089 *** M-x which-function-mode enables a minor mode that displays the
11090 current function name continuously in the mode line, as you move
11091 around in a buffer.
11092
11093 Which Function mode is effective in major modes which support Imenu.
11094
11095 *** Gametree is a major mode for editing game analysis trees. The author
11096 uses it for keeping notes about his postal Chess games, but it should
11097 be helpful for other two-player games as well, as long as they have an
11098 established system of notation similar to Chess.
11099
11100 *** The new minor mode checkdoc-minor-mode provides Emacs Lisp
11101 documentation string checking for style and spelling. The style
11102 guidelines are found in the Emacs Lisp programming manual.
11103
11104 *** The net-utils package makes some common networking features
11105 available in Emacs. Some of these functions are wrappers around
11106 system utilities (ping, nslookup, etc); others are implementations of
11107 simple protocols (finger, whois) in Emacs Lisp. There are also
11108 functions to make simple connections to TCP/IP ports for debugging and
11109 the like.
11110
11111 *** highlight-changes-mode is a minor mode that uses colors to
11112 identify recently changed parts of the buffer text.
11113
11114 *** The new package `midnight' lets you specify things to be done
11115 within Emacs at midnight--by default, kill buffers that you have not
11116 used in a considerable time. To use this feature, customize
11117 the user option `midnight-mode' to t.
11118
11119 *** The file generic-x.el defines a number of simple major modes.
11120
11121 apache-generic-mode: For Apache and NCSA httpd configuration files
11122 samba-generic-mode: Samba configuration files
11123 fvwm-generic-mode: For fvwm initialization files
11124 x-resource-generic-mode: For X resource files
11125 hosts-generic-mode: For hosts files (.rhosts, /etc/hosts, etc)
11126 mailagent-rules-generic-mode: For mailagent .rules files
11127 javascript-generic-mode: For JavaScript files
11128 vrml-generic-mode: For VRML files
11129 java-manifest-generic-mode: For Java MANIFEST files
11130 java-properties-generic-mode: For Java property files
11131 mailrc-generic-mode: For .mailrc files
11132
11133 Platform-specific modes:
11134
11135 prototype-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V prototype files
11136 pkginfo-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V pkginfo files
11137 alias-generic-mode: For C shell alias files
11138 inf-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INF files
11139 ini-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INI files
11140 reg-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Registry files
11141 bat-generic-mode: For MS-Windows BAT scripts
11142 rc-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Resource files
11143 rul-generic-mode: For InstallShield scripts
11144 \f
11145 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 since the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11146
11147 ** If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode,
11148 use -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line.
11149 That will force Emacs to read that file in unibyte mode.
11150 Otherwise, the file will be loaded and byte-compiled in multibyte mode.
11151
11152 Thus, each lisp file is read in a consistent way regardless of whether
11153 you started Emacs with --unibyte, so that a Lisp program gives
11154 consistent results regardless of how Emacs was started.
11155
11156 ** The new function assoc-default is useful for searching an alist,
11157 and using a default value if the key is not found there. You can
11158 specify a comparison predicate, so this function is useful for
11159 searching comparing a string against an alist of regular expressions.
11160
11161 ** The functions unibyte-char-to-multibyte and
11162 multibyte-char-to-unibyte convert between unibyte and multibyte
11163 character codes, in a way that is appropriate for the current language
11164 environment.
11165
11166 ** The functions read-event, read-char and read-char-exclusive now
11167 take two optional arguments. PROMPT, if non-nil, specifies a prompt
11168 string. SUPPRESS-INPUT-METHOD, if non-nil, says to disable the
11169 current input method for reading this one event.
11170
11171 ** Two new variables print-escape-nonascii and print-escape-multibyte
11172 now control whether to output certain characters as
11173 backslash-sequences. print-escape-nonascii applies to single-byte
11174 non-ASCII characters; print-escape-multibyte applies to multibyte
11175 characters. Both of these variables are used only when printing
11176 in readable fashion (prin1 uses them, princ does not).
11177 \f
11178 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 before the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11179
11180 ** Compiled Emacs Lisp files made with the modified "MBSK" version
11181 of Emacs 20.2 do not work in Emacs 20.3.
11182
11183 ** Buffer positions are now measured in characters, as they were
11184 in Emacs 19 and before. This means that (forward-char 1)
11185 always increases point by 1.
11186
11187 The function chars-in-region now just subtracts its arguments. It is
11188 considered obsolete. The function char-boundary-p has been deleted.
11189
11190 See below for additional changes relating to multibyte characters.
11191
11192 ** defcustom, defface and defgroup now accept the keyword `:version'.
11193 Use this to specify in which version of Emacs a certain variable's
11194 default value changed. For example,
11195
11196 (defcustom foo-max 34 "*Maximum number of foo's allowed."
11197 :type 'integer
11198 :group 'foo
11199 :version "20.3")
11200
11201 (defgroup foo-group nil "The foo group."
11202 :version "20.3")
11203
11204 If an entire new group is added or the variables in it have the
11205 default values changed, then just add a `:version' to that group. It
11206 is recommended that new packages added to the distribution contain a
11207 `:version' in the top level group.
11208
11209 This information is used to control the customize-changed-options command.
11210
11211 ** It is now an error to change the value of a symbol whose name
11212 starts with a colon--if it is interned in the standard obarray.
11213
11214 However, setting such a symbol to its proper value, which is that
11215 symbol itself, is not an error. This is for the sake of programs that
11216 support previous Emacs versions by explicitly setting these variables
11217 to themselves.
11218
11219 If you set the variable keyword-symbols-constant-flag to nil,
11220 this error is suppressed, and you can set these symbols to any
11221 values whatever.
11222
11223 ** There is a new debugger command, R.
11224 It evaluates an expression like e, but saves the result
11225 in the buffer *Debugger-record*.
11226
11227 ** Frame-local variables.
11228
11229 You can now make a variable local to various frames. To do this, call
11230 the function make-variable-frame-local; this enables frames to have
11231 local bindings for that variable.
11232
11233 These frame-local bindings are actually frame parameters: you create a
11234 frame-local binding in a specific frame by calling
11235 modify-frame-parameters and specifying the variable name as the
11236 parameter name.
11237
11238 Buffer-local bindings take precedence over frame-local bindings.
11239 Thus, if the current buffer has a buffer-local binding, that binding is
11240 active; otherwise, if the selected frame has a frame-local binding,
11241 that binding is active; otherwise, the default binding is active.
11242
11243 It would not be hard to implement window-local bindings, but it is not
11244 clear that this would be very useful; windows tend to come and go in a
11245 very transitory fashion, so that trying to produce any specific effect
11246 through a window-local binding would not be very robust.
11247
11248 ** `sregexq' and `sregex' are two new functions for constructing
11249 "symbolic regular expressions." These are Lisp expressions that, when
11250 evaluated, yield conventional string-based regexps. The symbolic form
11251 makes it easier to construct, read, and maintain complex patterns.
11252 See the documentation in sregex.el.
11253
11254 ** parse-partial-sexp's return value has an additional element which
11255 is used to pass information along if you pass it to another call to
11256 parse-partial-sexp, starting its scan where the first call ended.
11257 The contents of this field are not yet finalized.
11258
11259 ** eval-region now accepts a fourth optional argument READ-FUNCTION.
11260 If it is non-nil, that function is used instead of `read'.
11261
11262 ** unload-feature by default removes the feature's functions from
11263 known hooks to avoid trouble, but a package providing FEATURE can
11264 define a hook FEATURE-unload-hook to be run by unload-feature instead.
11265
11266 ** read-from-minibuffer no longer returns the argument DEFAULT-VALUE
11267 when the user enters empty input. It now returns the null string, as
11268 it did in Emacs 19. The default value is made available in the
11269 history via M-n, but it is not applied here as a default.
11270
11271 The other, more specialized minibuffer-reading functions continue to
11272 return the default value (not the null string) when the user enters
11273 empty input.
11274
11275 ** The new variable read-buffer-function controls which routine to use
11276 for selecting buffers. For example, if you set this variable to
11277 `iswitchb-read-buffer', iswitchb will be used to read buffer names.
11278 Other functions can also be used if they accept the same arguments as
11279 `read-buffer' and return the selected buffer name as a string.
11280
11281 ** The new function read-passwd reads a password from the terminal,
11282 echoing a period for each character typed. It takes three arguments:
11283 a prompt string, a flag which says "read it twice to make sure", and a
11284 default password to use if the user enters nothing.
11285
11286 ** The variable fill-nobreak-predicate gives major modes a way to
11287 specify not to break a line at certain places. Its value is a
11288 function which is called with no arguments, with point located at the
11289 place where a break is being considered. If the function returns
11290 non-nil, then the line won't be broken there.
11291
11292 ** window-end now takes an optional second argument, UPDATE.
11293 If this is non-nil, then the function always returns an accurate
11294 up-to-date value for the buffer position corresponding to the
11295 end of the window, even if this requires computation.
11296
11297 ** other-buffer now takes an optional argument FRAME
11298 which specifies which frame's buffer list to use.
11299 If it is nil, that means use the selected frame's buffer list.
11300
11301 ** The new variable buffer-display-time, always local in every buffer,
11302 holds the value of (current-time) as of the last time that a window
11303 was directed to display this buffer.
11304
11305 ** It is now meaningful to compare two window-configuration objects
11306 with `equal'. Two window-configuration objects are equal if they
11307 describe equivalent arrangements of windows, in the same frame--in
11308 other words, if they would give the same results if passed to
11309 set-window-configuration.
11310
11311 ** compare-window-configurations is a new function that compares two
11312 window configurations loosely. It ignores differences in saved buffer
11313 positions and scrolling, and considers only the structure and sizes of
11314 windows and the choice of buffers to display.
11315
11316 ** The variable minor-mode-overriding-map-alist allows major modes to
11317 override the key bindings of a minor mode. The elements of this alist
11318 look like the elements of minor-mode-map-alist: (VARIABLE . KEYMAP).
11319
11320 If the VARIABLE in an element of minor-mode-overriding-map-alist has a
11321 non-nil value, the paired KEYMAP is active, and totally overrides the
11322 map (if any) specified for the same variable in minor-mode-map-alist.
11323
11324 minor-mode-overriding-map-alist is automatically local in all buffers,
11325 and it is meant to be set by major modes.
11326
11327 ** The function match-string-no-properties is like match-string
11328 except that it discards all text properties from the result.
11329
11330 ** The function load-average now accepts an optional argument
11331 USE-FLOATS. If it is non-nil, the load average values are returned as
11332 floating point numbers, rather than as integers to be divided by 100.
11333
11334 ** The new variable temporary-file-directory specifies the directory
11335 to use for creating temporary files. The default value is determined
11336 in a reasonable way for your operating system; on GNU and Unix systems
11337 it is based on the TMP and TMPDIR environment variables.
11338
11339 ** Menu changes
11340
11341 *** easymenu.el now uses the new menu item format and supports the
11342 keywords :visible and :filter. The existing keyword :keys is now
11343 better supported.
11344
11345 The variable `easy-menu-precalculate-equivalent-keybindings' controls
11346 a new feature which calculates keyboard equivalents for the menu when
11347 you define the menu. The default is t. If you rarely use menus, you
11348 can set the variable to nil to disable this precalculation feature;
11349 then the calculation is done only if you use the menu bar.
11350
11351 *** A new format for menu items is supported.
11352
11353 In a keymap, a key binding that has the format
11354 (STRING . REAL-BINDING) or (STRING HELP-STRING . REAL-BINDING)
11355 defines a menu item. Now a menu item definition may also be a list that
11356 starts with the symbol `menu-item'.
11357
11358 The format is:
11359 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) or
11360 (menu-item ITEM-NAME REAL-BINDING . ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST)
11361 where ITEM-NAME is an expression which evaluates to the menu item
11362 string, and ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST has the form of a property list.
11363 The supported properties include
11364
11365 :enable FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11366 item is enabled.
11367 :visible FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11368 item should appear in the menu.
11369 :filter FILTER-FN
11370 FILTER-FN is a function of one argument,
11371 which will be REAL-BINDING.
11372 It should return a binding to use instead.
11373 :keys DESCRIPTION
11374 DESCRIPTION is a string that describes an equivalent keyboard
11375 binding for REAL-BINDING. DESCRIPTION is expanded with
11376 `substitute-command-keys' before it is used.
11377 :key-sequence KEY-SEQUENCE
11378 KEY-SEQUENCE is a key-sequence for an equivalent
11379 keyboard binding.
11380 :key-sequence nil
11381 This means that the command normally has no
11382 keyboard equivalent.
11383 :help HELP HELP is the extra help string (not currently used).
11384 :button (TYPE . SELECTED)
11385 TYPE is :toggle or :radio.
11386 SELECTED is a form, to be evaluated, and its
11387 value says whether this button is currently selected.
11388
11389 Buttons are at the moment only simulated by prefixes in the menu.
11390 Eventually ordinary X-buttons may be supported.
11391
11392 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) defines unselectable item.
11393
11394 ** New event types
11395
11396 *** The new event type `mouse-wheel' is generated by a wheel on a
11397 mouse (such as the MS Intellimouse). The event contains a delta that
11398 corresponds to the amount and direction that the wheel is rotated,
11399 which is typically used to implement a scroll or zoom. The format is:
11400
11401 (mouse-wheel POSITION DELTA)
11402
11403 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
11404 same format as a mouse-click event, and DELTA is a signed number
11405 indicating the number of increments by which the wheel was rotated. A
11406 negative DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated backwards, towards
11407 the user, and a positive DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated
11408 forward, away from the user.
11409
11410 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11411
11412 *** The new event type `drag-n-drop' is generated when a group of
11413 files is selected in an application outside of Emacs, and then dragged
11414 and dropped onto an Emacs frame. The event contains a list of
11415 filenames that were dragged and dropped, which are then typically
11416 loaded into Emacs. The format is:
11417
11418 (drag-n-drop POSITION FILES)
11419
11420 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
11421 same format as a mouse-click event, and FILES is the list of filenames
11422 that were dragged and dropped.
11423
11424 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11425
11426 ** Changes relating to multibyte characters.
11427
11428 *** The variable enable-multibyte-characters is now read-only;
11429 any attempt to set it directly signals an error. The only way
11430 to change this value in an existing buffer is with set-buffer-multibyte.
11431
11432 *** In a string constant, `\ ' now stands for "nothing at all". You
11433 can use it to terminate a hex escape which is followed by a character
11434 that could otherwise be read as part of the hex escape.
11435
11436 *** String indices are now measured in characters, as they were
11437 in Emacs 19 and before.
11438
11439 The function chars-in-string has been deleted.
11440 The function concat-chars has been renamed to `string'.
11441
11442 *** The function set-buffer-multibyte sets the flag in the current
11443 buffer that says whether the buffer uses multibyte representation or
11444 unibyte representation. If the argument is nil, it selects unibyte
11445 representation. Otherwise it selects multibyte representation.
11446
11447 This function does not change the contents of the buffer, viewed
11448 as a sequence of bytes. However, it does change the contents
11449 viewed as characters; a sequence of two bytes which is treated as
11450 one character when the buffer uses multibyte representation
11451 will count as two characters using unibyte representation.
11452
11453 This function sets enable-multibyte-characters to record which
11454 representation is in use. It also adjusts various data in the buffer
11455 (including its markers, overlays and text properties) so that they are
11456 consistent with the new representation.
11457
11458 *** string-make-multibyte takes a string and converts it to multibyte
11459 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care
11460 about the representation, because Emacs converts when necessary;
11461 however, it makes a difference when you compare strings.
11462
11463 The conversion of non-ASCII characters works by adding the value of
11464 nonascii-insert-offset to each character, or by translating them
11465 using the table nonascii-translation-table.
11466
11467 *** string-make-unibyte takes a string and converts it to unibyte
11468 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care about the
11469 representation, but it makes a difference when you compare strings.
11470
11471 The conversion from multibyte to unibyte representation
11472 loses information; the only time Emacs performs it automatically
11473 is when inserting a multibyte string into a unibyte buffer.
11474
11475 *** string-as-multibyte takes a string, and returns another string
11476 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as multibyte.
11477
11478 *** string-as-unibyte takes a string, and returns another string
11479 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as unibyte.
11480
11481 *** The new function compare-strings lets you compare
11482 portions of two strings. Unibyte strings are converted to multibyte,
11483 so that a unibyte string can match a multibyte string.
11484 You can specify whether to ignore case or not.
11485
11486 *** assoc-ignore-case now uses compare-strings so that
11487 it can treat unibyte and multibyte strings as equal.
11488
11489 *** Regular expression operations and buffer string searches now
11490 convert the search pattern to multibyte or unibyte to accord with the
11491 buffer or string being searched.
11492
11493 One consequence is that you cannot always use \200-\377 inside of
11494 [...] to match all non-ASCII characters. This does still work when
11495 searching or matching a unibyte buffer or string, but not when
11496 searching or matching a multibyte string. Unfortunately, there is no
11497 obvious choice of syntax to use within [...] for that job. But, what
11498 you want is just to match all non-ASCII characters, the regular
11499 expression [^\0-\177] works for it.
11500
11501 *** Structure of coding system changed.
11502
11503 All coding systems (including aliases and subsidiaries) are named
11504 by symbols; the symbol's `coding-system' property is a vector
11505 which defines the coding system. Aliases share the same vector
11506 as the principal name, so that altering the contents of this
11507 vector affects the principal name and its aliases. You can define
11508 your own alias name of a coding system by the function
11509 define-coding-system-alias.
11510
11511 The coding system definition includes a property list of its own. Use
11512 the new functions `coding-system-get' and `coding-system-put' to
11513 access such coding system properties as post-read-conversion,
11514 pre-write-conversion, character-translation-table-for-decode,
11515 character-translation-table-for-encode, mime-charset, and
11516 safe-charsets. For instance, (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1
11517 'mime-charset) gives the corresponding MIME-charset parameter
11518 `iso-8859-1'.
11519
11520 Among the coding system properties listed above, safe-charsets is new.
11521 The value of this property is a list of character sets which this
11522 coding system can correctly encode and decode. For instance:
11523 (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 'safe-charsets) => (ascii latin-iso8859-1)
11524
11525 Here, "correctly encode" means that the encoded character sets can
11526 also be handled safely by systems other than Emacs as far as they
11527 are capable of that coding system. Though, Emacs itself can encode
11528 the other character sets and read it back correctly.
11529
11530 *** The new function select-safe-coding-system can be used to find a
11531 proper coding system for encoding the specified region or string.
11532 This function requires a user interaction.
11533
11534 *** The new functions find-coding-systems-region and
11535 find-coding-systems-string are helper functions used by
11536 select-safe-coding-system. They return a list of all proper coding
11537 systems to encode a text in some region or string. If you don't want
11538 a user interaction, use one of these functions instead of
11539 select-safe-coding-system.
11540
11541 *** The explicit encoding and decoding functions, such as
11542 decode-coding-region and encode-coding-string, now set
11543 last-coding-system-used to reflect the actual way encoding or decoding
11544 was done.
11545
11546 *** The new function detect-coding-with-language-environment can be
11547 used to detect a coding system of text according to priorities of
11548 coding systems used by some specific language environment.
11549
11550 *** The functions detect-coding-region and detect-coding-string always
11551 return a list if the arg HIGHEST is nil. Thus, if only ASCII
11552 characters are found, they now return a list of single element
11553 `undecided' or its subsidiaries.
11554
11555 *** The new functions coding-system-change-eol-conversion and
11556 coding-system-change-text-conversion can be used to get a different
11557 coding system than what specified only in how end-of-line or text is
11558 converted.
11559
11560 *** The new function set-selection-coding-system can be used to set a
11561 coding system for communicating with other X clients.
11562
11563 *** The function `map-char-table' now passes as argument only valid
11564 character codes, plus generic characters that stand for entire
11565 character sets or entire subrows of a character set. In other words,
11566 each time `map-char-table' calls its FUNCTION argument, the key value
11567 either will be a valid individual character code, or will stand for a
11568 range of characters.
11569
11570 *** The new function `char-valid-p' can be used for checking whether a
11571 Lisp object is a valid character code or not.
11572
11573 *** The new function `charset-after' returns a charset of a character
11574 in the current buffer at position POS.
11575
11576 *** Input methods are now implemented using the variable
11577 input-method-function. If this is non-nil, its value should be a
11578 function; then, whenever Emacs reads an input event that is a printing
11579 character with no modifier bits, it calls that function, passing the
11580 event as an argument. Often this function will read more input, first
11581 binding input-method-function to nil.
11582
11583 The return value should be a list of the events resulting from input
11584 method processing. These events will be processed sequentially as
11585 input, before resorting to unread-command-events. Events returned by
11586 the input method function are not passed to the input method function,
11587 not even if they are printing characters with no modifier bits.
11588
11589 The input method function is not called when reading the second and
11590 subsequent events of a key sequence.
11591
11592 *** You can customize any language environment by using
11593 set-language-environment-hook and exit-language-environment-hook.
11594
11595 The hook `exit-language-environment-hook' should be used to undo
11596 customizations that you made with set-language-environment-hook. For
11597 instance, if you set up a special key binding for a specific language
11598 environment by set-language-environment-hook, you should set up
11599 exit-language-environment-hook to restore the normal key binding.
11600 \f
11601 * Changes in Emacs 20.1
11602
11603 ** Emacs has a new facility for customization of its many user
11604 options. It is called M-x customize. With this facility you can look
11605 at the many user options in an organized way; they are grouped into a
11606 tree structure.
11607
11608 M-x customize also knows what sorts of values are legitimate for each
11609 user option and ensures that you don't use invalid values.
11610
11611 With M-x customize, you can set options either for the present Emacs
11612 session or permanently. (Permanent settings are stored automatically
11613 in your .emacs file.)
11614
11615 ** Scroll bars are now on the left side of the window.
11616 You can change this with M-x customize-option scroll-bar-mode.
11617
11618 ** The mode line no longer includes the string `Emacs'.
11619 This makes more space in the mode line for other information.
11620
11621 ** When you select a region with the mouse, it is highlighted
11622 immediately afterward. At that time, if you type the DELETE key, it
11623 kills the region.
11624
11625 The BACKSPACE key, and the ASCII character DEL, do not do this; they
11626 delete the character before point, as usual.
11627
11628 ** In an incremental search the whole current match is highlighted
11629 on terminals which support this. (You can disable this feature
11630 by setting search-highlight to nil.)
11631
11632 ** In the minibuffer, in some cases, you can now use M-n to
11633 insert the default value into the minibuffer as text. In effect,
11634 the default value (if the minibuffer routines know it) is tacked
11635 onto the history "in the future". (The more normal use of the
11636 history list is to use M-p to insert minibuffer input used in the
11637 past.)
11638
11639 ** In Text mode, now only blank lines separate paragraphs.
11640 This makes it possible to get the full benefit of Adaptive Fill mode
11641 in Text mode, and other modes derived from it (such as Mail mode).
11642 TAB in Text mode now runs the command indent-relative; this
11643 makes a practical difference only when you use indented paragraphs.
11644
11645 As a result, the old Indented Text mode is now identical to Text mode,
11646 and is an alias for it.
11647
11648 If you want spaces at the beginning of a line to start a paragraph,
11649 use the new mode, Paragraph Indent Text mode.
11650
11651 ** Scrolling changes
11652
11653 *** Scroll commands to scroll a whole screen now preserve the screen
11654 position of the cursor, if scroll-preserve-screen-position is non-nil.
11655
11656 In this mode, if you scroll several screens back and forth, finishing
11657 on the same screen where you started, the cursor goes back to the line
11658 where it started.
11659
11660 *** If you set scroll-conservatively to a small number, then when you
11661 move point a short distance off the screen, Emacs will scroll the
11662 screen just far enough to bring point back on screen, provided that
11663 does not exceed `scroll-conservatively' lines.
11664
11665 *** The new variable scroll-margin says how close point can come to the
11666 top or bottom of a window. It is a number of screen lines; if point
11667 comes within that many lines of the top or bottom of the window, Emacs
11668 recenters the window.
11669
11670 ** International character set support (MULE)
11671
11672 Emacs now supports a wide variety of international character sets,
11673 including European variants of the Latin alphabet, as well as Chinese,
11674 Devanagari (Hindi and Marathi), Ethiopian, Greek, IPA, Japanese,
11675 Korean, Lao, Russian, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese scripts. These
11676 features have been merged from the modified version of Emacs known as
11677 MULE (for "MULti-lingual Enhancement to GNU Emacs")
11678
11679 Users of these scripts have established many more-or-less standard
11680 coding systems for storing files. Emacs uses a single multibyte
11681 character encoding within Emacs buffers; it can translate from a wide
11682 variety of coding systems when reading a file and can translate back
11683 into any of these coding systems when saving a file.
11684
11685 Keyboards, even in the countries where these character sets are used,
11686 generally don't have keys for all the characters in them. So Emacs
11687 supports various "input methods", typically one for each script or
11688 language, to make it possible to type them.
11689
11690 The Emacs internal multibyte encoding represents a non-ASCII
11691 character as a sequence of bytes in the range 0200 through 0377.
11692
11693 The new prefix key C-x RET is used for commands that pertain
11694 to multibyte characters, coding systems, and input methods.
11695
11696 You can disable multibyte character support as follows:
11697
11698 (setq-default enable-multibyte-characters nil)
11699
11700 Calling the function standard-display-european turns off multibyte
11701 characters, unless you specify a non-nil value for the second
11702 argument, AUTO. This provides compatibility for people who are
11703 already using standard-display-european to continue using unibyte
11704 characters for their work until they want to change.
11705
11706 *** Input methods
11707
11708 An input method is a kind of character conversion which is designed
11709 specifically for interactive input. In Emacs, typically each language
11710 has its own input method (though sometimes several languages which use
11711 the same characters can share one input method). Some languages
11712 support several input methods.
11713
11714 The simplest kind of input method works by mapping ASCII letters into
11715 another alphabet. This is how the Greek and Russian input methods
11716 work.
11717
11718 A more powerful technique is composition: converting sequences of
11719 characters into one letter. Many European input methods use
11720 composition to produce a single non-ASCII letter from a sequence which
11721 consists of a letter followed by diacritics. For example, a' is one
11722 sequence of two characters that might be converted into a single
11723 letter.
11724
11725 The input methods for syllabic scripts typically use mapping followed
11726 by conversion. The input methods for Thai and Korean work this way.
11727 First, letters are mapped into symbols for particular sounds or tone
11728 marks; then, sequences of these which make up a whole syllable are
11729 mapped into one syllable sign--most often a "composite character".
11730
11731 None of these methods works very well for Chinese and Japanese, so
11732 they are handled specially. First you input a whole word using
11733 phonetic spelling; then, after the word is in the buffer, Emacs
11734 converts it into one or more characters using a large dictionary.
11735
11736 Since there is more than one way to represent a phonetically spelled
11737 word using Chinese characters, Emacs can only guess which one to use;
11738 typically these input methods give you a way to say "guess again" if
11739 the first guess is wrong.
11740
11741 *** The command C-x RET m (toggle-enable-multibyte-characters)
11742 turns multibyte character support on or off for the current buffer.
11743
11744 If multibyte character support is turned off in a buffer, then each
11745 byte is a single character, even codes 0200 through 0377--exactly as
11746 they did in Emacs 19.34. This includes the features for support for
11747 the European characters, ISO Latin-1 and ISO Latin-2.
11748
11749 However, there is no need to turn off multibyte character support to
11750 use ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2; the Emacs multibyte character set
11751 includes all the characters in these character sets, and Emacs can
11752 translate automatically to and from either one.
11753
11754 *** Visiting a file in unibyte mode.
11755
11756 Turning off multibyte character support in the buffer after visiting a
11757 file with multibyte code conversion will display the multibyte
11758 sequences already in the buffer, byte by byte. This is probably not
11759 what you want.
11760
11761 If you want to edit a file of unibyte characters (Latin-1, for
11762 example), you can do it by specifying `no-conversion' as the coding
11763 system when reading the file. This coding system also turns off
11764 multibyte characters in that buffer.
11765
11766 If you turn off multibyte character support entirely, this turns off
11767 character conversion as well.
11768
11769 *** Displaying international characters on X Windows.
11770
11771 A font for X typically displays just one alphabet or script.
11772 Therefore, displaying the entire range of characters Emacs supports
11773 requires using many fonts.
11774
11775 Therefore, Emacs now supports "fontsets". Each fontset is a
11776 collection of fonts, each assigned to a range of character codes.
11777
11778 A fontset has a name, like a font. Individual fonts are defined by
11779 the X server; fontsets are defined within Emacs itself. But once you
11780 have defined a fontset, you can use it in a face or a frame just as
11781 you would use a font.
11782
11783 If a fontset specifies no font for a certain character, or if it
11784 specifies a font that does not exist on your system, then it cannot
11785 display that character. It will display an empty box instead.
11786
11787 The fontset height and width are determined by the ASCII characters
11788 (that is, by the font in the fontset which is used for ASCII
11789 characters).
11790
11791 *** Defining fontsets.
11792
11793 Emacs does not use any fontset by default. Its default font is still
11794 chosen as in previous versions. You can tell Emacs to use a fontset
11795 with the `-fn' option or the `Font' X resource.
11796
11797 Emacs creates a standard fontset automatically according to the value
11798 of standard-fontset-spec. This fontset's short name is
11799 `fontset-standard'. Bold, italic, and bold-italic variants of the
11800 standard fontset are created automatically.
11801
11802 If you specify a default ASCII font with the `Font' resource or `-fn'
11803 argument, a fontset is generated from it. This works by replacing the
11804 FOUNDARY, FAMILY, ADD_STYLE, and AVERAGE_WIDTH fields of the font name
11805 with `*' then using this to specify a fontset. This fontset's short
11806 name is `fontset-startup'.
11807
11808 Emacs checks resources of the form Fontset-N where N is 0, 1, 2...
11809 The resource value should have this form:
11810 FONTSET-NAME, [CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME]...
11811 FONTSET-NAME should have the form of a standard X font name, except:
11812 * most fields should be just the wild card "*".
11813 * the CHARSET_REGISTRY field should be "fontset"
11814 * the CHARSET_ENCODING field can be any nickname of the fontset.
11815 The construct CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME can be repeated any number
11816 of times; each time specifies the font for one character set.
11817 CHARSET-NAME should be the name of a character set, and FONT-NAME
11818 should specify an actual font to use for that character set.
11819
11820 Each of these fontsets has an alias which is made from the
11821 last two font name fields, CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING.
11822 You can refer to the fontset by that alias or by its full name.
11823
11824 For any character sets that you don't mention, Emacs tries to choose a
11825 font by substituting into FONTSET-NAME. For instance, with the
11826 following resource,
11827 Emacs*Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24
11828 the font for ASCII is generated as below:
11829 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1
11830 Here is the substitution rule:
11831 Change CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING to that of the charset
11832 defined in the variable x-charset-registries. For instance, ASCII has
11833 the entry (ascii . "ISO8859-1") in this variable. Then, reduce
11834 sequences of wild cards -*-...-*- with a single wildcard -*-.
11835 (This is to prevent use of auto-scaled fonts.)
11836
11837 The function which processes the fontset resource value to create the
11838 fontset is called create-fontset-from-fontset-spec. You can also call
11839 that function explicitly to create a fontset.
11840
11841 With the X resource Emacs.Font, you can specify a fontset name just
11842 like an actual font name. But be careful not to specify a fontset
11843 name in a wildcard resource like Emacs*Font--that tries to specify the
11844 fontset for other purposes including menus, and they cannot handle
11845 fontsets.
11846
11847 *** The command M-x set-language-environment sets certain global Emacs
11848 defaults for a particular choice of language.
11849
11850 Selecting a language environment typically specifies a default input
11851 method and which coding systems to recognize automatically when
11852 visiting files. However, it does not try to reread files you have
11853 already visited; the text in those buffers is not affected. The
11854 language environment may also specify a default choice of coding
11855 system for new files that you create.
11856
11857 It makes no difference which buffer is current when you use
11858 set-language-environment, because these defaults apply globally to the
11859 whole Emacs session.
11860
11861 For example, M-x set-language-environment RET Latin-1 RET
11862 chooses the Latin-1 character set. In the .emacs file, you can do this
11863 with (set-language-environment "Latin-1").
11864
11865 *** The command C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system)
11866 specifies the file coding system for the current buffer. This
11867 specifies what sort of character code translation to do when saving
11868 the file. As an argument, you must specify the name of one of the
11869 coding systems that Emacs supports.
11870
11871 *** The command C-x RET c (universal-coding-system-argument)
11872 lets you specify a coding system when you read or write a file.
11873 This command uses the minibuffer to read a coding system name.
11874 After you exit the minibuffer, the specified coding system
11875 is used for *the immediately following command*.
11876
11877 So if the immediately following command is a command to read or
11878 write a file, it uses the specified coding system for that file.
11879
11880 If the immediately following command does not use the coding system,
11881 then C-x RET c ultimately has no effect.
11882
11883 For example, C-x RET c iso-8859-1 RET C-x C-f temp RET
11884 visits the file `temp' treating it as ISO Latin-1.
11885
11886 *** You can specify the coding system for a file using the -*-
11887 construct. Include `coding: CODINGSYSTEM;' inside the -*-...-*-
11888 to specify use of coding system CODINGSYSTEM. You can also
11889 specify the coding system in a local variable list at the end
11890 of the file.
11891
11892 *** The command C-x RET t (set-terminal-coding-system) specifies
11893 the coding system for terminal output. If you specify a character
11894 code for terminal output, all characters output to the terminal are
11895 translated into that character code.
11896
11897 This feature is useful for certain character-only terminals built in
11898 various countries to support the languages of those countries.
11899
11900 By default, output to the terminal is not translated at all.
11901
11902 *** The command C-x RET k (set-keyboard-coding-system) specifies
11903 the coding system for keyboard input.
11904
11905 Character code translation of keyboard input is useful for terminals
11906 with keys that send non-ASCII graphic characters--for example,
11907 some terminals designed for ISO Latin-1 or subsets of it.
11908
11909 By default, keyboard input is not translated at all.
11910
11911 Character code translation of keyboard input is similar to using an
11912 input method, in that both define sequences of keyboard input that
11913 translate into single characters. However, input methods are designed
11914 to be convenient for interactive use, while the code translations are
11915 designed to work with terminals.
11916
11917 *** The command C-x RET p (set-buffer-process-coding-system)
11918 specifies the coding system for input and output to a subprocess.
11919 This command applies to the current buffer; normally, each subprocess
11920 has its own buffer, and thus you can use this command to specify
11921 translation to and from a particular subprocess by giving the command
11922 in the corresponding buffer.
11923
11924 By default, process input and output are not translated at all.
11925
11926 *** The variable file-name-coding-system specifies the coding system
11927 to use for encoding file names before operating on them.
11928 It is also used for decoding file names obtained from the system.
11929
11930 *** The command C-\ (toggle-input-method) activates or deactivates
11931 an input method. If no input method has been selected before, the
11932 command prompts for you to specify the language and input method you
11933 want to use.
11934
11935 C-u C-\ (select-input-method) lets you switch to a different input
11936 method. C-h C-\ (or C-h I) describes the current input method.
11937
11938 *** Some input methods remap the keyboard to emulate various keyboard
11939 layouts commonly used for particular scripts. How to do this
11940 remapping properly depends on your actual keyboard layout. To specify
11941 which layout your keyboard has, use M-x quail-set-keyboard-layout.
11942
11943 *** The command C-h C (describe-coding-system) displays
11944 the coding systems currently selected for various purposes, plus
11945 related information.
11946
11947 *** The command C-h h (view-hello-file) displays a file called
11948 HELLO, which has examples of text in many languages, using various
11949 scripts.
11950
11951 *** The command C-h L (describe-language-support) displays
11952 information about the support for a particular language.
11953 You specify the language as an argument.
11954
11955 *** The mode line now contains a letter or character that identifies
11956 the coding system used in the visited file. It normally follows the
11957 first dash.
11958
11959 A dash indicates the default state of affairs: no code conversion
11960 (except CRLF => newline if appropriate). `=' means no conversion
11961 whatsoever. The ISO 8859 coding systems are represented by digits
11962 1 through 9. Other coding systems are represented by letters:
11963
11964 A alternativnyj (Russian)
11965 B big5 (Chinese)
11966 C cn-gb-2312 (Chinese)
11967 C iso-2022-cn (Chinese)
11968 D in-is13194-devanagari (Indian languages)
11969 E euc-japan (Japanese)
11970 I iso-2022-cjk or iso-2022-ss2 (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
11971 J junet (iso-2022-7) or old-jis (iso-2022-jp-1978-irv) (Japanese)
11972 K euc-korea (Korean)
11973 R koi8 (Russian)
11974 Q tibetan
11975 S shift_jis (Japanese)
11976 T lao
11977 T tis620 (Thai)
11978 V viscii or vscii (Vietnamese)
11979 i iso-2022-lock (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
11980 k iso-2022-kr (Korean)
11981 v viqr (Vietnamese)
11982 z hz (Chinese)
11983
11984 When you are using a character-only terminal (not a window system),
11985 two additional characters appear in between the dash and the file
11986 coding system. These two characters describe the coding system for
11987 keyboard input, and the coding system for terminal output.
11988
11989 *** The new variable rmail-file-coding-system specifies the code
11990 conversion to use for RMAIL files. The default value is nil.
11991
11992 When you read mail with Rmail, each message is decoded automatically
11993 into Emacs' internal format. This has nothing to do with
11994 rmail-file-coding-system. That variable controls reading and writing
11995 Rmail files themselves.
11996
11997 *** The new variable sendmail-coding-system specifies the code
11998 conversion for outgoing mail. The default value is nil.
11999
12000 Actually, there are three different ways of specifying the coding system
12001 for sending mail:
12002
12003 - If you use C-x RET f in the mail buffer, that takes priority.
12004 - Otherwise, if you set sendmail-coding-system non-nil, that specifies it.
12005 - Otherwise, the default coding system for new files is used,
12006 if that is non-nil. That comes from your language environment.
12007 - Otherwise, Latin-1 is used.
12008
12009 *** The command C-h t (help-with-tutorial) accepts a prefix argument
12010 to specify the language for the tutorial file. Currently, English,
12011 Japanese, Korean and Thai are supported. We welcome additional
12012 translations.
12013
12014 ** An easy new way to visit a file with no code or format conversion
12015 of any kind: Use M-x find-file-literally. There is also a command
12016 insert-file-literally which inserts a file into the current buffer
12017 without any conversion.
12018
12019 ** C-q's handling of octal character codes is changed.
12020 You can now specify any number of octal digits.
12021 RET terminates the digits and is discarded;
12022 any other non-digit terminates the digits and is then used as input.
12023
12024 ** There are new commands for looking up Info documentation for
12025 functions, variables and file names used in your programs.
12026
12027 Type M-x info-lookup-symbol to look up a symbol in the buffer at point.
12028 Type M-x info-lookup-file to look up a file in the buffer at point.
12029
12030 Precisely which Info files are used to look it up depends on the major
12031 mode. For example, in C mode, the GNU libc manual is used.
12032
12033 ** M-TAB in most programming language modes now runs the command
12034 complete-symbol. This command performs completion on the symbol name
12035 in the buffer before point.
12036
12037 With a numeric argument, it performs completion based on the set of
12038 symbols documented in the Info files for the programming language that
12039 you are using.
12040
12041 With no argument, it does completion based on the current tags tables,
12042 just like the old binding of M-TAB (complete-tag).
12043
12044 ** File locking works with NFS now.
12045
12046 The lock file for FILENAME is now a symbolic link named .#FILENAME,
12047 in the same directory as FILENAME.
12048
12049 This means that collision detection between two different machines now
12050 works reasonably well; it also means that no file server or directory
12051 can become a bottleneck.
12052
12053 The new method does have drawbacks. It means that collision detection
12054 does not operate when you edit a file in a directory where you cannot
12055 create new files. Collision detection also doesn't operate when the
12056 file server does not support symbolic links. But these conditions are
12057 rare, and the ability to have collision detection while using NFS is
12058 so useful that the change is worth while.
12059
12060 When Emacs or a system crashes, this may leave behind lock files which
12061 are stale. So you may occasionally get warnings about spurious
12062 collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious, just
12063 tell Emacs to go ahead anyway.
12064
12065 ** If you wish to use Show Paren mode to display matching parentheses,
12066 it is no longer sufficient to load paren.el. Instead you must call
12067 show-paren-mode.
12068
12069 ** If you wish to use Delete Selection mode to replace a highlighted
12070 selection when you insert new text, it is no longer sufficient to load
12071 delsel.el. Instead you must call the function delete-selection-mode.
12072
12073 ** If you wish to use Partial Completion mode to complete partial words
12074 within symbols or filenames, it is no longer sufficient to load
12075 complete.el. Instead you must call the function partial-completion-mode.
12076
12077 ** If you wish to use uniquify to rename buffers for you,
12078 it is no longer sufficient to load uniquify.el. You must also
12079 set uniquify-buffer-name-style to one of the non-nil legitimate values.
12080
12081 ** Changes in View mode.
12082
12083 *** Several new commands are available in View mode.
12084 Do H in view mode for a list of commands.
12085
12086 *** There are two new commands for entering View mode:
12087 view-file-other-frame and view-buffer-other-frame.
12088
12089 *** Exiting View mode does a better job of restoring windows to their
12090 previous state.
12091
12092 *** New customization variable view-scroll-auto-exit. If non-nil,
12093 scrolling past end of buffer makes view mode exit.
12094
12095 *** New customization variable view-exits-all-viewing-windows. If
12096 non-nil, view-mode will at exit restore all windows viewing buffer,
12097 not just the selected window.
12098
12099 *** New customization variable view-read-only. If non-nil, visiting a
12100 read-only file automatically enters View mode, and toggle-read-only
12101 turns View mode on or off.
12102
12103 *** New customization variable view-remove-frame-by-deleting controls
12104 how to remove a not needed frame at view mode exit. If non-nil,
12105 delete the frame, if nil make an icon of it.
12106
12107 ** C-x v l, the command to print a file's version control log,
12108 now positions point at the entry for the file's current branch version.
12109
12110 ** C-x v =, the command to compare a file with the last checked-in version,
12111 has a new feature. If the file is currently not locked, so that it is
12112 presumably identical to the last checked-in version, the command now asks
12113 which version to compare with.
12114
12115 ** When using hideshow.el, incremental search can temporarily show hidden
12116 blocks if a match is inside the block.
12117
12118 The block is hidden again if the search is continued and the next match
12119 is outside the block. By customizing the variable
12120 isearch-hide-immediately you can choose to hide all the temporarily
12121 shown blocks only when exiting from incremental search.
12122
12123 By customizing the variable hs-isearch-open you can choose what kind
12124 of blocks to temporarily show during isearch: comment blocks, code
12125 blocks, all of them or none.
12126
12127 ** The new command C-x 4 0 (kill-buffer-and-window) kills the
12128 current buffer and deletes the selected window. It asks for
12129 confirmation first.
12130
12131 ** C-x C-w, which saves the buffer into a specified file name,
12132 now changes the major mode according to that file name.
12133 However, the mode will not be changed if
12134 (1) a local variables list or the `-*-' line specifies a major mode, or
12135 (2) the current major mode is a "special" mode,
12136 not suitable for ordinary files, or
12137 (3) the new file name does not particularly specify any mode.
12138
12139 This applies to M-x set-visited-file-name as well.
12140
12141 However, if you set change-major-mode-with-file-name to nil, then
12142 these commands do not change the major mode.
12143
12144 ** M-x occur changes.
12145
12146 *** If the argument to M-x occur contains upper case letters,
12147 it performs a case-sensitive search.
12148
12149 *** In the *Occur* buffer made by M-x occur,
12150 if you type g or M-x revert-buffer, this repeats the search
12151 using the same regular expression and the same buffer as before.
12152
12153 ** In Transient Mark mode, the region in any one buffer is highlighted
12154 in just one window at a time. At first, it is highlighted in the
12155 window where you set the mark. The buffer's highlighting remains in
12156 that window unless you select to another window which shows the same
12157 buffer--then the highlighting moves to that window.
12158
12159 ** The feature to suggest key bindings when you use M-x now operates
12160 after the command finishes. The message suggesting key bindings
12161 appears temporarily in the echo area. The previous echo area contents
12162 come back after a few seconds, in case they contain useful information.
12163
12164 ** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
12165 selected buffers, so that the default for C-x b is now based on the
12166 buffers recently selected in the selected frame.
12167
12168 ** Outline mode changes.
12169
12170 *** Outline mode now uses overlays (this is the former noutline.el).
12171
12172 *** Incremental searches skip over invisible text in Outline mode.
12173
12174 ** When a minibuffer window is active but not the selected window, if
12175 you try to use the minibuffer, you used to get a nested minibuffer.
12176 Now, this not only gives an error, it also cancels the minibuffer that
12177 was already active.
12178
12179 The motive for this change is so that beginning users do not
12180 unknowingly move away from minibuffers, leaving them active, and then
12181 get confused by it.
12182
12183 If you want to be able to have recursive minibuffers, you must
12184 set enable-recursive-minibuffers to non-nil.
12185
12186 ** Changes in dynamic abbrevs.
12187
12188 *** Expanding dynamic abbrevs with M-/ is now smarter about case
12189 conversion. If the expansion has mixed case not counting the first
12190 character, and the abbreviation matches the beginning of the expansion
12191 including case, then the expansion is copied verbatim.
12192
12193 The expansion is also copied verbatim if the abbreviation itself has
12194 mixed case. And using SPC M-/ to copy an additional word always
12195 copies it verbatim except when the previous copied word is all caps.
12196
12197 *** The values of `dabbrev-case-replace' and `dabbrev-case-fold-search'
12198 are no longer Lisp expressions. They have simply three possible
12199 values.
12200
12201 `dabbrev-case-replace' has these three values: nil (don't preserve
12202 case), t (do), or `case-replace' (do like M-x query-replace).
12203 `dabbrev-case-fold-search' has these three values: nil (don't ignore
12204 case), t (do), or `case-fold-search' (do like search).
12205
12206 ** Minibuffer history lists are truncated automatically now to a
12207 certain length. The variable history-length specifies how long they
12208 can be. The default value is 30.
12209
12210 ** Changes in Mail mode.
12211
12212 *** The key C-x m no longer runs the `mail' command directly.
12213 Instead, it runs the command `compose-mail', which invokes the mail
12214 composition mechanism you have selected with the variable
12215 `mail-user-agent'. The default choice of user agent is
12216 `sendmail-user-agent', which gives behavior compatible with the old
12217 behavior.
12218
12219 C-x 4 m now runs compose-mail-other-window, and C-x 5 m runs
12220 compose-mail-other-frame.
12221
12222 *** While composing a reply to a mail message, from Rmail, you can use
12223 the command C-c C-r to cite just the region from the message you are
12224 replying to. This copies the text which is the selected region in the
12225 buffer that shows the original message.
12226
12227 *** The command C-c C-i inserts a file at the end of the message,
12228 with separator lines around the contents.
12229
12230 *** The command M-x expand-mail-aliases expands all mail aliases
12231 in suitable mail headers. Emacs automatically extracts mail alias
12232 definitions from your mail alias file (e.g., ~/.mailrc). You do not
12233 need to expand mail aliases yourself before sending mail.
12234
12235 *** New features in the mail-complete command.
12236
12237 **** The mail-complete command now inserts the user's full name,
12238 for local users or if that is known. The variable mail-complete-style
12239 controls the style to use, and whether to do this at all.
12240 Its values are like those of mail-from-style.
12241
12242 **** The variable mail-passwd-command lets you specify a shell command
12243 to run to fetch a set of password-entries that add to the ones in
12244 /etc/passwd.
12245
12246 **** The variable mail-passwd-file now specifies a list of files to read
12247 to get the list of user ids. By default, one file is used:
12248 /etc/passwd.
12249
12250 ** You can "quote" a file name to inhibit special significance of
12251 special syntax, by adding `/:' to the beginning. Thus, if you have a
12252 directory named `/foo:', you can prevent it from being treated as a
12253 reference to a remote host named `foo' by writing it as `/:/foo:'.
12254
12255 Emacs uses this new construct automatically when necessary, such as
12256 when you start it with a working directory whose name might otherwise
12257 be taken to be magic.
12258
12259 ** There is a new command M-x grep-find which uses find to select
12260 files to search through, and grep to scan them. The output is
12261 available in a Compile mode buffer, as with M-x grep.
12262
12263 M-x grep now uses the -e option if the grep program supports that.
12264 (-e prevents problems if the search pattern starts with a dash.)
12265
12266 ** In Dired, the & command now flags for deletion the files whose names
12267 suggest they are probably not needed in the long run.
12268
12269 In Dired, * is now a prefix key for mark-related commands.
12270
12271 new key dired.el binding old key
12272 ------- ---------------- -------
12273 * c dired-change-marks c
12274 * m dired-mark m
12275 * * dired-mark-executables * (binding deleted)
12276 * / dired-mark-directories / (binding deleted)
12277 * @ dired-mark-symlinks @ (binding deleted)
12278 * u dired-unmark u
12279 * DEL dired-unmark-backward DEL
12280 * ? dired-unmark-all-files C-M-?
12281 * ! dired-unmark-all-marks
12282 * % dired-mark-files-regexp % m
12283 * C-n dired-next-marked-file M-}
12284 * C-p dired-prev-marked-file M-{
12285
12286 ** Rmail changes.
12287
12288 *** When Rmail cannot convert your incoming mail into Babyl format, it
12289 saves the new mail in the file RMAILOSE.n, where n is an integer
12290 chosen to make a unique name. This way, Rmail will not keep crashing
12291 each time you run it.
12292
12293 *** In Rmail, the variable rmail-summary-line-count-flag now controls
12294 whether to include the line count in the summary. Non-nil means yes.
12295
12296 *** In Rmail summary buffers, d and C-d (the commands to delete
12297 messages) now take repeat counts as arguments. A negative argument
12298 means to move in the opposite direction.
12299
12300 *** In Rmail, the t command now takes an optional argument which lets
12301 you specify whether to show the message headers in full or pruned.
12302
12303 *** In Rmail, the new command w (rmail-output-body-to-file) writes
12304 just the body of the current message into a file, without the headers.
12305 It takes the file name from the message subject, by default, but you
12306 can edit that file name in the minibuffer before it is actually used
12307 for output.
12308
12309 ** Gnus changes.
12310
12311 *** nntp.el has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
12312
12313 *** Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
12314 Gnus.
12315
12316 *** Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like
12317 `and', `or', `not', and parent redirection.
12318
12319 *** Article washing status can be displayed in the
12320 article mode line.
12321
12322 *** gnus.el has been split into many smaller files.
12323
12324 *** Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID.
12325
12326 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
12327
12328 *** New variables for specifying what score and adapt files
12329 are to be considered home score and adapt files. See
12330 `gnus-home-score-file' and `gnus-home-adapt-files'.
12331
12332 *** Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics.
12333
12334 *** Article editing has been revamped and is now usable.
12335
12336 *** Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions.
12337 See `gnus-signature-separator' and `gnus-signature-limit'.
12338
12339 *** Summary pick mode has been made to look more nn-like.
12340 Line numbers are displayed and the `.' command can be
12341 used to pick articles.
12342
12343 *** Commands for moving the .newsrc.eld from one server to
12344 another have been added.
12345
12346 `M-x gnus-change-server'
12347
12348 *** A way to specify that "uninteresting" fields be suppressed when
12349 generating lines in buffers.
12350
12351 *** Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with
12352 `C-M-_'.
12353
12354 *** Scoring can be done on words using the new score type `w'.
12355
12356 *** Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis:
12357
12358 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
12359
12360 *** Scores can be decayed.
12361
12362 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
12363
12364 *** Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The
12365 Date is normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first.
12366
12367 *** A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
12368 the native server.
12369
12370 `M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups'
12371
12372 *** A new command for reading collections of documents
12373 (nndoc with nnvirtual on top) has been added -- `C-M-d'.
12374
12375 *** Process mark sets can be pushed and popped.
12376
12377 *** A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post
12378 even when the NNTP server doesn't allow posting.
12379
12380 *** A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
12381 (DejaNews, Alta Vista, InReference) has been added.
12382
12383 Use the `G w' command in the group buffer to create such
12384 a group.
12385
12386 *** Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard
12387 sorting functions, and each topic can be sorted independently.
12388
12389 See the commands under the `T S' submap.
12390
12391 *** Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently.
12392
12393 See the commands under the `G P' submap.
12394
12395 *** Cached articles can be pulled into the groups.
12396
12397 Use the `Y c' command.
12398
12399 *** Score files are now applied in a more reliable order.
12400
12401 *** Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated.
12402
12403 `M-x nnmail-split-history'
12404
12405 *** More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk
12406 from incoming mail before saving the mail.
12407
12408 See `nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook'.
12409
12410 *** The nnml mail backend now understands compressed article files.
12411
12412 *** To enable Gnus to read/post multi-lingual articles, you must execute
12413 the following code, for instance, in your .emacs.
12414
12415 (add-hook 'gnus-startup-hook 'gnus-mule-initialize)
12416
12417 Then, when you start Gnus, it will decode non-ASCII text automatically
12418 and show appropriate characters. (Note: if you are using gnus-mime
12419 from the SEMI package, formerly known as TM, you should NOT add this
12420 hook to gnus-startup-hook; gnus-mime has its own method of handling
12421 this issue.)
12422
12423 Since it is impossible to distinguish all coding systems
12424 automatically, you may need to specify a choice of coding system for a
12425 particular news group. This can be done by:
12426
12427 (gnus-mule-add-group NEWSGROUP 'CODING-SYSTEM)
12428
12429 Here NEWSGROUP should be a string which names a newsgroup or a tree
12430 of newsgroups. If NEWSGROUP is "XXX.YYY", all news groups under
12431 "XXX.YYY" (including "XXX.YYY.ZZZ") will use the specified coding
12432 system. CODING-SYSTEM specifies which coding system to use (for both
12433 for reading and posting).
12434
12435 CODING-SYSTEM can also be a cons cell of the form
12436 (READ-CODING-SYSTEM . POST-CODING-SYSTEM)
12437 Then READ-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you read messages from the
12438 newsgroups, while POST-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you post messages
12439 there.
12440
12441 Emacs knows the right coding systems for certain newsgroups by
12442 default. Here are some of these default settings:
12443
12444 (gnus-mule-add-group "fj" 'iso-2022-7)
12445 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text" 'hz-gb-2312)
12446 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.hk" 'hz-gb-2312)
12447 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text.big5" 'cn-big5)
12448 (gnus-mule-add-group "soc.culture.vietnamese" '(nil . viqr))
12449
12450 When you reply by mail to an article, these settings are ignored;
12451 the mail is encoded according to sendmail-coding-system, as usual.
12452
12453 ** CC mode changes.
12454
12455 *** If you edit primarily one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, Java)
12456 code, you may want to make the CC Mode style variables have global
12457 values so that you can set them directly in your .emacs file. To do
12458 this, set c-style-variables-are-local-p to nil in your .emacs file.
12459 Note that this only takes effect if you do it *before* cc-mode.el is
12460 loaded.
12461
12462 If you typically edit more than one style of C (or C++, Objective-C,
12463 Java) code in a single Emacs session, you may want to make the CC Mode
12464 style variables have buffer local values. By default, all buffers
12465 share the same style variable settings; to make them buffer local, set
12466 c-style-variables-are-local-p to t in your .emacs file. Note that you
12467 must do this *before* CC Mode is loaded.
12468
12469 *** The new variable c-indentation-style holds the C style name
12470 of the current buffer.
12471
12472 *** The variable c-block-comments-indent-p has been deleted, because
12473 it is no longer necessary. C mode now handles all the supported styles
12474 of block comments, with no need to say which one you will use.
12475
12476 *** There is a new indentation style "python", which specifies the C
12477 style that the Python developers like.
12478
12479 *** There is a new c-cleanup-list option: brace-elseif-brace.
12480 This says to put ...} else if (...) {... on one line,
12481 just as brace-else-brace says to put ...} else {... on one line.
12482
12483 ** VC Changes [new]
12484
12485 *** In vc-retrieve-snapshot (C-x v r), if you don't specify a snapshot
12486 name, it retrieves the *latest* versions of all files in the current
12487 directory and its subdirectories (aside from files already locked).
12488
12489 This feature is useful if your RCS directory is a link to a common
12490 master directory, and you want to pick up changes made by other
12491 developers.
12492
12493 You can do the same thing for an individual file by typing C-u C-x C-q
12494 RET in a buffer visiting that file.
12495
12496 *** VC can now handle files under CVS that are being "watched" by
12497 other developers. Such files are made read-only by CVS. To get a
12498 writable copy, type C-x C-q in a buffer visiting such a file. VC then
12499 calls "cvs edit", which notifies the other developers of it.
12500
12501 *** vc-version-diff (C-u C-x v =) now suggests reasonable defaults for
12502 version numbers, based on the current state of the file.
12503
12504 ** Calendar changes.
12505
12506 *** A new function, list-holidays, allows you list holidays or
12507 subclasses of holidays for ranges of years. Related menu items allow
12508 you do this for the year of the selected date, or the
12509 following/previous years.
12510
12511 *** There is now support for the Baha'i calendar system. Use `pb' in
12512 the *Calendar* buffer to display the current Baha'i date. The Baha'i
12513 calendar, or "Badi calendar" is a system of 19 months with 19 days
12514 each, and 4 intercalary days (5 during a Gregorian leap year). The
12515 calendar begins May 23, 1844, with each of the months named after a
12516 supposed attribute of God.
12517
12518 ** ps-print changes
12519
12520 There are some new user variables and subgroups for customizing the page
12521 layout.
12522
12523 *** Headers & Footers (subgroup)
12524
12525 Some printer systems print a header page and force the first page to
12526 be printed on the back of the header page when using duplex. If your
12527 printer system has this behavior, set variable
12528 `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' to t.
12529
12530 If variable `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' is non-nil, it prints a
12531 blank page as the very first printed page. So, it behaves as if the
12532 very first character of buffer (or region) were a form feed ^L (\014).
12533
12534 The variable `ps-spool-config' specifies who is responsible for
12535 setting duplex mode and page size. Valid values are:
12536
12537 lpr-switches duplex and page size are configured by `ps-lpr-switches'.
12538 Don't forget to set `ps-lpr-switches' to select duplex
12539 printing for your printer.
12540
12541 setpagedevice duplex and page size are configured by ps-print using the
12542 setpagedevice PostScript operator.
12543
12544 nil duplex and page size are configured by ps-print *not* using
12545 the setpagedevice PostScript operator.
12546
12547 The variable `ps-spool-tumble' specifies how the page images on
12548 opposite sides of a sheet are oriented with respect to each other. If
12549 `ps-spool-tumble' is nil, ps-print produces output suitable for
12550 bindings on the left or right. If `ps-spool-tumble' is non-nil,
12551 ps-print produces output suitable for bindings at the top or bottom.
12552 This variable takes effect only if `ps-spool-duplex' is non-nil.
12553 The default value is nil.
12554
12555 The variable `ps-header-frame-alist' specifies a header frame
12556 properties alist. Valid frame properties are:
12557
12558 fore-color Specify the foreground frame color.
12559 Value should be a float number between 0.0 (black
12560 color) and 1.0 (white color), or a string which is a
12561 color name, or a list of 3 float numbers which
12562 correspond to the Red Green Blue color scale, each
12563 float number between 0.0 (dark color) and 1.0 (bright
12564 color). The default is 0 ("black").
12565
12566 back-color Specify the background frame color (similar to fore-color).
12567 The default is 0.9 ("gray90").
12568
12569 shadow-color Specify the shadow color (similar to fore-color).
12570 The default is 0 ("black").
12571
12572 border-color Specify the border color (similar to fore-color).
12573 The default is 0 ("black").
12574
12575 border-width Specify the border width.
12576 The default is 0.4.
12577
12578 Any other property is ignored.
12579
12580 Don't change this alist directly; instead use Custom, or the
12581 `ps-value', `ps-get', `ps-put' and `ps-del' functions (see there for
12582 documentation).
12583
12584 Ps-print can also print footers. The footer variables are:
12585 `ps-print-footer', `ps-footer-offset', `ps-print-footer-frame',
12586 `ps-footer-font-family', `ps-footer-font-size', `ps-footer-line-pad',
12587 `ps-footer-lines', `ps-left-footer', `ps-right-footer' and
12588 `ps-footer-frame-alist'. These variables are similar to those
12589 controlling headers.
12590
12591 *** Color management (subgroup)
12592
12593 If `ps-print-color-p' is non-nil, the buffer's text will be printed in
12594 color.
12595
12596 *** Face Management (subgroup)
12597
12598 If you need to print without worrying about face background colors,
12599 set the variable `ps-use-face-background' which specifies if face
12600 background should be used. Valid values are:
12601
12602 t always use face background color.
12603 nil never use face background color.
12604 (face...) list of faces whose background color will be used.
12605
12606 *** N-up printing (subgroup)
12607
12608 The variable `ps-n-up-printing' specifies the number of pages per
12609 sheet of paper.
12610
12611 The variable `ps-n-up-margin' specifies the margin in points (pt)
12612 between the sheet border and the n-up printing.
12613
12614 If variable `ps-n-up-border-p' is non-nil, a border is drawn around
12615 each page.
12616
12617 The variable `ps-n-up-filling' specifies how the page matrix is filled
12618 on each sheet of paper. Following are the valid values for
12619 `ps-n-up-filling' with a filling example using a 3x4 page matrix:
12620
12621 `left-top' 1 2 3 4 `left-bottom' 9 10 11 12
12622 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
12623 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
12624
12625 `right-top' 4 3 2 1 `right-bottom' 12 11 10 9
12626 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
12627 12 11 10 9 4 3 2 1
12628
12629 `top-left' 1 4 7 10 `bottom-left' 3 6 9 12
12630 2 5 8 11 2 5 8 11
12631 3 6 9 12 1 4 7 10
12632
12633 `top-right' 10 7 4 1 `bottom-right' 12 9 6 3
12634 11 8 5 2 11 8 5 2
12635 12 9 6 3 10 7 4 1
12636
12637 Any other value is treated as `left-top'.
12638
12639 *** Zebra stripes (subgroup)
12640
12641 The variable `ps-zebra-color' controls the zebra stripes grayscale or
12642 RGB color.
12643
12644 The variable `ps-zebra-stripe-follow' specifies how zebra stripes
12645 continue on next page. Visually, valid values are (the character `+'
12646 to the right of each column indicates that a line is printed):
12647
12648 `nil' `follow' `full' `full-follow'
12649 Current Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12650 1 XXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXX + 1 XXXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12651 2 XXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXX + 2 XXXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12652 3 XXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXX + 3 XXXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12653 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 +
12654 5 + 5 + 5 + 5 +
12655 6 + 6 + 6 + 6 +
12656 7 XXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXX + 7 XXXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12657 8 XXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXX + 8 XXXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12658 9 XXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXX + 9 XXXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12659 10 + 10 +
12660 11 + 11 +
12661 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12662 Next Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12663 12 XXXXX + 12 + 10 XXXXXX + 10 +
12664 13 XXXXX + 13 XXXXXXXX + 11 XXXXXX + 11 +
12665 14 XXXXX + 14 XXXXXXXX + 12 XXXXXX + 12 +
12666 15 + 15 XXXXXXXX + 13 + 13 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12667 16 + 16 + 14 + 14 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12668 17 + 17 + 15 + 15 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12669 18 XXXXX + 18 + 16 XXXXXX + 16 +
12670 19 XXXXX + 19 XXXXXXXX + 17 XXXXXX + 17 +
12671 20 XXXXX + 20 XXXXXXXX + 18 XXXXXX + 18 +
12672 21 + 21 XXXXXXXX +
12673 22 + 22 +
12674 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12675
12676 Any other value is treated as `nil'.
12677
12678
12679 *** Printer management (subgroup)
12680
12681 The variable `ps-printer-name-option' determines the option used by
12682 some utilities to indicate the printer name; it's used only when
12683 `ps-printer-name' is a non-empty string. If you're using the lpr
12684 utility to print, for example, `ps-printer-name-option' should be set
12685 to "-P".
12686
12687 The variable `ps-manual-feed' indicates if the printer requires manual
12688 paper feeding. If it's nil, automatic feeding takes place. If it's
12689 non-nil, manual feeding takes place.
12690
12691 The variable `ps-end-with-control-d' specifies whether C-d (\x04)
12692 should be inserted at end of the generated PostScript. Non-nil means
12693 do so.
12694
12695 *** Page settings (subgroup)
12696
12697 If variable `ps-warn-paper-type' is nil, it's *not* treated as an
12698 error if the PostScript printer doesn't have a paper with the size
12699 indicated by `ps-paper-type'; the default paper size will be used
12700 instead. If `ps-warn-paper-type' is non-nil, an error is signaled if
12701 the PostScript printer doesn't support a paper with the size indicated
12702 by `ps-paper-type'. This is used when `ps-spool-config' is set to
12703 `setpagedevice'.
12704
12705 The variable `ps-print-upside-down' determines the orientation for
12706 printing pages: nil means `normal' printing, non-nil means
12707 `upside-down' printing (that is, the page is rotated by 180 degrees).
12708
12709 The variable `ps-selected-pages' specifies which pages to print. If
12710 it's nil, all pages are printed. If it's a list, list elements may be
12711 integers specifying a single page to print, or cons cells (FROM . TO)
12712 specifying to print from page FROM to TO. Invalid list elements, that
12713 is integers smaller than one, or elements whose FROM is greater than
12714 its TO, are ignored.
12715
12716 The variable `ps-even-or-odd-pages' specifies how to print even/odd
12717 pages. Valid values are:
12718
12719 nil print all pages.
12720
12721 `even-page' print only even pages.
12722
12723 `odd-page' print only odd pages.
12724
12725 `even-sheet' print only even sheets.
12726 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
12727 `even-page', but for values greater than 1, it'll
12728 print only the even sheet of paper.
12729
12730 `odd-sheet' print only odd sheets.
12731 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
12732 `odd-page'; but for values greater than 1, it'll print
12733 only the odd sheet of paper.
12734
12735 Any other value is treated as nil.
12736
12737 If you set `ps-selected-pages' (see there for documentation), pages
12738 are filtered by `ps-selected-pages', and then by
12739 `ps-even-or-odd-pages'. For example, if we have:
12740
12741 (setq ps-selected-pages '(1 4 (6 . 10) (12 . 16) 20))
12742
12743 and we combine this with `ps-even-or-odd-pages' and
12744 `ps-n-up-printing', we get:
12745
12746 `ps-n-up-printing' = 1:
12747 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
12748 nil 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20
12749 even-page 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
12750 odd-page 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
12751 even-sheet 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
12752 odd-sheet 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
12753
12754 `ps-n-up-printing' = 2:
12755 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
12756 nil 1/4, 6/7, 8/9, 10/12, 13/14, 15/16, 20
12757 even-page 4/6, 8/10, 12/14, 16/20
12758 odd-page 1/7, 9/13, 15
12759 even-sheet 6/7, 10/12, 15/16
12760 odd-sheet 1/4, 8/9, 13/14, 20
12761
12762 *** Miscellany (subgroup)
12763
12764 The variable `ps-error-handler-message' specifies where error handler
12765 messages should be sent.
12766
12767 It is also possible to add a user-defined PostScript prologue code in
12768 front of all generated prologue code by setting the variable
12769 `ps-user-defined-prologue'.
12770
12771 The variable `ps-line-number-font' specifies the font for line numbers.
12772
12773 The variable `ps-line-number-font-size' specifies the font size in
12774 points for line numbers.
12775
12776 The variable `ps-line-number-color' specifies the color for line
12777 numbers. See `ps-zebra-color' for documentation.
12778
12779 The variable `ps-line-number-step' specifies the interval in which
12780 line numbers are printed. For example, if `ps-line-number-step' is set
12781 to 2, the printing will look like:
12782
12783 1 one line
12784 one line
12785 3 one line
12786 one line
12787 5 one line
12788 one line
12789 ...
12790
12791 Valid values are:
12792
12793 integer an integer specifying the interval in which line numbers are
12794 printed. If it's smaller than or equal to zero, 1
12795 is used.
12796
12797 `zebra' specifies that only the line number of the first line in a
12798 zebra stripe is to be printed.
12799
12800 Any other value is treated as `zebra'.
12801
12802 The variable `ps-line-number-start' specifies the starting point in
12803 the interval given by `ps-line-number-step'. For example, if
12804 `ps-line-number-step' is set to 3, and `ps-line-number-start' is set to
12805 3, the output will look like:
12806
12807 one line
12808 one line
12809 3 one line
12810 one line
12811 one line
12812 6 one line
12813 one line
12814 one line
12815 9 one line
12816 one line
12817 ...
12818
12819 The variable `ps-postscript-code-directory' specifies the directory
12820 where the PostScript prologue file used by ps-print is found.
12821
12822 The variable `ps-line-spacing' determines the line spacing in points,
12823 for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
12824 `ps-font-size').
12825
12826 The variable `ps-paragraph-spacing' determines the paragraph spacing,
12827 in points, for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
12828 `ps-font-size').
12829
12830 The variable `ps-paragraph-regexp' specifies the paragraph delimiter.
12831
12832 The variable `ps-begin-cut-regexp' and `ps-end-cut-regexp' specify the
12833 start and end of a region to cut out when printing.
12834
12835 ** hideshow changes.
12836
12837 *** now supports hiding of blocks of single line comments (like // for
12838 C++, ; for lisp).
12839
12840 *** Support for java-mode added.
12841
12842 *** When doing `hs-hide-all' it is now possible to also hide the comments
12843 in the file if `hs-hide-comments-when-hiding-all' is set.
12844
12845 *** The new function `hs-hide-initial-comment' hides the comments at
12846 the beginning of the files. Finally those huge RCS logs don't stay in your
12847 way! This is run by default when entering the `hs-minor-mode'.
12848
12849 *** Now uses overlays instead of `selective-display', so is more
12850 robust and a lot faster.
12851
12852 *** A block beginning can span multiple lines.
12853
12854 *** The new variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' if t, directs hideshow
12855 to show only the beginning of a block when it is hidden. See the
12856 documentation for more details.
12857
12858 ** Changes in Enriched mode.
12859
12860 *** When you visit a file in enriched-mode, Emacs will make sure it is
12861 filled to the current fill-column. This behavior is now independent
12862 of the size of the window. When you save the file, the fill-column in
12863 use is stored as well, so that the whole buffer need not be refilled
12864 the next time unless the fill-column is different.
12865
12866 *** use-hard-newlines is now a minor mode. When it is enabled, Emacs
12867 distinguishes between hard and soft newlines, and treats hard newlines
12868 as paragraph boundaries. Otherwise all newlines inserted are marked
12869 as soft, and paragraph boundaries are determined solely from the text.
12870
12871 ** Font Lock mode
12872
12873 *** Custom support
12874
12875 The variables font-lock-face-attributes, font-lock-display-type and
12876 font-lock-background-mode are now obsolete; the recommended way to specify the
12877 faces to use for Font Lock mode is with M-x customize-group on the new custom
12878 group font-lock-highlighting-faces. If you set font-lock-face-attributes in
12879 your ~/.emacs file, Font Lock mode will respect its value. However, you should
12880 consider converting from setting that variable to using M-x customize.
12881
12882 You can still use X resources to specify Font Lock face appearances.
12883
12884 *** Maximum decoration
12885
12886 Fontification now uses the maximum level of decoration supported by
12887 default. Previously, fontification used a mode-specific default level
12888 of decoration, which is typically the minimum level of decoration
12889 supported. You can set font-lock-maximum-decoration to nil
12890 to get the old behavior.
12891
12892 *** New support
12893
12894 Support is now provided for Java, Objective-C, AWK and SIMULA modes.
12895
12896 Note that Font Lock mode can be turned on without knowing exactly what modes
12897 support Font Lock mode, via the command global-font-lock-mode.
12898
12899 *** Configurable support
12900
12901 Support for C, C++, Objective-C and Java can be more easily configured for
12902 additional types and classes via the new variables c-font-lock-extra-types,
12903 c++-font-lock-extra-types, objc-font-lock-extra-types and, you guessed it,
12904 java-font-lock-extra-types. These value of each of these variables should be a
12905 list of regexps matching the extra type names. For example, the default value
12906 of c-font-lock-extra-types is ("\\sw+_t") which means fontification follows the
12907 convention that C type names end in _t. This results in slower fontification.
12908
12909 Of course, you can change the variables that specify fontification in whatever
12910 way you wish, typically by adding regexps. However, these new variables make
12911 it easier to make specific and common changes for the fontification of types.
12912
12913 *** Adding highlighting patterns to existing support
12914
12915 You can use the new function font-lock-add-keywords to add your own
12916 highlighting patterns, such as for project-local or user-specific constructs,
12917 for any mode.
12918
12919 For example, to highlight `FIXME:' words in C comments, put:
12920
12921 (font-lock-add-keywords 'c-mode '(("\\<FIXME:" 0 font-lock-warning-face t)))
12922
12923 in your ~/.emacs.
12924
12925 *** New faces
12926
12927 Font Lock now defines two new faces, font-lock-builtin-face and
12928 font-lock-warning-face. These are intended to highlight builtin keywords,
12929 distinct from a language's normal keywords, and objects that should be brought
12930 to user attention, respectively. Various modes now use these new faces.
12931
12932 *** Changes to fast-lock support mode
12933
12934 The fast-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now process
12935 cache files silently. You can use the new variable fast-lock-verbose, in the
12936 same way as font-lock-verbose, to control this feature.
12937
12938 *** Changes to lazy-lock support mode
12939
12940 The lazy-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now fontify
12941 according to the true syntactic context relative to other lines. You can use
12942 the new variable lazy-lock-defer-contextually to control this feature. If
12943 non-nil, changes to the buffer will cause subsequent lines in the buffer to be
12944 refontified after lazy-lock-defer-time seconds of idle time. If nil, then only
12945 the modified lines will be refontified; this is the same as the previous Lazy
12946 Lock mode behavior and the behavior of Font Lock mode.
12947
12948 This feature is useful in modes where strings or comments can span lines.
12949 For example, if a string or comment terminating character is deleted, then if
12950 this feature is enabled subsequent lines in the buffer will be correctly
12951 refontified to reflect their new syntactic context. Previously, only the line
12952 containing the deleted character would be refontified and you would have to use
12953 the command M-o M-o (font-lock-fontify-block) to refontify some lines.
12954
12955 As a consequence of this new feature, two other variables have changed:
12956
12957 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-driven' is renamed `lazy-lock-defer-on-scrolling'.
12958 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-time' can now only be a time, i.e., a number.
12959 Buffer modes for which on-the-fly deferral applies can be specified via the
12960 new variable `lazy-lock-defer-on-the-fly'.
12961
12962 If you set these variables in your ~/.emacs, then you may have to change those
12963 settings.
12964
12965 ** Ada mode changes.
12966
12967 *** There is now better support for using find-file.el with Ada mode.
12968 If you switch between spec and body, the cursor stays in the same
12969 procedure (modulo overloading). If a spec has no body file yet, but
12970 you try to switch to its body file, Ada mode now generates procedure
12971 stubs.
12972
12973 *** There are two new commands:
12974 - `ada-make-local' : invokes gnatmake on the current buffer
12975 - `ada-check-syntax' : check syntax of current buffer.
12976
12977 The user options `ada-compiler-make', `ada-make-options',
12978 `ada-language-version', `ada-compiler-syntax-check', and
12979 `ada-compile-options' are used within these commands.
12980
12981 *** Ada mode can now work with Outline minor mode. The outline level
12982 is calculated from the indenting, not from syntactic constructs.
12983 Outlining does not work if your code is not correctly indented.
12984
12985 *** The new function `ada-gnat-style' converts the buffer to the style of
12986 formatting used in GNAT. It places two blanks after a comment start,
12987 places one blank between a word end and an opening '(', and puts one
12988 space between a comma and the beginning of a word.
12989
12990 ** Scheme mode changes.
12991
12992 *** Scheme mode indentation now uses many of the facilities of Lisp
12993 mode; therefore, the variables to customize it are the variables used
12994 for Lisp mode which have names starting with `lisp-'. The variables
12995 with names starting with `scheme-' which used to do this no longer
12996 have any effect.
12997
12998 If you want to use different indentation for Scheme and Lisp, this is
12999 still possible, but now you must do it by adding a hook to
13000 scheme-mode-hook, which could work by setting the `lisp-' indentation
13001 variables as buffer-local variables.
13002
13003 *** DSSSL mode is a variant of Scheme mode, for editing DSSSL scripts.
13004 Use M-x dsssl-mode.
13005
13006 ** Changes to the emacsclient program
13007
13008 *** If a socket can't be found, and environment variables LOGNAME or
13009 USER are set, emacsclient now looks for a socket based on the UID
13010 associated with the name. That is an emacsclient running as root
13011 can connect to an Emacs server started by a non-root user.
13012
13013 *** The emacsclient program now accepts an option --no-wait which tells
13014 it to return immediately without waiting for you to "finish" the
13015 buffer in Emacs.
13016
13017 *** The new option --alternate-editor allows to specify an editor to
13018 use if Emacs is not running. The environment variable
13019 ALTERNATE_EDITOR can be used for the same effect; the command line
13020 option takes precedence.
13021
13022 ** M-x eldoc-mode enables a minor mode in which the echo area
13023 constantly shows the parameter list for function being called at point
13024 (in Emacs Lisp and Lisp Interaction modes only).
13025
13026 ** C-x n d now runs the new command narrow-to-defun,
13027 which narrows the accessible parts of the buffer to just
13028 the current defun.
13029
13030 ** Emacs now handles the `--' argument in the standard way; all
13031 following arguments are treated as ordinary file names.
13032
13033 ** On MSDOS and Windows, the bookmark file is now called _emacs.bmk,
13034 and the saved desktop file is now called _emacs.desktop (truncated if
13035 necessary).
13036
13037 ** When you kill a buffer that visits a file,
13038 if there are any registers that save positions in the file,
13039 these register values no longer become completely useless.
13040 If you try to go to such a register with C-x j, then you are
13041 asked whether to visit the file again. If you say yes,
13042 it visits the file and then goes to the same position.
13043
13044 ** When you visit a file that changes frequently outside Emacs--for
13045 example, a log of output from a process that continues to run--it may
13046 be useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you whenever
13047 you visit the file afresh with C-x C-f.
13048
13049 You can request this behavior for certain files by setting the
13050 variable revert-without-query to a list of regular expressions. If a
13051 file's name matches any of these regular expressions, find-file and
13052 revert-buffer revert the buffer without asking for permission--but
13053 only if you have not edited the buffer text yourself.
13054
13055 ** set-default-font has been renamed to set-frame-font
13056 since it applies only to the current frame.
13057
13058 ** In TeX mode, you can use the variable tex-main-file to specify the
13059 file for tex-file to run TeX on. (By default, tex-main-file is nil,
13060 and tex-file runs TeX on the current visited file.)
13061
13062 This is useful when you are editing a document that consists of
13063 multiple files. In each of the included files, you can set up a local
13064 variable list which specifies the top-level file of your document for
13065 tex-main-file. Then tex-file will run TeX on the whole document
13066 instead of just the file you are editing.
13067
13068 ** RefTeX mode
13069
13070 RefTeX mode is a new minor mode with special support for \label, \ref
13071 and \cite macros in LaTeX documents. RefTeX distinguishes labels of
13072 different environments (equation, figure, ...) and has full support for
13073 multifile documents. To use it, select a buffer with a LaTeX document and
13074 turn the mode on with M-x reftex-mode. Here are the main user commands:
13075
13076 C-c ( reftex-label
13077 Creates a label semi-automatically. RefTeX is context sensitive and
13078 knows which kind of label is needed.
13079
13080 C-c ) reftex-reference
13081 Offers in a menu all labels in the document, along with context of the
13082 label definition. The selected label is referenced as \ref{LABEL}.
13083
13084 C-c [ reftex-citation
13085 Prompts for a regular expression and displays a list of matching BibTeX
13086 database entries. The selected entry is cited with a \cite{KEY} macro.
13087
13088 C-c & reftex-view-crossref
13089 Views the cross reference of a \ref or \cite command near point.
13090
13091 C-c = reftex-toc
13092 Shows a table of contents of the (multifile) document. From there you
13093 can quickly jump to every section.
13094
13095 Under X, RefTeX installs a "Ref" menu in the menu bar, with additional
13096 commands. Press `?' to get help when a prompt mentions this feature.
13097 Full documentation and customization examples are in the file
13098 reftex.el. You can use the finder to view the file documentation:
13099 C-h p --> tex --> reftex.el
13100
13101 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
13102
13103 *** Info documentation is now available.
13104
13105 *** Don't allow parentheses in string constants anymore. This confused
13106 both the BibTeX program and Emacs BibTeX mode.
13107
13108 *** Renamed variable bibtex-mode-user-optional-fields to
13109 bibtex-user-optional-fields.
13110
13111 *** Removed variable bibtex-include-OPTannote
13112 (use bibtex-user-optional-fields instead).
13113
13114 *** New interactive functions to copy and kill fields and complete
13115 entries to the BibTeX kill ring, from where they can be yanked back by
13116 appropriate functions.
13117
13118 *** New interactive functions for repositioning and marking of
13119 entries. They are bound by default to C-M-l and C-M-h.
13120
13121 *** New hook bibtex-clean-entry-hook. It is called after entry has
13122 been cleaned.
13123
13124 *** New variable bibtex-field-delimiters, which replaces variables
13125 bibtex-field-{left|right}-delimiter.
13126
13127 *** New variable bibtex-entry-delimiters to determine how entries
13128 shall be delimited.
13129
13130 *** Allow preinitialization of fields. See documentation of
13131 bibtex-user-optional-fields, bibtex-entry-field-alist, and
13132 bibtex-include-OPTkey for details.
13133
13134 *** Book and InBook entries require either an author or an editor
13135 field. This is now supported by bibtex.el. Alternative fields are
13136 prefixed with `ALT'.
13137
13138 *** New variable bibtex-entry-format, which replaces variable
13139 bibtex-clean-entry-zap-empty-opts and allows specification of many
13140 formatting options performed on cleaning an entry (see variable
13141 documentation).
13142
13143 *** Even more control on how automatic keys are generated. See
13144 documentation of bibtex-generate-autokey for details. Transcriptions
13145 for foreign languages other than German are now handled, too.
13146
13147 *** New boolean user option bibtex-comma-after-last-field to decide if
13148 comma should be inserted at end of last field.
13149
13150 *** New boolean user option bibtex-align-at-equal-sign to determine if
13151 alignment should be made at left side of field contents or at equal
13152 signs. New user options to control entry layout (e.g. indentation).
13153
13154 *** New function bibtex-fill-entry to realign entries.
13155
13156 *** New function bibtex-reformat to reformat region or buffer.
13157
13158 *** New function bibtex-convert-alien to convert a BibTeX database
13159 from alien sources.
13160
13161 *** New function bibtex-complete-key (similar to bibtex-complete-string)
13162 to complete prefix to a key defined in buffer. Mainly useful in
13163 crossref entries.
13164
13165 *** New function bibtex-count-entries to count entries in buffer or
13166 region.
13167
13168 *** Added support for imenu.
13169
13170 *** The function `bibtex-validate' now checks current region instead
13171 of buffer if mark is active. Now it shows all errors of buffer in a
13172 `compilation mode' buffer. You can use the normal commands (e.g.
13173 `next-error') for compilation modes to jump to errors.
13174
13175 *** New variable `bibtex-string-file-path' to determine where the files
13176 from `bibtex-string-files' are searched.
13177
13178 ** Iso Accents mode now supports Latin-3 as an alternative.
13179
13180 ** The command next-error now opens blocks hidden by hideshow.
13181
13182 ** The function using-unix-filesystems has been replaced by the
13183 functions add-untranslated-filesystem and remove-untranslated-filesystem.
13184 Each of these functions takes the name of a drive letter or directory
13185 as an argument.
13186
13187 When a filesystem is added as untranslated, all files on it are read
13188 and written in binary mode (no cr/lf translation is performed).
13189
13190 ** browse-url changes
13191
13192 *** New methods for: Grail (browse-url-generic), MMM (browse-url-mmm),
13193 Lynx in a separate xterm (browse-url-lynx-xterm) or in an Emacs window
13194 (browse-url-lynx-emacs), remote W3 (browse-url-w3-gnudoit), generic
13195 non-remote-controlled browsers (browse-url-generic) and associated
13196 customization variables.
13197
13198 *** New commands `browse-url-of-region' and `browse-url'.
13199
13200 *** URLs marked up with <URL:...> (RFC1738) work if broken across
13201 lines. Browsing methods can be associated with URL regexps
13202 (e.g. mailto: URLs) via `browse-url-browser-function'.
13203
13204 ** Changes in Ediff
13205
13206 *** Clicking Mouse-2 on a brief command description in Ediff control panel
13207 pops up the Info file for this command.
13208
13209 *** There is now a variable, ediff-autostore-merges, which controls whether
13210 the result of a merge is saved in a file. By default, this is done only when
13211 merge is done from a session group (eg, when merging files in two different
13212 directories).
13213
13214 *** Since Emacs 19.31 (this hasn't been announced before), Ediff can compare
13215 and merge groups of files residing in different directories, or revisions of
13216 files in the same directory.
13217
13218 *** Since Emacs 19.31, Ediff can apply multi-file patches interactively.
13219 The patches must be in the context format or GNU unified format. (The bug
13220 related to the GNU format has now been fixed.)
13221
13222 ** Changes in Viper
13223
13224 *** The startup file is now .viper instead of .vip
13225 *** All variable/function names have been changed to start with viper-
13226 instead of vip-.
13227 *** C-\ now simulates the meta-key in all Viper states.
13228 *** C-z in Insert state now escapes to Vi for the duration of the next
13229 Viper command. In Vi and Insert states, C-z behaves as before.
13230 *** C-c \ escapes to Vi for one command if Viper is in Insert or Emacs states.
13231 *** _ is no longer the meta-key in Vi state.
13232 *** The variable viper-insert-state-cursor-color can be used to change cursor
13233 color when Viper is in insert state.
13234 *** If search lands the cursor near the top or the bottom of the window,
13235 Viper pulls the window up or down to expose more context. The variable
13236 viper-adjust-window-after-search controls this behavior.
13237
13238 ** Etags changes.
13239
13240 *** In C, C++, Objective C and Java, Etags tags global variables by
13241 default. The resulting tags files are inflated by 30% on average.
13242 Use --no-globals to turn this feature off. Etags can also tag
13243 variables which are members of structure-like constructs, but it does
13244 not by default. Use --members to turn this feature on.
13245
13246 *** C++ member functions are now recognized as tags.
13247
13248 *** Java is tagged like C++. In addition, "extends" and "implements"
13249 constructs are tagged. Files are recognised by the extension .java.
13250
13251 *** Etags can now handle programs written in Postscript. Files are
13252 recognised by the extensions .ps and .pdb (Postscript with C syntax).
13253 In Postscript, tags are lines that start with a slash.
13254
13255 *** Etags now handles Objective C and Objective C++ code. The usual C and
13256 C++ tags are recognized in these languages; in addition, etags
13257 recognizes special Objective C syntax for classes, class categories,
13258 methods and protocols.
13259
13260 *** Etags also handles Cobol. Files are recognised by the extension
13261 .cobol. The tagged lines are those containing a word that begins in
13262 column 8 and ends in a full stop, i.e. anything that could be a
13263 paragraph name.
13264
13265 *** Regexps in Etags now support intervals, as in ed or grep. The syntax of
13266 an interval is \{M,N\}, and it means to match the preceding expression
13267 at least M times and as many as N times.
13268
13269 ** The format for specifying a custom format for time-stamp to insert
13270 in files has changed slightly.
13271
13272 With the new enhancements to the functionality of format-time-string,
13273 time-stamp-format will change to be eventually compatible with it.
13274 This conversion is being done in two steps to maintain compatibility
13275 with old time-stamp-format values.
13276
13277 In the new scheme, alternate case is signified by the number-sign
13278 (`#') modifier, rather than changing the case of the format character.
13279 This feature is as yet incompletely implemented for compatibility
13280 reasons.
13281
13282 In the old time-stamp-format, all numeric fields defaulted to their
13283 natural width. (With format-time-string, each format has a
13284 fixed-width default.) In this version, you can specify the colon
13285 (`:') modifier to a numeric conversion to mean "give me the historical
13286 time-stamp-format width default." Do not use colon if you are
13287 specifying an explicit width, as in "%02d".
13288
13289 Numbers are no longer truncated to the requested width, except in the
13290 case of "%02y", which continues to give a two-digit year. Digit
13291 truncation probably wasn't being used for anything else anyway.
13292
13293 The new formats will work with old versions of Emacs. New formats are
13294 being recommended now to allow time-stamp-format to change in the
13295 future to be compatible with format-time-string. The new forms being
13296 recommended now will continue to work then.
13297
13298 See the documentation string for the variable time-stamp-format for
13299 details.
13300
13301 ** There are some additional major modes:
13302
13303 dcl-mode, for editing VMS DCL files.
13304 m4-mode, for editing files of m4 input.
13305 meta-mode, for editing MetaFont and MetaPost source files.
13306
13307 ** In Shell mode, the command shell-copy-environment-variable lets you
13308 copy the value of a specified environment variable from the subshell
13309 into Emacs.
13310
13311 ** New Lisp packages include:
13312
13313 *** battery.el displays battery status for laptops.
13314
13315 *** M-x bruce (named after Lenny Bruce) is a program that might
13316 be used for adding some indecent words to your email.
13317
13318 *** M-x crisp-mode enables an emulation for the CRiSP editor.
13319
13320 *** M-x dirtrack arranges for better tracking of directory changes
13321 in shell buffers.
13322
13323 *** The new library elint.el provides for linting of Emacs Lisp code.
13324 See the documentation for `elint-initialize', `elint-current-buffer'
13325 and `elint-defun'.
13326
13327 *** M-x expand-add-abbrevs defines a special kind of abbrev which is
13328 meant for programming constructs. These abbrevs expand like ordinary
13329 ones, when you type SPC, but only at the end of a line and not within
13330 strings or comments.
13331
13332 These abbrevs can act as templates: you can define places within an
13333 abbrev for insertion of additional text. Once you expand the abbrev,
13334 you can then use C-x a p and C-x a n to move back and forth to these
13335 insertion points. Thus you can conveniently insert additional text
13336 at these points.
13337
13338 *** filecache.el remembers the location of files so that you
13339 can visit them by short forms of their names.
13340
13341 *** find-func.el lets you find the definition of the user-loaded
13342 Emacs Lisp function at point.
13343
13344 *** M-x handwrite converts text to a "handwritten" picture.
13345
13346 *** M-x iswitchb-buffer is a command for switching to a buffer, much like
13347 switch-buffer, but it reads the argument in a more helpful way.
13348
13349 *** M-x landmark implements a neural network for landmark learning.
13350
13351 *** M-x locate provides a convenient interface to the `locate' program.
13352
13353 *** M4 mode is a new mode for editing files of m4 input.
13354
13355 *** mantemp.el creates C++ manual template instantiations
13356 from the GCC error messages which indicate which instantiations are needed.
13357
13358 *** mouse-copy.el provides a one-click copy and move feature.
13359 You can drag a region with M-mouse-1, and it is automatically
13360 inserted at point. M-Shift-mouse-1 deletes the text from its
13361 original place after inserting the copy.
13362
13363 *** mouse-drag.el lets you do scrolling by dragging Mouse-2
13364 on the buffer.
13365
13366 You click the mouse and move; that distance either translates into the
13367 velocity to scroll (with mouse-drag-throw) or the distance to scroll
13368 (with mouse-drag-drag). Horizontal scrolling is enabled when needed.
13369
13370 Enable mouse-drag with:
13371 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-throw)
13372 -or-
13373 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-drag)
13374
13375 *** mspools.el is useful for determining which mail folders have
13376 mail waiting to be read in them. It works with procmail.
13377
13378 *** Octave mode is a major mode for editing files of input for Octave.
13379 It comes with a facility for communicating with an Octave subprocess.
13380
13381 *** ogonek
13382
13383 The ogonek package provides functions for changing the coding of
13384 Polish diacritic characters in buffers. Codings known from various
13385 platforms are supported such as ISO8859-2, Mazovia, IBM Latin2, and
13386 TeX. For example, you can change the coding from Mazovia to
13387 ISO8859-2. Another example is a change of coding from ISO8859-2 to
13388 prefix notation (in which `/a' stands for the aogonek character, for
13389 instance) and vice versa.
13390
13391 To use this package load it using
13392 M-x load-library [enter] ogonek
13393 Then, you may get an explanation by calling one of
13394 M-x ogonek-jak -- in Polish
13395 M-x ogonek-how -- in English
13396 The info specifies the commands and variables provided as well as the
13397 ways of customization in `.emacs'.
13398
13399 *** Interface to ph.
13400
13401 Emacs provides a client interface to CCSO Nameservers (ph/qi)
13402
13403 The CCSO nameserver is used in many universities to provide directory
13404 services about people. ph.el provides a convenient Emacs interface to
13405 these servers.
13406
13407 *** uce.el is useful for replying to unsolicited commercial email.
13408
13409 *** vcursor.el implements a "virtual cursor" feature.
13410 You can move the virtual cursor with special commands
13411 while the real cursor does not move.
13412
13413 *** webjump.el is a "hot list" package which you can set up
13414 for visiting your favorite web sites.
13415
13416 *** M-x winner-mode is a minor mode which saves window configurations,
13417 so you can move back to other configurations that you have recently used.
13418
13419 ** movemail change
13420
13421 Movemail no longer needs to be installed setuid root in order for POP
13422 mail retrieval to function properly. This is because it no longer
13423 supports the RPOP (reserved-port POP) protocol; instead, it uses the
13424 user's POP password to authenticate to the mail server.
13425
13426 This change was made earlier, but not reported in NEWS before.
13427 \f
13428 * Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
13429
13430 ** Changes in handling MS-DOS/MS-Windows text files.
13431
13432 Emacs handles three different conventions for representing
13433 end-of-line: CRLF for MSDOS, LF for Unix and GNU, and CR (used on the
13434 Macintosh). Emacs determines which convention is used in a specific
13435 file based on the contents of that file (except for certain special
13436 file names), and when it saves the file, it uses the same convention.
13437
13438 To save the file and change the end-of-line convention, you can use
13439 C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) to specify a different
13440 coding system for the buffer. Then, when you save the file, the newly
13441 specified coding system will take effect. For example, to save with
13442 LF, specify undecided-unix (or some other ...-unix coding system); to
13443 save with CRLF, specify undecided-dos.
13444 \f
13445 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 20.1
13446
13447 ** Byte-compiled files made with Emacs 20 will, in general, work in
13448 Emacs 19 as well, as long as the source code runs in Emacs 19. And
13449 vice versa: byte-compiled files made with Emacs 19 should also run in
13450 Emacs 20, as long as the program itself works in Emacs 20.
13451
13452 ** Windows-specific functions and variables have been renamed
13453 to start with w32- instead of win32-.
13454
13455 In hacker language, calling something a "win" is a form of praise. We
13456 don't want to praise a non-free Microsoft system, so we don't call it
13457 "win".
13458
13459 ** Basic Lisp changes
13460
13461 *** A symbol whose name starts with a colon now automatically
13462 evaluates to itself. Therefore such a symbol can be used as a constant.
13463
13464 *** The defined purpose of `defconst' has been changed. It should now
13465 be used only for values that should not be changed whether by a program
13466 or by the user.
13467
13468 The actual behavior of defconst has not been changed.
13469
13470 *** There are new macros `when' and `unless'
13471
13472 (when CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION (progn BODY...))
13473 (unless CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION nil BODY...)
13474
13475 *** Emacs now defines functions caar, cadr, cdar and cddr with their
13476 usual Lisp meanings. For example, caar returns the car of the car of
13477 its argument.
13478
13479 *** equal, when comparing strings, now ignores their text properties.
13480
13481 *** The new function `functionp' tests whether an object is a function.
13482
13483 *** arrayp now returns t for char-tables and bool-vectors.
13484
13485 *** Certain primitives which use characters (as integers) now get an
13486 error if the integer is not a valid character code. These primitives
13487 include insert-char, char-to-string, and the %c construct in the
13488 `format' function.
13489
13490 *** The `require' function now insists on adding a suffix, either .el
13491 or .elc, to the file name. Thus, (require 'foo) will not use a file
13492 whose name is just foo. It insists on foo.el or foo.elc.
13493
13494 *** The `autoload' function, when the file name does not contain
13495 either a directory name or the suffix .el or .elc, insists on
13496 adding one of these suffixes.
13497
13498 *** string-to-number now takes an optional second argument BASE
13499 which specifies the base to use when converting an integer.
13500 If BASE is omitted, base 10 is used.
13501
13502 We have not implemented other radices for floating point numbers,
13503 because that would be much more work and does not seem useful.
13504
13505 *** substring now handles vectors as well as strings.
13506
13507 *** The Common Lisp function eql is no longer defined normally.
13508 You must load the `cl' library to define it.
13509
13510 *** The new macro `with-current-buffer' lets you evaluate an expression
13511 conveniently with a different current buffer. It looks like this:
13512
13513 (with-current-buffer BUFFER BODY-FORMS...)
13514
13515 BUFFER is the expression that says which buffer to use.
13516 BODY-FORMS say what to do in that buffer.
13517
13518 *** The new primitive `save-current-buffer' saves and restores the
13519 choice of current buffer, like `save-excursion', but without saving or
13520 restoring the value of point or the mark. `with-current-buffer'
13521 works using `save-current-buffer'.
13522
13523 *** The new macro `with-temp-file' lets you do some work in a new buffer and
13524 write the output to a specified file. Like `progn', it returns the value
13525 of the last form.
13526
13527 *** The new macro `with-temp-buffer' lets you do some work in a new buffer,
13528 which is discarded after use. Like `progn', it returns the value of the
13529 last form. If you wish to return the buffer contents, use (buffer-string)
13530 as the last form.
13531
13532 *** The new function split-string takes a string, splits it at certain
13533 characters, and returns a list of the substrings in between the
13534 matches.
13535
13536 For example, (split-string "foo bar lose" " +") returns ("foo" "bar" "lose").
13537
13538 *** The new macro with-output-to-string executes some Lisp expressions
13539 with standard-output set up so that all output feeds into a string.
13540 Then it returns that string.
13541
13542 For example, if the current buffer name is `foo',
13543
13544 (with-output-to-string
13545 (princ "The buffer is ")
13546 (princ (buffer-name)))
13547
13548 returns "The buffer is foo".
13549
13550 ** Non-ASCII characters are now supported, if enable-multibyte-characters
13551 is non-nil.
13552
13553 These characters have character codes above 256. When inserted in the
13554 buffer or stored in a string, they are represented as multibyte
13555 characters that occupy several buffer positions each.
13556
13557 *** When enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, a single character in
13558 a buffer or string can be two or more bytes (as many as four).
13559
13560 Buffers and strings are still made up of unibyte elements;
13561 character positions and string indices are always measured in bytes.
13562 Therefore, moving forward one character can increase the buffer
13563 position by 2, 3 or 4. The function forward-char moves by whole
13564 characters, and therefore is no longer equivalent to
13565 (lambda (n) (goto-char (+ (point) n))).
13566
13567 ASCII characters (codes 0 through 127) are still single bytes, always.
13568 Sequences of byte values 128 through 255 are used to represent
13569 non-ASCII characters. These sequences are called "multibyte
13570 characters".
13571
13572 The first byte of a multibyte character is always in the range 128
13573 through 159 (octal 0200 through 0237). These values are called
13574 "leading codes". The second and subsequent bytes are always in the
13575 range 160 through 255 (octal 0240 through 0377). The first byte, the
13576 leading code, determines how many bytes long the sequence is.
13577
13578 *** The function forward-char moves over characters, and therefore
13579 (forward-char 1) may increase point by more than 1 if it moves over a
13580 multibyte character. Likewise, delete-char always deletes a
13581 character, which may be more than one buffer position.
13582
13583 This means that some Lisp programs, which assume that a character is
13584 always one buffer position, need to be changed.
13585
13586 However, all ASCII characters are always one buffer position.
13587
13588 *** The regexp [\200-\377] no longer matches all non-ASCII characters,
13589 because when enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, these characters
13590 have codes that are not in the range octal 200 to octal 377. However,
13591 the regexp [^\000-\177] does match all non-ASCII characters,
13592 guaranteed.
13593
13594 *** The function char-boundary-p returns non-nil if position POS is
13595 between two characters in the buffer (not in the middle of a
13596 character).
13597
13598 When the value is non-nil, it says what kind of character follows POS:
13599
13600 0 if POS is at an ASCII character or at the end of range,
13601 1 if POS is before a 2-byte length multi-byte form,
13602 2 if POS is at a head of 3-byte length multi-byte form,
13603 3 if POS is at a head of 4-byte length multi-byte form,
13604 4 if POS is at a head of multi-byte form of a composite character.
13605
13606 *** The function char-bytes returns how many bytes the character CHAR uses.
13607
13608 *** Strings can contain multibyte characters. The function
13609 `length' returns the string length counting bytes, which may be
13610 more than the number of characters.
13611
13612 You can include a multibyte character in a string constant by writing
13613 it literally. You can also represent it with a hex escape,
13614 \xNNNNNNN..., using as many digits as necessary. Any character which
13615 is not a valid hex digit terminates this construct. If you want to
13616 follow it with a character that is a hex digit, write backslash and
13617 newline in between; that will terminate the hex escape.
13618
13619 *** The function concat-chars takes arguments which are characters
13620 and returns a string containing those characters.
13621
13622 *** The function sref access a multibyte character in a string.
13623 (sref STRING INDX) returns the character in STRING at INDEX. INDEX
13624 counts from zero. If INDEX is at a position in the middle of a
13625 character, sref signals an error.
13626
13627 *** The function chars-in-string returns the number of characters
13628 in a string. This is less than the length of the string, if the
13629 string contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
13630
13631 *** The function chars-in-region returns the number of characters
13632 in a region from BEG to END. This is less than (- END BEG) if the
13633 region contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
13634
13635 *** The function string-to-list converts a string to a list of
13636 the characters in it. string-to-vector converts a string
13637 to a vector of the characters in it.
13638
13639 *** The function store-substring alters part of the contents
13640 of a string. You call it as follows:
13641
13642 (store-substring STRING IDX OBJ)
13643
13644 This says to alter STRING, by storing OBJ starting at index IDX in
13645 STRING. OBJ may be either a character or a (smaller) string.
13646 This function really does alter the contents of STRING.
13647 Since it is impossible to change the length of an existing string,
13648 it is an error if OBJ doesn't fit within STRING's actual length.
13649
13650 *** char-width returns the width (in columns) of the character CHAR,
13651 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
13652
13653 *** string-width returns the width (in columns) of the text in STRING,
13654 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
13655
13656 *** truncate-string-to-width shortens a string, if necessary,
13657 to fit within a certain number of columns. (Of course, it does
13658 not alter the string that you give it; it returns a new string
13659 which contains all or just part of the existing string.)
13660
13661 (truncate-string-to-width STR END-COLUMN &optional START-COLUMN PADDING)
13662
13663 This returns the part of STR up to column END-COLUMN.
13664
13665 The optional argument START-COLUMN specifies the starting column.
13666 If this is non-nil, then the first START-COLUMN columns of the string
13667 are not included in the resulting value.
13668
13669 The optional argument PADDING, if non-nil, is a padding character to be added
13670 at the beginning and end the resulting string, to extend it to exactly
13671 WIDTH columns. If PADDING is nil, that means do not pad; then, if STRING
13672 is narrower than WIDTH, the value is equal to STRING.
13673
13674 If PADDING and START-COLUMN are both non-nil, and if there is no clean
13675 place in STRING that corresponds to START-COLUMN (because one
13676 character extends across that column), then the padding character
13677 PADDING is added one or more times at the beginning of the result
13678 string, so that its columns line up as if it really did start at
13679 column START-COLUMN.
13680
13681 *** When the functions in the list after-change-functions are called,
13682 the third argument is the number of bytes in the pre-change text, not
13683 necessarily the number of characters. It is, in effect, the
13684 difference in buffer position between the beginning and the end of the
13685 changed text, before the change.
13686
13687 *** The characters Emacs uses are classified in various character
13688 sets, each of which has a name which is a symbol. In general there is
13689 one character set for each script, not for each language.
13690
13691 **** The function charsetp tests whether an object is a character set name.
13692
13693 **** The variable charset-list holds a list of character set names.
13694
13695 **** char-charset, given a character code, returns the name of the character
13696 set that the character belongs to. (The value is a symbol.)
13697
13698 **** split-char, given a character code, returns a list containing the
13699 name of the character set, followed by one or two byte-values
13700 which identify the character within that character set.
13701
13702 **** make-char, given a character set name and one or two subsequent
13703 byte-values, constructs a character code. This is roughly the
13704 opposite of split-char.
13705
13706 **** find-charset-region returns a list of the character sets
13707 of all the characters between BEG and END.
13708
13709 **** find-charset-string returns a list of the character sets
13710 of all the characters in a string.
13711
13712 *** Here are the Lisp facilities for working with coding systems
13713 and specifying coding systems.
13714
13715 **** The function coding-system-list returns a list of all coding
13716 system names (symbols). With optional argument t, it returns a list
13717 of all distinct base coding systems, not including variants.
13718 (Variant coding systems are those like latin-1-dos, latin-1-unix
13719 and latin-1-mac which specify the end-of-line conversion as well
13720 as what to do about code conversion.)
13721
13722 **** coding-system-p tests a symbol to see if it is a coding system
13723 name. It returns t if so, nil if not.
13724
13725 **** file-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
13726 for certain file names. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
13727 except that the PATTERN is matched against the file name.
13728
13729 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
13730 which file names the element applies to. PATTERN should be a regexp
13731 to match against a file name.
13732
13733 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
13734 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
13735 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
13736 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
13737 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
13738 specifies the coding system for encoding.
13739
13740 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
13741 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
13742
13743 **** The variable network-coding-system-alist specifies
13744 the coding system to use for network sockets.
13745
13746 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
13747 which network sockets the element applies to. PATTERN should be
13748 either a port number or a regular expression matching some network
13749 service names.
13750
13751 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
13752 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
13753 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
13754 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
13755 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
13756 specifies the coding system for encoding.
13757
13758 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
13759 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
13760
13761 **** process-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
13762 for certain subprocess. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
13763 except that the PATTERN is matched against the program name used to
13764 start the subprocess.
13765
13766 **** The variable default-process-coding-system specifies the coding
13767 systems to use for subprocess (and net connection) input and output,
13768 when nothing else specifies what to do. The value is a cons cell
13769 (OUTPUT-CODING . INPUT-CODING). OUTPUT-CODING applies to output
13770 to the subprocess, and INPUT-CODING applies to input from it.
13771
13772 **** The variable coding-system-for-write, if non-nil, specifies the
13773 coding system to use for writing a file, or for output to a synchronous
13774 subprocess.
13775
13776 It also applies to any asynchronous subprocess or network connection,
13777 but in a different way: the value of coding-system-for-write when you
13778 start the subprocess or connection affects that subprocess or
13779 connection permanently or until overridden.
13780
13781 The variable coding-system-for-write takes precedence over
13782 file-coding-system-alist, process-coding-system-alist and
13783 network-coding-system-alist, and all other methods of specifying a
13784 coding system for output. But most of the time this variable is nil.
13785 It exists so that Lisp programs can bind it to a specific coding
13786 system for one operation at a time.
13787
13788 **** coding-system-for-read applies similarly to input from
13789 files, subprocesses or network connections.
13790
13791 **** The function process-coding-system tells you what
13792 coding systems(s) an existing subprocess is using.
13793 The value is a cons cell,
13794 (DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM . ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM)
13795 where DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for decoding output from
13796 the subprocess, and ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for encoding
13797 input to the subprocess.
13798
13799 **** The function set-process-coding-system can be used to
13800 change the coding systems in use for an existing subprocess.
13801
13802 ** Emacs has a new facility to help users manage the many
13803 customization options. To make a Lisp program work with this facility,
13804 you need to use the new macros defgroup and defcustom.
13805
13806 You use defcustom instead of defvar, for defining a user option
13807 variable. The difference is that you specify two additional pieces of
13808 information (usually): the "type" which says what values are
13809 legitimate, and the "group" which specifies the hierarchy for
13810 customization.
13811
13812 Thus, instead of writing
13813
13814 (defvar foo-blurgoze nil
13815 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely.")
13816
13817 you would now write this:
13818
13819 (defcustom foo-blurgoze nil
13820 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely."
13821 :type 'boolean
13822 :group foo)
13823
13824 The type `boolean' means that this variable has only
13825 two meaningful states: nil and non-nil. Other type values
13826 describe other possibilities; see the manual for Custom
13827 for a description of them.
13828
13829 The "group" argument is used to specify a group which the option
13830 should belong to. You define a new group like this:
13831
13832 (defgroup ispell nil
13833 "Spell checking using Ispell."
13834 :group 'processes)
13835
13836 The "group" argument in defgroup specifies the parent group. The root
13837 group is called `emacs'; it should not contain any variables itself,
13838 but only other groups. The immediate subgroups of `emacs' correspond
13839 to the keywords used by C-h p. Under these subgroups come
13840 second-level subgroups that belong to individual packages.
13841
13842 Each Emacs package should have its own set of groups. A simple
13843 package should have just one group; a more complex package should
13844 have a hierarchy of its own groups. The sole or root group of a
13845 package should be a subgroup of one or more of the "keyword"
13846 first-level subgroups.
13847
13848 ** New `widget' library for inserting UI components in buffers.
13849
13850 This library, used by the new custom library, is documented in a
13851 separate manual that accompanies Emacs.
13852
13853 ** easy-mmode
13854
13855 The easy-mmode package provides macros and functions that make
13856 developing minor modes easier. Roughly, the programmer has to code
13857 only the functionality of the minor mode. All the rest--toggles,
13858 predicate, and documentation--can be done in one call to the macro
13859 `easy-mmode-define-minor-mode' (see the documentation). See also
13860 `easy-mmode-define-keymap'.
13861
13862 ** Text property changes
13863
13864 *** The `intangible' property now works on overlays as well as on a
13865 text property.
13866
13867 *** The new functions next-char-property-change and
13868 previous-char-property-change scan through the buffer looking for a
13869 place where either a text property or an overlay might change. The
13870 functions take two arguments, POSITION and LIMIT. POSITION is the
13871 starting position for the scan. LIMIT says where to stop the scan.
13872
13873 If no property change is found before LIMIT, the value is LIMIT. If
13874 LIMIT is nil, scan goes to the beginning or end of the accessible part
13875 of the buffer. If no property change is found, the value is the
13876 position of the beginning or end of the buffer.
13877
13878 *** In the `local-map' text property or overlay property, the property
13879 value can now be a symbol whose function definition is a keymap. This
13880 is an alternative to using the keymap itself.
13881
13882 ** Changes in invisibility features
13883
13884 *** Isearch can now temporarily show parts of the buffer which are
13885 hidden by an overlay with a invisible property, when the search match
13886 is inside that portion of the buffer. To enable this the overlay
13887 should have a isearch-open-invisible property which is a function that
13888 would be called having the overlay as an argument, the function should
13889 make the overlay visible.
13890
13891 During incremental search the overlays are shown by modifying the
13892 invisible and intangible properties, if beside this more actions are
13893 needed the overlay should have a isearch-open-invisible-temporary
13894 which is a function. The function is called with 2 arguments: one is
13895 the overlay and the second is nil when it should show the overlay and
13896 t when it should hide it.
13897
13898 *** add-to-invisibility-spec, remove-from-invisibility-spec
13899
13900 Modes that use overlays to hide portions of a buffer should set the
13901 invisible property of the overlay to the mode's name (or another symbol)
13902 and modify the `buffer-invisibility-spec' to include that symbol.
13903 Use `add-to-invisibility-spec' and `remove-from-invisibility-spec' to
13904 manipulate the `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
13905 Here is an example of how to do this:
13906
13907 ;; If we want to display an ellipsis:
13908 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
13909 ;; If you don't want ellipsis:
13910 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
13911
13912 ...
13913 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) 'invisible 'my-symbol)
13914
13915 ...
13916 ;; When done with the overlays:
13917 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
13918 ;; Or respectively:
13919 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
13920
13921 ** Changes in syntax parsing.
13922
13923 *** The syntax-directed buffer-scan functions (such as
13924 `parse-partial-sexp', `forward-word' and similar functions) can now
13925 obey syntax information specified by text properties, if the variable
13926 `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil.
13927
13928 If the value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is nil, the behavior
13929 is as before: the syntax-table of the current buffer is always
13930 used to determine the syntax of the character at the position.
13931
13932 When `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil, the syntax of a
13933 character in the buffer is calculated thus:
13934
13935 a) if the `syntax-table' text-property of that character
13936 is a cons, this cons becomes the syntax-type;
13937
13938 Valid values of `syntax-table' text-property are: nil, a valid
13939 syntax-table, and a valid syntax-table element, i.e.,
13940 a cons cell of the form (SYNTAX-CODE . MATCHING-CHAR).
13941
13942 b) if the character's `syntax-table' text-property
13943 is a syntax table, this syntax table is used
13944 (instead of the syntax-table of the current buffer) to
13945 determine the syntax type of the character.
13946
13947 c) otherwise the syntax-type is determined by the syntax-table
13948 of the current buffer.
13949
13950 *** The meaning of \s in regular expressions is also affected by the
13951 value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties'. The details are the same as
13952 for the syntax-directed buffer-scan functions.
13953
13954 *** There are two new syntax-codes, `!' and `|' (numeric values 14
13955 and 15). A character with a code `!' starts a comment which is ended
13956 only by another character with the same code (unless quoted). A
13957 character with a code `|' starts a string which is ended only by
13958 another character with the same code (unless quoted).
13959
13960 These codes are mainly meant for use as values of the `syntax-table'
13961 text property.
13962
13963 *** The function `parse-partial-sexp' has new semantics for the sixth
13964 arg COMMENTSTOP. If it is `syntax-table', parse stops after the start
13965 of a comment or a string, or after end of a comment or a string.
13966
13967 *** The state-list which the return value from `parse-partial-sexp'
13968 (and can also be used as an argument) now has an optional ninth
13969 element: the character address of the start of last comment or string;
13970 nil if none. The fourth and eighth elements have special values if the
13971 string/comment is started by a "!" or "|" syntax-code.
13972
13973 *** Since new features of `parse-partial-sexp' allow a complete
13974 syntactic parsing, `font-lock' no longer supports
13975 `font-lock-comment-start-regexp'.
13976
13977 ** Changes in face features
13978
13979 *** The face functions are now unconditionally defined in Emacs, even
13980 if it does not support displaying on a device that supports faces.
13981
13982 *** The function face-documentation returns the documentation string
13983 of a face (or nil if it doesn't have one).
13984
13985 *** The function face-bold-p returns t if a face should be bold.
13986 set-face-bold-p sets that flag.
13987
13988 *** The function face-italic-p returns t if a face should be italic.
13989 set-face-italic-p sets that flag.
13990
13991 *** You can now specify foreground and background colors for text
13992 by adding elements of the form (foreground-color . COLOR-NAME)
13993 and (background-color . COLOR-NAME) to the list of faces in
13994 the `face' property (either the character's text property or an
13995 overlay property).
13996
13997 This means that you no longer need to create named faces to use
13998 arbitrary colors in a Lisp package.
13999
14000 ** Changes in file-handling functions
14001
14002 *** File-access primitive functions no longer discard an extra redundant
14003 directory name from the beginning of the file name. In other words,
14004 they no longer do anything special with // or /~. That conversion
14005 is now done only in substitute-in-file-name.
14006
14007 This makes it possible for a Lisp program to open a file whose name
14008 begins with ~.
14009
14010 *** If copy-file is unable to set the date of the output file,
14011 it now signals an error with the condition file-date-error.
14012
14013 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
14014 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a list of integers.
14015
14016 *** insert-file-contents can now read from a special file,
14017 as long as the arguments VISIT and REPLACE are nil.
14018
14019 *** The RAWFILE arg to find-file-noselect, if non-nil, now suppresses
14020 character code conversion as well as other things.
14021
14022 Meanwhile, this feature does work with remote file names
14023 (formerly it did not).
14024
14025 *** Lisp packages which create temporary files should use the TMPDIR
14026 environment variable to decide which directory to put them in.
14027
14028 *** interpreter-mode-alist elements now specify regexps
14029 instead of constant strings.
14030
14031 *** expand-file-name no longer treats `//' or `/~' specially. It used
14032 to delete all the text of a file name up through the first slash of
14033 any `//' or `/~' sequence. Now it passes them straight through.
14034
14035 substitute-in-file-name continues to treat those sequences specially,
14036 in the same way as before.
14037
14038 *** The variable `format-alist' is more general now.
14039 The FROM-FN and TO-FN in a format definition can now be strings
14040 which specify shell commands to use as filters to perform conversion.
14041
14042 *** The new function access-file tries to open a file, and signals an
14043 error if that fails. If the open succeeds, access-file does nothing
14044 else, and returns nil.
14045
14046 *** The function insert-directory now signals an error if the specified
14047 directory cannot be listed.
14048
14049 ** Changes in minibuffer input
14050
14051 *** The functions read-buffer, read-variable, read-command, read-string
14052 read-file-name, read-from-minibuffer and completing-read now take an
14053 additional argument which specifies the default value. If this
14054 argument is non-nil, it should be a string; that string is used in two
14055 ways:
14056
14057 It is returned if the user enters empty input.
14058 It is available through the history command M-n.
14059
14060 *** The functions read-string, read-from-minibuffer,
14061 read-no-blanks-input and completing-read now take an additional
14062 argument INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. If this is non-nil, then the
14063 minibuffer inherits the current input method and the setting of
14064 enable-multibyte-characters from the previously current buffer.
14065
14066 In an interactive spec, you can use M instead of s to read an
14067 argument in this way.
14068
14069 *** All minibuffer input functions discard text properties
14070 from the text you enter in the minibuffer, unless the variable
14071 minibuffer-allow-text-properties is non-nil.
14072
14073 ** Echo area features
14074
14075 *** Clearing the echo area now runs the normal hook
14076 echo-area-clear-hook. Note that the echo area can be used while the
14077 minibuffer is active; in that case, the minibuffer is still active
14078 after the echo area is cleared.
14079
14080 *** The function current-message returns the message currently displayed
14081 in the echo area, or nil if there is none.
14082
14083 ** Keyboard input features
14084
14085 *** tty-erase-char is a new variable that reports which character was
14086 set up as the terminal's erase character when time Emacs was started.
14087
14088 *** num-nonmacro-input-events is the total number of input events
14089 received so far from the terminal. It does not count those generated
14090 by keyboard macros.
14091
14092 ** Frame-related changes
14093
14094 *** make-frame runs the normal hook before-make-frame-hook just before
14095 creating a frame, and just after creating a frame it runs the abnormal
14096 hook after-make-frame-functions with the new frame as arg.
14097
14098 *** The new hook window-configuration-change-hook is now run every time
14099 the window configuration has changed. The frame whose configuration
14100 has changed is the selected frame when the hook is run.
14101
14102 *** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
14103 selected buffers, in its buffer-list frame parameter, so that the
14104 value of other-buffer is now based on the buffers recently displayed
14105 in the selected frame.
14106
14107 *** The value of the frame parameter vertical-scroll-bars
14108 is now `left', `right' or nil. A non-nil value specifies
14109 which side of the window to put the scroll bars on.
14110
14111 ** X Windows features
14112
14113 *** You can examine X resources for other applications by binding
14114 x-resource-class around a call to x-get-resource. The usual value of
14115 x-resource-class is "Emacs", which is the correct value for Emacs.
14116
14117 *** In menus, checkboxes and radio buttons now actually work.
14118 The menu displays the current status of the box or button.
14119
14120 *** The function x-list-fonts now takes an optional fourth argument
14121 MAXIMUM which sets a limit on how many matching fonts to return.
14122 A smaller value of MAXIMUM makes the function faster.
14123
14124 If the only question is whether *any* font matches the pattern,
14125 it is good to supply 1 for this argument.
14126
14127 ** Subprocess features
14128
14129 *** A reminder: it is no longer necessary for subprocess filter
14130 functions and sentinels to do save-match-data, because Emacs does this
14131 automatically.
14132
14133 *** The new function shell-command-to-string executes a shell command
14134 and returns the output from the command as a string.
14135
14136 *** The new function process-contact returns t for a child process,
14137 and (HOSTNAME SERVICE) for a net connection.
14138
14139 ** An error in running pre-command-hook or post-command-hook
14140 does clear the variable to nil. The documentation was wrong before.
14141
14142 ** In define-key-after, if AFTER is t, the new binding now always goes
14143 at the end of the keymap. If the keymap is a menu, this means it
14144 goes after the other menu items.
14145
14146 ** If you have a program that makes several changes in the same area
14147 of the buffer, you can use the macro combine-after-change-calls
14148 around that Lisp code to make it faster when after-change hooks
14149 are in use.
14150
14151 The macro arranges to call the after-change functions just once for a
14152 series of several changes--if that seems safe.
14153
14154 Don't alter the variables after-change-functions and
14155 after-change-function within the body of a combine-after-change-calls
14156 form.
14157
14158 ** If you define an abbrev (with define-abbrev) whose EXPANSION
14159 is not a string, then the abbrev does not expand in the usual sense,
14160 but its hook is still run.
14161
14162 ** Normally, the Lisp debugger is not used (even if you have enabled it)
14163 for errors that are handled by condition-case.
14164
14165 If you set debug-on-signal to a non-nil value, then the debugger is called
14166 regardless of whether there is a handler for the condition. This is
14167 useful for debugging problems that happen inside of a condition-case.
14168
14169 This mode of operation seems to be unreliable in other ways. Errors that
14170 are normal and ought to be handled, perhaps in timers or process
14171 filters, will instead invoke the debugger. So don't say you weren't
14172 warned.
14173
14174 ** The new variable ring-bell-function lets you specify your own
14175 way for Emacs to "ring the bell".
14176
14177 ** If run-at-time's TIME argument is t, the action is repeated at
14178 integral multiples of REPEAT from the epoch; this is useful for
14179 functions like display-time.
14180
14181 ** You can use the function locate-library to find the precise file
14182 name of a Lisp library. This isn't new, but wasn't documented before.
14183
14184 ** Commands for entering view mode have new optional arguments that
14185 can be used from Lisp. Low-level entrance to and exit from view mode
14186 is done by functions view-mode-enter and view-mode-exit.
14187
14188 ** batch-byte-compile-file now makes Emacs return a nonzero status code
14189 if there is an error in compilation.
14190
14191 ** pop-to-buffer, switch-to-buffer-other-window and
14192 switch-to-buffer-other-frame now accept an additional optional
14193 argument NORECORD, much like switch-to-buffer. If it is non-nil,
14194 they don't put the buffer at the front of the buffer list.
14195
14196 ** If your .emacs file leaves the *scratch* buffer non-empty,
14197 Emacs does not display the startup message, so as to avoid changing
14198 the *scratch* buffer.
14199
14200 ** The new function regexp-opt returns an efficient regexp to match a string.
14201 The arguments are STRINGS and (optionally) PAREN. This function can be used
14202 where regexp matching or searching is intensively used and speed is important,
14203 e.g., in Font Lock mode.
14204
14205 ** The variable buffer-display-count is local to each buffer,
14206 and is incremented each time the buffer is displayed in a window.
14207 It starts at 0 when the buffer is created.
14208
14209 ** The new function compose-mail starts composing a mail message
14210 using the user's chosen mail composition agent (specified with the
14211 variable mail-user-agent). It has variants compose-mail-other-window
14212 and compose-mail-other-frame.
14213
14214 ** The `user-full-name' function now takes an optional parameter which
14215 can either be a number (the UID) or a string (the login name). The
14216 full name of the specified user will be returned.
14217
14218 ** Lisp packages that load files of customizations, or any other sort
14219 of user profile, should obey the variable init-file-user in deciding
14220 where to find it. They should load the profile of the user name found
14221 in that variable. If init-file-user is nil, meaning that the -q
14222 option was used, then Lisp packages should not load the customization
14223 files at all.
14224
14225 ** format-time-string now allows you to specify the field width
14226 and type of padding. This works as in printf: you write the field
14227 width as digits in the middle of a %-construct. If you start
14228 the field width with 0, it means to pad with zeros.
14229
14230 For example, %S normally specifies the number of seconds since the
14231 minute; %03S means to pad this with zeros to 3 positions, %_3S to pad
14232 with spaces to 3 positions. Plain %3S pads with zeros, because that
14233 is how %S normally pads to two positions.
14234
14235 ** thing-at-point now supports a new kind of "thing": url.
14236
14237 ** imenu.el changes.
14238
14239 You can now specify a function to be run when selecting an
14240 item from menu created by imenu.
14241
14242 An example of using this feature: if we define imenu items for the
14243 #include directives in a C file, we can open the included file when we
14244 select one of those items.
14245 \f
14246 * For older news, see the file ONEWS
14247
14248 ----------------------------------------------------------------------
14249 Copyright information:
14250
14251 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
14252
14253 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
14254 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
14255 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
14256 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.
14257
14258 Permission is granted to distribute modified versions
14259 of this document, or of portions of it,
14260 under the above conditions, provided also that they
14261 carry prominent notices stating who last changed them.
14262 \f
14263 Local variables:
14264 mode: outline
14265 paragraph-separate: "[ \f]*$"
14266 end:
14267
14268 arch-tag: 1aca9dfa-2ac4-4d14-bebf-0007cee12793